Sunteți pe pagina 1din 348

OWNER’S

MANUAL
Ateca
575012720BE
Inglés 575012720BE (11.17)

Ateca Inglés
­­ (11.17)
SEAT recommends SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL Castrol EDGE Professional
About this manual The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
For the sake of the environment

versions, and is only supplied as op- Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
This manual contains a description of the vant information concerning environmental
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the tional extras for some versions, or are
protection.
time this manual was published. Some of the only offered in certain countries.
units described herein will not be available ® All registered marks are indicated with
Note
until a later date or are only available in cer- ®. Although the copyright symbol does
tain markets. not appear, it is a copyrighted mark. Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
Because this is a general manual for the >> The section is continued on the follow-
ATECA, some of the equipment and functions ing page.
that are described in this manual are not in- This manual is divided into six large parts,
cluded in all types or variants of the model; Important warnings on a given page which are:
they may vary or be modified depending on Detailed contents on a given page 1. The essentials
the technical requirements and on the mar- 2. Safety
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising. General information on a given page
3. Emergencies
The illustrations are intended as a general Emergency information on a given page 4. Operation
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details. 5. Tips
WARNING
The steering indications (left, right, forward, 6. Technical data
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the mation on safety. They warn you about possi- At the end of this manual, there is a detailed SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex- ble dangers of accident or injury. alphabetical index that will help you quickly stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
cept when otherwise indicated. find the information you require. no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
The audiovisual material only is intended to CAUTION All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
help users to understand certain car function- or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
alities better. It does not replace the instruc- Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications. All rights on changes are reserved.

❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.


© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.17
Foreword
This Instruction Manual and its correspond- You can access the information in this man- Thank you for trusting in us.
ing supplements should be read carefully to ual using:
familiarise yourself with your vehicle. ● Thematic table of contents that follows the
We wish you safe and enjoya-
Besides the regular care and maintenance of manual’s general chapter structure. ble motoring.
the vehicle, its correct handling will help pre- ● Visual table of contents that uses graphics
serve its value. to indicate the pages containing “essential” SEAT, S.A.
For safety reasons, always note the informa- information, which is detailed in the corre-
tion concerning accessories, modifications sponding chapters.
and part replacements. ● Alphabetical index with many terms and
If selling the vehicle, give all of the on-board synonyms to help you find information.
documentation to the new owner, as it
WARNING
should be kept with the vehicle.
Read and always observe safety informa-
tion concerning the passenger's front air-
bag ››› page 90, Important information
regarding the front passenger's airbag.
Related videos

Always connected
››› page 123
www.seat.com/youtube-af/se326/fulllink
››› Booklet Navigation system

Smart solutions ››› page 237


››› page 249
www.seat.com/youtube-af/se326/blindspot ››› page 265

Lighting
››› page 144
www.seat.com/youtube-af/se326/fullled

Autonomous driving ››› page 221


››› page 233
www.seat.com/youtube-af/se326/stauassist ››› page 242

Hands-free
››› page 129
››› page 137
www.seat.com/youtube-af/se326/electricboot
Frequently Asked Ques- How do you change a wheel? ››› page 64 How do you check and adjust tyre pressure values?
››› page 308
tions How do you change a fuse? ››› page 61
Vehicle washing tips ››› page 285
How do you change a light? ››› page 62
Before driving
How do you tow a vehicle? ››› page 68 Functions of interest
How do you adjust the seat? ››› page 18
Easy Connect, CAR menu ››› page 33
Useful tips
How do you adjust the steering wheel? ››› page 20
How does the START-STOP system work? ››› page 208
How do you set the time? ››› page 115
How do you adjust the exterior mirrors? ››› page 20
What parking assistants are available? ››› page 262
When should the vehicle inspection should be per-
How do you turn on the exterior lights? ››› page 30
formed? ››› page 43 How does the rear assist work? ››› page 270
How does the automatic gearbox selector lever work?
What functions do the buttons/thumbwheels on the How does the adaptive cruise control work?
››› page 49
steering wheel perform? ››› page 121 ››› page 221
How do you refuel? ››› page 56
How do you remove the luggage compartment cover? How can the SEAT driving mode be adjusted?
How do you activate the windscreen wipers and wind- ››› page 167 ››› page 242
screen washer system? ››› page 32
How do you drive in an economical and environmental- How does the lane departure warning system work?
ly-friendly way? ››› page 201 ››› page 230
Emergency situations
How do you check and top up the engine oil? How does tyre pressure monitoring work? ››› page 312
A warning lamp lights up or flashes. What does this ››› page 57
mean? ››› page 46 How do you open the vehicle without a key (Keyless Ac-
How do you check and top up the engine coolant? cess)? ››› page 129
How do you open the bonnet? ››› page 17 ››› page 58
Interior lighting and ambient light ››› page 152
How do you perform a jump start? ››› page 69 How do you top up the windscreen washer fluid?
››› page 59
Where is the vehicle tool kit located? ››› page 64
How do you check and top up the brake fluid?
How do you repair a tyre with the anti-puncture kit? ››› page 59
››› page 63
Table of Contents

Table of Contents How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


Changing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
69
71
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
The essentials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
7 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Instruments and warning/control lamps . . . . . 114
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Safety first! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Driver-side general instrument panel (left- Control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Advice about driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Introduction to the Easy Connect system* . . . . 120
Correct position of the vehicle occupants . . . . 74
Driver-side general instrument panel (right- System settings (CAR)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Pedal area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Communications and multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Centre console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Controls on the steering wheel* . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Why wear a seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Passenger-side general instrument panel (left- Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
How to properly adjust your seatbelt . . . . . . . . 82
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Passenger-side general instrument panel Central locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
(right-hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Anti-theft alarm system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Brief introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Rear lid (luggage compartment) . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Airbag safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
How it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Controls for the windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Deactivating airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Sunroof* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Transporting children safely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Before driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Safety for children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Windscreen wiper and window wiper sys-
Description and operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 tems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Driver information System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Self-help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Seats and head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Vehicle tool kit, anti-puncture kit* . . . . . . . . . . 95 Adjusting the seats and headrests . . . . . . . . . . 156
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Tyre repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Seat functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Manual unlocking/locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Transport and practical equipment . . . . . . . . . 160
Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Changing the windscreen wiper blades . . . . . . 97 Storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Tow-starting and towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Storing objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Fluid Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Fuses and bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Roof carrier* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Heating, ventilation and cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Change the front bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Auxiliary heater (additional heater)* . . . . . . . . 177
Action in the event of a puncture . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Change the rear bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Side turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Starting and stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Braking and parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192

5
Table of Contents

Automatic gearbox/DSG automatic gear- Vehicle exterior care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285


box* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 Caring for the vehicle interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Checking and refilling levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Run-in and economical driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Engine management and exhaust gas purifica- AdBlue® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
tion system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Driver assistance systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Start-Stop System* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Hill Descent Control (HDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Auto Hold Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Cruise control system (CCS)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
Speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
Emergency brake assist system (Front As- Tyre monitoring systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
sist)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Temporary spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Adaptive Cruise Control ACC* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Winter service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
Lane Assist system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Traffic Jam Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Blind spot detector (BSD) with parking assis- Important . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
tance (RCTA)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Vehicle identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
SEAT Drive Profile* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Information on fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . 318
Traffic sign detection system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Fatigue detection (break recommendation)* . . 248 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Park Assist* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Parking System Plus (ParkPilot)* . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
Parking aid (Park Pilot)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
Top View Camera* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Rear Assist (Rear View Camera)* . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Towing bracket device* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Care and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Accessories and modifications to the vehi-
cle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
6
The essentials

Exterior view

1 ››› page 16 5 ››› page 68


2 ››› page 56 6 ››› page 17
3 ››› page 15 7 ››› page 62
4 ››› page 56
7
The essentials

Exterior view

1 ››› page 58 5 ››› page 57 9 ››› page 29


2 ››› page 57 6 ››› page 59 10 ››› page 64
3 ››› page 59 7 ››› page 59 11 ››› page 63
4 ››› page 61 8 ›››  page 165
8
The essentials

Driver-side general instrument panel (left-hand drive)

1 ››› page 31 5 ››› page 20 8 ››› page 46 11 ››› page 30


2 ››› page 44 6 ››› page 18 9 ››› page 32 12 ››› page 20
3 ››› page 15 7 ››› page 17 10 ››› page 36 13 ››› page 61
4 ››› page 30

9
The essentials

Driver-side general instrument panel (right-hand drive)

1 ››› page 32 4 ››› page 30 7 ››› page 46 10 ››› page 20


2 ››› page 36 5 ››› page 20 8 ››› page 31 11 ››› page 30
3 ››› page 15 6 ››› page 18 9 ››› page 44

10
The essentials

Centre console

1 ››› page 49 3 ››› page 33 5 ››› page 51, ››› page 53


2 ›››  page 183 4 ››› page 31
The layout in right-hand drive vehicles is symmetrical.

11
The essentials

Passenger-side general instrument panel (left-hand drive)

1 ››› page 21
2 ›››  page 161

12
The essentials

Passenger-side general instrument panel (right-hand drive)

1 ››› page 21
2 ››› page 61
3 ››› page 17
4 ›››  page 161
13
The essentials

Interior view

1 ››› page 19 5 ››› page 26


2 ››› page 19 6 ›››  page 164
3 ››› page 18 7 ››› page 18
4 ›››  page 155 8 ››› page 22
14
The essentials

How it works Locking and unlocking the vehicle using the


key
Unlocking or locking of driver door

● Locking: press the  ››› Fig. 1 button.


Unlocking and locking
● Locking the vehicle without activating the
Doors anti-theft system: Press the  ››› Fig. 1 button
for a second time within 2 seconds.
● Unlocking: press the  ››› Fig. 1 button.
● Unlocking the rear lid: Hold down the 
››› Fig. 1 button for at least 1 second.

Locking and unlocking with the central lock-


ing switch Fig. 3 Driver door lever: hidden lock cylinder.
● Locking: press the  ››› Fig. 2 button. None
of the doors can be opened from the outside. If the central locking system should fail to op-
The doors can be opened from the inside by erate, the driver door can still be locked and
pulling the inside door handle. unlocked by turning the key in the lock.
Fig. 1 Remote control key: buttons.
● Unlocking: press the  ››› Fig. 2 button. As a general rule, when the driver door is
locked manually all other doors are locked.
When it is unlocked manually, only the driver
 ››› in Description on page 125 door opens. Please observe the instructions
relating to the anti-theft alarm system
 ››› page 125 ›››  page 125.
● Unfold the vehicle key blade
 ››› page 15, ››› page 16 ›››  page 126.
● Insert the key shaft into the lower opening
in the cover on the driver door handle
››› Fig. 3 (arrow) then remove the cover up-
Fig. 2 Driver door: central locking switch. wards.
● Insert the key blade into the lock cylinder
to unlock or lock the vehicle. »

15
The essentials

Special Characteristics If the central locking system should fail to


● The anti-theft alarm will remain active when work at any time, doors with no lock cylinder
vehicles are unlocked. However, the alarm will have to be locked separately.
will not be triggered ›››  page 125. A mechanical locking device (only visible
● After the driver door is opened, you have when the door is open) is provided on the
15 seconds to switch on the ignition. Once front passenger door.
this time has elapsed, the alarm is triggered.
● Pull the cap out of the opening.
● Switch the ignition on. The electronic im-
● Insert the key in the inside slot and turn it
mobilizer recognises a valid vehicle key and
to the right as far as it will go (if the door is
deactivates the anti-theft alarm system.
on the right side) or to the left (if the door is Fig. 6 Rear lid: button to close rear lid.
on the left side).
Note
The rear lid opening system operates electri-
The anti-theft alarm is not activated when the Once the door has been closed it can no lon- cally*. It is activated by exerting slight pres-
vehicle is locked manually using the key ger be opened from the outside. Pull the inte- sure on the handle ››› Fig. 5.
shaft ›››  page 125. rior door handle once to unlock and open the
door. To lock/unlock, press the button  or button
 ››› Fig. 1 on the remote control key.

Emergency locking of doors without A warning appears on the instrument panel


door cylinder Rear lid display if the rear lid is open or not properly
closed.* An audible warning is also given if it
is opened while the vehicle is moving faster
than 6 km/h (4 mph)*.

Opening and closing


● Opening the rear lid: Exert slight pressure
on the handle. The rear lid opens automati-
cally.
● Closing the rear lid: hold one of the han-
dles on the inner trim and close it by sliding
down, or press the button on the rear lid*
Fig. 4 Locking the door manually. Fig. 5 Rear lid: handle ››› Fig. 6.

16
The essentials

››› Bonnet
 in Rear lid automatic locking on
page 139

 ››› page 137

 ››› page 17

Manual release mechanism for the


rear lid Fig. 8 Luggage compartment: emergency re-
lease.
Fig. 9 Release lever in the driver's footwell
The rear lid can be unlocked manually from area.
inside in the event of an emergency.
● Remove the cover using the key blade as a
lever ››› Fig. 7.
● To unlock the rear lid, push the lever in the
direction of the arrow using the key blade
››› Fig. 8.

Fig. 7 Luggage compartment: access to man-


ual release.

Fig. 10 Cam under the bonnet

● Opening the bonnet: Pull the lever under


the dashboard ››› Fig. 9 1 .
● Lift up the bonnet. Press the release catch
under the bonnet upwards ››› Fig. 10 2 . The
arrester hook under the bonnet is released. »
17
The essentials

● The bonnet can be opened. Release the 4 Window on the rear right door
bonnet stay and secure it in the fixture de-
signed for this in the bonnet.
5 Safety switch for deactivating the electric
window buttons in the rear doors.
 ››› in Introduction on page 141

›››  ››› page 141

 in Working in the engine compart-


ment on page 299  ››› in Electric opening and closing of
windows on page 140

 ››› page 298


 ››› page 139 Before driving
Manually adjusting the front seats
*Controls for the windows Panoramic roof*

Fig. 13 Front seats: manual seat adjustment.


Fig. 11 Detail of the driver door: controls for Fig. 12 On the interior roof lining: sunroof
the windows. 1 Forward/back: pull the lever and move
button.
the seat forwards or backwards.
● Opening the window: Press the  button. ● Opening: press button C backwards. 2 Raising/lowering: pull/push the lever.
● Closing the window: Pull the  button. ● Closing: press button D forwards. 3 Tilting the backrest: turn the hand wheel.
● To tilt open: press the rear part of button 4 Lumbar support: move the lever until the
Buttons on the driver door
B . required position is achieved.
1 Window on the front left door ● Lowering: press the front part of button A .
›››
2
3
Window on the front right door
Window on the rear left door
 in Manual adjustment of the seats
on page 156

18
The essentials

Electric adjustment of the driver's Adjusting the head restraints Adjustment of the seat belt
seat*

Fig. 15 Front seat: adjustment of the head re-


Fig. 14 Driver's seat: electric seat adjust- straint.
ment.
● Grab the sides of the head restraints with
A Adjusting the lumbar support: press the both hands and push upwards to the desired
button according to the desired position. position. To lower it, repeat the same action,
B Seat up/down: Press the button pressing the 1 button on the side.
up/down. To adjust the front of the seat
›››
cushion, press the front of the button
up/down. To adjust the rear of the seat  in Correct adjustment of front head
restraints on page 77
cushion, press the rear of the button Fig. 16 Positioning and removing the seat
up/down.
Seat forwards/backwards: press the but-
 ››› page 77, ››› page 157 belt buckle. »
ton forwards/backwards.
C Backrest further upright/further reclined:
press the button forwards/backwards.

›››
 in Electric driver's seat adjustment*
on page 157

19
The essentials

Seat belt tensioners L/R Turning the knob to the desired posi-
tion, adjust the mirrors on the driver
During a collision, the seat belts on the front side (L, left) and the passenger side (R,
seats and side rear seats1) tighten automati- right) to the direction desired.
cally.  Depending on the equipment fitted on
The tensioner can be triggered only once. the vehicle, the mirrors may be heated
according to the outside temperature.
›››
 in Maintenance and disposal of belt
tensioners on page 84
 Folding in mirrors.

›››
Fig. 17 Correct seat belt and head restraint
positions, viewed from front and the side.
 ››› page 83  in Adjusting the exterior rear-view
mirrors on page 156

To adjust the seat belt around your should-  ››› page 155

ers, adjust the height of the seats. Adjusting the exterior mirrors
The shoulder part of the seat belt should be
well centred over it, never over the neck. The Adjusting the steering wheel
seat belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the
upper part of the body.
The lap part of the seat belt lies across the
pelvis, never across the stomach. The seat
belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the pel-
vis.

 ››› page 80
Fig. 18 Detail of the driver door: control for
the exterior mirror.
 ››› page 82
Adjusting the exterior mirrors: Turn the knob
Fig. 19 Lever in the lower left side of the
steering column.
to the corresponding position:

1) Depending on version/market.
20
The essentials

● Adjusting the position of the steering Airbags


wheel: Pull the ››› Fig. 19 1 lever down,
move the steering wheel to the desired posi-
Front airbags
tion and lift the lever back up until it locks.

›››
 in Adjusting the steering wheel po-
sition on page 75

Fig. 21 Front passenger airbag located in


dash panel.

The front airbag for the driver is located in


the steering wheel ››› Fig. 20 and the airbag
Fig. 20 Driver airbag located in steering
for the front passenger is located in the dash
wheel.
panel ››› Fig. 21. Airbags are identified by the
word “AIRBAG”.
When the driver and front passenger airbags
are deployed, the covers remain attached to
the steering wheel and dashboard, respec-
tively ››› Fig. 20 ››› Fig. 21.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the front
airbag system gives the front occupants ad-
ditional protection for the head and chest in »
21
The essentials

the event of a severe frontal collision ››› in ›››


Front airbags on page 86.  in Activation and deactivation of
front passenger airbag* on page 89
Their special design allows the controlled es-
cape of the propellant gas when an occupant
puts pressure on the bag. Thus, the head and
 ››› page 88

chest are protected by the airbag. After the


collision, the airbag deflates sufficiently to
allow visibility.

 ››› page 86
Fig. 23 Dash panel: control lamp for deactiva-
ted front passenger airbag in centre console.

To deactivate the front passenger front air-


Deactivating the front passenger front bag:
airbag ● Switch the ignition off.
● Open the door on the front passenger side.
● Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
deactivating the front passenger airbag
››› Fig. 22. About 3/4 of the key should enter;
this is as far as it will go.
● Turn the key gently to the  position. If
you have difficulty, ensure that you have in-
serted the key as far as it will go.
● Close the front passenger door.

Fig. 22 Front passenger front airbag switch.


● Check, with the ignition switched on, that
the   control lamp remains lit where it
says      in the centre of the
dash panel ››› Fig. 23.

22
The essentials

Knee airbag* it is deployed. Objects should never be The side airbags are located in the driver's
placed or mounted in this area. seat and front passenger seat backrests
››› Fig. 26. The locations are identified by the
text “AIRBAG” in the upper region of the
 ››› page 86
backrests.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the side
airbag system provides additional protection
Side airbags* for the upper body in the event of a severe
side collision ››› in Side airbags* on
page 86.
In a side collision, the side airbags reduce
the risk of injury to passengers to the areas
Fig. 24 On the driver side: location of the
knee airbag of the body facing the impact. In addition to
their normal protection, the seat belts also
hold the passengers in the event of a side
collision; this is how these airbags provide
maximum protection.

Fig. 26 Side airbag in driver's seat.  ››› page 86

Fig. 25 On the driver side: radius of action of


the knee airbag.

The knee airbag is located on the driver side


below the dash panel ››› Fig. 24. Airbags are
identified by the word “AIRBAG”.
The area framed in red (deployment area) Fig. 27 Illustration of completely inflated side
››› Fig. 25 is covered by the knee airbag when airbags on the left side of the vehicle.
23
The essentials

Head-protection airbags* Child seats


Important information regarding the
front passenger's airbag

Fig. 28 Location of head-protection airbags.

The head-protection airbags are located on


both sides in the interior above the doors
››› Fig. 28 and are identified with the text
“AIRBAG”.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the head-
protection airbag system gives the vehicle
occupants additional protection for the head Fig. 30 Airbag stickers - version 2: on the
and upper body in the event of a severe side passenger-side sun blind  and on the rear
collision ››› in Curtain airbags* on frame of the front passenger's door .
page 87.
A sticker with important information about
the passenger airbag is located on the pas-
 ››› in Curtain airbags* on page 87 Fig. 29 Airbag stickers - version 1: on the
passenger-side sun blind  and on the rear
senger's sun visor and/or on the passenger
side door frame.
frame of the front passenger's door .
›››
 in Important information regarding
the front passenger's airbag on page 91

 ››› page 90

24
The essentials

Securing child seats

Fig. 31 On the rear seats: Possible installations


for the child seat.

Figure ››› Fig. 31 A shows the basic child re- passenger seat in its rearmost and highest perfect position, adjust the passenger back-
straint system mounting using lower retain- position1). rest as far forward as possible1).
ing rings and the upper retaining strap. Fig-
To correctly use a child seat in the back, the If a semi-universal type chair is to be instal-
ure ››› Fig. 31 B shows the child restraint
front backrest must be adjusted so that there led, in which the method of attachment to
system mounting using the vehicle seat belt.
is no contact with the child seat in the back the car is through the seat belt and support
The seat belt may be used to secure univer- in the case that it goes opposite to the direc- bracket, it should never be installed in the
sal type child seats to the vehicle seats tion of the car. In the case of front facing re- central rear seat as the ground clearance is
marked with a U in the table below. straint systems, the front backrest must be lower than in other places and the support
adjusted so that there is no contact with the bracket will not allow the seat to remain suffi-
● In a front passenger seat without height ad- child's feet. ciently stable.
justment: It is necessary to place the front
passenger seat in its rearmost position 1). To adjust the passenger seat to accommo- The systems include the child restraint sys-
date a child's seat and get the seat belt in a tem mounting with an upper retaining strap
● In a front passenger seat with height ad-
(Top Tether) and lower anchoring points on
justment: it is necessary to place the front »
the seat.

1) Compliance with current national legislation and

the manufacturer's instructions is required when us-


ing or installing child seats.
25
The essentials

Seating position

Weight group Front passenger seata) Rear side seat Rear central seatb)

airbag on airbag off


Group 0 to 10 kg X Uc) U U

Group 0+ to 13 kg X Uc) U U

Group I 9 to 18 kg X Uc) U U

Group II 15 to 25 kg X UFc) UF UF

Group III 22 to 36 kg X UFc) UF UF

X: It is not compatible to install chairs in this configuration.


U: Suitable for universal restraint systems for use in this weight group.
UF: Acceptable for front-facing universal-category child restraint systems approved for this mass group.
a) Compliance with current national legislation and the manufacturer's instructions is required when using or installing child seats.
b) For semi-universal chairs where the securing system is the car safety belt and the support bracket, do not use them in the centre rear seat.
c) Seats without height adjustment should be placed in their rearmost position. Seats with height adjustment should be placed in their rearmost and highest position.

 ››› in Safety instructions on page 91

Securing child seats with “ISOFIX” and Top Tether*


Child seats can be secured quickly, easily FIX” rings are located between the rear seat To understand the compatibility of the "ISO-
and safely on the rear outer seats with the backrest and the seat cushioning ››› Fig. 32. FIX" systems in the vehicle, consult the table
“ISOFIX” and Top Tether* system. The Top Tether* rings are located on the rear below.
part of the backrests of the rear seats (be-
Two “ISOFIX” retaining rings are fitted on The body weight permitted and information
hind the seat backrest or in the boot)
each rear seat. In some vehicles, the rings regarding sizes A to F is indicated on the la-
are secured to the seat frame and, in others,
››› Fig. 33. bel on child seats with “universal” or “semi-
they are secured to the rear floor. The “ISO- universal” certification.
26
The essentials

Vehicle Isofix positions


Electrical equip-
Weight group Size class Front passenger seat
ment Rear side seat Rear central seat
airbag on airbag off
F ISO/L1 X X X X
Baby carrier
G ISO/L2 X X X X

Group 0 to 10 kg E ISO/R1 X X IL X

E ISO/R1 X X IL X

Group 0+ to 13 kg D ISO/R2 X X IL X

C ISO/R3 X X IL X

D ISO/R2 X X IL X

C ISO/R3 X X IL X

Group I 9 to 18 kg B ISO/F2 X X IUF/IL X

B1 ISO/F2X X X IUF/IL X

A ISO/F3 X X IUF/IL X

Group II 15 to 25 kg --- --- --- ---

Group III 22 to 36 kg --- --- --- ---

IUF: Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX universal child restraint systems approved for use in this mass group.
IL: Suitable for certain ISOFIX child restraint systems (CRSs) listed in the attached list. This relates to ISOFIX CRSs that can be for the specific vehicle, restricted or semi-universal
categories.
: ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems for this weight group or size class.

 ››› in Safety instructions on page 91

27
The essentials

Securing child seats with the “ISOFIX/i-Size” ISOFIX System


You are obliged to follow the seat manufac- Child seats with the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether*
turer's instructions. attachment system are available from Techni-
cal Services.
● Press the child seat onto the “ISOFIX” re-
taining rings ››› Fig. 32 until the child seat is
heard to engage securely. If the child seat is
equipped with Top Tether* anchor points, se-
cure it to the correspondent ring ››› Fig. 33.
Observe the manufacturer's instructions.
● Pull on both sides of the child seat to en-
sure that it is properly anchored.
Fig. 32 ISOFIX/iSize securing rings.

Vehicle i-Size positions

Front passenger seat


Rear side seat Rear central seat
airbag on airbag off
Child restraint system approved under ECE R129 X X i-U X

i-U Valid position for front-facing and rear-facing child restraint systems approved under ECE R129.
X: Invalid position for child restraint systems approved under ECE R129.

28
The essentials

Securing child seats with the Top Securing the Top Tether* to the an- structions of the chair itself, lift or remove the
Tether* retaining straps chorage point head restraint if necessary).
● Slide the strap and secure it properly with
the anchorage of the backrest ››› Fig. 33.
● Firmly tighten the strap following the manu-
facturer's instructions.

Releasing the retaining strap


● Loosen the strap following the manufactur-
er's instructions.
● Push the lock and release it from the an-
choring support.
Fig. 33 Position of the Top Tether rings on the
back of the rear seat.
 ››› in Safety instructions on page 91

Child seats with the Top Tether system come


with a strap for securing the seat to the vehi-
cle anchor point, located at the back of the
rear seat backrest and provide greater re-
straint.
The objective of this strap is to reduce for-
ward movements of the child seat in a crash,
to reduce the risk of injuries to the head from Fig. 34 Retainer strap: adjustment and as-
hitting the inside of the vehicle. sembly according to the Top Tether belt.

Using the Top Tether in rear-facing mounted Securing the retainer strap
seats ● Follow the manufacturer's instructions to
Currently, there are very few rear-facing child deploy the child seat Top Tether retainer
safety seats that have Top Tether. Please strap.
carefully read and follow the seat manufac- ● Place the belt under the head restraint of
turer instructions to learn the proper way to the back seat ››› Fig. 34 (depending on the in-
install the Top Tether strap.
29
The essentials

Starting the vehicle Turning on/switching off the ignition, glow Lights and visibility
plugs reheating
Ignition lock ● Switch ignition on: Turn the key to the 2 Light switch
position.
● Switch ignition off. Turn the key to the 1
position.
● Diesel vehicles : The glow plugs reheat
when the ignition is switched on.

Starting the engine


● Manual gearbox: press the clutch pedal all
the way down and move the gearbox lever in-
to neutral.
Fig. 35 Ignition key positions. ● Automatic gearbox: Press the brake pedal Fig. 36 Dash panel: light control.
and move the selector lever to the P position
Switch ignition on: Place the key in the igni- or into N. ● Turn the switch to the required position
tion and start the engine. ● Turn the key to the 3 position. The key au- ››› Fig. 36.
tomatically returns to the 2 position. Do not
Locking and unlocking the steering wheel press the accelerator. Sym- Ignition switched Ignition is
● Engaging the steering wheel lock: Remove bol off switched on
the key from the ignition and turn the wheel Start-Stop System* Fog lights, dipped
until it locks. Depending on the country, in Daylight running
When you stop and release the clutch pedal,  beam and side lights
lights switched on.
vehicles with an automatic gearbox, to re- the Start-Stop system* turns off the engine. off.
move the key the gear lever must be in the P The ignition remains switched on. The “Coming home”, Automatic control of
position. If necessary, press the locking key “Leaving home” and dipped beam and
on the selector lever and release it again. ››› in Switching the ignition on and  Welcome lights may daytime running
● Unlocking the steering wheel: Put the key
into the ignition and turn it at the same time
 starting the engine with the key on
page 182
be switched on. light.

Daylight running
as the steering wheel in the direction indica-  Side light on.
ted by the arrow. If it is not possible to turn
the steering wheel, it may be because it is
 ››› page 181
Dipped beam head-
lights switched on.

Dipped beam
 light off switched on.
locked.
30
The essentials

 Front fog lights: move the switch to the 2 Left turn signal: Left-hand parking light ● In an emergency
first position, from positions ,  or . (ignition switched off). ● The vehicle has broken down
 Rear fog light: move the switch completely 3 Main beam switched on: Control lamp  ● When towing or being towed
from positions ,  or . lit up on the instrument panel.
Headlight flasher: lit up when the lever is ›››
● Switching off fog lights: Push the switch or
turn it to the  position.
4
pushed. Control lamp  lit up.  in Hazard warning lights  on
page 150

›››
Lever all the way down to switch it off.
 ››› page 149
 in Side light and dipped beam head-
light on page 144 ›››
 in Turn signal and main beam lever
on page 145
 ››› page 144 Interior lights
 ››› page 145

Turn signal and main beam lever


Hazard warning lights

Fig. 39 Detail of headliner: front interior light-


ing.

Knob Function
Fig. 37 Turn signal and main beam lever.
Fig. 38 Dash panel: switch for hazard warn-  Switches interior lights off.
More the lever to the required position: ing lights.
 Switches interior lights on. »
1 Right turn signal: Right-hand parking Switched on, for example:
light (ignition switched off).
● When approaching a traffic jam

31
The essentials

Knob Function Windscreen wipers and window wiper More the lever to the required position:
blade
Door contact switch-on. 2  Slow wipe.
The interior lights come on automati-
Central position
cally when the vehicle is unlocked, a 3  Continuous wipe.
door is opened or the key is removed
or from the ignition. Short wipe. Brief press, short clean. Hold
a) The light goes off a few seconds af- 4  the lever down for more time to increase
ter all the doors are closed, the vehi- the wipe frequency.
cle is locked or the ignition is switch-
ed on. Automatic wipe. The windscreen washer
function is activated by pushing the lever
 Turning the reading light on and off
5  forwards, and simultaneously the wind-
screen wipers start.
a) Depending on version.
Interval wipe for rear window. The wiper
Ambient light*: light guide on door panel. Fig. 40 Operating the windscreen wiper and 6  will wipe the window approximately every
Lighting can be selected from 8 possible col- rear wiper. six seconds.
ours via the  menu and the SETTINGS func-
The rear window wash function is activa-
tion button. More the lever to the required position: 7  ted by pressing the lever, and the rear
wiper starts simultaneously.
 Windscreen wiper off.

0
››› page 152

1 
Windscreen wipers interval wipe.
Using the control ››› Fig. 40 A adjust the
interval (vehicles without rain sensor), or
 ››› page 153

the sensitivity of the rain sensor.


 ››› page 71

32
The essentials

Easy Connect
CAR menu settings

Fig. 41 Easy Connect: Main menu. Fig. 42 Easy Connect: CAR menu.

The actual number of menus available and or, press the Infotainment button  to go to Pressing the menu button  will always take
the name of the various options will depend the Vehicle menu ››› Fig. 42. you to the last menu used.
on the vehicle’s electronics and equipment. ● Press the SETTINGS function button to open Any changes made using the settings menus
● Switch the ignition on. the Vehicle settings menu. are automatically saved on closing those me-
● To select a function in the menu, press the nus.
● If the Infotainment System is off, switch it
on. desired button.
● Press the Infotainment button  and When the function button check box is activa-
then the Vehicle function button ››› Fig. 41, ted , the function is active.

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description


Activation and deactivation of the traction control system (ASR) and the electronic sta-
ESC system – bility control (ESC) system, selecting the Sport / Off-road* mode of the electronic sta- ››› page 189
bility control (ESC Sport)

Tyre pressure monitoring Tyre pressure storing (Calibration) ››› page 311
Tyres
Winter tyres Activation and deactivation of the speed warning, adjusting the speed warning value ››› page 315 »
33
The essentials

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description


Dynamic Light Assist, Light Assist, motorway function, turning-on time, headlamp
Light assist ››› page 144
range adjustment, automatic lights when raining, one-touch signalling, travel mode.

Lights Vehicle interior lighting Brightness of instrument panel and controls ››› page 151

Coming Home/Leaving Home function Switch-on time of the “Coming home” and “Leaving home” functions
››› page 148
››› page 149
ACC (adaptive cruise control) Activation and deactivation: default distance level, driving profiles. ››› page 221
Front Assist (emergency brake as-
sist system)
Activation and deactivation: Front Assist, advance warning, distance warning display ››› page 217

Lane Assist (system warning you


if you leave the lane)
Activation and deactivation of lane departure warning, adaptive lane guidance ››› page 230
Driver assistance
Detection of traffic signs Display on the instrument panel, activation and deactivation of the speed warning ››› page 245
Trailer recognition (display of traffic signs for vehicles with trailer), use to calculate the
Trailer
route, maximum speed for trailer
››› page 273

Fatigue detection Activation and deactivation ››› page 248

ParkPilot
Automatic activation, front volume, front sound treble, rear volume, rear sound treble, ››› page 257,
adjust Infotainment volume ››› page 262
Auto Hold Switching on and off when starting off ››› page 211
Parking and ma-
noeuvring
Electric parking brake Switching on and off automatically ››› page 186
Braking while manoeuvring func-
tion
Switching on and off ››› page 262

Displaying the parking space Switching on and off

Ambient lighting – Switching on and off, selecting brightness, colour, area or total ››› page 152

34
The essentials

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description

Mirrors
Synchronised regulation, lower the rear-view mirror when reversing, fold in after park- ››› page 20,
Mirrors and wind-
ing, rear-view mirror heating, dim in the dark ››› page 155
screen wipers
Activate and deactivate automatic windscreen wipers in case of rain, wipe when re-
Windscreen wipers
versing
››› page 32

Convenience opening, automatic closure in case of rain, automatic closure with cen-
Electric windows control
tral locking
››› page 140
Opening and clos-
ing Unlocking doors, automatic lock/unlock when driving, “Easy Open” audible confirma-
Central locking system tion, “Easy Entry” convenient entry function, automatic opening of the rear lid, interior ››› page 125
monitoring

Current consumption, average consumption, volume to refuel, convenience consum-


ers, ECO Advice, travelling time, distance travelled, average speed, digital speed dis-
Instrument panel – ››› page 36
play, speed warning, oil temperature, coolant temperature, reset data “when setting
off”, reset data for “total calculation”, traffic signal detection

Date and time – Time source, time, select time zone, time format, date, date format –

Distance, speed, temperature, volume, fuel consumption, GNC consumption, electric


Units – –
consumption, pressure

Service – Chassis number, date of next SEAT service inspection, date of next oil change service ››› page 43
All Restore all settings –
Factory settings
Lights, driver assistance, parking and manoeuvring, background lighting, rear view
Individual –
mirrors and windscreen wipers, opening and closing, instrument panel

 ››› in CAR menu on page 120

35
The essentials

Driver information System ■ MFD from refuelling Using the menus on the instrument
■ MFD total calculation panel
Introduction Assist systems ››› page 39

With the ignition switched on, it is possible Navigation ››› Booklet Navigation system
to read the different functions of the display Audio ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Booklet Naviga-
by scrolling through the menus. tion system
In vehicles with multifunction steering wheel, Telephone ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Booklet
the multifunction display can only be operat- Navigation system
ed with the steering wheel buttons.
Vehicle status ››› page 33
The number of menus displayed on the in-
strument panel will vary according to the ve- WARNING
hicle electronics and equipment. Fig. 43 Windscreen wiper lever: control but-
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
A specialised workshop will be able to pro- tons.
the risk of injury.
gramme or modify additional functions, ac- ● Do not operate the instrument panel con-
cording to the vehicle equipment. SEAT rec- trols when driving.
ommends visiting a SEAT Official Service.
Some menu options can only be read when
the vehicle is at a standstill.
As long as a priority 1 warning is displayed, it
will not be possible to read the menus
››› page 40. Some warning messages can
be confirmed and made to disappear with the
windscreen wiper lever button or the multi-
function steering wheel button. Fig. 44 Right side of multifunction steering
wheel: control buttons.
The information system also provides the fol-
lowing information and displays (depending
The driver information system is controlled
on the vehicle's equipment):
with the multifunction steering wheel buttons
Driving data ››› page 38 ››› Fig. 44 or with the windscreen wiper lever
■ MFD from departure
››› Fig. 43 (if the vehicle is not equipped with
multifunction steering wheel).
36
The essentials

Enabling the main menu Making changes according to the menu in the Assist systems menu
● Switch the ignition on. ● With the rocker switch on the windscreen ›››  page 208.
● If a message or vehicle pictogram appears, wiper lever or the thumbwheel of the multi-
function steering wheel, make the desired Activate or deactivate a driver assistance
press button ››› Fig. 43 1 on the windscreen system
wiper lever or button  on the multifunction changes. To increase or decrease the values
steering wheel ››› Fig. 44. more quickly, turn the thumbwheel faster. ● Briefly press the button ››› Fig. 45 in the di-
● Mark or confirm the selection with button rection of the arrow to open the menu As-
● If managed from the windscreen wiper lev-
››› Fig. 43 1on the windscreen wiper lever sist systems.
er: to display the main screen or to return to
the main menu from another menu, hold or button  on the multifunction steering ● Select the driver assistance system and ac-
down the rocker button ››› Fig. 43 2 . wheel ››› Fig. 44. tivate or deactivate it ››› page 36. A mark indi-
cates that driver assistance system is switch-
● If managed from the multifunction steering
ed on.
wheel: the main menu list is not displayed.
To go from point to point in the main menu, Button for the driver assistance sys-
press button   or   several times tems*
››› Fig. 44. Selection menu

Select a submenu Menu Function


● Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 43 2 on the Information and possible configurations
Driving
windscreen wiper lever up or down or turn data
of the multifunction display (MFD)
the thumbwheel of the multifunction steering ››› page 38.
wheel ››› Fig. 44 until the desired option ap- Information and possible configurations
pears marked on the menu. Assist
of the driver assistance systems
systems
● The selected option is displayed between ››› page 39, ››› page 33.
two horizontal lines. In addition, a triangle is Information instructions from the activa-
displayed on the right:  Fig. 45 On the turn signal and main beam ted navigation system: when a route guid-
● To consult the submenu option, press but- headlight lever: button for the driver assis- ance is activated, the turning arrows and
proximity bars are displayed. The appear-
ton ››› Fig. 43 1 on the windscreen wiper tance systems
Naviga- ance is similar to the Easy Connect sys-
lever or button  on the multifunction steer- tion tem.
ing wheel ››› Fig. 44. With the turn signal and main beam head- If route guidance is not activated, the di-
light lever button, you can activate or deacti- rection of travel (compass) and the name
vate the driver assistance systems displayed of the street along which you are driving
are shown ››› Booklet Navigation system. »
37
The essentials

Menu Function from departure, MFD from refuelling and MFD Menu Function
total calculation. On the screen display, you
Station display on the radio. can read which memory is currently dis- The memory records the values for a
Track name on the CD. played. specific number of partial trips, up to a
Audio
Track name in Media mode ››› Booklet Ra- total of 19 hours and 59 minutes or 99
dio or ››› Booklet Navigation system. MFD total hours and 59 minutes, or 1999.9 km or
● Toggle between memories with the ignition calcula- 9999 km, depending on the model of
Information and possible configurations on and the memory displayed: Press the tion instrument panel. On reaching either of
Tele- of the mobile phone preinstallation  button on the windscreen wiper lever these limitsa), the memory is automati-
phone ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Booklet Navigation cally erased and starts to count from 0
or the  button of the multifunction steering
system. again.
wheel.
Display of the current warning or informa- a) It varies according to the instrument panel version.
Vehicle tion texts and other system components, Menu Function
status depending on the equipment
››› page 120. Erasing a memory manually
Display and storage of the values for
the journey and the consumption from ● Select the memory that you wish to erase.
when the ignition is switched on to
● Hold the  button of the multifunction
when it is switched off.
Driving data If the journey is continued in less than steering wheel or the  button of the multi-
MFD from
2 hours after the ignition is switched function wheel pressed down for about 2 sec-
departure
The MFD (multifunction display) shows differ- off, the new data is added to the data onds.
ent values for the journey and the consump- already stored in the memory. The
memory will automatically be deleted if
tion. Personalising the displays
the journey is interrupted for more than
2 hours. In the Easy Connect system you can adjust
Changing between display modes on the which of the possible displays of the MFD can
MFD Display and storage of the values for
MFD from the journey and the consumption. By be shown on the instrument panel display
● In vehicles without multifunction steering refuelling refuelling, the memory will be erased with the  button and the SETTINGS function
wheel: Press the rocker switch  on the automatically. button ›››  page 120.
windscreen wiper lever ››› Fig. 43.
● Vehicles with a multifunction steering
wheel: turn the thumbwheel ››› Fig. 44.

Multifunction display memory


The multifunction display is equipped with
three memories that work automatically: MFD
38
The essentials

Data summary Menu Function Storing a speed with the speed warning
● Select the display Speed warning at
Menu Function Digital dis-
Current speed displayed in digital --- km/h (--- mph)
play of
The current fuel consumption dis- format.
speed ● Press the button  on the windscreen
play operates throughout the jour-
Current fuel
ney, in litres/100 km; and with the wiper lever or the button  on the multifunc-
consumption Speed warn- If the stored speed is exceeded (be-
engine running and the vehicle ing at --- tween 30 - 250 km/h, or 19 -
tion steering wheel to store the current speed
stopped, in litres/hour. km/h or Speed 155 mph), an audible warning is and activate the warning.
warning at given together with a visual warn- ● To switch system on: adjust to the desired
After turning on the ignition, aver-
--- mph ing. speed within 5 seconds using the rocker
age fuel consumption in li-
tres/100 km will be displayed after Detection of switch  on the windscreen wiper lever or
travelling about 100 metres. Other- The traffic signs detected are dis-
Average fuel traffic by turning the thumbwheel on the multifunc-
wise horizontal lines are displayed. played.
consumption signs tion steering wheel. Next, press the button
The value shown is updated approxi-  or  again or wait several seconds.
mately every 5 seconds. Oil tempera- Updated engine oil temperature dig-
ACT®*: Depending on the equip- ture ital display The speed is stored and the warning activa-
ment, number of active cylinders. ted.
Coolant tem- ● To switch system off: press the but-
Digital display of the current temper-
Approximate distance in km that can perature
ature of the liquid coolant. ton  or  . The stored speed is de-
still be travelled with the fuel re- gauge
Operating maining in the tank, assuming the leted.
range same style of driving is maintained. Information about the vehicle’s
This is calculated using the current Convenience main convenience consumers. It is
fuel consumption. consumers displayed by means of a consump-
tion indicator bar. Assist systems menu
This indicates the hours (h) and mi-
Travelling Eco tips Tips on how to save fuel.
nutes (min) since the ignition was Menu Function
time
switched on.
Reset data
“when set- Reset journey data when setting off. Adaptive cruise control (ACC) dis-
Distance covered in km (m) after ACC
Journey ting off” play ››› page 221.
switching on the ignition.
Reset data Switching the monitoring system on
The average speed will be shown af- Front Assist
for “total Reset travel journey to zero. and off ››› page 217.
ter a distance of about 100 metres
Average has been travelled. Otherwise hori- calculation”
Switching the Lane Assist system on
speed zontal lines are displayed. The value Lane Assist*
or off ››› page 231.
shown is updated approximately ev-
ery 5 seconds. Switching the Blind Spot Detection
Blind spot*
system (BSD) on or off ››› page 237 »
39
The essentials

Menu Function Status display Illustra-


Key to ››› Fig. 46
tion
Detection of
traffic Display of traffic signs ››› page 245: Bonnet, rear lid and doors open  Do not continue driving!
signs A The bonnet is open or is not properly
closed ››› page 298.
Switching the fatigue detection on
Fatigue de-
or off (pause recommendation)  Do not continue driving!
tection*
››› page 248. B The rear lid is open or is not properly
closed ››› page 137.

 Do not continue driving!


C, D A vehicle door is open or is not properly
closed ››› page 125.

 ››› page 115

Warning and information messages


The system runs a check on certain compo-
nents and functions when the ignition is
switched on and while the vehicle is moving.
Faults in the operation are displayed on the
screen using red and yellow symbols and
Fig. 46 A: bonnet open; B: rear lid open; C: messages on the instrument panel display
front left door open; D: right rear door open. (›››  page 119) and, in some cases, with
audible warnings. The display may vary ac-
When the ignition is switched on or when cording to the type of instrument panel fitted.
driving, the bonnet, rear lid or doors that are
open will be indicated on the instrument pan-
el display, and, as applicable, this will be in-
dicated audibly. The display may vary accord-
ing to the type of instrument panel fitted.

40
The essentials

Priority 1 warning (red symbols) Gear-change indicator Vehicles with an automatic gearbox*
The display is only visible in tiptronic mode
Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible
warnings.
›››  page 195.
 Stop the vehicle! It is dangerous ››› in Warning The following display symbols mean:
and control lamps on page 119 !
Check the function that is faulty and repair it. If necessa- ●  Shifting up a gear
ry, request assistance from specialised personnel.
●  Shifting down a gear

Priority 2 warning (yellow symbols) CAUTION


Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible The gear-change indicator is intended to help
warnings. save fuel, but it is not intended to recom-
A faulty function, or fluids which are below the correct mend the right gear for all driving situations.
levels may cause damage to the vehicle! ››› in Warn- Fig. 47 Instrument panel: gear-change indica-
tor (manual gearbox). In certain situations, only the driver can
ing and control lamps on page 119
choose the correct gear (for instance when
Check the faulty function as soon as possible. If neces-
overtaking, driving up a steep gradient or
sary, request assistance from specialised personnel. A gear change will be recommended if the
towing a trailer).
gear you are in is not the most economical
Informative text choice. If no gear-change is recommended, it
means that you are already in the most eco- Note
Information relating to different vehicle processes. nomical gear. The display disappears from the instrument
panel when you press the clutch pedal.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox
The following display symbols ››› Fig. 47
mean: Outside temperature display
●  Change to a higher gear: the suggested When the outside temperature is below +4°C
gear appears to the right of the current gear (+39°F), the “ice crystal” symbol (warning of
when a higher gear is recommended. risk of freezing) is also displayed. At first, this
●  Change to a lower gear: the suggested symbol flashes and then it remains lit until
gear appears to the left of the current gear the outside temperature rises above +6°C
when a lower gear is recommended. (+43°F) ››› in Indications on the display on
page 117. »
The gear recommendation may occasionally
skip a gear (2nd  4th).
41
The essentials

When the vehicle is at a standstill or when Additional consumers Note


travelling at very low speeds, the tempera-
● Operation with the windscreen wiper lever*: ● If you hide a saving tip, it will reappear af-
ture displayed may be higher than the true
ter you switch the ignition on again.
outside temperature as a result of the heat Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 43 2 until the
produced by the engine. main menu appears. Enter into the section ● The saving tips do not appear in all situa-
Driving data. With the rocker switch, tions, but rather with a large separation of
The temperatures measured range from time.
move to the display Convenience con-
-40°C to +50°C (-40°F to +122°F).
sumers.

● Operation with the multi-function steering


Speed warning device
Engine oil temperature display wheel*: move with the buttons   or  
to Driving data and enter with OK. Turn The speed warning device warns the driver
Vehicles without multifunction steering the right thumbwheel until the Conven- when they have exceeded the pre-set speed
wheel ience consumers display appears. limit by 3 km/h (2 mph). An audible warning
● Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 43 2 until signal sounds, and the warning lamp  and
In addition, a scale will inform you of the cur-
the main menu appears. Enter into Driving the driver message Speed limit excee-
rent sum of all the additional appliances.
data. With the button 2 move to the oil ded! will be displayed simultaneously on the
temperature gauge. instrument panel. The warning lamp 
switches off when reducing speed below the
Vehicles with multifunction steering wheel Saving tips stored maximum limit.
● Enter the submenu Driving data and Tips on how to save fuel will be displayed in Speed warning programming is recommen-
turn the thumbwheel until the oil tempera- conditions that increase fuel consumption. ded if you wish to be reminded of a maxi-
ture display appears. Follow them to reduce consumption. The indi- mum speed, such as when travelling in a
cations appear automatically only with the ef- country with different speed limits or for a
The engine reaches its operating temperature maximum speed for winter tyres.
ficiency programme. After a time, the tips will
when in normal driving conditions, the oil
disappear automatically.
temperature is between 80°C (180°F) and Setting speed limit warning
120°C (250°F). If the engine is required to If you wish to hide a saving tip immediately
work hard and the outside temperature is after it appears, press any button on the You can use the radio or the Easy Connect* to
high, the engine oil temperature can in- windscreen wiper lever*/multifunction steer- set, alter or cancel the speed limit warning.
crease. This does not present any problem as ing wheel*.
● Vehicles with radio: press the SETUP button
long as the warning lamps  ››› table on
> control button  Driver Assistant >
page 47 or  ››› table on page 47 do not
Speed warning.
appear on the display.
42
The essentials

● Vehicles with Easy Connect: Press the  Service intervals hicle so requires. To calculate this change
button and the function button SETTINGS > (max. 2 years), the vehicle's conditions of
Driver assistance > ACC > Dis- use and individual driving styles are consid-
tance. ered. The advance warning first appears 20
days before the date established for the cor-
The warning limit can be set from 30 to responding service. The kilometres (miles)
240 km/h (20 to 149 mph). The adjustment remaining until the next service are always
is made at 10 km/h (5 mph) intervals. rounded up to the nearest 100 km (miles)
and the time is given in complete days. The
Note current service message cannot be viewed
● Please bear in mind that, even with the until 500 km after the last service. Prior to
speed warning function, it is still important this, only lines are visible on the display.
to keep an eye on the vehicle speed with the
speedometer and to observe the legal speed Inspection reminder
limits.
When the Service date is approaching, when
● The speed limit warning function in the ver-
Fig. 48 Instrument panel the ignition is switched on a Service remind-
sion for some countries warns you at a speed
er is displayed.
of 120 km/h (75 mph). This is a factory-set
speed limit. The service interval indication appears on the Vehicles without text messages: a span-
instrument panel display ››› Fig. 48 1 . ner  will be displayed on the instrument
SEAT distinguishes between services with en- panel plus an indication in km.
gine oil change (e.g. Oil change service) and The kilometres indicated are the maximum
services without engine oil change (e.g. In- number of kilometres that can be travelled
spection). until the next service. After a few seconds,
In vehicles with Services established by time the display mode changes. A clock symbol
or mileage, the service intervals are already appears and the number of days until the
pre-defined. next service is due.

In vehicles with LongLife Service, the inter- Vehicles with text messages: Service in
vals are determined individually. Thanks to --- km or --- days will be shown on the
technological progress, maintenance work instrument panel display. »
has been greatly reduced. Because of the
technology used by SEAT, with this service
you only need to change the oil when the ve-
43
The essentials

Service due ● Release the button 0.0/SET and press it Cruise control
When the service date is due, an audible again for the next 20 seconds.
warning is given when the ignition is switch- Operating the cruise control system
ed on and the spanner displayed on the Note
(CCS)*
screen flashes for a few seconds . ● The service message disappears after a few
seconds, when the engine is started or when
Vehicles with text messages: Service now OK/RESET is pressed on the windscreen wiper
will be shown on the instrument panel dis- lever, or OK on the multifunction steering
play. wheel.
● In vehicles with the LongLife system in
Reading a service notification which the battery has been disconnected for
With the ignition switched on, the engine off a long period of time, it is not possible to cal-
and the vehicle at a standstill, the current culate the date of the next service. Therefore
service notification can be read: the service interval display may not be cor-
rect. In this case, bear in mind the maximum
Press and hold the button 0.0/SET for more service intervals permitted in the ››› Booklet
than 5 seconds to consult the service mes- Maintenance Programme. Fig. 49 On the left of the steering column:
sage 2 . ● If you reset the display manually, the next switches and controls for operating the CCS
When the service date has passed, a minus service interval will be indicated as in vehi-
sign is displayed in front of the number of kil- cles with fixed service intervals. For this rea-
son we recommend that the service interval
ometres or days.
display be reset by a SEAT authorised Dealer.
Vehicles with text messages: the following
message is displayed: Service --- km
(miles) or --- days ago.

Resetting service interval display


If the service was not carried out by a SEAT
dealership, the display can be reset as fol-
lows: Fig. 50 On the left of the steering column:
third lever to operate the CCS.
● Switch off the ignition, press and hold the
button 0.0/SET 2 .
● Switch ignition back on.
44
The essentials

Operation of the turn signal lever ● Reducing stored speed during CCS regula- press the brake pedal. The cruise control sys-
● Switching on the CCS: Move switch tion: press button 2 in  to lower the tem is switched off temporarily.
››› Fig. 491 to . The system is on. If no speed by 1 km/h (1 mph). Speed is reduced ● Reactivating the CCS: move the lever to
speed has been programmed, the system will until reaching the new stored speed.  ››› Fig. 50 and release it. The memo-
not control it. ● Switching off the CCS: Move switch rised speed is saved and controlled again.
● Activating the CCS: Press button ››› Fig. 49 ››› Fig. 49
1 to . The system is disconnec- ● Switching off the CCS: move the third lever
2in the  area. The current speed is ted and the memorised speed is deleted. to position  ››› Fig. 50. The system is dis-
memorised and controlled. connected and the memorised speed is de-
Operation using the third lever leted.
● Temporarily switching off the CCS: Move
switch ››› Fig. 49 1 to  or push the ● Switching on the CCS: move the third lever
to  ››› Fig. 50. The system switches on but it
brake. The cruise control system is switched
off temporarily. does not control the speed as no speed has  ››› in Operation on page 213

been programmed.
● Reactivating the CCS: Press button
››› Fig. 492 in . The memorised speed ● Activating the CCS: press the  ››› Fig. 50
button. It memorises and maintains the cur-
 ››› page 212

is saved and controlled again.


rent speed.
● Increasing stored speed during CCS regula-
tion: press button 2 in . The vehicle ac- ● Temporarily switching off the CCS: move
celerates until the new stored speed. the lever to  ››› Fig. 50 and release it or

45
The essentials

Warning lamps
On the instrument panel

Fig. 51 Instrument panel, on dash panel.

Red warning lamps  Do not continue driving! ››› page ››› page
 The brake fluid level is too low or 188  Use the foot brake!
222
Central warning lamp: additional
there is a fault in the brake system.
 information on the instrument pan- –
el display Lit up or flashing: Yellow warning lamps
››› page
››› page   Do not continue driving!
200 Central warning lamp: additional
 Parking brake on.
186
Fault in the steering.
 information on the instrument pan- –
Driver or passenger has not fas- ››› page el display
 tened seat belt. 79

46
The essentials

››› page ››› page ›››


 Front brake pads worn.
188  Lane Assist is switched on, but not
active. 230  in Warning and control lamps on
page 119


it lights up: Fault in the ESC, or dis-
connection caused by the system. ››› page
189
Other warning lamps  ››› page 119

flashes: ESC or ASR activated. ››› page


Left or right turn signal.
145
ASR manually deactivated.  On the instrument panel display
 ››› page Hazard warning lights on.
››› page
ESC in Sport mode. 149
189
 ABS faulty or does not work. ››› page
 Trailer turn signals.
273
››› page
 Rear fog light switched on.
144 it lights up green: Auto Hold activa- ››› page
 ted. 211
lights up or flashes: fault in the ››› page
 emission control system. 204 it lights up green: Press the brake
pedal! ››› page
it lights up: pre-heating of diesel  It blinks in green: the selector lever 193
engine. ››› page locking button has not engaged.
 205
flashes: fault in the diesel engine it lights up green: cruise control ac-
management. tivated or speed limiter switched
on and active. ››› page
fault in the petrol engine manage- ››› page 
 ment. 205 it blinks in green: the speed set by 212
the speed limiter has been excee-
lights up or flashes: fault in the ››› page ded.
 steering system. 200 Fig. 52 On the instrument panel display: door
it lights up green: Lane Assist is ››› page open.
Tyre pressure too low, or fault in
››› page  switched on and active. 230
 the tyre pressure monitoring sys-
311
tem. ››› page ››› page
 Main beam on or flasher on.
145
 Do not continue driving!
125
››› page With the corresponding indi-
 Fuel tank almost empty. ››› page
118  cation: door(s), rear lid or bon-
137
net open or not properly
››› page
 Fault in airbag system and seat
belt tensioners.
››› page
89
closed.
298 »

47
The essentials

Ignition:  Do not carry on it lights up white: Hill Descent On the instrument panel
driving! Engine coolant level Control (HDC) is active.
too low, coolant temperature ››› page it lights up grey: Hill Descent ››› page
 too high 302
 Control (HDC) is not active. 210
The system is switched on, but
Flashing: Fault in the engine is not adjusting.
coolant system.
››› page
 Do not continue driving!  Immobiliser active.
133
Engine oil pressure too low. If
the warning lamp flashes, ››› page  Service interval display ››› page 43
 stop driving, even if the oil 300
level is correct. Do not even Mobile telephone is connec-
run the engine at idle speed!  ted via Bluetooth to the origi-
nal telephone device. ››› Booklet
››› page Audio or Fig. 53 Warning lamp for disabling the front
 Fault in the battery.
305 Mobile telephone battery navigation passenger airbag.
charge meter. Available only system
Driving light totally or partially ››› page  for devices pre-installed in fac- Front passenger front airbag is
faulty. 106 tory. ››› page
   disabled (  
89
Fault in the cornering light ››› page Freezing warning. The outside  ).
system. 148  temperature is lower than ››› page 41
+4°C (+39°F).
The front passenger front airbag ››› page
Diesel particulate filter ››› page   is activated (   89
 blocked 205
 Start-Stop system activated.
››› page
 ).

Level of windscreen washer ››› page 208


  Start-Stop system unavailable.
›››
fluid too low.

Flashing: Fault in the oil level


153

 Low consumption driving sta- ››› page  in Activation and deactivation of
front passenger airbag* on page 89
tus 116

detection. Control manually.

Ignition: Insufficient engine


››› page
300
 ››› page 88

oil.  ››› page 115

››› page
 Fault in the gearbox.
200

››› page
 Light Assist on.
146

48
The essentials

Gearbox lever ● Release the clutch.


›››
 in Selector lever positions on
page 194
Manual gearbox
 ››› in Changing gear on page 192
 ››› page 193

 ››› page 192


 ››› page 49

Automatic gearbox*
Manual release of the selector lever

Fig. 54 Gear shift pattern of a 5 or 6-speed


manual gearbox.

The position of the gears is indicated on the


gearbox lever ››› Fig. 54.
● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
right down. Fig. 55 Automatic gearbox: selector lever po-
sitions. Fig. 56 Selector lever: manual release from
● Move the gearbox lever to the required po- position P.
sition. P Parking lock
● Release the clutch. Should the power supply be interrupted,
R Reverse gear there is a manual unlocking device located
Selecting reverse gear N Neutral (idling) under the console of the selector lever, on
D/S Drive (forward) the right. Releasing the selector lever re-
● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
quires a certain degree of practical skill.
right down. +/– Tiptronic mode: pull the lever forwards
● With the gearbox lever in neutral, push it (+) to go up a gear or backwards (–) to ● Unlocking: use the flat part of a screwdriver
downwards, move it to the left as far as it will
go down a gear. blade. »
go and then forwards to select reverse
››› Fig. 54 R .
49
The essentials

Removing the cover from the selector lever ● Press the interlock button on the selector be moved to position N, after operating the
● Apply the handbrake  ››› to ensure that lever and move the selector lever to posi- manual release mechanism.
the car does not move. tion N.
● After carrying out the manual release, at- WARNING
● Carefully pull the corners of the selector
lever boot and twist it upwards above the lev- tach the selector lever boot on the gearbox The selector lever may be moved out of posi-
er handle. console again. tion P only when the handbrake is firmly ap-
plied. If this does not work, secure the vehi-
If the power supply should ever fail (e.g. dis- cle with the brake pedal. On a slope the vehi-
Releasing the selector lever charged battery) and the vehicle has to be cle could otherwise start to move inadver-
● Using a screwdriver, press and hold the yel- pushed or towed, the selector lever must first tently after shifting the selector lever out of
low unlocking tab sideways ››› Fig. 56. position P - accident risk!

50
The essentials

Air conditioning
How does Climatronic* work?

Fig. 57 In the centre console: Climatronic con-


trols

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1
The left and right sides can be adjusted separately: Turn the control to adjust the temperature
Temperature

2
The power of the fan is automatically adjusted. The fan is also adjusted manually by turning the control.
Fan

3
The airflow adjusts automatically for comfort. You can also switch it on manually using the buttons 3 .
Air distribution

4 Indications on the temperature display screen selected for the right and left sides. »

51
The essentials

 The air drawn in from outside the vehicle is directed at the windscreen and air recirculation is automatically switched off. To defrost the wind-
Defrost function screen more quickly, the air is dehumidified at temperatures over approximately +3°C (+38°F) and the fan runs at maximum output.

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Upward air distribution.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes.

 Air recirculation

 Seat heating buttons

 Press the button to switch on or off the cooling system.

Press the button to make maximum cooling capacity available. The recirculation of air and the cooling system turn on automatically and air distri-
  bution adjusts automatically to the position .

When the warning light for button  lights up, the settings on the driver side also apply to the passenger side. Press the button or the temper-
 ature control on the passenger side

 Automatic adjustment of temperature, fan, and air distribution. Press the button: the warning lamp on the button will light up .

 Press the configuration button : the air conditioning operation menu will be displayed on the Easy Connect system screen.

Switching off Turn the blower control to the  position or press the  button.

 ››› in Introduction on page 171

 ››› page 170

52
The essentials

How does the manual air conditioning work*?

Fig. 58 In the centre console: Manual air condi-


tioning controls.

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1
Turn the control to adjust the temperature
Temperature

2 Setting 0: blower and manual air conditioning switched off


Fan Level 6: maximum fan level.

3
Rotate the continuous control to direct the airflow to the desired area.
Air distribution

 The airflow is directed at the windscreen. Air recirculation is automatically switched off or is not switched on. Increase the fan power to clear the
Defrost function windscreen of condensation as soon as possible. To dehumidify the air, the cooling system will automatically switch on.

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Distribution of air towards the chest and the footwell area. »


53
The essentials

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Air distribution towards the windscreen and the footwell.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes.

 Air recirculation

 Seat heating buttons

Maximum cooling power. The recirculation of air and the cooling system turn on automatically and air distribution adjusts automatically to the
  position 

 ››› in Introduction on page 171

 ››› page 170

How does the heating and the fresh air system work?

Fig. 59 In the centre console: heating system and


fresh air controls.
54
The essentials

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1 Turn the control to adjust the temperature. The temperature cannot be lower than that of the exterior air temperature, as this system cannot cool
Temperature or dehumidify the air

2 Setting 0: blower, heating and fresh air systems switched off


Fan Level 6: maximum fan level

3
Rotate the continuous control to direct the airflow to the desired area.
Air distribution

 The airflow is directed at the windscreen.


Defrost function

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Distribution of air towards the chest and the footwell area.

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Air distribution towards the windscreen and the footwell.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes

 Air recirculation ››› page 174

 Seat heating buttons

 ››› in Introduction on page 171

 ››› page 170

55
The essentials

Fluid Level control Fuel Opening the fuel tank cap


● Open the fuel tank flap by pressing on the
Filling capacities left side.
● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the left.
Tank level ● Place it in the space on the hinge of the
Front-wheel drive vehicles:
open flap ››› Fig. 60.
Petrol and diesel 50 l, of which approx. 7 l reserve
engines
Closing the fuel tank cap
Four-wheel drive vehicles:
55 l, of which approx. 8.5 l reserve ● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the right as
far as it will go.
Capacity of the windscreen washer fluid container ● Close the lid.
Fig. 60 Fuel tank flap with tank cap attached.
Versions without
headlight washer
system
approx. 3 litres
The flap that covers the tank cap is unlocked
and locked automatically using the central
 ››› in Refuelling on page 292

Versions with
headlight washer
system
approx. 5 litres
locking.
 ››› page 292

56
The essentials

Oil

Fig. 61 Engine oil dipstick. Fig. 62 In the engine compartment: Engine


oil filler cap.

The level is measured using the dipstick loca- ● Zone C : Add oil up to zone B . ● When the oil level reaches at least zone B ,
ted in the engine compartment unscrew the engine oil filler cap carefully.
›››  page 298. Topping up engine oil
● Unscrew cap from oil filler opening. Engine oil additives
The oil should leave a mark between zones
A and C . It should never exceed zone A . ● Add oil slowly. No type of additive should be mixed with the
engine oil. The deterioration caused by these
● Zone A : Do not add oil. ● At the same time, check the level to ensure
additives is not covered by the warranty. »
● Zone B : You can add oil but keep the level
you do not add too much.
in that zone.

57
The essentials

Engine oil specifications

Set Service (dependent on time/distance travel-


Engine type Flexible service (LongLife)
led)
VW 508 00
Petrol engines VW 504 00
VW 504 00a)

Engines with particulate filter (DPF)b) VW 507 00 VW 507 00

VW 505 01c)
Diesel engines without particulate filter (DPF) –
VW 506 01c)
a) Use of engine oil compliant with the VW 504 00 specification instead of VW 508 00 may have a slight negative effect on the vehicle’s exhaust gas values.
b) Only use recommended oils, otherwise you may damage the engine.
c) If the quality of the fuel available in the country does not fulfil the EN 228 (for petrol) and EN 590 (for diesel) standards.

Coolant Coolant specifications


 ››› in Changing engine oil on page 302
The engine cooling system is supplied from
the factory with a specially treated mixture of
 ››› page 300 water and at least 40 % of the additive G13
(TL-VW 774 J), purple. This mixture gives the
necessary frost protection down to -25°C
(-13°F) and protects the light alloy parts of
the engine cooling system against corrosion.
It also prevents scaling and considerably rai-
ses the boiling point of the coolant.
To protect the cooling system, the percentage
of additive must always be at least 40 %,
Fig. 63 Engine compartment: coolant expan-
even in warm climates where anti-freeze pro-
sion tank cap.
tection is not required.
The coolant tank is located in the engine If for weather reasons further protection is
compartment ›››  page 298. necessary, the proportion of additive may be
When the engine is cold, replace the coolant
when the level is below .
58
The essentials

increased, but only up to 60 %; otherwise an- Brake fluid Windscreen washer


tifreeze protection will diminish and this will
worsen cooling.
When the coolant is topped up, use a mixture
of distilled water and at least 40 % of the
G13 or G12 plus-plus (TL-VW 774 G) additive
(both are purple) to obtain an optimum anti-
corrosion protection ››› in Topping up cool-
ant on page 303. The mixture of G13 with
G12 plus (TL-VW 774 F), G12 (red) or G11
(green-blue) engine coolants will significant-
ly reduce anti-corrosion protection and
should therefore be avoided ››› in Topping Fig. 64 Engine compartment: brake fluid res- Fig. 65 In the engine compartment: wind-
up coolant on page 303. ervoir cap. screen washer reservoir top.

The brake fluid reservoir is located in the en- The windscreen washer reservoir is located in
 ››› in Topping up coolant on page 303 gine compartment ›››  page 298. the engine compartment ›››  page 298.
The level should be between the  and  To top up, mix water with a product recom-
 ››› page 302 marks. If it is below , please visit a Techni-
cal Service.
mended by SEAT.
In cold temperatures, add anti-freeze.

 ››› in Top up brake fluid on page 304



››› in Checking and topping up the
windscreen washer reservoir on
page 304
 ››› page 303

 ››› page 304

Battery
The battery is located in the engine compart-
ment ›››  page 298. It does not require »
59
The essentials

maintenance. It is checked as part of the In-


spection Service.

›››
 in Important safety warnings for
handling a vehicle battery on page 306

 ››› page 305

60
The essentials

Emergencies Colour Amp rating


Purple 3
Fuses
Light brown 5

Fuse location Brown 7.5

Red 10

Blue 15

Fig. 67 In the engine compartment: fuse box Yellow 20


cover. White or transparent 25

Underneath the instrument panel (left-hand Green 30


drive)
Orange 40
The fuse box is located behind the storage
compartment ››› Fig. 66 .

Behind the glove compartment (right-hand


 ››› in Introduction on page 102

drive)
The fuse box is located behind the glove
 ››› page 102

compartment ››› Fig. 66 . To be able to ac-


cess the fuse box ›››  page 103.

In the engine compartment


Press the locking tabs to release the fuse box
Fig. 66  Left-hand drive: fuse box cover on
cover ››› Fig. 67.
the driver-side dash panel.  Right-hand
drive: fuse box behind the glove compart- Identifying fuses situated below the dash
ment. panel by colours

Colour Amp rating


Black 1
61
The essentials

Replacing a blown fuse ● Replace the cover again or close the fuse
Rear lights Type
box lid.
Brake light/tail light P21W LL

Side lights P21W LL


Bulbs Turn signal PY21W LL

Bulbs (12 V) Retro fog light P21W LL

Reverse lights W16W


Note: Depending on the level of equipment
fitted in the vehicle, LEDs may be used for
part or all of the interior and/or exterior light- LED rear lights Type
ing. LEDs have an estimated life that exceeds Turn signal PY21W LL
Fig. 68 Image of a blown fuse.
that of the vehicle. If an LED light fails, go to
an authorised workshop for its replacement. Reverse lights W16W
Preparation
The remaining functions work with LEDs
● Switch off the ignition, lights and all elec- Light source used for each function
trical equipment. Halogen headlights. Type
● Open the corresponding fuse box
›››  page 103. Daytime running light/side LED (it cannot be re-
 ››› page 106

light placed)

Identifying a blown fuse Dipped beam headlights H7 LL


A fuse is blown if its metal strip is ruptured Main beam headlights H7 LL
Action in the event of a punc-
››› Fig. 68. ture
Turn signal PY21W
● Point a lamp at the fuse to see if it has
blown. What to do first
Full-LED main headlights
No bulbs may be replaced. All functions are with LEDs
● Park the vehicle on a horizontal surface
To replace a fuse
and in a safe place as far away from traffic as
● Remove the fuse. possible.
Front fog light Type
● Replace the blown fuse by one with an ● Apply the handbrake.
identical amperage rating (same colour and Fog/cornering lights* H8
● Switch on the hazard warning lights.
markings) and identical size.
● Manual gearbox: select the 1st gear.
62
The essentials

● Automatic gearbox: Move the selector lever Repairing a tyre with the anti-punc- ● Remove the lid from the filling tube
to position P. ture kit ››› Fig. 693 and screw the open end of the
● If you are towing a trailer, unhitch it from tube into the tyre valve.
your vehicle. ● With the tyre sealant bottle upside down,
● Have the vehicle tool kit ›››  page 95 fill the tyre with the contents of the sealant
and the spare wheel* ready bottle.
›››  page 314. ● Remove the bottle from the valve.
● Observe the applicable legislation for each ● Place the insert back into the tyre valve us-
country (reflective vest, warning triangles, ing the tool ››› Fig. 69 1 .
etc.).
● All occupants should leave the vehicle and Inflating the tyre
wait in a safe place (for instance behind the ● Screw the compressor tyre inflator tube
roadside crash barrier). ››› Fig. 69 5 into the tyre valve.
● Check that the air bleed screw is closed
WARNING
Fig. 69 Standard representation: contents of ››› Fig. 69 7 .
● Always observe the above steps and pro- the anti-puncture kit. ● Start the engine and leave it running.
tect yourself and other road users.
● Insert the connector ››› Fig. 69 9 into the
● If you change the wheel on a slope, block The anti-puncture kit is located under the
the wheel on the opposite side of the car with
vehicle's 12-volt socket ›››  page 162.
floor panel in the luggage compartment.
a stone or similar to prevent the vehicle from ● Turn the air compressor on with the ON/OFF
moving. Sealing the tyre switch ››› Fig. 69 8 .
● Unscrew the tyre valve cap and insert. Use ● Keep the air compressor running until it
the ››› Fig. 69 1 tool to remove the insert. reaches 2.0 to 2.5 bar
Place it on a clean surface. (29-36 psi/200-250 kPa). A maximum of 8
minutes.
● Shake the tyre sealant bottle vigorously
● Disconnect the air compressor.
››› Fig. 69 10 .

● Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 69 3 into ● If it does not reach the pressure indicated,
the sealant bottle. The bottle's seal will break unscrew the tyre inflator tube from the valve.
automatically. ● Move the vehicle 10m so that the sealant is
distributed throughout the tyre. »

63
The essentials

● Screw the compressor tyre inflator into the Changing a wheel Central wheel trim*
valve.
● Repeat the inflation process. Vehicle tool kit
● If the indicated pressure still cannot be
reached, the tyre is too badly damaged. Stop
and request assistance from an authorised
technician.
● Disconnect the air compressor. Unscrew
the tyre inflator tube from the tyre valve.
● When the tyre pressure is between 2.5 and
2.0 bars, continue driving without exceeding
80 km/h (50 mph). Fig. 71 Correct positioning of the central
● Check the pressure again after 10 minutes wheel trim for steel rims.
›››  page 97. Fig. 70 Underneath the floor panel of the lug-
The central trims must be removed for access
gage compartment: vehicle tool kit.
››› to the wheel bolts.
 in TMS (Tyre Mobility System)* on
page 95 1 An adapter for the anti-theft wheel bolts*
Removing
Towline anchorage
 ››› page 95
2
3 Box spanner for wheel bolts*
● Attach the wire hook (vehicle tools) to one
of the chambers of the central wheel trim.
4 Crank handle for jack ● Insert the box spanner through the hook,
5 Jack* supporting it on the tyre and remove the
6 Hook for extracting the central wheel wheel trim.
trims*
7 Clip for removing the wheel bolt caps. Fitting
● Fit the central wheel trim onto the rim. The
bottom of the “S” of the SEAT badge should
 ››› in What to do first on page 63
align with the inflation valve ››› Fig. 71 1 .
● Press the central trim firmly until it locks in
 ››› page 95 with an audible click.

64
The essentials

Note Anti-theft wheel bolts Loosening the wheel bolts


There is also a valve mark on the back of the
central wheel trim that indicates the correct
alignment.

Wheel bolt caps*

Fig. 73 Anti-theft wheel bolt with cap and Fig. 74 Wheel: loosen the wheel bolts.
adapter.
● Insert the box spanner (vehicle tools) onto
● Remove the wheel cover* or the cap*. the wheel bolt as far as it will go. An adapter
● Insert the special adapter (vehicle tools) is required to unscrew or tighten the anti-
onto the anti-theft wheel bolt and push it on theft wheel bolts ››› page 65.
as far as it will go. ● Turn the wheel bolt approximately one turn
Fig. 72 Wheel: wheel bolts with caps.
● Insert the wheel brace (vehicle tools) onto to the left ››› Fig. 74 (arrow). To apply the re-
the adapter as far as it will go. quired torque, hold the wheel brace at the
Removal
● Remove the wheel bolt ››› page 65.
end. If it is not possible to loosen a wheel
● Fit the plastic clip (vehicle tools bolt, carefully apply pressure with one foot
››› Fig. 70 7 ) over the cap until it clicks into on the end of the box spanner. Hold on to the
Note
place ››› Fig. 72. vehicle for support and take care not to slip.
● Remove the cap with the plastic clip. Make a note of the code number of the anti-
theft wheel bolt and keep it in a safe place, WARNING
but not in your vehicle. If you need a new
adapter, you can obtain it from the SEAT Offi- Slightly loosen the wheel bolts (one turn) be-
cial Service, indicating the code number. fore raising the vehicle with the jack*. If not,
an accident may occur.

65
The essentials

Raising the vehicle ● Find the support point on the strut (sunken CAUTION
area) closest to the wheel to be changed
››› Fig. 75. The vehicle must not be raised on the cross-
bar. Only place the jack* on the points de-
● Turn the jack* crank handle, located below signed for this purpose on the strut. Other-
the strut support point, to raise it until the wise, the vehicle may be damaged.
tab 1 ››› Fig. 76 is below the housing provi-
ded.
● Align the jack* so that tab 1 “grips” onto Removing and fitting a wheel
the housing provided on the strut and the
mobile base 2 is resting on the ground. The Change the wheel after loosening the wheel
base plate 2 should fall vertically with re- bolts and raising the vehicle with the jack.
spect to the support point 1 .
Fig. 75 Crossbar: marks. Taking off the wheel
● Continue turning the jack* until the wheel
is slightly lifted off the ground. ● Unscrew the wheel bolts using the box
spanner and place them on a clean surface.
WARNING
● Take off the wheel.
● Make sure that the jack* remains stable. If
the surface is slippery or soft, the jack* could Putting on the spare wheel
slip or sink, respectively, with the resultant
risk of injury. When fitting tyres with a compulsory rotation
● Only raise the vehicle with the jack* sup- direction, observe the instructions in
plied by the manufacturer. Other vehicles ››› page 67.
could slip, with the consequent risk of injury. ● Mount the wheel.
● Only mount the jack* on the support points
Fig. 76 Strut: mounting the jack on the vehi- ● Screw on the wheel bolts in position and
cle. designed for this purpose on the strut, and
always align the jack correctly. If you do not, tighten them loosely with a box spanner.
the jack* could slip as it does not have an ad- ● Carefully lower the vehicle using the jack*.
● Place the jack* (vehicle tools) on firm
equate grip on the vehicle: risk of injury! ● Tighten the wheel bolts in diagonal pairs
ground. If necessary use a large, strong
● The height of the parked vehicle can using the wheel brace.
board or similar support. If the surface is slip-
pery (for example tiles) place the jack on a change as a result of variations in tempera-
ture and loading. The wheel bolts should be clean and turn
rubber mat or similar to prevent it from slip- easily. Before fitting the spare wheel, inspect
ping ››› .

66
The essentials

the wheel condition and hub mounting surfa- ● Return all tools to their proper storing loca- If there is a danger of being trapped despite
ces. These surfaces must be clean before fit- tion. having mounted the chains, it is best to disa-
ting the wheel. ● If the replaced wheel does not fit in the ble the driving wheels (ASR) in the ESC
spare wheel housing, store it safely in the ›››  page 191, Switching on/off the ESC
luggage compartment ›››  page 162. and ASR.
Tyres with compulsory direction of ro- ● Check the tyre pressure of the newly moun- Snow chains will improve braking ability as
tation ted tyre as soon as possible. well as traction in winter conditions.
● In vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure indi- For technical reasons snow chains may only
A directional tread pattern can be identified
by the arrows on the sidewall that point in cator, adjust the pressure and store the read- be used with the following wheel rim/tyre
the direction of rotation. Always observe the ing in the radio/Easy Connect system* combination.
direction of rotation indicated when fitting ›››  page 311.
● Have the tightening torque of the wheel 215/60 R16 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
the wheel to guarantee optimum properties
of this type of tyres with regard to grip, bolts checked as soon as possible with a tor- 215/55 R17 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
noises, wear and aquaplaning. que wrench (it should be 140 Nm). Mean-
while, drive carefully. 215/50 R18 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
If it is absolutely necessary to fit the spare
tyre* against the direction of rotation, drive ● Have the flat tyre replaced as quickly as Other dimensions do not allow chains
with care as this means the tyre does not of- possible.
fer optimum driving properties. This is of par- Remove any central wheel trims and the rim
ticular importance when the road surface is ring before fitting snow chains.
wet.
Snow chains Remove the chains when roads are free of
To return to directional tread tires, replace snow. Driving characteristics worsen, and the
the punctured tyre as soon as possible and Use wheels become damaged quickly and may
restore the obligatory direction of rotation of even be rendered unusable.
all tyres. Snow chains should only be used on the
front wheels.
Check that they are correctly seated after
Subsequent work driving for a few yards; correct the position if
necessary, in accordance with the manufac-
● Alloy wheels: replace the wheel bolt caps.
turer's fitting instructions. Keep your speed
● Plate wheels: fit the central wheel rim again below 50 km/h (30 mph).
››› page 64.
67
The essentials

Emergency towing of the vehi- Towline anchorages Do not pull too hard with the towing vehicle
Attach the bar or rope to the towline ancho- and take care to avoid jerking the tow rope.
cle When towing on an unpaved road, there is al-
rages.
ways a risk of overloading and damaging the
Towing The towline anchorages are located under anchorage points.
the floor panel in the luggage compartment,
next to the vehicle tools ›››  page 95. Switch on the ignition so that the turn sig-
nals, windscreen wipers and windscreen
Screw the towline anchorage into the screw washer can work. Ensure that the steering
connection ››› Fig. 77 o ››› Fig. 78 and tighten wheel is unlocked and moves freely.
it with the wheel brace.
Place the gear lever in neutral on vehicles
Tow rope or tow bar with a manual gearbox. With an automatic
gearbox, place the lever in N.
The tow bar offers increased safety and a
lower risk of damage. To brake, press the brake pedal firmly. The
brake servo does not work when the engine
The tow rope is recommended when there is is switched off.
Fig. 77 Right side of the front bumper: tow- no tow bar. It must be elastic so that it does
line anchorage screwed in. not damage the vehicle. The power steering only works when the igni-
tion is switched on and the vehicle is moving,
Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle provided that the battery is sufficiently charg-
ed. Otherwise, it will need more force.
● The tow rope must be taut before you drive
off. Ensure that the tow rope remains taut at all
times.
● Release the clutch very carefully when start-
ing the vehicle (manual gearbox), or acceler-
ate gently (automatic gearbox).  ››› in Introduction on page 98

Driving style
Towing requires some experience, especially
 ››› page 98

Fig. 78 Right side of the rear bumper: towline when using a tow rope. Both drivers should
anchorage screwed in. realise how difficult it is to tow a vehicle. In-
experienced drivers should not attempt to
tow.

68
The essentials

Tow-starting Jump leads must comply with standard DIN


72553 (see cable manufacturer's instruc-
If the engine will not start, first try starting it tions). The wire cross section must be at least
using the battery of another vehicle 25 mm2 for petrol engines and at least
››› page 69. You should only attempt to tow- 35 mm2 for diesel engines.
start a vehicle if charging the battery does
not work. This is done by leveraging wheel Note
movement. ● The vehicles must not touch each other,
When tow-starting a vehicle with a petrol en- otherwise electricity could flow as soon as
gine, do not tow it more than a short dis- the positive terminals are connected.
tance, otherwise unburned fuel can enter the ● The discharged battery must be properly Fig. 80 Diagram of connections for vehicles
catalytic converter. connected to the on-board network. with Start Stop system

● Engage 2nd or 3rd gear before moving off. Jump lead terminal connections
● Press the clutch and hold the pedal down. How to jump start: description 1. Switch off the ignition of both vehicles
● Switch the ignition on. ››› .
● Once both vehicles are moving, release the 2. Connect one end of the red jump lead to
clutch. the positive + terminal of the vehicle
● As soon as the engine has started, press
with the flat battery A ››› Fig. 79.
the clutch and move the gear lever to neutral. 3. Connect the other end of the red jump
lead to the positive terminal + in the
vehicle providing assistance B .
4a. For vehicles without Start-Stop system:
How to jump start connect one end of the black jump lead
to the negative terminal – of the vehi-
Jump leads cle providing the current B ››› Fig. 79.
Fig. 79 Diagram of connections for vehicles
The jump lead must have a sufficient wire without Start Stop system 4b. For vehicles with Start-Stop system: con-
cross section. nect one end of the black jump lead X
to a suitable ground terminal, to a solid
If the engine fails to start because of a dis- piece of metal in the engine block, or to
charged battery, the battery can be connec- the engine block itself ››› Fig. 80. »
ted to the battery of another vehicle to start
the engine.
69
The essentials

5. Connect the other end of the black jump Make sure the battery clamps have sufficient ● Never attach the negative cable to fuel sys-
lead X to a solid metal component bol- metal-to-metal contact with the battery termi- tem components or the brake lines in the oth-
ted to the engine block or to the engine nals. er vehicle.
block itself of the vehicle with the flat ● The non-insulated parts of the battery
If the engine fails to start after about 10 sec-
battery. Do not connect it to a point near clamps must not be allowed to touch. The
onds, switch off the starter and try again after
the battery A . jump lead attached to the positive battery
about 1 minute.
6. Position the leads in such a way that terminal must not touch metal parts of the ve-
they cannot come into contact with any hicle, this can cause a short circuit.
WARNING
moving parts in the engine compart- ● Position the leads in such a way that they
● Please note the safety warnings referring to
ment. cannot come into contact with any moving
working in the engine compartment
parts in the engine compartment.
›››  page 298.
Starting ● Do not lean on the batteries. This could re-
● The battery providing assistance must have
sult in chemical burns.
7. Start the engine of the vehicle with the the same voltage as the flat battery (12V) and
boosting battery and let it run at idling approximately the same capacity (see imprint
speed. on battery). Failure to comply could result in Note
an explosion.
8. Start the engine of the vehicle with the The vehicles must not touch each other, oth-
flat battery and wait for 2 or 3 minutes ● Never use jump leads when one of the bat- erwise electricity could flow as soon as the
until the engine is running. teries is frozen. Danger of explosion! Even af- positive terminals are connected.
ter the battery has thawed, battery acid could
leak and cause chemical burns. If a battery
Removing the jump leads
freezes, it should be replaced.
9. Before you remove the jump leads, ● Keep sparks, flames and lighted cigarettes
switch off the dipped beam headlights if away from batteries, danger of explosion.
they are switched on. Failure to comply could result in an explo-
10. Turn on the heater blower and heated sion.
rear window in the vehicle with the flat ● Observe the instructions provided by the
battery. This helps minimise voltage manufacturer of the jump leads.
peaks which are generated when the ● Do not connect the negative cable from the
leads are disconnected. other vehicle directly to the negative terminal
11. When the engine is running, disconnect of the flat battery. The gas emitted from the
the leads in reverse order to the details battery could be ignited by sparks. Danger of
given above. explosion.

70
The essentials

Changing the wiper blades Changing the windscreen and rear Cleaning windscreen wiper blades
window wiper blades ● Raise the wiper arms.
Windscreen wipers service position ● Use a soft cloth to remove dust and dirt
from the windscreen wiper blades.
● If the blades are very dirty, a sponge or
damp cloth may be used ››› in Changing
the windscreen and rear window wiper
blades on page 98.

Changing the windscreen wiper blades


● Lift and unfold the wiper arms.
● Press and hold release button ››› Fig. 82 1
Fig. 82 Changing the windscreen wiper and pull gently on the wiper blade in the di-
Fig. 81 Wipers in service position. blades rection of the arrow.
● Fit a new wiper blade of the same length
The wiper arms can be raised when the wip- and design on to the wiper arm and hook it
ers are in service position ››› Fig. 81. into place.
● Close the bonnet ›››  page 298. ● Rest the wiper arms back onto the wind-
● Switch the ignition on and off. screen.
● Press the windscreen wiper lever down-
Changing the rear wiper blade
wards briefly 4 ››› page 32.
● Raising/lowering the wiper arm.
Before driving, always lower the wiper arms. ● Turn the blade slightly ››› Fig. 83 (arrow
Using the windscreen wiper lever, the wind- A ).
screen wiper arms return to their initial posi- Fig. 83 Changing the rear wiper blade
● Hold down the release button 1 while
tion.
Raising and lowering windscreen wiper arms gently pulling the blade in the direction of ar-
row B .
 ››› page 97 ● Place the windscreen wipers in the service
position ››› page 71.
● Insert a new blade of the same length and
type in the rear wiper arm in the opposite di-
● Grip the wiper arms only by the blade's fas- rection to the arrow B and hook into place
tening point. button 1 . »
71
The essentials

● Replace the wiper arm on the rear window.

›››
 in Changing the windscreen and
rear window wiper blades on page 98

 ››› page 97

72
Safe driving

Safety – Ensure that all windows provide a clear and cumstance, you endanger yourself as well as

Technical data
good view of the surroundings. others on the road ››› , for this reason:
– Make sure all luggage is secured – Always pay attention to traffic and do not
Safe driving ››› page 162. get distracted by passengers or telephone
calls.
– Make sure that no objects can interfere
Safety first!
with the pedals. – Never drive when your driving ability is im-
paired (e.g. by medication, alcohol, drugs).
WARNING – Adjust front seat, head restraint and mir-
rors properly according to your size. – Observe traffic laws and speed limits.

Advice
● This manual contains important informa-
tion about the operation of the vehicle, both – Ensure that the passengers in the rear – Always reduce your speed as appropriate
for the driver and the passengers. The other seats always have the head restraints in for road, traffic and weather conditions.
sections of the on-board documentation also the in-use position ››› page 77.
contain further information that you should – When travelling long distances, take
be aware of for your own safety and for the – Instruct passengers to adjust the head re- breaks regularly - at least every two hours.

Operation
safety of your passengers. straints according to their height.
– If possible, avoid driving when you are tired
● Ensure that the on-board documentation is – Protect children with appropriate child or stressed.
kept in the vehicle at all times. This is espe- seats and properly applied seat belts
cially important when lending or selling the ››› page 90. WARNING
vehicle to another person.
– Assume the correct sitting position. Instruct When driving safety is impaired during a trip,
the risk of injury and accidents increases.

Emergencies
your passengers also to assume a proper
sitting position ››› page 74.
Advice about driving – Fasten your seat belt securely. Instruct your
passengers also to fasten their seat belts Safety equipment
Before setting off properly ››› page 79.
Never put your safety or the safety of your
For your own safety and the safety of your passengers in danger. In the event of an acci-
passengers, always note the following points dent, the safety equipment may reduce the »
What affects driving safety?

Safety
before every trip:
– Make sure that the vehicle's lights and turn As a driver, you are responsible for yourself
signals are working properly. and your passengers. When your concentra-
– Check tyre pressure.
tion or driving safety is affected by any cir-

73
Safety

risk of injury. The following points cover part Correct position of the vehicle For your own safety and to reduce the risk of
of the safety equipment in your SEAT 1): injury in the event of an accident, we recom-
occupants mend the following adjustments for the driv-
● three-point seat belts, er:
● belt tension limiters for the front and rear Correct sitting position for the driver
– Adjust the steering wheel so that there is a
side seats,
distance of at least 25 cm between the
● belt tensioners for the front and rear side steering wheel and the centre of your chest
seats, ››› Fig. 84.
● front airbags,
– Move the driver's seat forwards or back-
● knee airbags, wards so that you are able to press the ac-
● side airbags in the front seat backrests, celerator, brake and clutch pedals to the
floor with your knees still slightly angled
● head-protection airbags,
››› .
● “ISOFIX” anchor points for child seats in
– Ensure that you can reach the highest point
the rear side seats with the “ISOFIX” system,
of the steering wheel.
● height-adjustable front head restraints, Fig. 84 The proper distance between driver
and steering wheel. – Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
● rear head restraints with in-use position
edge is at the same level as the top of your
and non-use position,
head, or as close as possible to the same
● adjustable steering column. level as the top of your head ››› Fig. 85.
The safety equipment mentioned above – Move the seat backrest to an upright posi-
works together to provide you and your pas- tion so that your back rests completely
sengers with the best possible protection in against it.
the event of an accident. However, these
– Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 79.
safety systems can only be effective if you
and your passengers are sitting in a correct – Keep both feet in the footwell so that you
position and use this equipment properly. have the vehicle under control at all times.
Safety is everyone's business! Adjustment of the driver's seat ››› page 156.
Fig. 85 Correct head restraint position for the
driver.

1) Depending on the version/market.


74
Safe driving

WARNING Adjusting the steering wheel position – Move the seat backrest to an upright posi-

Technical data
tion so that your back rests completely
● An incorrect sitting position of the driver
Read the additional information carefully against it.
can lead to severe injuries.
›››  page 20. – Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
● Adjust the driver's seat so that there is at
least 25 cm distance between the centre of edge is at the same level as the top of your
WARNING
the chest and the centre of the steering head, or as close as possible to the same
wheel ››› Fig. 84. If you are sitting closer than ● Never adjust the position of the steering level as the top of your head ››› page 77.
25 cm, the airbag system cannot protect you wheel when the vehicle is moving, as this
could cause an accident. – Always keep both feet in the footwell in
properly.

Advice
● Move the lever up firmly so the steering
front of the front passenger seat.
● If your physical constitution prevents you
from maintaining the minimum distance of 25 wheel position does not accidentally change – Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 79.
cm, contact a specialised workshop. The during driving. risk of accident!
workshop will help you decide if special spe- ● Make sure you are capable of reaching and It is possible to deactivate the front passen-
cific modifications are necessary. firmly holding the upper part of the steering ger airbag in exceptional circumstances
››› page 89.

Operation
● When driving, always hold the steering wheel: risk of accident!
wheel with both hands on the outside of the ● If you adjust the steering wheel so that it Adjusting the front passenger seat
ring at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions. points towards your face, the driver airbag ››› page 156.
This reduces the risk of injury when the driver will not protect you properly in the event of
airbag is triggered. an accident. Make sure that the steering WARNING
● Never hold the steering wheel at the 12 wheel points towards your chest.
● An incorrect sitting position of the front

Emergencies
o'clock position, or in any other manner (e.g.
passenger can lead to severe injuries.
in the centre of the steering wheel). In such
cases, if the airbag is triggered, you may sus- ● Adjust the front passenger seat so that
Correct position for the front passen- there is at least 25 cm between your chest
tain injuries to the arms, hands and head.
ger and the dash panel. If you are sitting closer
● To reduce the risk of injury to the driver
than 25 cm, the airbag system cannot protect
during sudden braking manoeuvres or an ac- For your own safety and to reduce the risk of you properly.
cident, never drive with the backrest tilted far
injury in the event of an accident, we recom- ● If your physical constitution prevents you
back! The airbag system and seat belts can
mend the following adjustments for the front

Safety
only provide optimal protection when the from maintaining the minimum distance of 25
backrest is in an upright position and the passenger: cm, contact a specialised workshop. The
driver is wearing his or her seat belt correct- – Move the front passenger seat back as far workshop will help you decide if special spe-
ly. as possible ››› . cific modifications are necessary. »
● Adjust the head restraint properly to ach-
ieve optimal protection.
75
Safety

● Always keep your feet in the footwell when – Always keep both feet in the footwell in – Never allow anyone to assume an incorrect
the vehicle is moving; never rest them on the front of the rear seat. sitting position in the vehicle while travel-
dash panel, out the window or on the seat. An ling ››› .
– Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 79.
incorrect sitting position exposes you to an
increased risk of injury in case of a sudden – Use an appropriate child restraint system The following list contains examples of sit-
braking or an accident. If the airbag is trig- when you take children in the vehicle ting positions that could be dangerous for all
gered, you could sustain severe injuries due ››› page 90. vehicle occupants. The list is not complete,
to an incorrect sitting position. but we would like to make you aware of this
● To reduce the risk of injury to the front pas- WARNING issue.
senger in events such as sudden braking ma- ● If the passengers in the rear seats are not
noeuvres or an accident, never travel with the Therefore, whenever the vehicle is in motion:
sitting properly, they could sustain severe in-
backrest tilted far back! The airbag system juries. ● Never stand in the vehicle.
and seat belts can only provide optimal pro-
tection when the backrest is in an upright po- ● Adjust the head restraint correctly in order ● Never stand on the seats.
sition and the front passenger is wearing his to achieve maximum protection. ● Never kneel on the seats.
or her seat belt properly. The further the seat ● Seat belts can only provide optimal protec-
● Never tilt your seat backrest far to the rear.
backrests are tilted to the rear, the greater tion when seat backrests are in an upright
the risk of injury due to incorrect positioning position and the vehicle occupants are wear- ● Never lean against the dash panel.
of the belt web or to the incorrect sitting po- ing their seat belts correctly. If passengers In ● Never lie on the rear bench.
sition! the rear seats are not sitting in an upright po-
sition, the risk of injury due to incorrect posi- ● Never sit on the front edge of a seat.
● Adjust the head restraint correctly in order
to achieve maximum protection. tioning of the seat belt increases. ● Never sit sideways.
● Never lean out of a window.
● Never put your feet out of a window.
Correct sitting position for rear seat Examples of incorrect sitting posi-
● Never put your feet on the dash panel.
passengers tions
● Never put your feet on the surface of a seat.
To reduce the risk of injury in the event of a Seat belts can provide optimal protection on- ● Do not allow anyone to travel in the foot-
sudden braking manoeuvre or an accident, ly when the belt webs are properly posi- well.
passengers on the rear seat bench must con- tioned. Incorrect sitting positions substan- ● Never travel without wearing the seat belt.
sider the following: tially reduce the protective function of seat
belts and increase the risk of injury due to in- ● Do not allow anyone to travel in the lug-
– Sit up straight. correct seat belt position. As the driver, you gage compartment.
– Adjust the head restraint to the correct po- are responsible for all passengers, especially
sition ››› page 77. children.
76
Safe driving

WARNING Properly adjusted head restraints are an im- Correct adjustment of rear head re-

Technical data
portant part of passenger protection and can straints
● Any incorrect sitting position increases the
reduce the risk of injuries in most accident
risk of severe injuries. Sitting in an incorrect
situations.
position exposes the vehicle occupants to se-
vere injuries if airbags are triggered, by strik- ● Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
ing a vehicle occupant who has assumed an edge is, as far as possible, at the same level
incorrect sitting position.
as the top of your head, or at the very least,
● Before the vehicle moves, assume the prop- at eye level ››› Fig. 86.

Advice
er sitting position and maintain it throughout
the trip. Before every trip, instruct your pas- WARNING
sengers to sit properly and to stay in this po-
sition during the trip ››› page 74, Correct posi- ● Travelling with the head restraints removed
tion of the vehicle occupants. or improperly adjusted increases the risk of
severe injuries. An improper adjustment of
the head restraints may cause death in an ac- Fig. 87 Head restraints in the correct posi-

Operation
cident and increase the risk of suffering inju- tion.
Correct adjustment of front head re- ries during abrupt braking actions or unex-
straints pected manoeuvres.
● The head restraints must always be adjus-
ted according to the height of the passenger.

Emergencies
Fig. 88 Head restraint position warning label.

Safety
Fig. 86 Correctly adjusted head restraint as Properly adjusted head restraints are an im-
viewed from the front and the side. portant part of the passenger protection and
can reduce the risk of injuries in most acci-
Read the additional information carefully dent situations »
›››  page 19.
77
Safety

Rear head restraints Pedal area ● Never lay or fit floor mats or other floor cov-
– The rear head restraints have 2 positions: erings over the original floor mats. This
use and non-use. Pedals would reduce the pedal area and could ob-
struct the pedals. Risk of accident.
– One position for use (head restraint raised)
– Ensure that you can always press the accel- ● Never place objects in the driver footwell.
››› Fig. 87. In this position, the head re- An object could move into the pedal area and
erator, brake and clutch pedals unimpaired
straints are used normally, protecting pas- impair pedal operation. In the event of a sud-
to the floor.
sengers along with the rear seat belts. den driving or braking manoeuvre, you will
– Ensure that the pedals can return unim- not be able to operate the brake, clutch or ac-
– And one position for non-use (head re-
paired to their initial positions. celerator pedal. Risk of accident!
straint lowered).
– Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas-
– To fit the head restraints in position for use,
tened during the trip and do not obstruct
pull on the edges with both hands in the
the pedals ››› .
direction of the arrow.
Only use floor mats which leave the pedals
WARNING clear and which are secured to prevent them
● Under no circumstances should the rear from slipping. You can obtain suitable floor
passengers travel while the head restraints mats from a specialised dealership. Fasten-
are in the non-use position. See the warning ers* for floor mats are fitted in the footwells.
label located on the rear side fixed window
››› Fig. 88. If a brake circuit fails, the brake pedal must
be pressed down thoroughly in order to stop
● Do not swap the centre rear head restraint
the vehicle.
with either of the outer seat rear head re-
straints. Risk of injury in case of an accident!
Wear suitable footwear

CAUTION Always wear shoes which support your feet


properly and give you a good feeling for the
Note the instructions on the adjustment of pedals.
the head restraints ››› page 157.
WARNING
● Restricting pedal operation can lead to crit-
ical situations while driving.

78
Seat belts

Seat belts Seat belt control lamp*  of more than approximately 25 km/h

Technical data
(15 mph) or if the seat belts are unfastened
while the vehicle is in motion. The warning
Why wear a seat belt light will also flash .
The lamp  goes out when the driver and
Number of seats
passenger seat belts are fastened with the ig-
Your vehicle has five seats, two in the front nition switched on.
and three in the rear. Each seat is equipped

Advice
with a three-point seat belt. Rear seat belts fastened display*
Depending on the model version, when the
In some versions, your vehicle is approved
ignition is switched on, the seat belt status
only for four seats. Two front seats and two
display ››› Fig. 89 on the instrument panel in-
rear seats. Fig. 89 Instrument panel: right rear seat oc-
cupied and corresponding seat belt fastened forms the driver whether the passengers in
display. the rear seats have fastened their seat belts.

Operation
WARNING
The  symbol indicates that the passenger in
● Never transport more than the permitted this seat has fastened “his or her” seat belt.
The control lamp illuminates to remind the
amount of people in your vehicle.
driver to fasten his seat belt. When a seat belt in the rear seats is fastened
● Every vehicle occupant must properly fas-
ten and wear the seat belt belonging to his or Before starting the vehicle: or unfastened, the seat belt status is dis-
her seat. Children must be protected with an played for approximately 30 seconds. The in-
– Fasten your seat belt securely.

Emergencies
appropriate child restraint system. dication can be hidden by pressing the
– Instruct your passengers to fasten their 0.0/SET button on the dash panel.
seat belts properly before driving off. The seat belt status flashes for a maximum of
– Protect children by using a child seat ac- 30 seconds when a seat belt in the rear seats
cording to the child's height and weight. is unfastened while the vehicle is in motion.
An audible warning will also be heard if the
When the ignition is switched on, the control vehicle is travelling at over 25 km/h
lamp  in the instrument panel lights up (de- (15 mph).

Safety
pending on the model version) if the driver or
passenger have not fastened their seat belts.
An audible warning signal will sound for a
few seconds if the seat belts are not fastened
as the vehicle drives off and reaches a speed
79
Safety

The protective function of seat belts Ensure that your passengers wear their seat WARNING
belts as well. Accident statistics have shown
● If seat belts are worn incorrectly or not at
that wearing seat belts is an effective means
all, the risk of severe injuries increases. The
of substantially reducing the risk of injury
optimal protection from seat belts can be
and improving the chances of survival when
achieved only if you use them properly.
involved in a serious accident. Furthermore,
● Fasten your seat belt before every trip -
properly worn seat belts improve the protec-
even when driving in town. Other vehicle oc-
tion provided by airbags in the event of an
cupants must also wear the seat belts at all
accident. For this reason, wearing a seat belt
times, otherwise they run the risk of being in-
is required by law in most countries. jured.
Although your vehicle is equipped with air- ● The seat belt cannot offer its full protection
bags, the seat belts must be fastened and if the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
Fig. 90 Drivers with properly worn seat belts worn. The front airbags, for example, are only ● Never allow two passengers (even children)
will not be thrown forward in the event of sud- triggered in some cases of head-on collision. to share the same seat belt.
den braking. The front airbags will not be triggered during ● Always keep both feet in the footwell in
minor frontal or side collisions, rear-end colli- front of your seat as long as the vehicle is in
Properly worn seat belts hold the occupants sions, overturns or accidents in which the air- motion.
in the proper position. They also help prevent bag trigger threshold value in the control unit
uncontrolled movements that may result in ● Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi-
is not exceeded.
serious injury and reduce the risk of being cle is in motion. Risk of fatal injury.
thrown out of the vehicle in case of an acci- Therefore, you should always wear your seat ● The seat belt must never be twisted while it
dent. belt and ensure that all vehicle occupants is being worn.
have fastened their seat belts properly before ● The seat belt should never lie on hard or
Vehicle occupants wearing their seat belts you drive off! fragile objects (such as glasses or pens, etc.)
correctly benefit greatly from the ability of the
because this can cause injuries.
belts to absorb kinetic energy. In addition,
the front part of your vehicle and other pas- ● Do not allow the seat belt to be damaged or
sive safety features (such as the airbag sys-
Important safety instructions for the jammed, or to rub on any sharp edges.
tem) are designed to absorb the kinetic ener- use of seat belts ● Never wear the seat belt under the arm or
gy released in a collision. Taken together, all in any other incorrect position.
– Always wear the seat belt as described in
these features reduce the releasing kinetic ● Bulky and unfastened clothing (such as an
energy and consequently, the risk of injury. this section. overcoat over a sweater) impairs the proper
This is why it is so important to fasten seat – Ensure that the seat belts can be fastened fit and function of the seat belts, reducing
belts before every trip, even when "just driv- at all times and are not damaged. their capacity to protect.
ing around the corner".
80
Seat belts

● The slot in the seat belt buckle must not be Head-on collisions and the laws of called “kinetic energy” is created both in the

Technical data
blocked with paper or other objects, as this physics passengers and inside the vehicle.
can prevent the latch plate from engaging se- The amount of “kinetic energy” depends on
curely.
the speed of the vehicle and on the weight of
● Never use seat belt clips, fastening rings or the vehicle and of its passengers. The higher
similar items to alter the position of the belt they are, the more energy there is to be “ab-
webbing. sorbed” in the event of an accident.
● Frayed or torn seat belts or damage to the
connections, belt retractors or parts of the The most significant factor, however, is the

Advice
buckle could cause severe injuries in the speed of the vehicle. If the speed doubles
event of an accident. Therefore, you must from 25 km/h (15 mph) to 50 km/h
check the condition of all seat belts at regular (30 mph), for example, the corresponding ki-
intervals. netic energy is multiplied by four.
● Seat belts which have been worn in an acci- Given that the passengers of the vehicle in
Fig. 91 A driver not wearing a seat belt is
dent and have been stretched must be re-

Operation
thrown forward violently. our example do not have their seat belts fas-
placed by a specialised workshop. Renewal tened, in the event of a collision the entire
may be necessary even if there is no apparent
amount of the passengers' kinetic energy will
damage. The belt anchorage should also be
be only absorbed by the mentioned impact.
checked.
● Do not attempt to repair a damaged seat Even at speeds of 30 km/h (19 mph) to
belt yourself. The seat belts must not be re- 50 km/h (30 mph), the forces acting on bod-

Emergencies
moved or modified in any way. ies in a collision can easily exceed one tonne
● The belts must be kept clean, otherwise the (1000 kg). At greater speed these forces are
retractors may not work properly. even higher.
Vehicle occupants not wearing seat belts are
not “attached” to the vehicle. In a head-on
Fig. 92 The unbelted passenger in the rear
collision, they will move forward at the same
seat is thrown forward violently, hitting the speed their vehicle was travelling just before

Safety
driver who is wearing a seat belt. the impact. This example applies not only to
head-on collisions, but to all accidents and
It is easy to explain how the laws of physics collisions.
work in the case of a head-on collision: when Even at low speeds the forces acting on the
a vehicle starts moving, a type of energy body in a collision are so great that it is not »
81
Safety

possible to brace oneself with one's hands. How to properly adjust your
In a frontal collision, unbelted passengers
are thrown forward and will make violent con- seatbelt
tact with the steering wheel, dash panel,
windscreen or whatever else is in the way Fastening and unfastening your seat
››› Fig. 91. belt
It is also important for rear passengers to
wear seat belts properly, as they could other-
wise be thrown forward violently through the
vehicle interior in an accident. Passengers in
the rear seats who do not use seat belts en-
danger not only themselves but also the front
Fig. 94 Position of seat belt during pregnan-
occupants ››› Fig. 92. cy.

Read the additional information carefully


›››  page 19.
Fasten your seat belt
The seat belt cannot offer its full protection if
the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
● Adjust the seat and head restraint correctly.
● To fasten the belt, take hold of the latch
plate and pull it slowly across your chest and
lap.
● Insert the latch plate into the buckle for the
Fig. 93 Positioning and removing the seat appropriate seat and push it down until it is
belt buckle. securely locked with an audible click
››› Fig. 93 A.

82
Seat belts

● Pull the belt to ensure that the latch plate is and the seat belts have been fastened prop- The seat belts for the front seats and the side

Technical data
securely engaged in the buckle. erly. rear seats1) are equipped with belt tension-
● Never put the latch plate in the buckle of
ers. The belt tensioners are activated by sen-
The seat belts are equipped with an automat- sors, although only in severe head-on, lateral
ic retractor on the shoulder strap. Full free- another seat. If you do this, the seat belt will
not protect you properly and the risk of injury and rear-end collisions. This retracts and
dom of movement is permitted when the tightens the seat belts, reducing the forward
is increased.
shoulder belt is pulled slowly. However, dur- motion of the occupants.
● Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi-
ing sudden braking, during travel in steep
areas or bends and during acceleration, the cle is in motion. If you do, you increase the The belt tensioners will not be triggered in
risk of sustaining severe or fatal injuries.

Advice
automatic retractor on the shoulder belt is the event of minor collisions, if the vehicle
locked. ● An incorrectly worn seat belt can cause se- overturns, or in accidents where no major
vere injuries in the event of an accident. forces act on the vehicle.
The automatic belt retractors on the front ● For pregnant women, the lap part of the
seats and side rear seats are1) fitted with seat belt must lie as low as possible over the Note
seat belt tensioners ››› page 83. pelvis, never across the stomach, and always ● If the seat belt tensioners are triggered, a

Operation
lie flat so that no pressure is exerted on the fine dust is produced. This is normal and it is
Releasing the seat belt abdomen ››› Fig. 94. not an indication of fire in the vehicle.
● Press the red button on the belt buckle ● Always engage the retractor lock when you ● The relevant safety requirements must be
››› Fig. 93 B. The latch plate is released and are securing a child seat in group 0, 0+ or 1 observed when the vehicle or components of
springs out ››› . ››› page 90. the system are scrapped. Specialised work-
● Guide the belt back by hand so that it rolls ● Read and observe the warnings ››› page 80. shops are familiar with these regulations,

Emergencies
up easily and the trim is not damaged. which are also available to you.

Positioning seat belts


Seat belt tensioners Maintenance and disposal of belt ten-
Seat belts offer their maximum protection on-
ly when they are properly positioned. sioners
How the seat belt tensioner works
WARNING The belt tensioners are components of the
Read the additional information carefully

Safety
seat belts that are installed in the seats of
● The seat belts offer best protection only ›››  page 20. your vehicle. If you work on the belt tension-
when the backrests are in an upright position
ers or remove and install parts of the system
when performing other repair work, the seat »

1) Depending on version/market.
83
Safety

belt may be damaged. The consequence may


be that, in the event of an accident, the belt
Airbag system airbag. In this case, the inflating airbag may
inflict critical or fatal injuries on the occu-
tensioners function incorrectly or may not pant. This also applies to children.
function at all. Brief introduction
Always maintain the greatest possible dis-
So that the effectiveness of the seat belt ten- tance between yourself and the front airbag.
Why is it so important to wear a seat
sioner is not reduced and that removed parts This way, the front airbags can completely
do not cause any injuries or environmental belt and to sit correctly? deploy when triggered, providing their maxi-
pollution, regulations, which are known to mum protection.
For the inflating airbags to achieve the best
the specialised workshops, must be ob-
protection, the seat belt must always be worn The most important factors that will trigger
served.
properly and the correct sitting position must an airbag are: the type of accident, the angle
be assumed. of collision and the speed of the vehicle.
WARNING
● Improper use or repairs not carried out by The airbag system is not a substitute for seat Whether or not the airbags are triggered de-
qualified mechanics increase the risk of se- belts, but it is an integral part of the vehicle's pends primarily on the vehicle deceleration
vere or fatal injuries. The belt tensioners may overall passive safety system. Please bear in rate resulting from the collision and detected
fail to trigger or may trigger in the wrong cir- mind that the airbag system can only work ef- by the control unit. If the vehicle deceleration
cumstances. fectively when the vehicle occupants are occurring during the collision and measured
● Never attempt to repair, adjust, remove or wearing their seat belts correctly and have by the control unit remains below the speci-
install parts of the belt tensioners or seat adjusted the head restraints properly. There- fied reference values, the front, side and/or
belts. fore, it is most important to properly wear the curtain airbags will not be triggered. Take in-
● The seat belt tensioner, seat belt and auto- seat belts at all times, not only because this to account that the visible damage in a vehi-
matic retractor cannot be repaired. is required by law in most countries, but also cle involved in an accident, no matter how
for your safety ››› page 79, Why wear a seat serious, is not a determining factor for the
● Any work on the belt tensioners and seat
belt. airbags to have been triggered.
belts, including the removal and refitting of
system parts in conjunction with other repair The airbag inflates in a matter of seconds, so
work, must be performed by a specialised WARNING
if you are not properly seated when the air-
workshop only. bag is triggered, you may sustain fatal inju- ● Wearing the seat belt incorrectly or assum-
● The belt tensioners will only provide pro- ries. Therefore, it is essential that all vehicle ing an incorrect sitting position can lead to
tection for one accident and must be changed occupants assume a correct sitting position critical or fatal injuries.
if they have been activated. while travelling. ● All vehicle occupants, including children,
who are not properly belted can sustain criti-
Sharp braking before an accident may cause cal or fatal injuries if the airbag is triggered.
a passenger not wearing a seat belt to be Children up to 12 years old should always
thrown forward into the area of the deploying
84
Airbag system

travel on the rear seat. Never transport ● Head airbag WARNING

Technical data
children in the vehicle if they are not restrain- ● Airbag control lamp  on the instrument ● The seat belts and airbags can only provide
ed or the restraint system is not appropriate panel ››› page 89 maximum protection if the occupants are
for their age, size or weight.
● Key-operated switch for front passenger air- seated correctly ››› page 74, Correct position
● If you are not wearing a seat belt, or if you of the vehicle occupants.
bag
lean forward or to the side while travelling or ● If a fault has occurred in the airbag system,
assume an incorrect sitting position, there is ● Control lamp for disabled/enabled status
of the front passenger airbag. have the system checked immediately by a
a substantially increased risk of injury. This
specialised workshop. Otherwise there is a
increased risk of injury will be further in-

Advice
The airbag system operation is monitored danger that during a collision, the system
creased if you are struck by an inflating air-
electronically. The airbag control lamp will il- may fail to trigger, or not trigger correctly.
bag.
● To reduce the risk of injury from an inflating
luminate for a few seconds every time the ig-
airbag, always wear the seat belt properly
nition is switched on (self-diagnosis).
››› page 79. Airbag activation
There is a fault in the system if the control
● Always adjust the front seats properly.

Operation
lamp : The airbags deploy extremely rapidly, within
● does not light up when the ignition is thousandths of a second, to provide addi-
switched on ››› page 89, tional protection in the event of an accident.
Description of airbag system A fine dust may develop when the airbag de-
● turns off after 4 seconds after the ignition ploys. This is normal and it is not an indica-
Read the additional information carefully is switched on, tion of fire in the vehicle.
›››  page 21.

Emergencies
● turns off and then lights up again after the
The airbag system is only ready to function
The airbag system is not a substitute for the ignition is switched on,
when the ignition is on.
seat belts. The airbag system offers addition- ● illuminates or flashes while the vehicle is
al protection for the driver and passenger in moving. In special accidents instances, several air-
combination with the seat belts. bags may activate at the same time.
The airbag system is not triggered if: In the event of minor head-on and side colli-
The airbag system comprises the following ● the ignition is switched off sions, rear-end collisions, overturning or roll-
modules (as per vehicle equipment):

Safety
over of the vehicle, airbags do not activate.
● there is a minor frontal collision
● Electronic control unit
● there is a minor side collision Activation factors
● Front airbags for driver and passenger
● there is a rear-end collision The conditions that lead to the airbag system
● Knee airbag for the driver
● the vehicle turns over. activating in each situation cannot be gener-
● Side airbags alised. Some factors play an important role, »
85
Safety

such as the properties of the object the vehi- ● the hazard warning lights switch on; WARNING
cle hits (hard/soft), angle of impact, vehicle ● all doors are unlocked; ● The knee airbag is deployed in front of the
speed, etc.
● the fuel supply to the engine is cut. driver's knees. Always keep the deployment
Deceleration trajectory is key for airbag acti- areas of the knee airbags free.
vation. ● Never not fix objects to the cover or in the
deployment area of the knee airbag.
The control unit analyses the collision trajec- Airbag safety instructions ● Adjust the driver's seat so that there is a
tory and activates the respective restraint
system. distance of at least 10 cm (4 inches) between
Front airbags your knees and the location of the this air-
If the deceleration rate is below the prede- bag. If your physical constitution prevents
fined reference value in the control unit the Read the additional information carefully you from meeting these requirements, make
airbags will not be triggered, even though ›››  page 21. sure you contact a specialised workshop.
the accident may cause extensive damage to
the car. WARNING
● The deployment space between the front Side airbags*
The following airbags are triggered in seri- passengers and the airbags must not in any
ous head-on collisions: case be occupied by other passenger, pets Read the additional information carefully
● Driver airbag. and objects. ›››  page 23.
● The airbags provide protection for just one
● Front passenger front airbag
accident; replace them once they have de- WARNING
● Knee airbag for the driver. ployed.
● If you do not wear a seat belt, if you lean
● It is also important not to attach any ob- forward, or are not seated correctly while the
The following airbags are triggered in seri- jects such as cup holders or telephone vehicle is in motion, you are at a greater risk
ous side-on collisions: mountings to the surfaces covering the air- of injury if the side airbag system is triggered
● Front side airbag on the side of the acci- bag units. in an accident.
dent. ● Do not attempt to modify components of ● In order for the side airbags to provide their
● Curtain (head) airbag on the side of the ac-
the airbag system in any way. maximum protection, the prescribed sitting
cident. position must always be maintained with
seat belts fastened while travelling.
In an accident with airbag activation: Knee airbag* ● In a side-on collision the side airbags will
not work if the sensors do not correctly meas-
● the interior lights switch on (if the interior
Read the additional information carefully ure the pressure increase on the interior of
light switch is in the courtesy light position); ›››  page 23. the doors, due to air escaping through the

86
Airbag system

areas with holes or openings in the door pan- airbag, seriously reducing the airbag's effec- See your technical service to make this ad-

Technical data
el. tiveness. justment.
● Never drive if the interior door panels have ● Any damage to the original seat upholstery ● There must be no other persons, animals or
been removed or if the panels have not been or around the seams of the side airbag units objects between the occupants of the outer
correctly fitted. must be repaired immediately by a special- seats and the deployment space of the head-
● Never drive the vehicle if the loudspeakers ised workshop. protection airbags so that the head-protec-
in the door panels have been removed, un- ● The airbags provide protection for just one tion airbag can deploy completely without re-
less the holes left by the loudspeakers have accident; replace them once they have de- striction and provide the greatest possible
been closed properly. ployed. protection. Therefore, sun blinds which have

Advice
not been expressly approved for use in your
● Always check that the openings are closed ● Any work on the side airbag system or re-
vehicle may not be attached to the side win-
or covered if loudspeakers or other equip- moval and installation of the airbag compo- dows
ment are fitted inside the door panels. nents for other repairs (such as removal of
● The built-in coat hooks should be used only
● Occupants of the outer seats must never the front seat) should only be performed by a
specialised workshop. Otherwise, faults may for lightweight clothing. Do not leave any
carry any objects or pets in the deployment heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets.
occur during the airbag system operation.

Operation
space between them and the airbags, or al- Please, do not hang the clothes on coat hang-
low children or other passengers to travel in ● Do not attempt to modify components of
ers.
this position. It is also important not to at- the airbag system in any way.
● The airbags provide protection for just one
tach any accessories (such as cup holders) to
the doors. This would impair the protection accident; replace them once they have de-
offered by the side airbags. ployed.
Curtain airbags* ● Any work on the head-protection airbag

Emergencies
● The built-in coat hooks should be used only
for lightweight clothing. Do not leave any system or removal and installation of the air-
Read the additional information carefully bag components for other repairs (such as re-
heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets.
›››  page 24. moval of the roof lining) should only be per-
● Great forces, such as hard blows or kicks,
formed by a specialised workshop. Other-
must not be exerted upon the backrest bol- WARNING wise, faults may occur during the airbag sys-
ster because the system may be damaged. In tem operation.
this case, the side airbags would not be trig- ● In order for the head-protection airbags to
provide their maximum protection, the pre- ● Do not attempt to modify components of
gered.
scribed sitting position must always be main- the airbag system in any way.

Safety
● Under no circumstances should protective
tained with seat belts fastened while travel- ● The side and head airbags are managed
covers be fitted over seats with side airbags ling.
unless the covers have been approved for use through sensors located in the interior of the
in your vehicle. Because the airbag deploys ● For safety reasons, the curtain airbag must front doors. To ensure the correct operation of
from the side of the backrest, the use of con- be disabled in those vehicles fitted with a the side and curtain airbags neither the
ventional seat covers would obstruct the side screen dividing the interior of the vehicle. doors nor the door panels should be modified
in any way (e.g. fitting loudspeakers). If the »
87
Safety

front door is damaged, the airbag system ››› Fig. 95. About 3/4 of the key should enter;
may not work correctly. All work carried out this is as far as it will go.
on the front door must be done in a special- ● Turn the key gently to the  position. If
ised workshop. you have difficulty, ensure that you have in-
serted the key as far as it will go.
● Close the front passenger door.
Deactivating airbags ● Check, with the ignition switched on, that
the   control lamp remains lit where it
Activation and deactivation of front says      in the centre of the
passenger airbag* dash panel ››› Fig. 96.
Fig. 96 Dash panel: control lamp for deactiva-
ted front passenger airbag in centre console.
Connect the front passenger front airbag
Deactivate the front passenger front airbag ● Switch the ignition off.
only if you have to use a rear-facing child ● Open the front passenger door.
seat in the front passenger seat.
● Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
SEAT recommends fitting the child seat in the deactivating the front passenger airbag
rear seat to avoid having to deactivate the ››› Fig. 95. About 3/4 of the key should enter,
front passenger airbag. as far as it will go.
● Turn the key gently to the  position. If you
Front passenger front airbag switch have difficulty, ensure that you have inserted
Fig. 95 Switch for activating and deactivating When the front passenger airbag is deactiva- the key as far as it will go.
the front passenger airbag. ted, this means that only the front passenger ● Close the front passenger door.
front airbag is deactivated. All the other air-
● Check, with the ignition switched on, that
bags in the vehicle remain activated.
the   control lamp does not remain lit
where it says      in the cen-
Disconnect the front passenger front airbag
tre of the dash panel ››› Fig. 96. The   con-
● Switch the ignition off. trol lamp lights up for 60 seconds and then
● Open the door on the front passenger side. goes off.
● Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
deactivating the front passenger airbag

88
Airbag system

WARNING   It lights up on the dash panel belts may not trigger correctly, may fail to

Technical data
● The driver of the vehicle is responsible for
trigger or may even trigger unexpectedly.
Front passenger The control lamp switches off auto- ● The vehicle occupants run the risk of sus-
disabling or switching on the airbag. front airbag ena- matically 60 seconds after the igni-
● Always switch off the ignition before disa-
taining severe or fatal injuries. Have the sys-
bled. tion is switched on
tem checked immediately by a specialised
bling the front passenger airbag! Failure to do
workshop.
so could result in a fault in the airbag deacti- Several warning and control lamps light up
vation system. for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- ● Do not mount a child seat in the front pas-
● Never leave the key in the airbag disabling ed on, signalling that the function is being senger seat or remove the mounted child
seat! The front passenger front airbag may

Advice
switch as it could get damaged or enable or verified. They will switch off after a few sec-
deploy during an accident in spite of the
disable the airbag during driving. onds.
fault.
● If for any reason an airbag is deactivated, If the airbag and seat belt tensioner system
reactivate it as soon as possible so that it can control lamp  remains on or flashes, it indi-
fulfil its protective function. CAUTION
cates a malfunction in the airbag and seat
belt tensioner system ››› . Have the system Always pay attention to any lit control lamps

Operation
checked immediately by a specialised work- and to the corresponding descriptions and in-
Airbag system control lamps structions to avoid damage to the vehicle or
shop.
harm to the occupants.
If the front passenger airbag is deactivated,
It lights up on the combi-in- the warning lamp      re-
 strument mains lit on the dash panel to remind you

Emergencies
Fault in airbag that the airbag is deactivated. If, with the
Have the system checked immedi- front passenger airbag deactivated, this lamp
system and seat
ately by a specialised workshop.
belt tensioners. does not remain lit or if it is lit together with
the control lamp  on the dash panel, there
  It lights up on the dash panel is a fault in the airbag system ››› . If the
control lamp is flashing, there is a fault in the
Front passenger
Check whether the airbag should
disabling of the airbag system ››› . Have the
front airbag disa- system checked immediately by a specialised

Safety
remain disabled
bled. workshop.

WARNING
In the event of a fault in the airbag and seat
belt tensioner system, the airbags and seat

89
Safety

Transporting children safely made by “Peke” (not for all countries) (see
www.seat.com).
Important information regarding the
front passenger's airbag
Safety for children These systems have been especially de-
Read the additional information carefully
signed and approved, complying with the
ECE-R44. regulation. ›››  page 24.
Introduction
SEAT recommends securing the child seats Read and always observe the safety informa-
For safety reasons, as we have learned from shown on the website as described below: tion included in the following chapters:
accident statistics, we recommend that chil-
● Child seats in the opposite direction of ● Safety distance with respect to the passen-
dren under 12 years of age travel in the rear
seats. Depending on their age, height and travel (group 0+): ISOFIX and support bracket ger airbag ››› page 84.
weight, children travelling in rear seats must (Peke G0 Plus + ISOFIX Base (RWF)). ● Objects between the passenger and the
use a child seat or a seat belt. For safety rea- ● Child seats in the direction of travel (group passenger side airbag ››› in Front airbags
sons, the child seat should be installed in the 1): ISOFIX and Top Tether (Peke G1 ISOFIX on page 86.
rear seat, behind the front passenger seat or DUO Plus).
in the centre back seat. The passenger side front airbag, when ena-
● Child seats in the direction of travel (group
bled, is a serious risk for a child that is facing
The physical laws involved and the forces 2): seat belt and ISOFIX (Peke G3 KIDFIX) 1). backward since the airbag can strike the seat
acting in a collision apply also to children ● Child seats in the direction of travel (group with such force that it can cause serious or
››› page 81. But unlike adults, children do not 3): with seat belt (Peke G3 KIDFIX)1). fatal injuries. Children up to 12 years old
have fully developed muscle and bone struc- should always travel on the rear seat.
tures. This means that children are subject to Follow the manufacturer's instructions and
a greater risk of injury. observe any statutory requirements when in- Therefore we strongly recommend you to
stalling and using child seats. Always read transport children on the rear seats. This is
To reduce the risk of injuries, children must and note ››› page 90. the safest location in the vehicle. Alternative-
always use special child restraint systems ly, the front passenger airbag can be disa-
when travelling in the vehicle. We recommend you always carry the manu-
bled with a key-operated switch ››› page 88.
facturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual to-
We recommend the use of child safety prod- When transporting children, use a child seat
gether with the on-board documentation.
ucts from the SEAT Original Accessories Pro- suitable for the age and size of each child
gramme, which includes systems for all ages ››› page 92.

1) Temporarily, the child seat recommended by the

Accessories Programme for groups 2 and 3 will be


ROMER KIDFIX XP© instead of Peke G3 KIDFIX. It is
available from the SEAT website.
90
Transporting children safely

WARNING stand up or kneel on a seat while travelling. Child seats

Technical data
● If a child seat is secured to the front pas-
In an accident, the child could be flung
through the vehicle, causing possibly fatal in- Safety instructions
senger seat, the risk to the child of sustain-
juries to themselves and to the other vehicle
ing critical or fatal injuries in the event of an
occupants. Read the additional information carefully
accident increases.
● An inflating front passenger airbag can
● If children assume an improper sitting posi- ›››  page 24.
tion when the vehicle is moving, they expose
strike the rear-facing child seat and project it
themselves to greater risk of injury in the WARNING
with great force against the door, the roof or
event of a sudden braking manoeuvre or in an

Advice
the backrest. When travelling, children must be secured in
accident. This is particularly important if the
● Never install a child seat facing backwards child is travelling on the front passenger seat the vehicle with a restraint system suitable
on the front passenger seat unless the front and the airbag system is triggered in an acci- for age, weight and size.
passenger front airbag has been disabled. dent; as this could cause serious injury or ● Read and always observe information and
Risk of potentially fatal injuries to the child! even death. warnings concerning the use of child seats
However, if it is necessary, in exceptional ca- ››› page 90.
● A suitable child seat can protect your child!
ses, to transport a child in the front passen-

Operation
ger seat, the front passenger front airbag ● Never leave a child alone in the child seat
must always be disabled ››› page 89. If the or inside the vehicle because depending on WARNING
passenger seat has a height adjustment op- the season, very high temperatures may be
The retaining rings are designed only for use
tion, move it to the highest, most upright po- reached inside a parked vehicle, which could
with “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* system child
sition. If you have a fixed seat, do not install be fatal.
seats.
any child restraint system in this location. ● Children who are less than 1.5 metres tall

Emergencies
● Never secure other child seats that do not
● For those vehicles that do not include a key must not wear a normal seat belt without a
have the “ISOFIX” or Top Tether* system, or
lock switch to deactivate the airbag, the vehi- child seat, as this could cause injuries to the
retaining belts or objects to the fastening
cle must be taken to a technical service. Do abdominal and neck areas during a sudden
rings - this can result in potentially fatal inju-
not forget to reconnect the airbag when an braking manoeuvre or in an accident.
ries to the child.
adult wants to sit in the front passenger seat. ● Do not allow the seat belt to become twis-
● Ensure that the child seat is secured cor-
● All vehicle occupants, especially children, ted and the seat belt should be properly in
rectly using the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* se-
must assume the proper sitting position and place ››› page 79.
curing rings.
be properly belted in while travelling.

Safety
● Only one child may occupy a child seat
● Never hold children or babies on your lap, ››› page 91, Child seats.
WARNING
this can result in potentially fatal injuries to ● When a child seat is mounted in the rear
the child! seats, the door child-proof lock should be ac- An undue installation of the safety seat will
● Never allow a child to be transported in a tivated ››› page 134. increase the risk of injury in the event of a
vehicle without being properly secured, or to crash. »
91
Safety

● Never tie the retainer strap to a hook in the Child seats that have been tested and ap- versal approval, requires safety devices to
luggage compartment. proved under the ECE-R 44 or ECE-R 129 lock the child seat, which require additional
● Never secure or tie luggage or other items
standard bear the test mark ECE-R 44 or ECE- testing. Child seats with semi-universal ap-
to the lower anchorages (ISOFIX) or the upper R 129 on the seat (the letter E in a circle with proval include a list of vehicle models for
ones (Top Tether). the test number below it). which they can be installed.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and ● Vehicle-specific: vehicle-specific approval
observe any statutory requirements when in- requires a dynamic test of the child seat for
Categorisation of child seats into stalling and using child seats. each vehicle model separately. Child seats
with vehicle-specific approval also include a
groups We recommend you to always include the list of vehicle models for which they can be
manufacturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual installed.
Use only child seats that are officially ap- together with the on-board documentation.
proved and suitable for the child. ● i-Size: Child seats with i-Size approval must
SEAT recommends you use child seats from meet the requirements prescribed in the ECE-
These seats are subject to the ECE-R 44 or the Original Accessories Catalogue. These R 129 standard in relation to installation and
ECE-R 129 standard. ECE-R stands for: Eco- child seats have been designed and tested safety. Child seat manufacturers can tell you
nomic Commission for Europe Regulation. for use in SEAT vehicles. You can find the which seats have i-Size approval for this vehi-
The child seats are grouped into 5 catego- right child seat for your model and age group cle.
ries: at SEAT dealers.

Group 0: Up to 10 kg (up to around 9 Child seats by approval category Attachment systems


months)
Child seats may have the approval category
Group 0+: Up to 13 kg (up to around 18 of universal, semi-universal, vehicle specific Depending on the country, different attach-
months) (all according to the ECE-R 44 standard) or i- ment systems are used for safely installing
Size (according to the ECE-R 129 standard). child seats.
Group 1: from 9 to 18 kg (up to approx. 4
years old) ● Universal: Child seats with universal appro- Attachment systems overview
val can be installed in all vehicles. There is
● ISOFIX: ISOFIX is a standardised attach-
Group 2: from 15 to 25 kg (up to approx. 7 no need to consult any list of models. In the
years old) ment system allowing quick and safe attach-
case of universal approval for ISOFIX, the
ment of child seats in the vehicle. ISOFIX at-
child seat is additionally provided with a Top
Group 3: From 22 to 36 kg (over around 7 tachment establishes a rigid connection be-
Tether belt.
years old) tween the child seat and the car body.
● Semi-universal: semi-universal approval, in
addition to the standard requirements of uni-
92
Transporting children safely

The child seat has two rigid attachment clips, available in the instructions for child restraint

Technical data
called connectors. These connectors are fit- systems.
ted into the ISOFIX attachment rings found
between the seat cushion and the backrest of Recommended systems for attaching child
the vehicle's back seat (on the sides). ISOFIX seats
attachment systems are used mainly in Eu-
SEAT recommends attaching child seats as
rope ›››  page 26. If necessary, ISOFIX at-
follows:
tachment may have to be supplemented with
a Top Tether belt or a support bracket. ● Baby carriers or child seats in the opposite

Advice
direction of travel: ISOFIX and support brack-
● Automatic three-point seat belt. Whenever
et or iSize.
possible, it is preferable to attach the child
seats with the ISOFIX system rather than at- ● Child seats in the direction of travel: ISO-
taching them with an automatic three-point FIX and Top Tether.
seat belt ›››  page 25.

Operation
WARNING
Additional attachment: Incorrect use of the support bracket can
● Top Tether: The Top Tether belt is guided cause serious or fatal injury.
over the back of the rear seat and attached to ● Make sure the support bracket is correctly
an anchor point with a hook. Anchor points and safely installed.
are located at the back of the rear seat back-

Emergencies
rest on the boot side ›››  page 29. The
rings for retaining the Top Tether belt are
marked with an anchor symbol.
● Support bracket: Some child seats rest on
the floor of the vehicle with a support brack-
et. The support bracket prevents the child
seat from tipping forward in the event of im-

Safety
pact. Child seats fitted with a support bracket
should only be used in the passenger seat
and side rear seats ››› . For the assembly of
this type of seat you should also consult the
list of approved vehicles for this assembly,

93
Safety

Event Data Recorder Depending on vehicle equipment, this in-


cludes data from systems such as:
Due to legal requirements in safety-related
products, SEAT may use the EDR data for field
research and in order to improve vehicle sys-
Description and operation ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) tem quality. Any data used for the purposes
● Emergency brake assist system (Front As- of research will be treated anonymously (in
Your vehicle has an event data recorder
sist). other words, no reference will be made to the
(EDR).
● Park Pilot system vehicle, their owner or the lessee/hirer).
The EDR’s function is to record data in the
● Parking aid system (Park Assist).
event of a mild or serious accident. These da-
ta are used to support the analysis of how ● Lane Assist
different vehicle systems behaved.
The EDR data are only recorded in specific ac-
The EDR records, over a reduced time range cident situations. No data are recorded in
(normally 10 seconds or less), dynamic driv- normal driving conditions.
ing data and data from the restraint systems,
such as: No audio or video data inside or around the
vehicle are recorded. Under no circumstances
● How different vehicle systems worked. are personal data such as name, age, or gen-
● Whether the driver and the occupants were der recorded. Nevertheless, third parties
wearing their seatbelts. (such as criminal proceedings authorities)
may relate the contents of the EDR data to
● How hard the acceleration or brake pedal
other data sources and create a personal ref-
was pressed. erence in the context of an accident investi-
● Vehicle speed. gation.

These data will provide a better understand- In order to read the EDR data it is necessary
ing of the circumstances of the accident. to access (if legally permitted to do so) the
vehicle's ODB (“On-Board-Diagnose”) inter-
Data from the driving assist systems are also face while the vehicle is switched on.
recorded. This includes data such as whether
the systems were inactive or active and if SEAT will not have access to EDR data unless
such action had an impact on the vehicle’s the owner (or, in “Leasing” cases, the lessee
dynamic behaviour, changing its path in the or hirer) gives their consent. There may be ex-
aforementioned situations, accelerating or ceptions to this, depending on legal or con-
decelerating the vehicle. tractual provisions.

94
Self-help

Emergencies Note ● In the event of cuts or perforations in the

Technical data
tyre greater than 4 mm.
The jack does not generally require any main-
tenance. If required, it should be greased us- ● If you have been driving with very low pres-
Self-help ing universal type grease. sure or a completely flat tyre.
● If the sealant bottle has passed its use by
Vehicle tool kit, anti-puncture kit* date.

The tools and anti-puncture kit* are stored Tyre repair WARNING
under the floor panel in the luggage compart-

Advice
ment. Using the tyre mobility system can be dan-
TMS (Tyre Mobility System)* gerous, especially when filling the tyre at the
To access the vehicle tools: roadside. Please observe the following rules
Read the additional information carefully to minimise the risk of injury:
– Lift up the floor surface by the plastic han- ›››  page 63
● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
dle until it is fastened to the tabs on both
sides. The Anti-puncture kit* (Tyre Mobility System) Park it at a safe distance from surrounding

Operation
will reliably seal punctures caused by the traffic to fill the tyre.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the an- penetration of a foreign body of up to about ● Ensure the ground on which you park is flat
ti-puncture kit* is located under the floor 4 mm in diameter. Do not remove foreign ob- and solid.
panel in the luggage compartment. jects, e.g. screws or nails, from the tyre. ● All passengers and particularly children
The tool kit includes: After inserting the sealant residue in the tyre, must keep a safe distance from the work area.

Emergencies
you must again check the tyre pressure about ● Turn on the hazard warning lights to warn
● Jack* 10 minutes after starting the engine. other road users.
● Wire hook for pulling off the wheel cov- ● Use the tyre mobility system only if you are
You should only use the tyre mobility set if
er*/wheel bolt cap clip. the vehicle is parked in a safe place, you are familiar with the necessary procedures. Oth-
● Box spanner for wheel bolts* erwise, you should seek professional assis-
familiar with the procedure and you have the
tance.
● Towline anchorage necessary tyre mobility set! Otherwise, you
● The tyre mobility set is intended for tempo-
should seek professional assistance.
● Adapter for the anti-theft wheel bolts* rary emergency use only until you can reach

Safety
● Towing bracket device the nearest specialised workshop.
Do not use the tyre sealant in the following
cases: ● Replace the repaired tyre with the tyre mo-
Some of the items listed are only provided in bility set as soon as possible. »
certain model versions, or are optional ex- ● If the wheel rim has been damaged.
tras. ● In outside temperatures below -20°C (-4°F).

95
Emergencies

● The sealant is a health hazard and must be Note 4 Air compressor


cleaned immediately if it comes into contact 5 Tube for inflating tyres
Take into account the separate instruction
with the skin.
manual of the tyre mobility set* manufactur- 6 Warning provided by tyre pressure moni-
● Always keep the tyre mobility set out of the er. toring system (it can also be integrated in
reach of small children. the compressor).
● Never use an equivalent jack, even if it has
7 Air bleed screw (in its place, the compres-
been approved for your vehicle.
Contents of the tyre mobility system* sor may have a button).
● Always stop the engine, apply the hand-
brake lever firmly and engage gear if using a
8 ON/OFF switch
manual gearbox, in order to reduce the risk of 9 12 volt connector
vehicle involuntary movement. 10 Bottle of sealant
11 Spare tyre valve
WARNING
A tyre filled with sealant does not have the The valve insert remover 1 has a gap at the
same performance properties as a conven- lower end for a valve insert. The valve insert
tional tyre. can only be screwed or unscrewed in this
● Never drive faster than 80 km/h (50 mph).
way. This also applies to its replacement part
11 .
● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
fast cornering. WARNING
● Drive for only 10 minutes at a maximum
Fig. 97 Standard representation: contents of
When inflating the wheel, the air compressor
speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) and then check
the anti-puncture kit. and the inflator tube may become hot.
the tyre.
● Protect hands and skin from hot parts.
The anti-puncture kit is located underneath ● Do not place the hot flexible inflator tube or
For the sake of the environment
the floor covering in the luggage compart- hot air compressor on flammable material.
Dispose of used or expired sealant observing ment. It includes the following components ● Allow them to cool before storing the de-
any legal requirements. ››› Fig. 97: vice.
1 Tyre valve remover ● If it is not possible to inflate the tyre to at
Note least 2.0 bars (29 psi / 200 kPa), the tyre is
2 Sticker indicating maximum speed “max. too badly damaged. The sealant is not in a
A new bottle of sealant can be purchased at
80 km/h” or “max. 50 mph” good condition to seal the tyre. Do not con-
SEAT dealerships.
3 Filler tube with cap tinue driving. Seek specialist assistance.

96
Self-help

CAUTION ● Seek specialist assistance. WARNING

Technical data
Switch off the air compressor after a maxi- Getting in the way of the doors and the rear
mum of 8 operational minutes to avoid over- lid is dangerous and can lead to serious in-
heating! Before switching on the air compres- jury.
sor again, let it cool for several minutes. Manual unlocking/locking ● Open and close the doors and the rear lid
only when there is nobody in the way.
Introduction
Check after 10 minutes of driving Read the additional information carefully CAUTION

Advice
›››  page 16, ›››  page 17. When opening and closing in an emergency,
Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 97 again
5
and check the pressure on the gauge 6 . carefully disassemble components and then
The doors, rear lid and panoramic tilting sun- reassemble them carefully to avoid damage
roof can be locked manually and partially to the vehicle.
1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower: opened, for example if the key or the central
● Stop the vehicle! The tyre cannot be sealed locking is damaged.

Operation
sufficiently with the tyre mobility set.
● You should obtain professional assistance
WARNING Changing the windscreen wiper
››› . Opening and closing doors carelessly can blades
cause serious injury.
1.4 bar (20 psi / 140 kPa) and higher: ● If the vehicle is locked from outside, the Changing the windscreen and rear

Emergencies
doors and windows cannot be opened from
● Set the tyre pressure to the correct value window wiper blades
the inside.
again.
● Never leave children or disabled people Read the additional information carefully
● Carefully resume your journey until you alone in the car. They could be trapped in the
reach the nearest specialised workshop with-
›››  page 71.
car in an emergency and will not be able to
out exceeding 80 km/h (50 mph). get themselves to safety. The windscreen wiper blades are supplied as
● Have the damaged tyre replaced. ● Depending on the time of the year, temper- standard with a layer of graphite. This layer is
atures inside a locked and closed vehicle can responsible for ensuring that the wipe is si-

Safety
WARNING be extremely high or extremely low resulting lent. If the graphite layer is damaged, the
in serious injuries and illness or even death, noise of the water as it is wiped across the
Driving with an unsealed tyre is dangerous
particularly for young children. windscreen will be louder.
and can cause accidents and serious injury.
● Do not continue driving if the tyre pressure Check the condition of the wiper blades regu-
is 1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower. larly. If the wipers scrape across the glass, »
97
Emergencies

they should be changed if they are damaged, CAUTION the hazard warning lights. In vehicles with
or cleaned if they are dirty ››› . the Keyless Access system, the steering
● To prevent damage to the bonnet and the
wheel could lock ››› .
Damaged windscreen wiper blades should be wiper arms, only leave them in the service
replaced immediately. These are available position.
WARNING
from qualified workshops. ● Before driving, always lower the wiper
arms. A vehicle with no power should never be tow-
WARNING ed.
● During towing, never switch off the ignition
Worn or dirty windscreen wiper blades reduce
visibility and increase the risk of accident with the starter button. Otherwise, the elec-
and serious injury. Tow-starting and towing tronic lock of the steering column could sud-
denly get blocked and it would be impossible
● Always replace damaged or worn wind-
to steer the vehicle. This could cause an acci-
screen wiper blades or blades that no longer Introduction
dent, serious injury and loss of control of the
clean the windscreen properly. vehicle.
Tow-starting means starting the engine of
the vehicle while another pulls it. ● If during towing the vehicle runs out of
CAUTION power, stop towing immediately and request
● Damaged or dirty windscreen wipers could
Towing means one vehicle pulling another the assistance of specialist personnel.
scratch the glass.
that is not roadworthy.
● If products containing solvents, rough Always consider the legal provisions relating WARNING
sponges or sharp objects are used to clean to tow-starting and towing. Vehicle handling and braking capacity
the blades, the graphite layer will be dam- change considerably during towing. Please
For technical reasons, towing a vehicle with a
aged. observe the following instructions to mini-
discharged battery is not allowed. The jump
● Never use fuel, nail varnish remover, paint mise the risk of serious accidents and injury:
start should be used instead ›››  page 69.
thinner or similar products to clean the win- ● As the driver of the vehicle being towed:
dows. If the vehicle comes with the Keyless Access
system, towing is only allowed with the igni- – You should depress the brake much hard-
● In icy conditions, always check that the
tion on! er as the brake servo does not operate.
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be- Pay the utmost attention to avoid crash-
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it may The vehicle battery drains if the vehicle is ing into the towing vehicle.
help to leave the vehicle parked with the wip- towed with the engine switched off and the – More strength is required at the steering
ers in service position ›››  page 71.
ignition connected. Depending on the battery wheel as the power steering does not op-
charge status, the drop in voltage may be so erate when the engine is switched off.
large, even after just a few minutes, that no ● As the driver of the towing vehicle:
electrical device in the vehicle may work e.g.
98
Self-help

– Accelerate with particular care and cau- ● If the battery is flat, it is possible that the Indications for towing

Technical data
tion. engine control units may not operate correct-
ly. Tow rope or tow bar
– Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
– Brake earlier than usual and more It is safer for the vehicle to be towed using a
However, if the vehicle must absolutely be tow bar, avoiding damage to the vehicle. A
smoothly.
tow-started (in the case of manual gearbox- tow rope should only be used if a tow bar is
es): not available.
CAUTION
● Engage the 2nd or 3rd gear.
A tow rope should be slightly elastic to avoid
● To avoid damaging the vehicle, for example

Advice
● Keep the clutch pressed down. damage to both vehicles. It is advisable to
the paint, remove and replace the lid and
towing eye carefully. ● Switch on the ignition and the hazard warn- use a tow rope made of synthetic fibre or sim-
ing lights. ilarly elastic material.
● Unburnt fuel could enter the catalytic con-
verter and damage it during towing. ● Once both vehicles are moving, release the Only attach the tow rope or the tow bar to the
clutch. towing eyes provided or a towing bracket.

Operation
● Once the engine starts, press the clutch If the vehicle is factory-equipped with a tow-
Indications for tow-starting and disengage the gear to avoid colliding ing bracket, it is only allowed to tow with a
with the towing vehicle. tow bar if this has been specially designed to
Vehicle's should not generally be tow-star- be installed with a tow hitch ››› page 276.
ted. The jump start should be used instead CAUTION
›››  page 69. When tow-starting, unburnt fuel could enter When the vehicle needs to be towed:

Emergencies
For technical reasons, towing the following the catalytic converter and damage it. Check whether the vehicle may be towed
vehicles is not allowed: ››› page 100, Cases where towing a vehicle
Note is not allowed.
● Vehicles with an automatic gearbox.
● If the vehicle battery is discharged, be-
The vehicle can only be tow-started if the ● Switch the ignition on.
electronic parking brake and, if appropriate,
cause in vehicles with the Keyless Access the electronic lock of the steering column are ● Put the gearbox lever in neutral or the se-
locking and ignition system the steering re- deactivated. If the vehicle has no power sup- lector lever in the N ››› page 192 position.

Safety
mains locked and the electronic parking ply or there is an electric system fault, the ● Do not allow the vehicle to be towed at
brake cannot be deactivated nor can the elec- engine must be tow-started to deactivate the speeds of over 50 km/h (30 mph).
tronic lock of the steering column be re- electronic parking brake and the electronic
leased if they are activated. ● The vehicle must not be towed further than
lock of the steering column.
50 km (30 miles). »

99
Emergencies

● If a breakdown lorry is used, vehicles with Note


automatic transmission are only allowed to
be towed with the front wheels suspended. The vehicle can only be towed if the electron-
ic parking brake and the electronic lock of the
steering column are deactivated. If the vehi-
Towing vehicles with four-wheel drive cle has no power supply or there is an electric
(4Drive) system fault, the engine must be tow-started
Four-wheel drive vehicles (4Drive) can be ›››  page 69 to deactivate the electronic
towed using a tow bar or tow rope. If the ve- parking brake and the electronic lock of the
hicle is towed with the front or rear axle sus- steering column.
pended, the engine must be switched off,
otherwise the transmission may be damaged. Fig. 99 Front bumper on right: towline an-
Fitting the front towing eye chorage screwed in.
Cases where towing a vehicle is not allowed
The housing of the screw towing eye is on the
● If, due to a fault, the gearbox is out of lubri-
right side of the front bumper behind a lid
cant.
››› Fig. 98.
● If the vehicle battery is discharged, be-
cause the steering remains locked and, if ap- The towing eye should always be kept in the
propriate, the electronic parking brake can- vehicle.
not be deactivated or the electronic lock of Bear in mind the instructions for towing
the steering column released. ››› page 99.
● If a distance above 50 km needs to be trav-
elled. Fitting the towline anchorage
● When, for example, after an accident, the Fig. 98 Front bumper on right: remove the lid. ● Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
smooth rotation of the wheels or the steering tool kit in the luggage compartment
operation cannot be guaranteed. ››› page 95.
● Extract the lid for the towing eye using the
When the vehicle is to tow another vehicle: vehicle key blade (if you do not have the spe-
● Observe legal requirements. cific tool), pressing on the side and levering
gently from left to right.
● Keep in mind the instructions in the man-
ual on towing vehicles. ● Remove the lid and let it hang from the ve-
hicle.

100
Self-help

● Screw the towing eye in the housing by Fitting the rear towing eye or installed and used for towing

Technical data
turning it to the maximum anticlock- ››› page 273, ››› .
wise ››› . Use a suitable object that can
Bear in mind the instructions for towing
completely and securely tighten the towing
››› page 99.
eye in its housing.
● After towing, unscrew the towing eye clock- Assemble the rear towing eye (cars without a
wise with a suitable object. factory-equipped towing bracket)
● Insert the side tab of the lid into the open- ● Remove the towing eye from the vehicle

Advice
ing of the bumper and press until the tab is tool kit in the luggage compartment
properly clipped into the bumper. ››› page 95.
● Clean the towing eye if necessary and then ● Press the upper side of the lid ››› Fig. 100 to
store it in the luggage compartment along unclip it.
Fig. 100 Rear bumper on right: remove the
with the other vehicle tools.
lid. ● Remove the lid and let it hang from the ve-

Operation
CAUTION hicle.
● Screw the towing eye in the housing by
The towing eye must always be completely
and firmly tightened. Otherwise, it could be turning it to the maximum anticlockwise
released while towing and tow-starting. ››› Fig. 101 ››› . Use a suitable object that
can completely and securely tighten the tow-
ing eye in its housing.

Emergencies
● After towing, unscrew the towing eye clock-
wise with a suitable object.
● Insert the upper flange of the lid into the
opening of the bumper and press the lower
Fig. 101 Rear bumper on right: towline an- side of the lid until the upper flange is inser-
chorage screwed in. ted into the bumper.
● Clean the towing eye if necessary and then

Safety
The housing of the screw towing eye is on the store it in the luggage compartment along
right side of the rear bumper behind a lid with the other vehicle tools. »
››› Fig. 100. Vehicles equipped as standard
with a towing bracket do not have any hous-
ing for the screw towing eye behind the lid. In
this case, the tow hitch needs to be extracted
101
Emergencies

CAUTION position, the hazard warning lights will be


automatically reactivated.
Fuses and bulbs
● The towing eye must always be completely
and firmly tightened. Otherwise, it could be
Notes for the driver of the towed vehicle Fuses
released while towing and tow-starting.
● If the vehicle is factory-equipped with a ● Leave the ignition on, so that the steering
is not blocked, and the electronic parking
Introduction
towing bracket, it is only allowed to tow with
a tow bar if this has been specially designed brake may be deactivated and the turn sig-
In general, a fuse can be assigned to various
to be installed with a tow hitch. If an unsuita- nals and wash/wipe operated.
electrical components. Likewise, an electrical
ble tow bar is used, both the tow hitch and ● More strength is required at the steering component can be protected by several
the vehicle may be damaged. Instead, a tow wheel as the power steering does not oper-
rope should be used.
fuses.
ate when the engine is switched off.
Only replace fuses when the cause of the
● You should depress the brake much harder
problem has been solved. If a newly inserted
as the brake servo does not operate. Avoid fuse blows after a short time, you must have
Driving tips for towing hitting the towing vehicle. the electrical system checked by a special-
Towing requires some expertise and experi- ● Bear in mind the information and instruc- ised workshop as soon as possible.
ence, especially when using a tow rope. Both tions in the manual of the vehicle to be tow-
drivers should be familiar with the difficulties ed. WARNING
involved in towing. For this reason, inexper- The high voltages in the electrical system can
ienced drivers should abstain from towing. Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle give serious electrical shocks, causing burns
● Accelerate with particular care and caution. and even death!
During towing, it should be ensured that no
impermissible tractive forces or shocks are Avoid sharp manoeuvres. ● Never touch the electrical wiring of the igni-
generated. When towing on an unpaved ● Brake earlier than usual and smoothly. tion system.
road, there is always a risk of overloading ● Take care not to cause short circuits in the
● Bear in mind the information and instruc-
and damaging the anchorage points. electrical system.
tions in the manual of the towed vehicle.
During towing, the towing vehicle can signal
the change of direction even with the hazard WARNING
warning lights turned on. To do so, at the Using unsuitable fuses, repairing fuses or
same time, the turn signal lever must be op- bridging a current circuit without fuses can
erated with ignition switched on. Meanwhile, cause a fire and serious injury.
the hazard warning lights will go off. When
the turn signal lever is returned to the rest

102
Fuses and bulbs

● Never use a fuse with a higher value. Only Vehicle interior fuses

Technical data
replace fuses with a fuse of the same amper-
age (same colour and markings) and size.
● Never repair a fuse.
● Never replace a fuse by a metal strip, staple
or similar.

CAUTION

Advice
● To prevent damage to the vehicle's electric
system, before replacing a fuse always turn
off the ignition, the lights and all electrical
elements and remove the key from the igni- Fig. 102 On the driver-side dash panel (left-
tion. hand drive): fuse box cover.
● If you replace a fuse with higher-rating

Operation
fuse, you could cause damage to another part
of the electrical system.
● Protect the fuse boxes when open to pre-
vent the entry of dust or humidity as they can
damage the electrical system.

Emergencies
Fig. 103 Glove compartment (right-hand
Note drive): Access to the fuse box.
● One component may have more than one
fuse. Opening and closing the fuse box situated
below the dash panel (left-hand drive)
● Several components may run on a single
fuse. ● Opening: fold the cover down ››› Fig. 102.
● Closing: push back the cover it in until it

Safety
clicks into place.

Fuses behind the glove compartment (right-


hand drive)
To be able to access the fuse box: »
103
Emergencies

● Undo the opening limiter ››› Fig. 103 A in Engine compartment fuses Fuses in the vehicle interior
two steps: first, unlock the limiter by pulling
No. Consumers/Amps
back on it (arrow 1 ) and then move it gently
to the right (arrow 2 ). Remove the guide 1 Adblue (SCR) 30
when the cover is in the normal opening po-
sition (30°). 5 Gateway 5

● Free the side pivots B to release the cover 6 Automatic gearbox lever 5
to its second opening position (60°).
Air conditioning and heating con-
Follow the same procedure in reverse order to 7 trol panel, back window heating, 10
auxiliary heating.
return the glove compartment to its normal
position. Diagnosis, handbrake switch,
Fig. 104 In the engine compartment: fuse box light switch, reverse light, interior
8 10
CAUTION cover. lighting, driving mode, lit-up door
sill
● Always carefully remove the fuse box cov-
To open the engine compartment fuse box 9 Steering column 5
ers and refit them correctly to avoid problems
with your vehicle. ● Open the bonnet  ››› page 298.
10 Radio display 7.5
● Protect the fuse boxes when open to avoid ● Press the locking tabs to release the fuse
the entry of dust or humidity. Dirt and humid- box cover ››› Fig. 104. 11 Left lights 40
ity inside fuse boxes can cause damage to
● Then lift the cover out. 12 Radio 20
the electrical system.
● To fit the cover, place it on the fuse box.
14 Air conditioner fan 40
Push the locking tabs down until they click
audibly into place. 15 Steering column release 10

16 Connectivity Box. 7.5

Fuse placement 17 Instrument panel 7.5

18 Rear camera 7.5


Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 61 19 Kessy 7.5

Only replace fuses with a fuse of the same 21 4x4 Haldex Control Unit 15
amperage (same colour and markings) and
22 Trailer 15
size.

104
Fuses and bulbs

No. Consumers/Amps No. Consumers/Amps No. Consumers/Amps

Technical data
23 Electric sunroof 30 45 Electric driver's seat 15 13 Automatic gearbox control unit 15/30

24 Right lights 40 47 Rear window wiper 15 14 Heated windscreen 40

25 Left door 30 49 Starter motor; clutch sensor 5 15 Horn 15

26 Heated seats 30 50 Electric rear lid 40 16 Petrol pump 5/15/20

27 Interior light 30 52 Driving mode. 15 17 Engine control unit 7.5

Advice
28 Trailer 25 53 Heated rear window 30 18 Terminal 30 (positive reference) 5

Control unit for parking aid, front Fuse arrangement in engine compartment 19 Front windscreen washer 30
32 7.5/10
camera and radar
20 Alarm horn 10
No. Consumers/Amps
33 Airbag 5

Operation
22 Engine control unit 5
1 ESP control unit 25
Reverse switch, climate sensor,
34 electrochromic mirror, rear power 7.5 23 Starter motor 30
2 ESP control unit 40
sockets (USB)
24 PTC 40
Engine control unit (diesel/pet-
Diagnosis, headlight control unit, 3 30/15
35 10 rol) 31 Pressure pump 15
headlight adjuster

Emergencies
4 Engine sensors 5/10 33 Gearbox pump 30
36 Right LED headlight 7.5
5 Engine sensors 7.5 37 Parking heating 20
37 Left LED headlight 7.5
6 Brake light sensor 5
38 Trailer 25 Note
7 Engine power supply 10
39 Right door 30 ● In the vehicle, there are more fuses than
8 Lambda probe 10/15 those indicated in this chapter. These should
40 12V socket 20
only be changed by a specialised workshop.

Safety
9 Engine 5/10/20
42 Central locking 40 ● Positions not containing a fuse do not ap-
10 Fuel pump control unit 15/20 pear in the following tables.
SEAT Sound, beats sound CAN
43 30 ● Some of the equipment listed in the tables
and MOST. 11 PTC 40
below pertain only to certain versions of the
44 Trailer 15 12 PTC 40 model or are optional extras. »
105
Emergencies

● Please note that the above lists, while cor- Full-LED headlight system* For the sake of the environment
rect at the time of printing, are subject to Full-LED headlights handle all light functions Please ask your specialist retailer how to dis-
change. (daylight, side light, turn signal, dipped pose of used bulbs in the proper manner.
beam and route light) with light emitting di-
odes (LEDs) as a light source.
Note
Changing a bulb Full-LED headlights are designed to last the ● Please check at regular intervals that all
lifetime of the car and light bulbs cannot be lighting (especially the exterior lighting) on
Topic introduction replaced. In case of headlight failure, go to your vehicle is functioning properly. This is
an authorised workshop to have it replaced. not only in the interest of your own safety,
Read the additional information carefully but also that of all other road users.
›››  page 62. WARNING ● Before changing a bulb, make sure you
● Take particular care when working on com- have the correct new bulb.
Changing bulbs requires a certain degree of ponents in the engine compartment if the en- ● Do not touch the glass part of the bulb with
practical skill. gine is warm. Risk of burns. your bare hands, use a cloth or paper towel
If you choose to change the engine compart- ● Bulbs are highly sensitive to pressure. The instead, since the fingerprints left on the
ment lamps yourself, remember that it is a glass can break when you touch the bulb, glass will vaporise as a result of the heat gen-
dangerous area ››› in Working in the en- causing injury. erated by the bulb, they will be deposited on
gine compartment on page 299. ● When changing bulbs, please take care not the reflector and will impair its surface.
to injure yourself on sharp edges, in particu- ● Depending on the level of equipment fitted
Always use identical bulbs with the same
lar on the headlight housing. in the vehicle, LEDs may be used for part or
designation. The name can be found on the
all of the interior and/or exterior lighting.
base of the bulb holder. LEDs have an estimated life that exceeds than
CAUTION
Depending on how equipped the vehicle is, that of the car. If an LED light fails, go to an
there are different sets of headlights and tail ● Remove the ignition key before working on authorised workshop for its replacement.
lights: the electric system. Otherwise, a short circuit
could occur.
● Halogen headlights. ● Switch off the lights and the parking light
● Full-LED main headlights* before changing a bulb.
● Rear bulb light ● Take good care to avoid damaging any com-
ponents.
● LED rear light*

106
Fuses and bulbs

Change the front bulbs 2. Move the loops ››› Fig. 105 1 in the di-

Technical data
rection of the arrow and remove the cov-
er.
Dipped beam headlight
3. Remove connector ››› Fig. 106 2 from
the bulb.
4. Unclip the retainer spring ››› Fig. 106 3
pressing clockwise and inwards.
5. Extract the bulb and fit the replacement

Advice
so that the lug on the base fits into the
recess on the reflector.
6. Installation involves all of the above
steps in reverse sequence.

Operation
Fig. 105 In the engine compartment: remove
the lid. Main beam headlight bulb and turn Fig. 108 In the engine compartment: main
signal bulb beam headlight bulb 2 and turn signal bulb
3 .

Follow the steps indicated:

Emergencies
Main beam headlight bulb
1. Raise the bonnet.
2. Move the loop ››› Fig. 107 1 in the di-
rection of the arrow and remove the cov-
er.
3. Slide connector ››› Fig. 108 2 to the left

Safety
Fig. 106 In the engine compartment: dipped or right and pull.
beam headlight. Fig. 107 In the engine compartment: remove
the lid. 4. Remove the bulb by disconnecting the
connector.
Follow the steps indicated:
5. Installation involves all of the above
1. Raise the bonnet. steps in reverse sequence. »
107
Emergencies

Turn signal bulb Front fog light bulb*


1. Raise the bonnet.
2. Move the loop ››› Fig. 107 1 in the di-
rection of the arrow and remove the cov-
er.
3. Turn the bulb holder ››› Fig. 108 3 anti-
clockwise and pull.
4. Remove the bulb by pressing on the
bulb holder and turning it anticlockwise
at the same time. Fig. 110 Fog light: remove the bulb holder
5. Installation involves all of the above
steps in reverse sequence. Follow the steps indicated:

1. Remove the screw ››› Fig. 109 1  from


the fog light grille using a screwdriver
and extract the grille.
2. Remove the 3 screws ››› Fig. 109 2 .
3. Remove the metal clip situated on the
upper part of the fog light by pulling
away from the vehicle 3  and extract
the fog light.
Fig. 109 Fog light: extracting the grille. 4. Remove connector ››› Fig. 110 1 from
the bulb.
5. Turn the bulb holder ››› Fig. 110 2 anti-
clockwise and pull.
6. Remove the bulb by pressing on the
bulb holder and turning it anticlockwise
at the same time.
7. Installation involves all of the above
steps in reverse sequence.
8. Check that the bulb works properly.
108
Fuses and bulbs

Note Rear bulbs (in the side panel) 3. Remove the lid, levering it with the flat

Technical data
side of a screwdriver into the recess
Due to the difficulty of accessing fog light ››› Fig. 111 1 .
bulbs, have them replaced at a Technical
Service or specialised workshop. 4. Remove the bulb connector.
5. Unscrew the light securing bolt by hand
or using a screwdriver ››› Fig. 111 2 .
6. Remove the light from the body, gently
Change the rear bulbs pulling it toward you, and place on a

Advice
clean, smooth surface.
Overview of tail lights
7. Disassemble the bulb holder unlocking
Tail lights on side panel the securing tabs ››› Fig. 112 1 .
Fig. 111 Luggage compartment: access to the 8. Change the damaged bulb.
Turn signal PY21W NA LL
bolt securing the tail light unit.
9. To refit follow the steps in reverse order,

Operation
Side light and brake light P21W LL taking special care when fitting the bulb
holder. The securing tabs must click into
Tail lights on the rear lid place.
Left side
CAUTION
Side lights P21W LL Take care when removing the rear light unit to

Emergencies
make sure there is no damage to the paint-
Fog light/side light P21W LL
work or any of its components.
Reverse light W16W

Right side Note


Fig. 112 Retaining tabs on reverse side of tail ● Make sure you have a soft cloth ready to
Side lights 2 x P21W LL
light. place under the glass on the rear light unit, to
Reverse light W16W avoid any scratches.

Safety
Follow the steps indicated: ● In the case of LED lights, change only the
The table corresponds to a right-hand traffic turn signal bulb.
vehicle. The position of lights may vary ac- 1. Check which of the bulbs is defective.
cording to the country. 2. Open the rear lid.

109
Emergencies

Rear lights (in the rear lid) 2. Unlock the securing tabs from the bulb Changing number plate light bulbs
holder ››› Fig. 114 1 or turn the bulb
holder to the left 2 and 3 .
3. Remove the bulb holder from its loca-
tion.
4. Lightly press the defective bulb into the
bulb holder, then turn it to the left and
remove it.
5. Fit the new bulb, pressing it into the
bulb holder and turn it to the right as far
as it will go.
Fig. 113 Rear lid open: remove the lid. 6. Use a cloth to remove any fingerprints Fig. 115 In the rear bumper: number plate
from the glass part of the bulb. light.
7. Check that the new bulb works properly.
8. Carry out the same actions in reverse or-
der for assembly and pay special atten-
tion to placing the bulb holder, ensuring
that the tabs are properly secured.

Note
For LED pilots, you can only change the re-
verse bulb.

Fig. 114 Remove the bulb holder.


Fig. 116 Number plate light: Remove the bulb
The rear lid must be open to change the holder.
bulbs.
Follow the steps indicated:
Follow the steps indicated:
1. Press the number plate light in the direc-
1. Remove the rear lid cover in the direc- tion of the arrow ››› Fig. 115.
tion indicated ››› Fig. 113.
2. Remove the number plate light.

110
Fuses and bulbs

3. Turn the connector lock ››› Fig. 116 in the Side turn signals

Technical data
direction of arrow 1 and pull on the
connector.
4. Rotate the bulb holder in the direction of
arrow 2 and extract it with the bulb.
5. Replace the defective bulb with a new
bulb with the same features.
6. Insert the bulb holder in the number

Advice
plate light and turn in the opposite di-
rection of arrow 2 until it stops.
7. Plug the connector into the bulb holder.
Fig. 117 Turn signal integrated in the rear
Note view mirror

Operation
Depending on how equipped the vehicle is,
the number plate lights may be LEDs. LEDs The side turn signals are LEDS and are inte-
have an estimated life that exceeds than that grated in the exterior mirrors.
of the car. If a light with LEDs fails, go to an
In case of failure, go to an authorised work-
authorised workshop for replacement.
shop to have them replaced.

Emergencies
Safety
111
Operation

Fig. 118 Instruments and controls.

112
Controls and displays

Operation 9 Control lever for: – Lighter/power socket . . . . . . . . . . . 162

Technical data
– Windscreen wipers and washer . . 153 – Connectivity Box/Wireless Charg-
– Wipe and wash system . . . . . . . . . . 153 er* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Controls and displays – Storage compartment
– On-board computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Depending on equipment fitted: ra- 18 Gear lever for:
General instrument panel 10
dio or display for Easy Connect – Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
1 Door release lever (navigation, radio, TV/video) . . . . . . 120 – Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193

Advice
2 Central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 11 Depending on the equipment, but- 19 Rotating control(Driving Experience
3 Control for the electric adjustment tons for: button) for driving modes . . . . . . . . . 242
of the exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 – Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 20 Auto Hold switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
4 Air outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 – Park assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 21 Electronic parking brake switch . . . 186
5 Control lever for: – Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . 149 22 Starter button (Keyless Access lock-

Operation
– Turn signals and main beam – Tyre pressure switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 ing and ignition system) . . . . . . . . . . 183
headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 – Airbag off display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 23 Driver's seat heating control . . . . . . 158
– Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 12 Depending on the equipment, 24 Ignition lock (vehicles without Key-
– Main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 glove compartment with: . . . . . . . . . 161 less Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
– Cruise control system (CCS) . . . . . 212 – CD player* and/or SD card* 25 Steering column adjustment lev-

Emergencies
6 Depending on equipment fitted: ››› Booklet Radio er . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

– Lever for cruise control . . . . . . . . . . 212


13 Front passenger airbag . . . . . . . . . . . 21 26 Knee airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
7 Steering wheel with horn and
14 Front passenger airbag switch . . . . 88 27 Bonnet lock release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299

– Driver airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
15 Passenger seat heating control . . . . 158 28 Headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . 151

– On-board computer controls . . . . 36


16 Depending on the equipment, con- 29 Headlight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
trols for: 30 Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
– Controls for radio, telephone,

Safety
– Heating and ventilation system or
navigation and speech dialogue
system ››› Booklet Radio manual air conditioner . . . . . . . . . . 54, 53 Note
– Automatic air conditioner . . . . . . . 51 ● Some of the equipment listed in this sec-
– Paddle levers for tiptronic gear-
Depending on the equipment: tion is only fitted on certain models or are op-
shift (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . 195 17
tional extras. »
8 Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 – USB/AUX-IN input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
113
Operation

● A separate Instructions Manual is enclosed ● The arrangement of switches and controls ››› page 112. However, the symbols used to
if the vehicle is equipped with a factory-fitted on right-hand drive models* may be slightly identify the controls are the same.
radio, CD player, AUX IN connection or navi- different from the layout shown in
gation system.

Instruments and warning/control lamps


Instruments
View of instrument panel

Fig. 119 Instrument panel, on dash panel.

Details of the instruments ››› Fig. 119: 1 Rev counter (with the engine running, in The beginning of the red zone of the rev
hundreds of revolutions per minute). counter indicates the maximum speed in
any gear after running-in and with the
114
Instruments and warning/control lamps

engine hot. However, it is advisable to Revolution counter For the sake of the environment

Technical data
change up a gear or move the selector
lever to D (or lift your foot off the acceler- The rev counter indicates the number of en- Changing up a gear early will help you to save
fuel and minimise emissions and engine
ator) before the needle reaches the red gine revolutions per minute ››› Fig. 119 1 .
noise.
zone ››› .
Together with the gear-change indicator, the
2 Engine coolant temperature display rev counter offers you the possibility of using
››› page 117. the engine of your vehicle at a suitable Indications on the display
3 Displays on the screen ››› page 115. speed.

Advice
4 Adjuster button and display The start of the red zone on the dial indicates A variety of information can be viewed on the
››› page 117. the maximum engine speed which may be instrument panel display ››› Fig. 119 3 , de-
used briefly when the engine is warm and af- pending on the vehicle equipment:
5 Speedometer.
ter it has been run in properly. Before reach-
6 Fuel gauge ››› page 118. ● Bonnet, rear lid and doors open
ing this range, you should change to a higher
gear for vehicles with a manual gearbox or for
›››  page 40.

Operation
WARNING ● Warning and information messages
automatic gearboxes put the selector lever in
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with “D” or take your foot off the accelerator ped- ›››  page 40.
the risk of injury. al. ● Distance travelled ››› page 117.
● Do not operate the instrument panel con-
We recommend that you avoid high revs and ● Time ››› page 116.
trols when driving.
that you follow the recommendations on the ● Navigation instructions.

Emergencies
gear-change indicator. Consult the additional
● Outside temperature ›››  page 41.
CAUTION information in ›››  page 41, Gear-change
indicator. ● Compass ››› page 116.
● To prevent damage to the engine, the rev
counter needle should only remain in the red ● Shift lever position ››› page 193.
zone for a short period of time. CAUTION
● Recommended gear (manual gearbox)
● When the engine is cold, avoid high revs Never allow the rev counter needle 1 ›››  page 41.
and heavy acceleration and do not make the ››› Fig. 119 to go into the red zone on the ● Multifunction display (MFD) and menus
engine work hard. scale for more than a very brief period, other-

Safety
wise there is a risk of engine damage.
with different setting options ›››  page 36.
● Service interval display ›››  page 43.
For the sake of the environment
● Second speed display ››› page 116.
Changing up a gear in time reduces fuel con-
sumption and noise. ● Speed warning function ›››  page 42. »

115
Operation

● Start-Stop system status display ton down to scroll through the numbers This option cannot be deactivated in models
››› page 208. quickly. destined for countries in which the second
● Active cylinder management display ● Press the button 4 again in order to finish speed must always be visible.
(ACT®)* ››› page 202 setting the time. The second speed display can be adjusted in
● Signs recognised by the traffic signal de- the Easy Connect system by means of the 
The time can also be set on the Easy Connect
tection system ››› page 245 button and the function button SETTINGS >
system using the  button and the function
● Low consumption driving status (ECO) Units ›››  page 33.
button SETTINGS > Date and time
››› page 116 ›››  page 33.
Speed warning
● Engine code (MKB) ››› page 117.
Compass When the speed setting is exceeded, this will
Distance travelled be indicated on the instrument panel display.
With the ignition on and the navigation sys-
This is very useful, for example when using
The odometer registers the total distance tem on, the cardinal point corresponding to
winter tyres that are not designed for driving
travelled by the car. the direction of travel of the vehicle is dis-
at the maximum speed of the vehicle
played on the instrument panel.
The odometer (trip) shows the distance ›››  page 42.
travelled since the last odometer reset. The Selector lever position The speed warning settings can be adjusted
last digit of the trip recorder indicates distan- in the Easy Connect system by means of the
ces of 100 metres or one tenths of a mile. The selected gear is displayed on the side of
 button and the function button SET-
the selector lever and on the instrument pan-
● Briefly press the button ››› Fig. 119 TINGS > Driver Assistance
4 to re- el display. In positions D and S, and with the
set the trip recorder to 0. Tiptronic, the corresponding gear is also dis-
›››  page 33.
● Keep the button 4 pressed for about 3 played.
Start-Stop operating display
seconds and the previous value will be dis-
played. Recommended gear (manual gearbox) Updated information relating to the status is
displayed on the instrument panel
The recommended gear in order to save fuel
Time is displayed on the instrument panel while
››› page 208.
● To set the time, keep the button ››› Fig. 119 you are driving ›››  page 41.
Low consumption driving status (ECO)*
4 pressed for more than 3 seconds to select
the hour or minute display. Second speed display (mph or km/h) Depending on the equipment, when driving,
the “ECO” display appears on the instrument
● To continue setting the time, press the up- In addition to the speedometer, the speed
panel when the vehicle is in low consump-
per or lower part of the button 4 . Hold but- can also be displayed in a different unit of
tion status due to active cylinder manage-
measurement (in miles or in km per hour).
ment (ACT®)* ››› page 202.
116
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Identifying letters on engine (MKB) ● When several warnings are active at the used to measure short trips. The last digit of

Technical data
Hold the button ››› Fig. 119 4 down for more same time, the symbols are shown succes- the trip recorder indicates distances of 100
than 15 seconds to display the identifying sively for a few seconds and will stay on until metres or tenths of a mile.
letters of the vehicle engine (MKB). To do the fault is rectified.
The trip recorder can be set to zero by press-
this, the ignition must be switched on and ing 0.0/SET ››› Fig. 120.
the engine switched off.
Odometer Fault display
WARNING
If there is a fault in the instrument panel, the

Advice
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning letters DEF will appear in the trip recorder
and control lamps on page 119. display. Have the fault repaired immediately,
as far as is possible.
WARNING
Even though outside temperatures are above
freezing, some roads and bridges may be icy. Coolant temperature gauge

Operation
● At outside temperatures above +4°C
(+39°F), even when the “ice crystal” symbol
is not visible, there may still be patches of ice
on the road.
Fig. 120 Instrument panel: odometer and re-
● The outside temperature sensor takes a set button.

Emergencies
guideline measurement.
The distance covered is displayed in “kilome-
Note tres” or miles “m”. It is possible to change
the measurement units (kilometres
● Different versions of the instrument panel
“km”/miles “m”) in the radio/Easy Connect*.
are available and therefore the versions and
Please refer to the Easy Connect* Instructions
instructions on the display may vary. In the
Manual for more details. Fig. 121 Instrument panel: coolant tempera-
case of displays without warning or informa-
ture gauge
tion texts, faults are indicated exclusively by

Safety
the warning lamps. Odometer/trip recorder
For vehicles with no coolant temperature
● Depending on the equipment, some set- The odometer shows the total distance cov- gauge, a control lamp  appears for high
tings and instructions can also be carried out ered by the vehicle. coolant temperatures ››› page 302. Please
in the Easy Connect system.
The trip recorder shows the distance that has note ››› . »
been travelled since it was last reset. It is
117
Operation

The coolant temperature gauge only works CAUTION Fuel level


when the ignition is switched on ››› Fig. 121.
● To ensure a long useful life for the engine,
In order to avoid engine damage, please read
avoid high revs, driving at high speed and
the following notes for the different tempera-
making the engine work hard for approxi-
ture ranges.
mately the first 15 minutes when the engine
is cold. The phase until the engine is warm al-
Engine cold so depends on the outside temperature. If
If only the diodes in the lower part of the necessary, use the engine oil temperature*
scale light up, this indicates that the engine ›››  page 42 as a guide.
has not yet reached operating temperature. ● Additional lights and other accessories in
Avoid high revs and heavy acceleration and front of the air inlet reduce the cooling effect
do not make the engine work hard. of the coolant. At high outside temperatures
and high engine loads, there is a risk of the Fig. 122 Fuel gauge.
engine overheating.
Normal temperature
● The front spoiler also ensures proper distri- The display ››› Fig. 122 only works when the
If in normal operations, the diodes light up bution of the cooling air when the vehicle is ignition is switched on. When the display rea-
until the central zone, it means that the en- moving. If the spoiler is damaged this can re- ches the reserve mark, the lower diode lights
gine has reached operating temperature. At duce the cooling effect, which could cause up in red and the control lamp  appears
high outside temperatures and when making the engine to overheat. Seek specialist assis- ››› page 114. When the fuel level is very low,
the engine work hard, the diodes may contin- tance. the lower diode flashes in red.
ue lighting up and reach the upper zone. This
is no cause for concern, provided the control The distance to empty fuel level is displayed
lamp  does not light up on the instrument on the instrument panel 3 ››› Fig. 119.
panel digital display. The capacity of the fuel tank of your vehicle is
given in the Technical data section
Heat range ›››  page 56.
When the diodes light up in the upper area of
the display and the control lamp appears  CAUTION
on the instrument panel display, the coolant Never run the fuel tank completely dry. An ir-
temperature is excessive ››› page 302. regular fuel supply could cause misfiring. In
this way the unburned fuel can reach the ex-
haust system, which could cause the catalytic
converter to overheat resulting in damage.

118
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Control lamps ● Park the vehicle away from traffic and en-

Technical data
sure that there are no highly flammable ma-
Warning and control lamps terials under the vehicle that could come into
contact with the exhaust system (e.g. dry
Read the additional information carefully grass, fuel).
›››  page 46. ● A faulty vehicle represents a risk of acci-
dent for the driver and for other road users. If
The control and warning lamps are indicators necessary, switch on the hazard warning
of warnings, ››› , faults ››› or certain func- lamps and put out the warning triangle to ad-

Advice
tions. Some control and warning lamps come vise other drivers.
on when the ignition is switched on, and ● Before opening the bonnet, switch off the
switch off when the engine starts running, or engine and allow it to cool.
while driving. ● In any vehicle, the engine compartment is a
Depending on the model, additional text hazardous area and could cause severe inju-
ries ››› page 298.

Operation
messages may be viewed on the instrument
panel display. These may be purely informa-
tive or they may be advising of the need for CAUTION
action ››› page 114, Instruments. Failure to heed the control lamps and text
Depending upon the equipment fitted in the messages when they appear may result in
vehicle, instead of a warning lamp, some- faults in the vehicle.

Emergencies
times a symbol may be displayed on the in-
strument panel.
When certain control and warning lamps are
lit, an audible warning is also heard.

WARNING
If the warning lamps and messages are ignor-

Safety
ed, the vehicle may stall in traffic, or may
cause accidents and severe injuries.
● Never ignore the warning lamps or text
messages.
● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.

119
Operation

Introduction to the Easy Function buttons in the Page


vehicle settings
Connect system* menu
Driver assistance ››› table on page 33
System settings (CAR)*
Parking and manoeuvring ››› page 262
CAR menu Vehicle lights ››› table on page 33
Read the additional information carefully Mirrors and windscreen wipers ››› table on page 33
›››  page 33
Opening and closing ››› table on page 33
To select the settings menus, press the Easy
Connect  button and the SETTINGS func- Multifunction display ››› table on page 33
tion button. Date and time ››› table on page 33
The actual number of menus available and Units ››› table on page 33
the name of the various options in these me-
nus will depend on the vehicle’s electronics Service ››› page 115
and equipment.
Factory settings ››› table on page 33
When the function button check box is activa-
ted , the function is active. WARNING
Pressing the menu button  will always take Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
you to the last menu used. the risk of injury. Operating the Easy Connect
system while driving could distract you from
Any changes made using the settings menus traffic.
are automatically saved on closing those me-
nus.

Function buttons in the Page


vehicle settings
menu
ESC system ››› page 189
Tyres ››› page 311
120
Communications and multimedia

Communications and multimedia

Technical data
Controls on the steering wheel*
Operating the audio, telephone and navigation system with voice control

Advice
Operation
Fig. 123 Controls on the steering wheel.

The steering wheel includes a multifunction the audio, telephone and radio/navigation
module from where it is possible to control functions without needing to distract the
driver.

Emergencies
Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephonea) Navigationa)
Turn announcement volume
up/down. You do not need to
Turn volume up/down. You do Turn volume up/down. You do Turn volume up/down. You do Turn volume up/down. You do
A be in navigation mode but
not need to be in audio mode not need to be in audio mode not need to be in audio mode not need to be in telephone
Turn there has to be an announce-
(radio). (media). (media). mode.
ment active when you adjust
the volume.

Safety
A Mute the current navigation an-
Mute volume. Mute volume. Mute volume. Mute incoming call.
Press nouncement.

Activate/deactivate voice control.


B a) This function can be used from any mode (audio, media, navigation, assistants, vehicle status, travel data). When the system is in telephone mode this button’s function
is deactivated during the ongoing call, and without Radio/Media functionality (except AUX). »
121
Operation

Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephonea) Navigationa)


Short press: Switch to the pre- – There is no active call: Ra-
vious/next song. dio/Media functionality (ex- No function for the other
Search for the previous/next
C / D No function cept AUX) modes (navigation, assistants,
stationb).
Hold down: Fast rewind/for- vehicle status, travel data).
wardc). – Active call: no function

Change instrument panel menu.


E / F a)
This function can be used from any mode (audio, media, navigation, assistants, vehicle status, travel data).

Coloured instrument panel: switch to the previous menu.


G
Monochrome instrument panel: switch to the previous function.

– There is no active call: List of


latest calls. – Active route: access the view
Coloured instrument panel: List
Coloured instrument panel: to halt guidance to destination.
H of stations available (only if
next track (only if the instru- No function – Active call: access the call
Turn the instrument panel is in au-
ment panel is in audio menu). options list (call on hold, hang – No active route: list of recent
dio menu).
up, mute microphone, private destinations.
number, etc.).

H
Acts on the instrument panel or confirms the instrument panel menu option depending on the menu option.
Press
a) According to the vehicle's equipment package.
b) This action can be performed when you are listening to the radio; there is no need to be in audio-radio mode.
c) These actions can be performed when you are listening to media; there is no need to be in audio-radio mode.

122
Communications and multimedia

Multimedia Depending on the special characteristics and

Technical data
the country, the vehicle may have a
USB/AUX-IN port.
USB/AUX-INPort
The USB/AUX-IN port can be found in the
storage compartment area of the centre con-
sole ››› Fig. 124.
The operating description is located in the re-
spective Instruction Manuals of the audio

Advice
system or the navigation system.
Depending on the equipment and the coun- Fig. 127 Centre console: Connectivity Box.
try, the vehicle may also have USB connec-
tions exclusively for charging or as a power Depending on the features and the country,
socket. the vehicle may have one of these two op-

Operation
tions: Connectivity Box or Wireless Charger.
Fig. 124 Centre console: USB/AUX-IN input. These USB ports are located at the rear of the
console, between the front seats ››› Fig. 125. With the Connectivity Box you can charge
your mobile device wirelessly with Qi1) tech-
nology, while also reducing the radiation in
Connectivity Box* / Wireless Charger* the vehicle and getting better reception.
With the Wireless Charger you only have the

Emergencies
wireless charging function if your mobile de-
vice has Qi technology.
The Connectivity Box/Wireless Charger is in
the storage compartment area of the centre
console ››› Fig. 127.
Fig. 126 Related video
Fig. 125 Centre console, rear section: USB The operating description is located in the re-

Safety
connectors. spective Instruction Manuals of the audio
system or the navigation system. »

1) Qi technology allows you to charge your mobile

phone wirelessly.
123
Operation

Note
Your mobile device must support the Qi wire-
less inductive charging interface standard for
proper operation.

124
Opening and closing

Opening and closing The vehicle is unlocked again when the igni- the alarm from being triggered accidentally

Technical data
tion key is removed. Alternatively, the vehicle ››› page 136.
can also be unlocked via the central locking
Central locking switch or by pulling one of the inside door Turn signals
handles. The Auto Lock function can be
The turn signals will flash twice when the ve-
Description switched on and off on the sound system or
hicle is unlocked and once when the vehicle
on the Easy Connect* system ››› page 128.
is locked.
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 15 In the event of an accident in which the air-
If it does not flash, this indicates that one of

Advice
bags inflate, the doors will be automatically
the doors, the rear lid or the bonnet is not
The vehicle can be locked and unlocked via unlocked to facilitate access and assistance.
closed correctly.
the central locking system. There are several
methods, depending on the vehicle equip- Anti-theft alarm system*
ment: Accidental lock-out
If the anti-theft alarm system senses interfer-
The central locking system prevents you from
● key with remote control ››› page 127, ence with the vehicle it triggers an audible
being locked out of the vehicle in the follow-

Operation
and visible alarm.
● lock on driver door (emergency opening ing situations:
›››  page 15) or The anti-theft alarm system is automatically
● If the driver door is open, the vehicle can-
● interior central locking switch ››› page 128. switched on when locking the vehicle. It
switches off when the vehicle is unlocked not be locked with the central locking switch
from a distance. ››› page 128.
Unlocking one side of the vehicle only

Emergencies
When you lock the vehicle with the key, the When the driver door is unlocked with the Lock the vehicle with the remote control key,
doors and the rear lid are locked. When you key, you should switch on the ignition within when all the doors and the rear lid have been
open the door, you can either unlock only the 15 seconds. Otherwise the alarm will be trig- closed. This prevents the accidental locking
driver door, or all the vehicle doors. To select gered. On some export versions, the alarm is of the vehicle.
the required option, use Easy Connect* triggered immediately when you open a door.
››› page 128. WARNING
To deactivate the alarm, press the  button
on the remote control key, or switch on the Do not leave anyone (especially children) in

Safety
Auto Lock* ignition. After a certain time, the alarm will the vehicle if it is locked from the outside and
automatically switch off. the anti-theft security system* is enabled, as
The Auto Lock function locks the doors and the doors and windows cannot then be
the rear lid when the vehicle exceeds a speed Switch off the vehicle interior monitoring and opened from the inside. Locked doors could
of about 15 km/h (9 mph). tow-away protection if you wish to prevent delay assistance in an emergency, potentially
putting lives at risk. »
125
Operation

Note a longer period the control lamp flashes sev-


eral times, such as in convenience opening.
● Never leave any valuable items in the vehi-
cle unattended. Even a locked vehicle is not a If the vehicle key control lamp does not light
safe. up when the button is pressed, replace the
● If the diode on the driver door sill lights up key's battery ››› page 133.
for about 30 seconds when the vehicle is
locked, the central locking system or anti- Unfolding and folding the key shaft
theft alarm* is not working properly. You
Press button 1 ››› Fig. 128 or ››› Fig. 129 to
should have the fault repaired at a SEAT Offi-
unlock and unfold the key shaft.
cial Service or specialised workshop.
● The vehicle interior monitoring of the anti- Fig. 129 Vehicle key with alarm button. To fold the shaft away, press button 1 and
theft alarm* system will only function as in- fold the key shaft in until it locks in place.
tended if the windows and the sunroof* are Vehicle key
closed. With the vehicle key the vehicle may be Alarm button*
locked or unlocked remotely ››› page 125. Only press alarm button 2 in the event of an
The vehicle key includes an emitter and bat- emergency! When the alarm button is press-
Car key tery. The receiver is in the interior of the vehi- ed, the vehicle horn is heard and the turn sig-
cle. The range of the vehicle key with remote nals are switched on for a short time. When
control and new battery is several metres the alarm button is pressed again, the alarm
around the vehicle. is switched off.

If it is not possible to open or close the vehi- Spare key


cle using the remote control key, this should
be re-synchronised ››› page 134 or the bat- To obtain a spare key and other vehicle keys,
tery changed ››› page 133. the vehicle chassis number is required.

Different keys belonging to the vehicle may Each new key contains a microchip which
be used. must be coded with the data from the vehicle
electronic immobiliser. A vehicle key will not
Fig. 128 Vehicle key Control lamp on the vehicle key work if it does not contain a microchip or the
microchip has not been encoded. This is also
When a button on the vehicle key is pressed, true for keys which are specially cut for the
the control lamp flashes ››› Fig. 128 (arrow) vehicle.
once briefly, but if the button is held down for

126
Opening and closing

The vehicle keys or new spare keys can be against overloading. The vehicle is then un- ● Other functions of the remote control key

Technical data
obtained from a SEAT Official Service, a spe- locked. Lock it if necessary. ››› page 140, Convenience opening and clos-
cialised workshop or an approved key service ing.
qualified to create this kind of key.
New keys or spare keys must be synchron- Unlocking/Locking by remote control
ised before use ››› page 134. Selective unlocking system
Read the additional information carefully
CAUTION ›››  page 15 The selective unlocking system allows you to
only unlock the driver door and the fuel tank

Advice
All of the vehicle keys contain electronic com- The vehicle will be locked again automatical-
ponents. Protect them from damage, impacts flap. All other doors and the rear lid remain
ly if you do not open one of the doors or the
and humidity. locked.
rear lid within 30 seconds after unlocking the
car. This function prevents the vehicle from
Unlocking the driver door and tank flap
Note remaining unlocked if the unlocking button is
pressed by mistake. This does not apply if – Press (once) the  button on the remote

Operation
● Only use the key button when you require
you press the  button for at least one sec- control key or turn the key once in the
the corresponding function. Pushing the but-
ond. opening direction.
ton unnecessarily could accidentally unlock
the vehicle or trigger the alarm. It is also pos- In vehicles with a security central locking
sible even when you are outside the radius of Unlocking all the doors, the rear lid and the
feature (selective unlocking of side doors)
action. tank flap simultaneously.
››› page 127, when the  button is pressed
● Key operation can be greatly influenced by – Within 5 seconds, press (twice) the  but-

Emergencies
once, only the driver door and the fuel tank
overlapping radio signals close to the vehicle flap are unlocked. When the button is press- ton on the remote control key, or turn the
working in the same range of frequencies, for ed a second time, all the vehicle doors are key twice within 5 seconds in the opening
example, radio transmitters or mobile tele- unlocked. direction.
phones.
● Obstacles between the remote control and The anti-theft security system* and the anti-
WARNING
the vehicle, bad weather conditions and dis- theft alarm* are immediately disabled if you
charged batteries can considerably reduce Observe the safety warnings ››› in Descrip- unlock only the driver door, without unlock-
tion on page 125.

Safety
the range of the remote control. ing the other doors.
● If the buttons of the vehicle key are press- In vehicles with Easy Connect*, you can pro-
ed ››› Fig. 128 or ››› Fig. 129 or one of the cen- Note gramme the security central locking system
tral locking buttons ››› page 128 is pressed ● Do not use the remote control key until the directly ››› page 128.
repeatedly in short succession, the central vehicle is visible.
locking briefly disconnects as protection
127
Operation

Adjusting the central locking vehicle. In all the options, the fuel tank flap ● You can open the doors individually from
is also unlocked. the inside by pulling the inside door handle.
You can use Easy Connect* to select which ● In the event of an accident in which the air-
With the Driver setting, when you press the
doors are unlocked with the central locking bags inflate, doors locked from the inside will
 button on the remote control key once, on-
system. Using the radio or the Easy Connect* be automatically unlocked to facilitate access
ly the driver door is unlocked. If that button is
system, you can select whether the vehicle and assistance.
pressed twice, the rest of the doors and the
automatically closes with the “Auto Lock”
rear lid will be unlocked.
programme at speeds of more than 15 km/h WARNING
(9 mph). In vehicles with a conventional key, turn the
● The central locking switch also operates
key in the door lock, in the direction of open-
ing, twice within 2 seconds. when the ignition is switched off and auto-
Programming the unlocking of the doors (ve-
matically locks all the vehicle doors when the
hicles with Easy Connect) If the  button is pressed, all the vehicle  button is pressed.
– Select:  button > SETTINGS function doors are locked. At the same time, a confir- ● The central locking switch does not operate
button > Opening and closing > Cen- mation signal* is heard. if the vehicle is locked from the outside and
tral locking > Unlocking doors. the anti-theft security system is switched on.
Auto Lock while driving ● Locked doors could delay assistance in an
Programming the Auto Lock (vehicles with If you select on, all the vehicle doors are emergency, potentially putting lives at risk.
radio) locked at speeds above 15 km/h (9 mph). Do not leave anyone, especially children, in
– Select: SETUP button > control button  the vehicle.
Central locking > Locking while
driving. Central locking switch Note
Your vehicle will lock automatically when it
Programming the Auto Lock (vehicles with Read the additional information carefully reaches a speed of about 15 km/h (9 mph)
Easy Connect) ›››  page 15 (Auto Lock) ››› page 125. You can unlock the
– Select:  button > SETTINGS function vehicle again using the  button on the cen-
Please note the following when using the tral locking switch.
button > Opening and closing > Cen-
central locking switch to lock your vehicle:
tral locking > Locking while
driving. ● It is not possible to open the doors or the
rear lid from the outside (for safety reasons,
Unlocking doors
e.g. when stopped at traffic lights).
You can choose to unlock all the doors or ● The LED in the central locking switch lights
only the driver door when you unlock the up when all the doors are closed and locked.

128
Opening and closing

Related video Keyless Access Unlocking and locking the vehicle

Technical data
with Keyless Access*

Fig. 130 Handsfree

Advice
Fig. 132 Keyless Access locking and ignition
system: sensor surface A for unlocking in-
side the door handle and sensor surface B
for locking on the exterior of the handle.

Operation
Depending on the equipment, the vehicle
may have the Keyless Access system.
Keyless Access is a key-free locking and igni-
tion system to unlock and lock the vehicle
without actively using its key. To do this, all

Emergencies
that is required is to have a valid vehicle key
in the detection area where you are attempt-
ing to access the vehicle ››› Fig. 131  and to
Fig. 131 Keyless Access locking and ignition touch one of the sensor surfaces on the door
system:  In the proximity of the car.  handles ››› Fig. 132 or operate the soft-
Opening the rear lid with sensor-controlled touch/handle on the rear lid
opening (Easy Open) ››› page 137 ››› .

Safety
The vehicle can be unlocked and locked via
the front doors only. When doing so, the re-
mote control key must be no further than ap-
prox. 1.5 m from the door handle. »

129
Operation

It does not matter where you carry the key, for ● Press & Drive: keyless starting of the en- On vehicles without a “Safe” security sys-
instance whether it is in your jacket pocket or gine with the starter button ››› page 181. tem: shutting and locking doors (Keyless-Ex-
in a briefcase. it)
The central locking and locking systems oper-
Once the doors have been locked, they can- ● Switch the ignition off.
ate in the same way as a normal locking and
not be opened again immediately. This will unlocking system. Only the controls change. ● Close the driver's door.
enable you to check that the doors are prop- ● Touch (once) the locking sensor surface B
erly closed. Unlocking the vehicle is confirmed with a
double flash of the indicator lights; locking (arrow) on one of the front door handles. The
If you wish, when unlocking, you can unlock by a single flash. door that is used must be closed.
only the corresponding door or the entire ve-
hicle. The necessary adjustments can be per- If the vehicle is locked and then all doors and On vehicles with a “Safe” security system:
formed in vehicles with a driver information the rear lid are closed leaving the last key shutting and locking doors (Keyless-Exit)
system ›››  page 33. used inside the vehicle and none outside,
the vehicle will not lock immediately. All the ● Switch the ignition off.

General information vehicle's indicator lights will flash four times. ● Close the driver's door.
The vehicle will lock after a few seconds if ● Touch (once) the sensor surface B (arrow)
If a valid key is in the proximity of the car, you do not open any door or the rear lid.
››› Fig. 131  the Keyless Access locking and on one of the front door handles. The vehicle
starting system gives the key entry as soon The vehicle will lock again after a few sec- locks with the “Safe” ››› page 133 system.
as one of the sensor surfaces on the door onds if you unlock the vehicle but fail to open The door that is used must be closed.
handles is touched or the softtouch/handle any door or boot hatch. ● Touch (twice) the sensor surface B (arrow)
on the rear lid is operated. The following fea- of one of the front door handles to lock the
tures are then available without having to Unlocking and opening the doors (Keyless- vehicle without activating the “Safe” security
use the vehicle key actively: Entry) system ››› page 133.
● Grip one of the front door handles. In doing
● Keyless-Entry: unlocking the vehicle using Unlocking and locking the boot hatch
this, the sensor surface ››› Fig. 132 A (arrow)
the handles of the front doors or the soft-
on the handle is touched and the vehicle un- When the vehicle is locked, the rear lid auto-
touch/handle on the rear lid.
locks. matically unlocks on opening if there is a val-
● Keyless-Exit: locking the vehicle using the
● Open the door. id vehicle key in the proximity ››› Fig. 131 .
sensor of the driver or passenger door han-
dle. On vehicles with selective opening or info- Open or close the rear lid normally.
● Easy Open: opening the rear lid moving one tainment system configuration, pulling the After closing, the hatch locks automatically. If
foot below the rear bumper. door handle twice will unlock all doors. the complete vehicle is unlocked, the rear lid
will not lock automatically after closing it.

130
Opening and closing

Rear lid with sensor-controlled open- While the rear lid is in motion (either opening blocked for engine ignition ››› page 181. In

Technical data
ing/closing (Easy Open) or closing), it can be stopped with another order to enable engine ignition, the  button
If there is a valid vehicle key in the proximity foot movement similar to the opening one on the key inside the vehicle needs to be
››› Fig. 131  of the rear lid, it is possible to (provided a valid vehicle key is in the proxim- pressed.
unlock and open or close it moving one foot ity of the rear lid).
in the area of the sensors ››› Fig. 131  loca- Automatically disabling sensors
The Easy Open feature is not available or only
ted under the rear bumper. has limited availability in the following situa- If the vehicle is not locked or unlocked for a
tions (examples): long period of time, the proximity sensors on
● Switch the ignition off.
the passenger doors are automatically disa-

Advice
● Stand in front of the rear bumper, in the ● If the rear bumper is very dirty. bled.
middle. ● If the rear bumper is wet with salt water,
If one of the sensor surfaces on the door han-
● With a brisk movement, bring your foot and e.g. after having driven on gritted roads. dles is often activated in an unusual manner
lower leg as close as you can to the bumper. ● If the electrical unlocking tow hitch is not with the vehicle locked (e.g. by the branches
The lower part of the leg needs to be close to covered. of a bush rubbing against it), all proximity

Operation
the upper sensor area and your foot to the ● If the vehicle has been equipped at a later sensors are disabled for a certain period of
lower sensor area ››› Fig. 131  1 . time.
time with a tow bracket.
● Quickly remove your foot and lower leg
Sensors will again be enabled:
from the sensor areas ››› Fig. 131  2 . The In the event of heavy rain, the Easy Open fea-
rear lid will be automatically opened. ture may take a little longer to open the boot ● After a time.
● If the rear lid fails to open, repeat the pro-
or may deactivate automatically, to avoid the

Emergencies
● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked with the 
boot opening by accident, e.g. because of
cedure after a few seconds. button on the key.
the running water.
The third brake light flashes once to show the ● OR: if the boot is opened.
The Easy Open function can be connected
boot has opened with the Easy Open func- and disconnected permanently in the info- ● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked manually with
tion. tainment system by pressing the  button the key.
The rear lid can be closed with another foot and the SETTINGS and the Opening and closing
movement similar to the opening one (provi- function buttons ›››  page 33. Keyless Access temporary disconnection

Safety
ded a valid vehicle key is in the proximity of function*
the rear lid). What happens when locking the vehicle with You can deactivate the vehicle's Keyless Ac-
a second key cess unlocking for a locking and unlocking
When closed, the rear lid automatically locks
if the vehicle has been locked beforehand If there is a vehicle key inside the vehicle and cycle. »
and there is no valid key inside. it is locked from the outside with a second
vehicle key, the key inside the vehicle is
131
Operation

● Move the gear lever to position P (if the ve- SETTINGS and Opening and closing function but- windows is open and the sensor surface B
hicle has automatic gearbox), since other- tons. (arrow) on one of the handles is activated
wise the vehicle cannot be locked. continuously, all windows will close.
● Close the door. WARNING
● Push the central locking button  on the If there is a valid key in the proximity of the Note
remote control and touch the locking sensor rear lid, in some cases the Easy Open func-
● If the vehicle battery has little or no charge,
tion may be accidentally activated and the
surface ››› Fig. 132 B on the driver door han- or the vehicle key battery is almost or entire-
rear lid will open, for example, when sweep-
dle once within the following 5 seconds. Do ly out of charge, you will probably not be able
ing under the rear bumper, when directing a
not grip the door handle, otherwise the vehi- water jet or high pressure steam to the area to lock or unlock the vehicle with the Keyless
cle will not lock. Deactivation is also possible or when carrying out maintenance work or re- Access system. The vehicle can be unlocked
if the vehicle is locked through the driver’s pairs in that area. If accidentally opened, the or locked manually ››› page 97.
door lock. rear lid could injure somebody situated in its ● To control the proper locking of the vehicle,
● To check that the function has been deacti- area of operation or cause material damage. the release function is disabled for approx. 2
vated, wait at least 10 seconds, grip and pull ● Therefore, always make sure that there is seconds.
on the door handle. The door should not no unsupervised valid key in the area near ● If the message Keyless access system
open. the rear lid. faulty is displayed on the screen of the
● Before carrying out any maintenance or re- dash panel, abnormalities may occur in the
The next time the door can only be unlocked pair work on the vehicle, always disable the operation of the Keyless Access system. Con-
via the remote control or the lock cylinder. Easy Open feature via the infotainment sys- tact a specialised workshop. SEAT recom-
The next time the door is locked/unlocked, tem. mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this.
Keyless Access will be active again. ● Before washing the vehicle, always disable
● Depending on the function set on the info-
the Easy Open feature via the infotainment tainment system for the mirrors, the exterior
Convenience functions system. mirrors will unfold and the surround lighting
will come on when unlocking the vehicle us-
To close all the electric windows using the ● Before attaching a bicycle rack or a trailer,
ing the sensor surface on the driver and pas-
convenience function, keep a finger on the ››› page 273, always disable the Easy Open senger door handles ››› page 155.
locking sensor surface B (arrow) of the door feature via the infotainment system.
● If there is no valid key inside the vehicle or
handle for a few seconds until the windows
the system fails to detect one, a warning will
have closed. CAUTION display on the dash panel screen. This could
The doors opened by touching the sensor The sensor surfaces on the door handles happen if any other radio frequency signal in-
surface of the door handle depend on the could engage if hit with a water jet or high terferes with the key signal (e.g. from a mo-
settings that have been activated in the info- pressure steam if there is a valid vehicle key bile device accessory) or if the key is covered
by another object (e.g. an aluminium case).
tainment system with the  button and the in the proximity. If at least one of the electric

132
Opening and closing

● If the sensors are very dirty, e.g. have a lay- Initially, the diode flashes in a fast sequence SEAT recommends you ask a specialised

Technical data
er of salt, the correct functioning of the sen- for a brief period, then it stops for approxi- workshop to replace the battery.
sors on the door handles may be affected. In mately 30 seconds and, lastly continues
The battery is located to the rear of the vehi-
this case, clean the vehicle. flashing slowly.
cle key, under a cover.
● If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic
gearbox, it may only be locked in the gear Changing the battery
stick is in position P. Replacing the battery
● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 126.
● Remove the cover from the back of the ve-

Advice
Anti-theft security system (Safelock)* hicle key ››› Fig. 133 in the direction of the ar-
row ››› .
The following message is displayed on the in- ● Extract the battery from the compartment
strument panel to remind the driver that using a suitable thin object ››› Fig. 134.
when the vehicle is closed from the outside, ● Place the new battery in the compartment

Operation
the anti-theft security system is switched on. as shown ››› Fig. 134, pressing in the oppo-
 Do not forget the Safelock. site direction to that shown by the arrow
Please see Instruction Manual. The ››› .
vehicle cannot be opened from inside. This ● Fit the cover as shown ››› Fig. 133, pressing
makes it more difficult for unauthorised per- Fig. 133 Vehicle key: opening the battery
compartment. it onto the vehicle key casing in the opposite
sons to break into the vehicle ››› in De- direction to that shown by the arrow until it

Emergencies
scription on page 125. clicks into place.
The anti-theft security system can be switch-
ed off each time the vehicle is locked: CAUTION
● If the battery is not changed correctly, the
● Turn the key a second time to the lock posi-
vehicle key may be damaged.
tion, in the door lock, within two seconds. If
● Use of unsuitable batteries may damage
necessary, remove the protective cover on
the vehicle key. For this reason, always re-
the driver door handle ›››  page 15 or

Safety
place the dead battery with another of the
● Press the  button on the remote control same voltage, size and specifications.
key for a second time within 2 seconds. ● When fitting the battery, check that the po-

The flashing frequency of the diode in the Fig. 134 Vehicle key: removing the battery. larity is correct. »
door sill immediately confirms the process.
133
Operation

For the sake of the environment Childproof lock anti-clockwise for the right hand side
doors.
Please dispose of your used batteries correct-
ly and with respect for the environment.
Deactivating the childproof lock
– Unlock the vehicle and open the door
whose childproof lock you want to deacti-
Synchronising the vehicle key
vate.
If the  button is pressed frequently outside – With the door open, rotate the groove in
of the vehicle range, it is possible that the ve- the door using the ignition key, anti-clock-
hicle can no longer be locked or unlocked us- wise for the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 135
ing the key. In this case, the key must be re- and clockwise for the right hand side
synchronised as described below: doors.
Fig. 135 Childproof lock on the left hand side
● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 126. door. Once the childproof lock is activated, the
● If necessary, remove the cover from the door can only be opened from the outside.
The childproof lock prevents the rear doors The childproof lock can be activated or deac-
driver door lever ›››  page 15. from being opened from the inside. This sys- tivated by inserting the key in the groove
● Press the  button on the vehicle key. For tem prevents minors from opening a door ac- when the door is open, as described above.
this, it must remain with the vehicle. cidentally while the vehicle is running.
● Open the vehicle within one minute using This function is independent of the vehicle
the key blade. The key has been synchron- electronic opening and locking systems. It
ised. only affects rear doors. It can only be activa- Anti-theft alarm system*
● If necessary, fit the cap. ted and deactivated manually, as described
below: Description

Activating the childproof lock The anti-theft alarm makes it more difficult to
break into the vehicle or steal it.
– Unlock the vehicle and open the door in
which you wish to activate the childproof The anti-theft alarm is automatically turned
lock. on when the vehicle is locked with the key.

– With the door open, rotate the groove in ● The turn signal light will flash twice on
the door using the ignition key, clockwise opening and deactivating the alarm.
for the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 135 and

134
Opening and closing

● The turn signal light will flash once on clos- ● When the vehicle is transported on a ferry ● If the vehicle battery is run down or flat

Technical data
ing and activating the alarm. or by rail (vehicles with an anti-tow system or then the anti-theft alarm will not operate cor-
vehicle interior monitoring ››› page 136). rectly.
When does the system trigger an alarm? ● When a trailer connected to the anti-theft ● Vehicle monitoring remains active even if
The anti-theft alarm siren will be triggered for alarm system is disconnected. the battery is disconnected or not working for
about 30 seconds accompanied by sound any reason.
and optical (flashing) warning signals and How to turn OFF the alarm ● The alarm is triggered immediately if one of
will be repeated about ten times when the Unlock the vehicle with the unlocking button the battery cables is disconnected while the
vehicle is locked and the following unauthor- alarm system is active.

Advice
on the key or turn on the ignition with a valid
ised actions are attempted: key.
● Opening a door that is mechanically un-
locked using the vehicle key without switch-
Note Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-
ing on the ignition in the next 15 seconds (in ● After 28 days, the indicator light will be tow system*
certain markets, such as the Netherlands, switched off to prevent the battery from ex-

Operation
hausting if the vehicle has been left parked It is a monitoring or control function incorpo-
there is no 15 second waiting time and the
for a long period of time. The alarm system rated in the anti-theft alarm* which detects
alarm is activated immediately on opening
remains activated. unauthorised vehicle entry by means of ultra-
the door).
● If, after the audible warning goes off, an- sound.
● A door is opened.
other monitored area is accessed (e.g. the
● The bonnet is opened. rear lid is opened after a door has been Activation

Emergencies
● The rear lid is opened. opened), the alarm is triggered again. – It is automatically switched on when the
● When the ignition is switched on with a ● The anti-theft alarm is not activated when anti-theft alarm is activated.
non-authorised key. the vehicle is locked from within using the
central locking button . Deactivation
● When the vehicle battery is disconnected.
● If the driver door is unlocked mechanically
● Movement inside the vehicle (in vehicles – Open the vehicle with the key, either me-
with the key, only the driver door is unlocked,
with interior monitoring ››› page 136). the rest of the doors remain locked. Only
chanically or by pressing the  button on
when the ignition has been turned on will the the remote control. The time period from

Safety
● When the vehicle is towed (in vehicles with
other doors be available - but not unlocked - when the door is opened until the key is in-
anti-tow system ››› page 136). serted in the contact should not exceed 15
and the central locking button will be activa-
● When the vehicle is raised (in vehicles with ted. seconds, otherwise the alarm will be trig-
anti-tow system ››› page 136). gered. »

135
Operation

– Press the  button on the remote control ● Panoramic/tilting sunroof open (partially or Deactivating the vehicle interior moni-
twice. The volumetric sensor and tilt sen- completely). toring and anti-tow system*
sors will be deactivated. The alarm system ● Movement of objects inside the vehicle,
remains activated. such as loose papers, items hanging from When the vehicle is locked, the alarm will be
the rear vision mirror (air fresheners), etc. triggered if movements are detected in the
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti- interior (e.g. by animals) or if the vehicle's in-
tow system are automatically switched on clination is changed (e.g. during transport).
Note
again next time the vehicle is locked. You can prevent the alarm from being trig-
● If the vehicle is relocked and the alarm is
The vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow gered accidentally by switching off the vehi-
activated without the volumetric sensor func-
sensor (tilt sensor) are automatically switch- tion, relocking will activate the alarm with all cle interior monitoring and/or tow-away pro-
ed on when the anti-theft alarm is switched its functions, except the volumetric sensor. tection.
on. In order to activate it, all the doors and This function is reactivated when the alarm is
● To switch off the interior monitoring and
the rear lid must be closed. switched on again, unless it is deliberately
switched off. tow-away protection, switch off the ignition
If you wish to switch off the vehicle interior and, using the Infotainment system, select:
monitoring and the anti-tow system, it must ● If the alarm has been triggered by the volu-
 button > SETTINGS function button > Open-
be done each time that the vehicle is locked; metric sensor, this will be indicated by a
ing and closing > Central locking > Switch off
if not, they will be automatically switched on. flashing of the warning lamp on the driver
door when the vehicle is opened. The flash is
alarm.
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti- different to the flash indicating the alarm is ● When the vehicle is locked now, the vehicle
tow system should be switched off if animals activated. interior monitoring and the tow-away protec-
are left inside the locked vehicle (otherwise, ● The vibration of a mobile phone left inside tion are switched off until the next time the
their movements will trigger the alarm) or the vehicle may cause the vehicle interior door is opened.
when, for example, the vehicle is transported monitoring alarm to trigger, as both sensors
or has to be towed with only one axle on the react to movements and shakes inside the ve- If the anti-theft security system (Safelock)*
ground. hicle. ››› page 133 is switched off, the vehicle interi-
● If on activating the alarm, any door or the or monitoring and the tow-away protection
False alarms are automatically switched off.
rear lid is open, only the alarm will be activa-
Interior monitoring will only operate correctly ted. The vehicle interior monitoring and the
if the vehicle is completely closed. Please ob- anti-tow system will only be activated once WARNING
serve related legal requirements. all the doors are closed (including the rear Observe the safety warnings ››› in Descrip-
lid). tion on page 125.
The following cases may cause a false alarm:
● Open windows (partially or fully).

136
Opening and closing

Rear lid (luggage compart- Open). The rear lid will be automatically

Technical data
opened.
ment)
Closing the rear lid
Related video ● Briefly press the  button on the rear lid
››› Fig. 137 ››› .
● OR: press the  button located on the
centre console until the rear lid is closed

Advice
››› Fig. 138.
● OR: on vehicles with Keyless Access, press
Fig. 138 Centre console: button to open and
Fig. 136 Handsfree close rear lid. and hold the  vehicle key button until the
rear lid is closed or move one foot in the area
Opening the rear lid of the sensors located below the rear bumper
(Easy Open) ››› page 129. The vehicle key

Operation
Rear lid with electric opening and ● Unlock the vehicle ››› page 125 and briefly
must not be further than approx. 1.5 m from
closing* press the handle of the rear lid. On vehicles the luggage compartment and should not be
with Keyless Access you can directly press in the vehicle.
the handle of the rear lid. The rear lid is un-
● OR: manually move the rear lid in the direc-
locked if an authorised key is recognised in
the proximity of the vehicle. tion of closing until it closes automatically.

Emergencies
● OR: press the button on the centre console ● The rear lid goes down automatically to the
for at least one second ››› Fig. 138. The but- final position and also closes automatically
ton also works when the ignition is switched ››› .
off.
Interrupting opening or closing
● OR: Press and hold the  button on the
vehicle key for approx. 1 second. If the vehi- After beginning to open or close the rear lid,
cle is locked, only the rear lid is unlocked the action can be halted by pressing one of

Safety
Fig. 137 Rear lid open: button to close the (the doors remain locked). the  buttons.
rear lid immediately. ● OR: on vehicles with Keyless Access and Continue opening or closing the rear lid by
sensor-controlled opening you can open the hand. To do this, some force will have to be
rear lid by moving one foot in the area of the used. »
sensors located below the rear bumper (Easy

137
Operation

If you press one of the  buttons again, the Modifying and memorising the opening an- Automatic protection against overheating
rear lid will move again in the original direc- gle If the system is operated repeatedly in a
tion. If the space behind or above the vehicle is short space of time, it automatically switches
If the rear lid is met with resistance or an ob- less than the travel area of the rear lid, you off to prevent overheating.
stacle during the automatic opening or clos- can change the opening angle of the rear lid.
Once the system is cool again, the function
ing, opening or closing will be interrupted To memorise a new opening angle, the rear can be reused. Until then, the rear lid can on-
immediately. For the closing process, the rear lid must be open at least halfway. ly be opened and closed by hand using rea-
lid opens again slightly. sonable force.
● Interrupt the opening process in the de-
● Check why it has not been possible to open If with the rear lid open the vehicle battery is
sired position.
or close the rear lid. disconnected ››› page 305 or the corre-
● Press the  button ››› Fig. 137 on the rear
● Try to open or close the rear lid again. sponding fuse burns out ››› page 102, the
lid for at least 3 seconds.
● If necessary, the rear lid can be opened or
system will have to be reset. This requires
The opening angle is memorised. Memorisa- closing the rear lid completely once.
closed by hand using reasonable force.
tion is indicated by blinking of the hazard
warning lights and an audible warning. Emergency unlocking
Special feature for pulling a trailer
If the factory-fitted towing bracket is electri-
›››  page 17
Resetting and memorising the opening angle
cally connected to a trailer ››› page 273, the
For the rear lid to reopen completely, the WARNING
electric rear lid can only be opened or closed
with the buttons on the rear lid itself. opening angle must be reset and memorised If a lot of snow builds up on the rear lid or it
again. is heavily loaded, the rear lid may not open
Acoustic warnings or, after opening, it may lower by itself due to
● Release the rear lid and open it to the the extra weight and cause serious injury.
Throughout the process of opening or closing memorised height. ● Do not open the rear lid when there is a lot
the rear lid, acoustic warnings can be heard. ● Lift the rear lid by hand as far as it goes. To of snow on it or when carrying a load (e.g. on
Exception: when the rear lid is opened man- do this, some force will have to be used. a rack).
ually using the handle or the Easy Open func-
● Press the  button ››› Fig. 137 on the rear ● Before opening the rear lid, remove the
tion with the movement of the foot or closed
lid for at least 3 seconds. snow or the load.
using the button on the rear lid itself
››› Fig. 137. ● This resets and memorises the factory-set
opening angle. Memorisation is indicated by WARNING
blinking of the hazard warning lights and an If the rear lid is closed incorrectly or without
audible warning. due care, it could result in serious injury.

138
Opening and closing

● Never leave the vehicle unattended or allow which will provide all the necessary informa- Controls for the windows

Technical data
children to play inside or next to it, especially tion.
if the rear lid is open. Children could enter Before the vehicle locks automatically, there Electric opening and closing of win-
the luggage compartment, close the rear lid
is a risk of intruders getting into the vehicle. dows
and become trapped. A locked vehicle can
Therefore, we recommend you always lock
reach extremely high and low temperatures,
depending on the time of year, thus causing the vehicle by pressing the  button on the
serious injuries, illness or even death. remote control or by using the central locking
button.

Advice
CAUTION WARNING
Before opening or closing the rear lid, make Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
sure that there is enough space to open or duction on page 97.
close it, e.g. when pulling a trailer or in a ga-
● Always close the rear lid properly. Risk of
rage.
accident or injury.

Operation
● The rear lid must not be opened when the
reverse or rear fog lights are lit. This may Fig. 139 Detail of the driver door: controls for
Rear lid automatic locking damage the tail lights. the windows.
● Do not close the rear lid by pushing it down
Where the vehicle has been locked by press- Read the additional information carefully
with your hand on the rear window. The glass
ing the  button on the remote control with ›››  page 18
could smash. Risk of injury!

Emergencies
the rear lid open, the rear lid will lock auto-
matically when closed. ● Ensure the rear lid is locked after closing it. The front and rear electric windows can be
If not, it may open unexpectedly while driv- operated by using the controls on the driver
The automatic rear lid locking time extension ing. door. The other doors each have a switch for
function can be activated. Where this func- ● Closing the rear lid without observing and their own window.
tion is activated and once the rear lid has ensuring it is clear could cause serious injury
been unlocked by pressing the  button on to you and to third parties. Make sure that no Always close the windows fully if you park
the remote control key ››› page 127, the rear one is in the path of the rear lid. the vehicle or leave it unattended ››› .

Safety
lid can be re-opened for a certain length of ● Never drive with the rear lid open or half- You can use the electric windows for approx.
time. closed, exhaust gases may penetrate into the 10 minutes after switching off the ignition if
Where required, the automatic tailgate lock- interior of the vehicle. Danger of poisoning! neither the driver door nor the front passen-
ing time extension function can be activated ● If you only open the rear lid, do not leave ger door has been opened and the key has
or deactivated at an Authorised SEAT Service, the key inside. The vehicle cannot be opened not been removed from the ignition. »
if the key is left inside.
139
Operation

Safety switch * ● The electric windows will work until the ig- ● If there is no obvious reason why the win-
The safety switch ››› Fig. 139 5 on the driver nition has been switched off and one of the dow cannot be closed, try to close it again by
door can be used to disable the electric win- front doors has been opened. pulling the tab within ten seconds. The win-
dow buttons on the rear doors. ● If necessary, use the safety switch to disa- dow closes with maximum force. The roll-
ble the rear electric windows. Make sure that back function is now deactivated.
Safety switch not pressed: buttons on rear they have been disabled. ● If more than 10 seconds pass, the window
doors are activated.
will open fully when you operate one of the
Safety switch pressed: buttons on rear doors Note buttons. One-touch closing is reactivated.
are deactivated.
If the window is not able to close because it WARNING
The safety control symbol  lights up in yel- is stiff or because of an obstruction, the win-
low if the buttons on the rear doors are dow will automatically open again Observe the safety warnings ››› in Electric
switched off. ››› page 140. If this happens, check why the opening and closing of windows on page 140.
window could not be closed before attempt- ● The roll-back function does not prevent fin-
WARNING ing to close it again. gers or other parts of the body getting
pinched against the window frame. Risk of
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
accident.
duction on page 97.
● Incorrect use of the electric windows can Roll-back function
result in injury.
● Never close the rear lid without observing
The roll-back function reduces the risk of in- Convenience opening and closing
jury when the electric windows close.
and ensuring it is clear, to do otherwise could
Use the convenience opening/closing func-
cause serious injury to you and third parties. ● If a window is obstructed when closing au-
Make sure that no one is in the path of a win- tion to easily open/close all the windows
tomatically, the window stops at this point from the outside.
dow.
and lowers immediately ››› .
● If the ignition is switched on, the electric
● Next, check why the window does not close Convenience open function
equipment could be activated with risk of in-
jury, for example, in the electric windows. before attempting it again. – Press and hold the  button on the remote
● The doors can be locked using the remote ● If you try within the following 10 seconds control key until all the windows have
control key. This could become an obstacle and the window closes again with difficulty reached the desired position, or
for assistance in an emergency situation. or there is an obstruction, the automatic clos-
– First unlock the vehicle using the  button
● Therefore always take the key with you ing will stop working for 10 seconds.
on the remote control key and then keep
when you leave the vehicle. ● If the window is still obstructed, the win-
the key in the driver door lock until all the
dow will stop at this point.

140
Opening and closing

windows have reached the required posi- One-touch opening and closing button briefly to the second stage, the win-

Technical data
tion. dow will open (one-touch opening) or close
One-touch opening and closing means you (one-touch closing) automatically. If you op-
Convenience close function do not have to hold down the button. erate the button while the window is opening
or closing, it stops at this position.
– Press and hold the  button on the remote Buttons ››› Fig. 139 1 , 2 , 3 and 4 have
control key until all the windows are closed two positions for opening windows and two
››› , or for closing them. This makes it easier to open
– Lock the driver's door with the key and hold
and close windows to the desired position. Sunroof*

Advice
the key in the <zitat>lock</zitat> position un-
til all the windows are closed One-touch closing Introduction
– Pull up the window button briefly up to the
Programming convenience opening in the second position. The window closes fully. The sunroof consists of two glass parts. The
Easy Connect* rear part is fixed and cannot be opened. It al-
One-touch opening so has a sun blind.
– Select:  button > SETTINGS function

Operation
button > Opening and closing > Open- – Push down the window button briefly up to
WARNING
ing the window by holding down the second position. The window opens
button or > Front window on/off. fully. If the sunroof is used negligently or without
paying due attention, it can cause serious in-
WARNING jury.
Resetting one-touch opening and closing
● Open or close the sunroof and the sun blind

Emergencies
● Never close the windows without due care The automatic open and close function will only when no one is in their path of move-
or proper control. There is a risk of suffering not work if the battery has been temporarily ment.
injury. disconnected. The function can be restored
● Never leave any key inside the vehicle
● For safety reasons, you should only use the as follows:
when exiting.
remote control open and close functions with-
– Close the window as far as it will go by lift- ● Never leave a child or any other person who
in about 2 metres of the vehicle. To avoid in-
juries, always keep an eye on the windows ing and holding the electric window switch. may need help in the vehicle, especially if
when pressing the button to close them. The they have access to the vehicle key. If using
– Release the switch and then lift it again for

Safety
windows stop moving as soon as the button they key unattended, they could lock the ve-
1 second. This will re-enable the automatic
is released. hicle, start the engine, switch on the ignition
function. and activate the sunroof.
If you push (or pull) a button to the first ● After switching off, it is still possible to
stage, the window will open (or close) until open or close the sunroof during a short »
you release the button. If you push or lift the
141
Operation

space of time provided that neither the driver Opening and closing the sunroof On the second level, the sunroof automatical-
nor passenger door is opened. ly moves to the corresponding final position
after briefly pressing the button. Activating
the button again stops the automatic func-
CAUTION
tion.
● To prevent damage, during winter tempera-
tures remove any ice or snow that might be Adjusting the tilt position of the sunroof
on the car roof before opening the sunroof or
adjusting the tilt position. ● Press the rear part of the button B to the
first level.
● Before leaving the vehicle or in case of rain-
fall, always close the sunroof. With the sun- ● Automatic operation: briefly press the rear
roof open or in a tilted position, water can en- part of button B to the second level.
ter the interior and can cause considerable
damage to the electrical system. As a result, Fig. 140 On the interior roof lining: sunroof
Closing the sunroof from a tilted position
other damage can occur in the vehicle. button.
● Press the front part of the button A to the
The sunroof only works when the ignition is first level.
Note switched on. Once the ignition has been ● Automatic operation: briefly press the front
● Leaves and other loose objects that accu- switched off, you can still open or close the part of the button A to the second level.
mulate on the sunroof rails should be regular- sunroof for a few minutes provided the driver
ly cleaned away either by hand or with a vac- door and the front passenger door are not Stopping the automatic operation by adjust-
uum. opened. ing the tilted position of the sunroof or by
● If the sunroof does not work correctly, the closing the sunroof
The sun blind automatically opens along with
anti-trap function will not work either. Con-
the sunroof if completely closed or if in front ● Press button A or B again.
tact a specialised workshop.
of the sunroof. The sun blind remains in the
previous position and does not automatically Opening the sunroof
close with the sunroof. The sun blind can on-
● Press button C backwards to the first lev-
ly be closed completely once the sunroof has
el.
been closed.
● Automatic operation to comfort position:
The  button ››› Fig. 140 has two levels. The briefly press button C backwards to the sec-
first level switches the sunroof to the tilted ond level.
position, opening or closing it fully or partial-
ly.

142
Opening and closing

Closing the sunroof Buttons ››› Fig. 141 1 and 2 have two lev- Anti-trap function of the panoramic

Technical data
● Press button D forwards to the first level. els. The first level opens or closes the sun sliding sunroof and the sun blind
blind fully or partially.
● Automatic operation: briefly press button
By briefly pressing the button to the second The anti-trap function can reduce the risk of
D forwards to the second level.
level, the sun blind automatically moves to injury when closing the sunroof and the sun
the corresponding final position. Activating blind ››› . If the sunroof or sun blind en-
Stopping the automatic operation during the counter resistance or an obstacle when clos-
opening or closing the button again stops the automatic func-
tion. ing, they reopen immediately.
● Press button C or D again.

Advice
Once the ignition has been switched off, you ● Check why the sunroof or sun blind do not
can still open or close the sun blind for a few close.
Opening and closing the sun blind minutes provided the driver door and the ● Try to close the sunroof or sun blind again.
front passenger door are not opened. ● If the sunroof or sun blind cannot be closed
due to an obstacle or some resistance, it
Opening the sun blind

Operation
stops at the corresponding position and then
● Press button 1 to the first level. opens. For automatic closing, a new closing
● Automatic operation: briefly press button attempt might take place.
1 to the second level. ● If the sunroof or sun blind is still unable to
close, close it without the anti-trap function.
Closing the sun blind

Emergencies
● Press button 2 to the first level. Closing the sunroof or sun blind without the
anti-trap function
● Automatic operation: briefly press button
2 to the second level. ● Sunroof: within approx. 5 seconds of hav-
Fig. 141 On the interior roof lining: switches
for the sun blind.
ing activated the roll-back function, press the
Stopping the automatic operation during the  button ››› Fig. 140 to the second level in
The electrical sun blind works when the igni- opening or closing the direction of arrow ››› Fig. 140 D until the
tion is switched on. sunroof closes completely.
● Press button 1 or 2 again.

Safety
● Sun blind: within approx. 5 seconds of hav-
When the sunroof is in its most tilted posi-
Note ing activated the anti-trap function, press
tion, the sun blind automatically goes into a
button ››› Fig. 141 2 until the sun blind
ventilation position. The sun blind remains in When the sunroof is open, the electric sun closes completely.
this position also with the sunroof closed. blind can only be closed to the front edge of
the sunroof. ● The sunroof or sun blind close without the
anti-trap function intervening! »
143
Operation

● When the parking light is on ››› page 145.


● If the sunroof or sun blind will still not
close, visit a specialised workshop.
Lights and visibility
● When the light switch is in position  or
.
WARNING Lights
Closing the sunroof or sun blind without the WARNING
anti-trap function can cause serious injuries. Related video
The side lights or daytime running lights are
● Always be careful when closing the sunroof not bright enough to illuminate the road
and sun blind. ahead and to ensure that other road users are
● No person should ever remain in the way of able to see you.
the sunroof or sun blind, especially when ● Always use your dipped beam head lights if
closing without the anti-trap function. it is raining or if visibility is poor.
● The anti-trap function does not prevent fin-
gers or other parts of the body from becom- Fig. 142 Vehicle lights
WARNING
ing trapped against the roof frame and inju-
ries occurring. If the headlights are set too high and not
used correctly, there is a risk of dazzling or
Side light and dipped beam headlight distracting other road users. This could result
in a serious accident.
Read the additional information carefully ● Always make sure that the headlights are
›››  page 30 correctly adjusted.
The driver is personally responsible for the
correct use and adjustment of the lights in all Note
situations.
The legal requirements regarding the use of
vehicle lights in each country must be ob-
Audible warnings to advise the driver that
served.
the lights have not been switched off
If the key is not in the ignition and the driver
door is open, an audible warning signal is
heard in the following cases: this is a remind-
er to turn off the lights.

144
Lights and visibility

Daytime running lights Turn signal and main beam lever ● Always give warning when you are going to

Technical data
change lane, overtake or when turning, acti-
The daytime running lights consist of individ- Read the additional information carefully vating the turn signal in good time.
ual lights, integrated in the front headlights. ›››  page 31 ● As soon as you have finished changing
By connecting the daytime running lights, lane, overtaking or turning, switch the turn
Push the lever all the way down to turn off
these lights are switched on1) ››› . signal off.
the corresponding function.
The daytime running lights switch on every
time the ignition is switched on, if the switch Convenience turn signals WARNING
is in positions  or , according to the level

Advice
For the one-touch signalling, when the igni- Incorrect use of the headlights may cause ac-
of exterior lighting.
tion is switched on, move the lever as far as cidents and serious injury, as the main beam
When the light switch is in position , a possible upwards or downwards and release may distract or dazzle other drivers.
light sensor automatically switches dipped the lever. The turn signal will flash three
beam on and off (including the control and times. Note
instrument lighting) or the daytime running

Operation
One-touch signalling is activated and deacti- ● If the convenience turn signals are operat-
lights depending on the level of exterior
vated in the Easy Connect system via the  ing (three flashes) and the other convenience
lighting.
button and the function button SETTINGS > turn signals are switched on, the active part
Lights > One-touch signalling stops flashing and only flashes once in the
WARNING
›››  page 33. new part selected.
● Never drive with daytime lights if the road ● The turn signal only works when the igni-
is not well lit due to weather or lighting con- In vehicles that do not have the correspond-

Emergencies
tion is switched on. The hazard warning
ditions. Daytime lights do not provide ing menu, this function can be deactivated in
lights also work when the ignition is switch-
enough light to illuminate the road properly a specialised workshop. ed off.
or be seen by other road users.
● If a trailer turn signal malfunctions, the
● On vehicles with rear lights with bulbs, WARNING
control lamp will stop flashing (trailer turn
when activating the daytime running light Improper or lack of use of the turn signals, or signals) and the vehicle turn signal will flash
the rear lights are not switched on. A vehicle forgetting to deactivate them can confuse at double speed.
which does not have the rear lights on may other road users. This could result in a seri- ● The main beam headlights can only be

Safety
not be visible to other drivers in the dark- ous accident.
switched on if the dipped beam headlights
ness, in the case of heavy rain or in condi-
tions of poor visibility.
are already on. »

1) On vehicles equipped with rear LED lights, the rear

side light is switched on as well.


145
Operation

● In cold or damp weather conditions, the ● The automatic dipped beam control () Switching the main beam assist on and off
headlights, tail lights and turn signals may only switches on the dipped beam when
Func- Use
mist up inside temporarily. This is normal and there are no changes in brightness, and not,
in no way effects the useful life of the vehicle for example when it is foggy. tion
lighting system. – Switch the ignition on and turn the light
switch to position .
– From the base position, move the main
Main beam assist* Activate:
beam and turn signal lever forwards
Automatic dipped beam control * 
Main beam assist (Light Assist)
››› page 145. When the warning lamp  is
displayed on the instrument panel display,
The automatic dipped beam control is merely The main beam assist acts within the limits the main beam assist is switched on.
intended as an aid and is not able to recog- of the system and depending on environmen-
– Switch off the ignition.
nise all driving situations. tal and traffic conditions. Once switched on, – OR: turn the light switch to a different po-
When the light switch is in position , the the system is activated as of a speed of sition to  ››› page 144.
vehicle lights and the instrument panel and about 60 km/h (37 mph) and is deactivated To switch – OR: with main beam on, move the main
switch lighting switch on and off automatical- below about 30 km/h (18 mph) ››› . system beam and turn signal lever backwards.
off: – OR: move the main beam and turn the
ly in the following situations ››› in Daytime When the system is activated and the camera signal lever forwards to manually switch
running lights on page 145: detects other vehicles that may be dazzled, the main beam on. The main beam assist
the main beam is automatically switched off. will then be deactivated.
Automatic switching Automatic switching Otherwise, the main beam is automatically
on off switched on. Malfunctions
The photo sensor detects When adequate lighting is The main beam assist generally detects illu- The following conditions may prevent the
darkness, for example, detected. minated areas and deactivates the main main beam headlight control from turning off
when driving through a beam when passing through a town, for ex- the headlights in time or from turning off al-
tunnel. ample. together:
The rain sensor detects When the windscreen wip-
rain and activates the ers have been inactive for ● In poorly lit towns with highly reflective
windscreen wipers. a few minutes. signs.
● Other insufficiently lit road users (such as
WARNING pedestrians or cyclists).
If the road is not well lit and other road users ● On tight bends and steep slopes (bumps)
cannot see the vehicle well enough or at all, and when oncoming vehicles are partially ob-
accidents may occur. scured.
146
Lights and visibility

● When the drivers of other oncoming vehi- cle lighting system, for example, if additional Fog lights

Technical data
cles (such as a truck) can see over a guard headlights are installed.
rail in the centre of the road.
● If the camera is damaged or the power sup- CAUTION
ply is cut off.
To avoid affecting the operation of the sys-
● In fog, snow and heavy rain. tem, take the following points into considera-
● With dust and sand turbulence. tion:
● With loose gravel in the field of vision of ● Clean the field of vision of the camera regu-

Advice
the camera. larly and make sure it is free of snow and ice.
● When the field of vision of the camera is ● Do not cover the field of vision of the cam-
era.
misted up, dirty or covered by stickers, snow,
ice, etc. ● Check that the windscreen is not damaged Fig. 143 Dash panel: light control.
in the area of the field of vision of the camera.

Operation
WARNING The warning lamps  or  also show, on the
Note light switch or instrument panel, when the
The convenience features of the main beam
assist should not encourage the taking of
fog lights are on.
Main beam and headlight flasher can be
risks. The system is not a replacement for turned on and off manually at any time with ● Switching on front fog lights* : pull the
driver concentration. the turn signal and main beam lever light switch to the first point ››› Fig. 143 1 ,
● You are always in control of the main beam ››› page 145. from positions ,  or .

Emergencies
and adapting it to the light, visibility and traf-
● Switching on the rear fog light : com-
fic conditions.
pletely pull the light switch 2 from position
● It is possible that the main beam headlight
,  or .
control does not recognise all driving situa-
tions and is limited under certain circumstan- ● To switch off the fog lights, press the light
ces. switch or turn it to position . »
● When the field of vision of the camera is
dirty, covered or damaged, operation of the

Safety
main beam control may be affected. This also
applies when changes are made to the vehi-

147
Operation

Note Vehicle with halogen headlights ● Switch off the engine and remove the key
In the “Coming Home” function, the daytime from the ignition.
The rear fog light can dazzle drivers behind
you. You should use the rear fog light only running lights (DRL), the rear side lights and ● Activate the headlight flashers for approxi-
when visibility is very poor. the licence plate lights are turned on. mately 1 second.
● Activated for any position of the rotary light
Vehicle with full-LED headlights switch.
Cornering lights*1) In the “Coming Home” function, the dipped ● When the car door is opened, the “Coming
beams, the daytime running lights (DRL), the Home” lighting comes on. The headlights are
When turning slowly or on very tight bends, rear side lights, the number plate lights and turned off 60 seconds after the vehicle door
the cornering lights are activated automati- the courtesy lights in the rear view mirror is opened.
cally. The cornering lights may be integrated (Welcome Light) switch on.
in the fog lights and are switched on only at Deactivation
speeds of less than 40 km/h (25 mph). Automatic* activation of “Coming Home” ● If no door has been closed, they go out au-
When reverse gear is engaged, the cornering For vehicles with a light and rain sensor (rota- tomatically after 60 seconds.
lights on both sides of the vehicle switch on, ry light switch in position ). ● After the last door has been closed, the
in order to better illuminate the area for park- ● Switch off the engine and remove the key headlights will be switched off after the
ing. from the ignition with the rotary light switch “Coming Home” delay (as established in the
in position  ›››  page 30. radio menu) has elapsed.
● The automatic “Coming Home” function is ● On turning the light switch to position 
“Coming home” function only active when the light sensor detects ›››  page 30.
darkness. ● When the ignition is switched on (when
This function may be connected/disconnec-
● When the car door is opened, the “Coming starting the engine).
ted through the radio menu. The “Coming
Home” and/or “Leaving Home” delay time Home” lighting comes on.
may also be set (default: 30 sec).
Manual “Coming Home” activation
For vehicles with a light and rain sensor (rota-
ry light switch without position ).

1) This function is not available on vehicles equipped

with full-LED headlights.


148
Lights and visibility

Function “Leaving Home” ● When the vehicle is locked using the re- Hazard warning lights 

Technical data
mote control.
The “Leaving Home” function is only availa- ● When the light control is switched into a
ble for vehicles with a light and rain sensor position other than .
(rotary light switch in position ).
● With the ignition is switched on.
This function may be connected/disconnec-
ted through the radio menu. The “Leaving
Home” function switch-off delay may also be Welcome light*
set (default: 30 sec).

Advice
3 Valid for vehicles with a light and rain sensor
(light switch in position ) and Full LED head-
Vehicle with halogen headlights lights.
In the “Leaving Home” function, the daytime
The Welcome light is a light located on the Fig. 144 Dash panel: switch for hazard warn-
running lights (DRL), the rear side lights and ing lights.
the licence plate lights are switched on. exterior mirrors facing the ground which is

Operation
switched on or off if the lights control is in
the  position and the “Coming Home” / Read the additional information carefully
Vehicle with full-LED headlights ›››  page 31
“Leaving Home” function is switched on or
In the “Leaving Home” function, the dipped off. The hazard warning lights are used to draw
beams, the daytime running lights (DRL), the the attention of other road users to your vehi-
rear side lights, the number plate lights and cle in emergencies.
the courtesy lights in the rear view mirror

Emergencies
(“Welcome Light”) switch on. If your vehicle breaks down:
1. Park your vehicle at a safe distance from
Activation moving traffic.
● When the vehicle is unlocked using the re-
2. Press the button to switch on the hazard
mote control. warning lights ››› .
● The “Leaving Home” function is only activa-
3. Switch the ignition off.

Safety
ted when the rotary light switch is in position
 and the light sensor detects darkness. 4. Apply the handbrake.
5. For a manual gearbox, engage 1st gear;
Deactivation for an automatic gearbox, move the gear
● When the “Leaving Home” delay period lever to P. »
ends (default: 30 sec).
149
Operation

6. Use the warning triangle to draw the atten- into contact with highly inflammable materi- Motorway light*
tion of other road users to your vehicle. als, for example dry grass or spilt petrol. This
could start a fire. The motorway light is available on vehicles
7. Always take the vehicle key with you when
equipped with full-LED lights.
you leave the vehicle.
Note The function is connected/disconnected via
All turn signals flash simultaneously when the corresponding Easy Connect system
● The battery will run down if the hazard
the hazard warning lights are switched on. menu.
warning lights are left on for a long time,
The two turn signal turn signal lamps  
even if the ignition is switched off.
and the turn signal lamp in the switch  will ● Activation: when going above 110 km/h
flash at the same time. The simultaneous ● The use of the hazard warning lights de- (68 mph) for more than 30 seconds, the dip-
hazard warning lights also work when the ig- scribed here is subject to the relevant statu- ped beam raises slightly to increase the driv-
tory requirements. er's visibility distance.
nition is switched off.
● Deactivation: when reducing the speed of
Emergency braking warning the car below 100 km/h (62 mph), the dip-
If the vehicle brakes suddenly and continu-
Parking lights  ped beam returns to its normal position.
ously at a speed of more than 80 km/h (50
When the parking light is switched on, (right
mph), the brake light flashes several times
or left turn signal), the front side light and
per second to warn the vehicles driving be-
the rear light on the corresponding side of Driving abroad
hind. If you continue braking, the hazard
the vehicle stay lit. The parking lights can on-
warning lights will come on automatically The light beam of the dipped beam lights is
ly be activated with the ignition switched off
when the vehicle comes to a standstill. They asymmetric: the side of the road on which
and the turn signal and main beam lever in
switch off automatically when the vehicle you are driving is lit more intensely.
the central position, before being triggered.
starts to move again.
When a car that is manufactured in a country
that drives on the right travels to a country
WARNING
Parking light on both sides that drives on the left (or vice versa), it is nor-
● The risk of an accident increases if your ve- mally necessary to cover part of the headlight
hicle breaks down. Always use the hazard With the ignition switched off and the light bulbs with stickers or to change the adjust-
warning lights and a warning triangle to draw switch in position , when locking the vehi- ment of the headlights to avoid dazzling oth-
the attention of other road users to your sta- er drivers.
cle from the outside, the parking lights on
tionary vehicle.
both sides of the vehicle light up. In doing In such cases, the regulations specify certain
● Due to the high temperatures that the cata-
so, only the side lights of both headlights light values that must be complied with for
lytic converter can reach, never park in an light up, and additionally the tail lights will
area where the catalytic converter could come designated points of the light distribution.
do so partially. This is known as “Tourist light”.
150
Lights and visibility

The light distribution of the halogen and full- The headlights can only be adjusted when Driver only, luggage compartment full

Technical data
LED headlights allows the specific “tourist the dipped beam is switched on. Setting 3 Driving with trailer and minimum draw-
light” values to be met without the need for bar load.
To reset, turn switch ››› Fig. 145:
stickers or changes in the settings.
Value Vehicle load statusa) Dynamic headlight range control
Note
The control is not mounted in vehicles with
“Tourist light” is only allowed temporarily. If Two front occupants, luggage compart-
you are planning a long stay in a country that
 ment empty dynamic headlight range control. The head-
light range is automatically adjusted accord-
drives on the other side, you should take the

Advice
All seats occupied, luggage compartment ing to the vehicle load status when they are
vehicle to an Authorised Technical Service to  empty switched on.
change the headlights.
All seats occupied, luggage compartment
 full. With trailer and minimum drawbar WARNING
load. Heavy objects in the vehicle may mean that
Headlight range control the headlights dazzle and distract other driv-
Driver only, luggage compartment full With

Operation
 trailer and maximum drawbar load. ers. This could result in a serious accident.
● Adjust the light beam to the vehicle load
a) If the vehicle load does not correspond to those shown in the
status so that it does not blind other drivers.
table, it is possible to select intermediary positions.

OR:
Lighting of the instrument panel,

Emergencies
Using the Easy Connect system, by means of
the  button and the function button SET- screens and controls
TINGS > Lights > Headlight height
adjustment ›››  page 33). Depending on the model, the lighting of the
instrument panel and controls can be adjus-
Fig. 145 Next to the steering wheel: Head- Two front occupants, luggage compart- ted in the Easy Connect system, using the 
Setting 0 button and the SETTINGS function button
light range control ment empty
›››  page 33.

Safety
All seats occupied, luggage compart-
The headlight range control ››› Fig. 145 is Setting 1
ment empty With the ignition on and without light activa-
modified according to the value of the head- tion, the instrument panel lighting remains
light beam and the vehicle load status. This All seats occupied, luggage compart- activated in daytime light conditions. The
offers the driver optimum visibility and the Setting 2 ment full. With trailer and minimum
drawbar load.
lighting is reduced as the exterior light di-
headlights do not dazzle oncoming drivers minishes. In some cases, e.g. when driving »
››› .
151
Operation

through a tunnel without the  function Settings > Interior lighting Visibility
active, the instrument panel lighting may ›››  page 33).
even switch off. The objective of this function
Sun visors
is to provide the driver with a visual indica- Ambient light*
tion that he or she should activate the dip-
The ambient light lights up the area of the
ped beam.
centre console, the footwell area and, de-
pending on the version, the front door pan-
els.
Interior and reading lights1)
The ambient lighting in the door panels may
Read the additional information carefully change colour. The brightness and colour of
›››  page 31 these lights can be adjusted using the radio
menu (see Easy Connect > Light Set-
Glove compartment and luggage compart- tings > Interior lighting
ment lighting* ›››  page 33).
Fig. 146 Sun visor
When opening and closing the glove com- Note
partment on the front passenger side and the Options for adjusting driver and front pas-
rear lid, the respective light will automatically The reading lights switch off when the vehi-
senger sun visors:
switch on and off. cle is locked using a key or after several mi-
nutes if the key is removed from the ignition. ● Lower the sun visor towards the wind-
This prevents the battery from discharging. screen.
Footwell lighting*
● The sun visor can be pulled out of its
The lights in the footwell area below the dash mounting and turned towards the door
(driver and front passenger sides) will switch ››› Fig. 146
1 .
on when the doors are opened and will de-
● Swing the sun visor towards the door, lon-
crease in intensity while driving. The intensity
of these lights can be adjusted using the ra- gitudinally backwards.
dio menu (see Easy Connect > Light

1) Depending on the level of equipment fitted in the

vehicle, LEDs can be used for the following interior


lights: front courtesy light, rear courtesy light, foot-
well light, sun blind and glove compartment light.
152
Lights and visibility

Vanity mirror light CAUTION moving, the more often the windscreen is

Technical data
There may be a vanity mirror, with a cover, on cleaned.
If the ignition is switched off with the wind-
the rear of the sun visor. When the cover is screen wipers active, they complete their ● The rear wiper is automatically switched on
opened 2 a light comes on. wipe before returning to the rest position. when the windscreen wiper is on and the car
When switching the ignition back on, the is in reverse gear.
The lamp goes out when the vanity mirror
windscreen wiper will continue to operate at
cover is closed or the sun visor is pushed
the same wiping level. Ice, snow and other
back up. obstacles on the windscreen may damage the
Windscreen wiper functions
wiper and the windscreen wiper motor.

Advice
WARNING
● If necessary, remove snow and ice from the
Folded sun blinds can reduce visibility. windscreen wipers before starting your jour-
Windscreen wiper performance in different sit-
ney. uations
● Always store sun blinds and visors in their
housing when not in use. ● Carefully lift the frozen windscreen wipers The activated position provision-
If the vehicle is at a
from the glass. SEAT recommends a de-icer ally changes to the previous posi-
standstill
spray for this operation. tion.

Operation
Note
● Do not switch on the windscreen wipers if The air conditioner comes on for
The light above the sun visor automatically
the windscreen is dry. Cleaning with the approximately 30 seconds in air
switches off after a few minutes in certain
windscreen wipers while dry can cause dam- During automatic recirculation mode to prevent the
conditions. This prevents the battery from
age. wipe smell of the windscreen washer
discharging. fluid entering the inside the vehi-
● In icy conditions, always check that the
cle.

Emergencies
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be-
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it may Intervals between wipes depend
Windscreen wiper and window help to leave the vehicle parked with the wip-
ers in service position ›››  page 71.
For the interval wipe
on the vehicle's speed. The high-
er the vehicle speed the shorter
wiper systems the intervals.

Note
Window wiper lever Heated windscreen washer jets*
● The windscreen and window wipers only
function when the ignition is switched on and The heating only thaws the frozen jets, it

Safety
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 32 the bonnet or rear lid, respectively, are does not thaw the water in the washer hoses.
closed. When the ignition is switched on the heated
● The interval wipe speed varies according to windscreen washer jets automatically adjust
the vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle is the heat depending on the ambient tempera-
ture. »
153
Operation

Headlight wash/wipe system* Rain sensor* Move the lever to the required position
The headlight washers/wipers clean the ››› Fig. 147:
headlight lenses. 0 Rain sensor off.
After the ignition is switched on, the first and 1 Rain sensor on; automatic wipe if neces-
every fifth time the windscreen washer is sary.
switched on, the headlights are also washed.
A Setting sensitivity level of rain sensor
Therefore, the windscreen wiper lever should
be pulled towards the steering wheel when – Set control to the right: highly sensi-
the dipped beam or main beam are on. Any tive.
incrusted dirt (such as insects) should be – Set control to the left: less sensitive.
cleaned regularly (e.g. when refuelling).
When the ignition is switched off and then
To ensure the headlight washers work cor- Fig. 147 Windscreen wiper lever: adjusting back on, the rain sensor stays on and starts
rectly in winter, any snow which has got into the rain sensor A operating again when the windscreen wipers
the bumper jet supports should be cleaned are in position 1 and the vehicle is travel-
away. If necessary, remove snow with an anti- ling at more than 16 km/h (10 mph).
icing spray.
Rain sensor modified behaviour
Note
Possible causes of faults and mistaken read-
The wiper will try to wipe away any obstacles
ings on the sensitive surface ››› Fig. 148 of
that are on the windscreen. The wiper will
the rain sensor include:
stop moving if the obstacle blocks its path.
Remove the obstacle and switch the wiper ● Damaged blades: a film of water on the
back on again.
damaged blades may lengthen the activation
time, reduce the washing intervals or result
Fig. 148 Rain sensor sensitive surface in a fast and continuous wipe.
● Insects: insects on the sensor may trigger
The rain sensor controls the frequency of the
the windscreen wiper.
windscreen wiper intervals, depending on
the amount of rain ››› . The sensitivity of the ● Salt on roads: in winter, salt spread in the
rain sensor can be adjusted manually. Man- roads may cause an extra long wipe when the
ual wipe ››› page 153. windscreen is almost dry.
● Dirt: dry dust, wax, coating on glass (Lotus
effect) or traces of detergent (car wash) may
154
Lights and visibility

reduce the effectiveness of the rain sensor or Rear view mirror with automatic anti-dazzle ● When the interior lights are on or reverse

Technical data
make it react more slowly, later or not at all. function* gear engaged, the mirrors do not darken with
● Cracked windscreen: the impact of a stone The anti-dazzle function is activated every automatic adjustment for anti-dazzle posi-
will trigger a single wipe cycle with the rain time the ignition is switched on. tion.
sensor on. Next the rain sensor detects the
When the anti-dazzle function is enabled, the
reduction in the sensitive surface area and
interior rear vision mirror will darken auto-
adapts accordingly. The behaviour of the sen- Adjusting the exterior rear-view mir-
matically according to the amount of light it
sor will vary with the size of the damage rors
receives. The anti-dazzle function is cancel-
caused by the stone.

Advice
led if reverse gear is engaged.
WARNING
WARNING
The rain sensor may not detect enough rain
In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle
to switch on the wipers.
rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte fluid
● If necessary, switch on the wipers manually may leak. This could cause irritation to the

Operation
when water on the windscreen obstructs visi- skin, eyes and respiratory organs. If you
bility. come into contact with this liquid, it must be
rinsed with large quantities of water. If neces-
Note sary, get medial help.

● Clean the sensitive surface of the rain sen-


CAUTION Fig. 149 Driver door: control for the exterior

Emergencies
sor regularly and check the blades for dam-
mirror.
age ››› Fig. 148 (arrow). In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle
● To remove wax and coatings, we recom- rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte fluid Read the additional information carefully
mend a window cleaner containing alcohol. may leak. This liquid attacks plastic surfaces. ›››  page 20
Clean it with a wet sponge as soon as possi-
ble. Synchronized regulation of the exterior mir-
rors
Mirror Note ● In the Settings - Convenience menu,

Safety
● If the light incident in the interior rear vi- select whether or not the exterior mirrors
Anti-dazzle rear view mirror sion mirror is obstructed (e.g. with the sun should move in synchronisation. »
blind*), the anti-dazzle rear vision mirror with
It is dangerous to drive if you cannot see
automatic setting will not operate perfectly.
clearly through the rear window.

155
Operation

● Turn the knob to position L1). jects look smaller and further away than they Seats and head restraints
● Adjust the left-hand exterior mirror. The really are. If you use these mirrors to esti-
right exterior mirror will be adjusted at the mate the distance to vehicles behind you
same time (synchronised). when changing lane, you could misjudge the Adjusting the seats and headr-
● If necessary the right exterior mirror adjust-
distance. Risk of accident! ests
ment may need correcting. turn the control to
position R1). CAUTION Manual adjustment of the seats
● In the Easy Connect system the exterior mir- ● If one of the mirror housings is knocked out
of position (e.g. when parking), the mirrors Read the additional information carefully
rors can be adjusted using the  button
must first be fully retracted with the electric ›››  page 18
and the SETTINGS function button.
control. Do not readjust the mirror housing by
hand, as this will interfere with the mirror ad- WARNING
Fold in the exterior mirrors after parking juster function.
(convenience function)* The safe driving chapter contains important
● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic information, tips, suggestions and warnings
The Easy Connect system, the  button and car wash, please make sure to retract the ex- that you should read and observe for your
the function buttons SETTINGS and terior mirrors to prevent them from being own safety and the safety of your passengers
Mirrors and windscreen wipers can be used to damaged. Electrically retractable exterior ››› page 73.
have the exterior mirrors fold in when the ve- mirrors must not be folded in or out by hand.
hicle is parked ››› page 120. Always use the electrical power control.
WARNING
When the vehicle is locked with the remote ● Adjust the front seats only when the vehi-
control, by pressing for more than approxi- Note
cle is stationary. Failure to follow this instruc-
mately 1 second the exterior mirrors are fol- If the electrical adjustment should fail to op- tion could result in an accident.
ded in automatically. When the vehicle is erate, both of the mirrors can be adjusted by ● Be careful when adjusting the seat height.
opened with the remote control, the exterior hand by lightly pressing the edge of the mir- Careless or uncontrolled adjustment can
mirrors are deployed automatically. ror glass. cause injuries.
● The front seat backrests must not be re-
WARNING clined for driving. Otherwise, seat belts and
the airbag system might not protect as they
Convex or wide-angle* exterior mirrors give a
should, with the subsequent danger of injury.
larger field of vision. However, they make ob-

1) Regulation in right-hand drive vehicles is symmet-

rical.
156
Seats and head restraints

Electric driver's seat adjustment* Adjusting the front head restraints Adjusting the head restraints

Technical data
– To set the head restraint higher, grasp the
Read the additional information carefully Read the additional information carefully sides with both hands and move it up-
›››  page 19 ›››  page 19 wards, until you see it engage.
Adjust the head restraint ›››  page 19 so – To set the head restraint lower down, press
WARNING
that as far as possible the top of the head re- the 1 ››› Fig. 150 button and move it
● If the electric front seats are used negli- straint is level with the top of your head. downwards.
gently or without paying due attention, it can When this is not possible, try to get as close
cause serious injury. as possible to this position.

Advice
Removing the head restraint
● The front seats can also be electrically ad-
justed when the ignition is switched off. Nev- To remove the head restraint, the correspond-
er leave a child or any other person who may ing backrest must be partially folded forward.
Adjustment of the rear head restraints
need help in the vehicle.
– Unlock the backrest ››› page 159.
● In the event of an emergency, electrical ad-
– Move the head restraint upwards until it ar-

Operation
justment can be stopped by pressing any
control. rives to the top.
– Press button 1 ››› Fig. 150, while simulta-
CAUTION neously pressing on the security hole 2
To avoid damaging the electrical components ››› Fig. 150 with a flat screwdriver a maxi-
of the front seats, please refrain from kneel- mum of 5 mm wide, and remove the head

Emergencies
ing on the seat or applying sharp pressure at restraint.
a single point to the seat cushion and back- – Move the backrest until it engages properly
rest.
››› .
Fig. 150 Rear centre head restraint: release
Note point. Fitting the head restraint
● It may not be possible to electrically adjust To mount the external head restraints, the
When transporting people in the back seat,
the seat if the vehicle battery is very low. corresponding backrest must be partially fol-
place the head restraints of the occupied

Safety
● If the engine is started while the seats are seats at a minimum of the next socket up ded forward.
being electrically adjusted, the adjustment ››› . – Unlock the backrest ››› page 159.
will stop.
– Insert the head restraint bars into the
guides until they perceptibly engage. It »
157
Operation

should not be possible to remove the head Seat heating Adjusting the heating output
restraint from the backrest. Press the button  or  repeatedly until the
– Move the backrest until it engages properly desired intensity level is reached.
››› .
Deactivating
WARNING Press the button  or  until all warning
● Please observe the general notes lamps switch off.
››› page 77.
● Remove the rear head restraints only when WARNING
it is necessary for the placement of a child Children and people who cannot perceive
seat ››› page 90. After removing a child seat, pain or temperature because of medications,
remount the head restraint immediately. paralysis or chronic diseases (e.g. diabetes)
Fig. 151 In the centre console: front seats
Travelling with the head restraints removed or have a limited perception of these, may
or improperly adjusted increases the risk of heating switch
suffer burns to the back, buttocks or legs
severe injuries. when using seat heating, an occurrence that
The seat cushions can be heated electrically
may entail a very lengthy recovery period or
when the ignition is switched on. The back-
from which it may not be possible to recover
rest is also heated in some versions. fully. Seek medical advice if you have doubts
Seat functions The seat heating should not be engaged in regarding your health.
any of the following conditions: ● People with limited pain and temperature
Introduction thresholds must never use seat heating.
● The seat is unoccupied.
● If an abnormality in the device's tempera-
WARNING ● The seat has a covering. ture control is detected, have it checked by a
Inappropriate use of the seat functions can ● There is a child seat installed in the seat. specialist workshop.
cause severe injuries. ● The seat cushion is wet or damp.
● Assume the proper sitting position before ● The indoor or outdoor temperature is great-
WARNING
your trip and remain in it throughout. This al- If the fabric of the cushion is wet, this can ad-
er than 25°C (77°F).
so applies to the other occupants. versely affect the operation of the seat heat-
● Always keep hands, fingers, feet and other ing, increasing the risk of burns.
Activate
parts of the body away from the operating ra- ● Make sure the seat cushion is dry prior to
dius and the adjustment of seats. Press the button  or . Seat heating is
using the seat heater.
switched on fully.

158
Seats and head restraints

● Do not sit on the seat with clothing that is – To return the armrest to the starting posi-

Technical data
wet or damp. tion, remove the armrest from the upper
● Do not leave clothing that is wet or damp
fixed position and lower it.
on the seat. The armrest can be moved backwards and
● Do not spill liquid on the seat. forwards.

CAUTION
● To avoid damaging the heating elements of Folding down and lifting the rear seat

Advice
the seat heaters, please do not kneel on the backrest
seat or apply sharp pressure to a single point Fig. 153 In the luggage compartment: levers
on the seat cushion or backrest. for remote release of the left part 1 and right
● Liquids, sharps objects and insulating ma- part 2 of the rear seat backrest.
terials (e.g. covers or child seats) can damage
the seat heating. The rear seat backrest is split and each part

Operation
● In the event of smells, switch off the seat be lowered separately to extend the luggage
heating immediately and have it inspected by compartment.
a specialised workshop.
When the rear seat backrest is lowered no-
body else can travel in the corresponding
For the sake of the environment seats (not even a child).

Emergencies
The seat heating should remain on only when Fig. 152 On the rear seat backrest: release
needed. Otherwise, it is an unnecessary fuel Lowering the rear seat backrest with the un-
catch 1 ; red mark 2 .
waste. lock button
● Lower the head restraint properly.
● Push the unlock button ››› Fig. 152 1 for-
Front centre armrest wards and at the same time lift the backrest.
● The rear seat backrest is not engaged when

Safety
The centre armrest can be adjusted to various
the red marking of the button 2 is visible.
levels.
Lowering the rear seat backrest with the re-
Adjusting the centre armrest
mote release lever
– To adjust the tilt, lift the armrest from the
starting position so that it is engaged.
● Lower the head restraint properly. »
159
Operation

● Open the rear lid. must be properly engaged. This is particular- Transport and practical
● Pull the remote release lever of the left part ly important in the case of the centre rear
››› Fig. 153 1 or right part 2 of the backrest seat. If someone is seated in a seat whose equipment
in the direction of the arrow. The released backrest is not properly engaged they will fly
forward, along with the backrest, during an
part of the rear seat backrest is folded auto-
accident or a sudden driving or braking ma-
Storage compartments
matically down and forwards.
noeuvre.
● If this occurs, close the rear lid.
● A red signal on the button 2 warns that
Storage areas under the front seats*
The rear seat backrest is not engaged when the backrest is not engaged. Always check
the red marking of the button ››› Fig. 152 2 that the red marking is not visible when the
backrest is in the upright position.
is visible.
● When the rear seat backrest is lowered or is
Folding up the rear seat backrest not properly engaged nobody else can travel
in the corresponding seats (not even a child).
● Lift the backrest and press it firmly into the
lock until it engages ››› .
CAUTION
● It should not be possible to see the red
mark of the unlock button 2 . Serious damage can be caused to the vehicle
and other objects if the rear seat backrest is
● The backrest must be properly engaged. lowered or lifted without due care and atten- Fig. 154 Storage compartment under the
tion. front seats.
WARNING ● Before lowering the rear seat backrest, al-
Serious injuries can be caused if the rear seat ways adjust the front seats so that neither There is a storage compartment with a cover
backrest is lowered or lifted without due care the head restraints nor the cushions of the under each front seat.
and attention. rear backrest can hit them.
The drawer* is opened by pulling on the han-
● Never lower or lift the rear seat backrest
dle of the cover ››› Fig. 154.
while driving.
● Do no trap or damage the seat belt when To close the drawer, press the cover until it
raising the rear seat backrest. locks into position.
● When lowering or lifting the rear seat back-
rest, keep your hands, fingers, feet and other WARNING
body parts out of its path. ● The drawers will hold a maximum weight of
● For the rear seat belts to offer the necessa- 1.5 kg.
ry protection all the parts of the rear backrest
160
Transport and practical equipment

● Do not drive with the drawer cover open. ● Do not use hard china cups or glasses. Depending on the vehicle equipment, the CD

Technical data
There is an injury risk for passengers if the These could cause injury in the event of an player is located in the glove compartment.
cargo is released in case of sudden braking or accident. Separate operating instructions are enclosed
an accident. for this equipment in the corresponding In-
struction Manual.
CAUTION
You should avoid putting open drinks con- WARNING
Drink holders tainers in the drink holders. The drinks could
otherwise spill over and cause damage to e.g. The cover of the glove compartment should
always be closed while driving. Failure to fol-

Advice
the electrical equipment or the seat covers.
low this instruction could result in an acci-
dent.

Glove compartment
Other storage compartments

Operation
You will find more object holders, compart-
ments and supports in other parts of the ve-
hicle:
Fig. 155 Centre console: front drink holders. ● In the top of the glove compartment in ve-
hicles that do not have a CD reader. The load

Emergencies
Front drink holders
of the compartment should not exceed
– Place drinks in the holder ››› Fig. 155. 1.2 kg.
Placement of two drinks is possible. There ● In the centre console under the centre arm-
is also the possibility of placing larger plas- Fig. 156 Glove compartment rest*.
tic bottles in the trims of the doors.
● Coat hooks in the door frames ››› .
Opening/closing
WARNING ● Other storage compartments are found in
– To open the glove compartment, pull the

Safety
● Do not place any hot drinks in the drink the rear seat, to the left and the right of the
holder while the vehicle is moving. Hot drinks
handle in the direction of the arrow. seats. »
could spill and cause burns, which may cause – To close the glove compartment, move the
an accident. cover upwards until it engages.

161
Operation

WARNING WARNING
● Please make sure that any items of clothing The power socket works only when the igni-
hanging from the coat hooks do not obstruct tion is on. Improper use may cause serious
your view to the rear. injury or even fire. Children should therefore
● The coat hooks should only be used for not be left in the vehicle unattended if the
lightweight clothing. Do not leave any heavy button is also left behind. Otherwise there is
or sharp objects in the pockets. a possibility that they may be injured.
● Do not use clothes hangers to hang up the
clothing, as this could interfere with the func- CAUTION
tion of the head-protection airbags. Always use the correct type of plugs to avoid
Fig. 158 Centre console, rear section: USB
damaging the sockets.
power sockets.

Power sockets ● Remove the cap located on the centre con- Note
sole of the socket ››› Fig. 157. ● The use of electrical appliances with the
● Insert the plug of the electrical appliance engine switched off will cause a battery dis-
into the power socket. charge.
● Should the connected appliance overheat,
Electrical equipment can be connected to the immediately switch it off and disconnect it
12 volt power socket. The appliances connec- from the socket.
ted to each power socket must not exceed a
● Before switching the ignition on or off, un-
power rating of 120 Watt.
plug the appliances from the USB ports to
protect them from any damage caused by
USB power sockets fluctuations in voltage.
Depending on the equipment and the coun-
Fig. 157 Centre console: 12 volt socket try, the vehicle may also have USB connec-
tions exclusively for charging or as a power
socket. Storing objects
These USB ports are located at the rear of the
Loading the luggage compartment
console, between the front seats ››› Fig. 158.
These connectors can work at a maximum All luggage and other loose objects must be
power of up to 10.5 W per port. safely secured in the luggage compartment.
They are not intended for file playback. Unsecured objects which shift back and forth
162
Transport and practical equipment

could impair the driving safety or driving your speed and driving style accordingly, to Luggage compartment shelf

Technical data
characteristics of the vehicle by shifting the avoid accidents.
centre of gravity. ● Never exceed the allowed axle weights or
– Distribute the load evenly in the luggage allowed maximum weight. If said weights are
compartment. exceeded, the driving characteristics of the
vehicle may change, leading to accidents, in-
– Place heavy objects as far forward as possi- juries and damage to the vehicle.
ble in the luggage compartment. ● Never leave your vehicle unattended, espe-
– Place the heavy objects first. cially when the rear lid is open. Children

Advice
could climb into the luggage compartment,
– Secure heavy objects to the fitted fastening closing the door behind them; they will be
rings ››› page 165. trapped and run the risk of death.
● Never allow children to play in or around Fig. 159 In the luggage compartment: remov-
WARNING the vehicle. Close and lock all the doors and ing and installing the rear shelf.
● Loose luggage and other objects in the lug- the rear lid when you leave the vehicle. Be-

Operation
gage compartment could cause serious inju- fore you lock the vehicle, make sure that
ries. there are no adults or children in the vehicle.
● Always stow objects in the luggage com-
partment and secure them on the fastening Note
rings.
● Air circulation in the vehicle helps reduce

Emergencies
● Use suitable straps to secure heavy ob- fogging of the windows. Used air escapes
jects. through ventilation slits in the side trim of
● During sudden manoeuvres or accidents, the luggage compartment. Ensure that the
loose objects can be thrown forward, injuring ventilation slots are never covered.
vehicle occupants or passers-by. This in- ● Straps for securing the load to the fasten-
creased risk of injury will be further increased ing rings are commercially available. Fig. 160 In the luggage compartment: remov-
if a loose object is struck by an inflating air- ing and installing the rear shelf.
bag. If this happens, objects may shoot out-

Safety
ward like a missile. Risk of fatal injury. The luggage compartment cover blocks the
● Please note that the centre of gravity may view into the luggage compartment. »
shift when transporting heavy objects; this
may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
cident. Therefore, it is essential to adjust

163
Operation

Removing Storing the rear shelf ● Press the rear shelf until it engages in its
● Detach the cord loops ››› Fig. 159 B from housing ››› Fig. 162.
their hooks A . ● Put the left and right covers in their original
● Remove the rear shelf from the side sup- position.
ports ››› Fig. 160 by pulling it upwards and
then take it out.
Tailboard for transporting long items*
If necessary, the rear shelf can be stored un-
der the luggage compartment double floor
››› page 164.

Fitting
● Insert the cover horizontally so that the “re- Fig. 161 In the luggage compartment: covers
for storing the rear shelf.
cess” fits onto the axis of the supports
››› Fig. 160 and press down until it engages.
● Hook the loops ››› Fig. 159 B to the rear
lid.

WARNING Fig. 163 On the rear seat backrest: opening


the tailboard.
● The luggage compartment cover must al-
ways be fixed properly (risk of accident).
● The luggage compartment cover should not
be used as a storage shelf. Articles placed on
this cover could cause injury to vehicle occu-
pants in an accident or if the brakes are ap- Fig. 162 In the luggage compartment: fitting
plied suddenly. the storage compartment shelf.

The rear shelf can be stored under the lug-


gage compartment variable floor.
● Remove the left and right covers
››› Fig. 161. Fig. 164 In the luggage compartment: open-
ing the tailboard.
164
Transport and practical equipment

On the rear seat, behind the central armrest, lease lever down, in the direction of the ar- ● Always use belts or retaining straps that

Technical data
there is a tailboard for transporting long row, and the cover upwards ››› Fig. 164. are suitable and in a good condition.
items in the interior, such as skis. ● Belts and retaining straps should be se-
To avoid soiling the interior, dirty objects curely fastened to the fastening rings.
should be wrapped (e.g. in a blanket) before Fastening rings* ● Objects in the luggage compartment that
they are inserted through the tailboard. are unsecured could move suddenly and mod-
ify the handling of the vehicle.
When the armrest is down, nobody may trav-
● Secure all objects, little and large.
el in the centre rear seat.

Advice
● Never exceed the maximum tensile load of
Opening the tailboard the fastening ring when securing objects.
● Lower the centre armrest. ● Never secure a child seat to the fastening
rings.
● Pull the release lever in the direction of the
arrow and push the tailboard cover

Operation
››› Fig. 163
1 down and forwards. Note

● Open the rear lid. ● The maximum tensile load that the fasten-
Fig. 165 In the luggage compartment: fasten- ing rings can support is 3.5 kN.
● Insert the long objects through the gap
ing rings ● Belts and securing systems for the appro-
from the luggage compartment.
priate load can be obtained from specialised
● Secure the objects with the seatbelt. In the front and rear part of the luggage com- dealerships. SEAT recommends visiting a

Emergencies
● Close the rear lid. partment there are fastening rings to secure SEAT dealership for this.
the luggage ››› Fig. 165. ● The fastening rings are rendered unusable
Closing the tailboard for versions with a spare wheel.
In order to use the front fastening rings, they
● Lift the tailboard cover until it engages. The must be lifted beforehand.
red mark on the luggage compartment side
should never be visible. WARNING
● Close the rear lid. If unsuitable or damaged belts or retaining

Safety
● Lift the centre armrest if necessary. straps are used, they could break in the event
of braking or an accident. Objects could then
be launched across the passenger compart-
Note
ment and cause serious or fatal injuries.
The tailboard can also be opened from the
luggage compartment. To do so, press the re-
165
Operation

Retaining hooks Net bag* Hooking the net bag into the luggage com-
partment floor
● As applicable, lift the front fastening rings
››› Fig. 167 2 .
● Secure the net hooks to the fastening rings
2 ››› . The bag zip should be facing up-
wards.
● Secure the net hooks to the fastening rings
1 .

Hook the net bag next to the load threshold


Fig. 166 In the luggage compartment: retain- Fig. 167 In the luggage compartment: net ● Secure the short net hooks to the fastening
ing hooks bag hooked to the ground. rings ››› Fig. 168 1 ››› . The bag zip should
be facing upwards.
At the rear of the luggage compartment, on ● Secure the straps in the bag hooks 2 .
the left and right, there are fixed retaining
hooks ››› Fig. 166.
Removing the net bag
The retaining hooks have been designed to The hooked up net bag is taut ››› .
secure light shopping bags.
● Remove the hooks and the net bag straps
WARNING from the fastening rings and from the bag
Never use the retaining hooks as fastening hooks.
rings. In case of sudden braking or an acci- ● Store the net bag in the luggage compart-
dent, the hooks could break. ment.
Fig. 168 In the luggage compartment: rings
1 and hooks 2 for attaching the net bag.
CAUTION WARNING

Each hook is designed for a maximum load of The luggage compartment prevents light lug- To secure the elastic net bag on the fastening
2.5 kg. gage from moving. The net bag has a zip and rings it must be stretched out. Once hooked
can be used to store small objects. up it is taut. If the net bag is hooked up or un-
hooked incorrectly the hooks could cause in-
The net bag can be hooked up to the luggage juries.
compartment in different ways.
166
Transport and practical equipment

● Always secure the net hooks properly so Luggage compartment variable floor

Technical data
that they do not suddenly release from the
fastening rings when hooking or unhooking
them.
● On hooking or unhooking them, protect
your eyes and face in case the hooks are re-
leased suddenly.
● Always hook up the net bag hooks in the
described order. If a hook is unexpectedly re-

Advice
leased the risk of injury is increased.
Fig. 170 Luggage compartment variable
floor: sloped position.

Variable floor in the high position

Operation
● To move from the low position to the high
position, lift the floor using the handle
››› Fig. 169 1 , and pull it back until the front
of the floor has fully passed the supports 2 .
● Move the floor forward over the supports as
far as the rear seat backrest and then lower

Emergencies
the floor with the handle 1 .
Fig. 169 Luggage compartment variable
Variable floor in the low position
floor:  raised position;  lowered position.
● To move from the high position to the low
position, lift the floor using the handle
››› Fig. 169 1 , and pull it back until the front
of the floor has fully passed the supports 2 .

Safety
● Now let the front part fall to the floor and
slide the floor forwards as far as the rear seat
backrest; lower the floor at the same time
with the handle 1 . »

167
Operation

Variable floor in the tilted position ried between the rear seat and the raised lug- As the roof water drains are integrated in the
When the variable floor is tilted you can ac- gage compartment floor. roof to reduce air resistance, only SEAT-ap-
cess the spare wheel/anti-puncture kit area. ● Only objects that do not weigh than ap-
proved cross bars and roof carrier systems
proximately 7.5 kg may be carried between can be used.
● Lift the variable floor in the high position the rear seat and the raised luggage compart-
using the handle 1 ››› Fig. 169, pull it up ment floor. Cases in which cross bars and the roof carri-
and push it towards the backrest of the rear er system should be disassembled.
seats until the floor folds along the hinge line ● When they are not used.
CAUTION
and the movable part of the floor is resting
● The maximum weight that can be loaded on ● When the vehicle is washed in a car wash.
on itself.
the luggage compartment variable floor in ● When the vehicle height exceeds the maxi-
● Rest the floor on its housings ››› Fig. 170
the top position is 150 kg. mum height, for example, in some garages.
(arrows).
● Do not let the luggage compartment floor
fall when closing it. Always carefully guide it WARNING
Variable floor with folded seats
downwards in a controlled manner. Other-
● To move from the high position to the low When heavy or bulky loads are transported
wise, the lining and the floor of the luggage
on the roof carrier system, car driving per-
position, lift the floor using the handle compartment could be damaged.
formance is affected, as the centre of gravity
››› Fig. 169 1 and pull it back a little.
shifts and there is greater wind resistance.
● Push the variable floor towards the folded Note ● Always secure the load properly using belts
rear seats with the handle 1 using some SEAT recommends the use of straps to secure or retaining straps that are suitable and in a
downward pressure so that the moving part objects to retaining rings. good condition.
of the floor is flush with the backs of the rear ● Bulky, heavy, long or flat loads have a neg-
seats. ative effect on aerodynamics, the centre of
gravity and driving performance.
WARNING Roof carrier* ● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
During a sudden driving or braking manoeu- ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
vre, or in the event of an accident, objects Introduction times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
could be flung though the interior and cause fic conditions.
serious or fatal injuries. The vehicle roof has been designed to opti-
● Always secure objects, even when the lug- mise aerodynamics. For this reason, cross
bars or conventional roof carrier systems can- CAUTION
gage compartment floor is properly lifted.
● Only objects that do not protrude more not be secured to the roof water drains. ● Remove the cross bars and the roof carrier
than 2/3 the height of the floor may be car- system before entering a car wash.

168
Transport and practical equipment

● Vehicle height is increased by the installa- Attach the cross bars and the roof car- and the brackets of the roof railings B must

Technical data
tion of cross bars or a roof carrier system and rier system be 15 cm.
the load secured on them. For this purpose,
check that your vehicle's height does not sur- WARNING
pass the headspace limit, for example, for un- Incorrect attachment and use of the cross-
derpasses or for entering garage doors. bars and the roof carrier system may cause
● Cross bars, the roof carrier system and the the whole system to detach from the roof and
load secured on them should not interfere cause an accident and injuries.
with the roof aerial or hamper the path of the ● Always take the manufacturer assembly in-

Advice
panoramic sun roof and the rear lid. structions into account.
● On opening the rear lid make sure that it
● Use only crossbars and the roof carrier sys-
does not knock into the roof load. tem when they are in perfect condition and
are properly secured.
For the sake of the environment ● Secure the crossbars and the roof carrier

Operation
When cross bars and a roof carrier system are system properly.
Fig. 171 Attachment points for the roof rail-
installed, the increased air resistance means ● Check threaded joints and attachments
ings for the roof carrier system.
that the vehicle uses more fuel. travelling and if necessary tighten them after
you have travelled a short distance. When
The crossbars are the basis of a series of spe-
making long trips, check the threaded joints
cial roof carrier systems. For safety reasons, whenever you stop for a rest.
special fixtures must be used to safely trans-

Emergencies
● Always fit the special roof carrier systems
port luggage, bicycles, skis, surf boards or
correctly for wheels, skis and surfboards, etc.
boats on the roof. Suitable accessories can
be acquired at SEAT dealerships. ● Do not modify or repair the crossbars or
roof carrier system.
Always secure the crossbars and the roof car-
rier system properly. Always take the assem-
Note
bly instructions that come with the crossbars
and the roof carrier system in question into Always read the assembly instructions that

Safety
account. come with the crossbars and the roof carrier
system carefully and keep them in the vehi-
The crossbars are assembled on the roof rail- cle.
ings. The distance between crossbars
››› Fig. 171 A should be between 70 and 90
cm and the distance between the crossbars
169
Operation

Loading the roof carrier system ney and subsequently with a certain frequen-
cy.
Air conditioning
The load can only be secured if the crossbars
and the roof carrier system are properly in- WARNING Heating, ventilation and cool-
stalled ››› . Exceeding the maximum authorised roof load ing
can result in accidents and considerable vehi-
Maximum authorised roof load cle damage. Introduction
The maximum permissible roof load is 75 kg. ● Never exceed the maximum authorised
This figure comes from the combined weight load on the roof and on the axles or the vehi- Read the additional information carefully
of the roof carrier, the cross bars and the load cle's maximum authorised weight. ›››  page 51
itself on the roof ››› . ● Never exceed the load capacity of the cross
bars and the roof carrier system, even if the Viewing Climatronic information
Always check the weight of the roof carrier
maximum authorised roof load has not been On the screen of Climatronic control unit and
system, the cross bars and the weight of the reached.
load to be transported and weigh them if on the screen of the factory-fitted Easy Con-
● Secure heavy items as far forward as possi- nect system, the theoretical values of the
necessary. Never exceed the maximum au-
ble and distribute the vehicle load uniformly. temperature zones are shown.
thorised roof load.
If you are using cross bars and a roof carrier The unit of temperature measurement can be
WARNING
with a lower weight rating, you will not be changed in the Easy Connect system.
able to carry the maximum authorised roof If the load is loose or not secured, it could fall
load. In this case, do not exceed the maxi- from the roof carrier system or cause acci- Dust and pollen filter
mum weight limit for the roof carrier which is dents and injuries.
The dust and pollen filter with its activated
listed in the fitting instructions. ● Always use belts or retaining straps that
charcoal cartridge serves as a barrier against
are suitable and in a good condition.
impurities in the air taken into the vehicle in-
Distributing a load ● Secure the load properly. terior.
Distribute loads uniformly and secure them The dust and pollen filter must be changed
correctly ››› . regularly so that air conditioner performance
is not adversely affected.
Check attachments
If the filter loses efficiency prematurely due
Once the cross bars and roof carrier system to use in areas with very high levels of air
have been installed, check the bolted con- pollution, the filter must be changed more
nections and attachments after a short jour- frequently than stated in the Service Sched-
ule.
170
Air conditioning

WARNING CAUTION Operating the Climatronic through the

Technical data
Reduced visibility through the windows in- ● To replace the pollen filter, always visit a Easy Connect system*
creases the risk of serious accidents. service centre. 3 Applies to vehicles with a Media System
● Always ensure that all windows are free of ● Switch the air conditioner off if you think it Touch/Colour.
ice and snow, and that they are not fogged, may be broken. This will avoid additional
so as to maintain good visibility of everything damage. Have the air conditioner checked by
outside. a specialised workshop.
● The maximum heat output required to de- ● Repairs to the air conditioner require spe-

Advice
frost windows as quickly as possible is only cialist knowledge and special tools. SEAT rec-
available when the engine has reached its ommends visiting a SEAT Official Service.
normal running temperature. Only drive when
you have good visibility.
Note
● Always ensure that you use the heating
● When the cooling system is turned off, air
system, fresh air system, air conditioner and

Operation
the heated rear window to maintain good visi- coming from the outside will not be dried. To
bility to the outside. prevent fogging of the windows, SEAT recom- Fig. 172 Easy Connect screen: air conditioner
mends leaving the cooling system (compres- menu.
● Never leave the air recirculation on for a
sor) turned on. To do this, press the button
long period of time. If the cooling system is  . The button lamp should light up.
switched off and air recirculation mode In the Easy Connect system it is also possible
● The maximum heat output required to de- to perform various adjustments to the Clima-
switched on, the windows can mist over very
frost windows as quickly as possible is only

Emergencies
quickly, considerably limiting visibility. tronic.
available when the engine has reached its
● Switch air recirculation mode off when it is
normal running temperature.
not required. Open the air conditioner menu
● Keep the air intake slots in front of the
● Press the  button on the Climatronic
windscreen free of snow, ice and leaves to en-
WARNING sure heating and cooling are not impaired, control panel.
Stuffy or used air will increase fatigue and re- and to prevent the windows from misting ● OR: press the  button in Easy Connect.
duce driver concentration possibly resulting over. With the rotating switch select the air con-

Safety
in a serious accident. ditioner menu and open it.
● Never leave the fresh air fan turned off or
On the touch screen you can see and change
use the air recirculation for long periods of
the current settings, for example, the temper-
time; the air in the vehicle interior will not be
refreshed. ature set for the driver and passenger sides,
the air distribution and the fan speed. »
171
Operation

To switch a function on or off, or to select a Operating the Climatronic through the To switch a function on or off, or to select a
submenu, you must press the corresponding Easy Connect system* submenu, you must press the corresponding
function button. function button.
3 Applies to vehicles with Media System Plus / Navi
System / Navi System Plus.
Function button: Function Function button: Function
OFF Switch off and switch on the Climatronic. OFF Climatronic is switched off.

Synchronise driver and front passenger ON Climatronic is switched on.


SYNC
temperatures.
Synchronise driver and front passenger
SYNC
The air conditioning settings submenu is temperatures.
opened. The following settings can also
be adjusted: The air conditioning settings submenu is
opened. The following settings can also
Air conditioning profile.: Adjust be adjusted:
the power of the fan in AUTO mode. You
can choose between low, medium and Automatic supplementary heater:
SETTINGS to activate/deactivate the automatic acti-
high. Fig. 173 Easy Connect screen: air conditioner
menu. vation of the auxiliary heating for colder
Automatic air recirculation: countries (only for engines with auxiliary
Switching automatic air recirculation on heating). With the option deactivated, de-
In the Easy Connect system it is also possible
and off ››› page 174. pending on the outside temperature the
to perform various adjustments to the Clima- heating may need more time than normal
SETTINGS
BACK : Close the submenu. tronic. to reach a comfortable temperature.

Automatic windscreen heating*: to


* The auxiliary heater submenu opens. Open the air conditioner menu switch the automatic windscreen heating
● Press the  button on the Climatronic on and off ››› page 175.
It enables manual switching on or off of
* the windscreen heater. control panel.
Automatic air recirculation: to
It enables activation and deactivation of On the top of the screen you can see and switch automatic air recirculation on and
 the PureAir and opens the submenu. change the current settings, such as, for ex- off ››› page 174.
ample, the temperature set for the driver side BACK : to close the submenu.
and for that of passenger. Temperatures up
to +22°C (+72°F) are shown with blue arrows,
and temperatures over +22°C (+72°F) with
* The auxiliary heater submenu opens.

red arrows. It enables manual switching on or off of


* the windscreen heater.
172
Air conditioning

Function button: Function fitted navigation system is done using the Special Characteristics

Technical data
menu on the instrument panel If the humidity and temperature outside the
It enables activation and deactivation of ›››  page 36.
 the PureAir and opens the submenu.
vehicle are high, condensation can drip off
the evaporator in the cooling system and
The cooling system cannot be activated form a pool underneath the vehicle. This is
If the air conditioning system cannot be normal and does not indicate a leak!
Air conditioning user instructions switched on, this may be caused by the fol-
lowing: Note
The interior cooling system only works when

Advice
After starting the engine, any residual humid-
the engine is running and fan is switched on. ● The engine is not running.
ity in the air conditioner could mist over the
The air conditioner operates most effectively ● The fan is switched off. windscreen. Switch on the defrost function as
with the windows and the panoramic sliding ● The air conditioner fuse has blown. soon as possible to clear the windscreen of
sunroof closed. However, if the vehicle has condensation.
● The outside temperature is lower than ap-
heated up after standing in the sun for some
proximately +3°C (+38°F).

Operation
time, the air inside can be cooled more quick-
ly by opening the windows and the panoram- ● The air conditioner compressor has been
ic sliding sunroof briefly. temporarily switched off because the engine
coolant temperature is too high.
Climatronic: change the temperature unit on ● Another fault in the vehicle. Have the air
the screen of the radio or on the factory-fit- conditioner checked by a specialised work-

Emergencies
ted navigation system shop.
Changing the temperature display from Cel-
sius to Fahrenheit on radio or on the factory-

Safety
173
Operation

Air outlets

Fig. 174 On the dash panel: air vents

Air vents Note When the outside temperature is very high,


To ensure proper heating, cooling and venti- selecting manual air recirculation mode for a
Food, medicine and other heat or cold sensi- short period refreshes the vehicle interior
lation in the vehicle interior, air vents tive objects should never be placed in front of
››› Fig. 174 1 should remain open. more quickly.
the air outlets as they may be damaged or
made unsuitable for use by the air coming For safety reasons, air recirculation mode is
● Turn the corresponding thumbwheel (de- from the air vents. switched off when the button  is press-
tail) in the required direction to open and ed or the air distributor turned to .
close the air vents. When the thumbwheel is
in the  position, the corresponding air vent
Air recirculation mode Switching the manual air recirculation mode
is closed.
on and off 
● Change the air direction using the ventila- Basic points To switch system on: press the  button un-
tion grille lever.
Air recirculation: til the warning lamp lights up.
There are other additional, non-adjustable air To switch system off: press the  button un-
vents in the dash panel 2 , in the footwell  Manual recirculation
til the warning lamp goes off.
and in the rear area of the interior.
Air recirculation mode prevents the ambient
air from entering the interior.
174
Air conditioning

Functioning mode of automatic air recircula- ● If the cooling system is switched off and air Heated windscreen*

Technical data
tion (air conditioning menu) recirculation mode switched on, the windows
With the automatic air recirculation mode ac- can mist over very quickly, considerably limit-
tivated, the entry of fresh air into the cabin ing visibility.
interior is enabled. If the system detects a ● Switch air recirculation mode off when it is
high concentration of hazardous substances not required.
in the ambient air, air recirculation mode is
switched on automatically. When the level of CAUTION
impurities drops to within a normal range, re-

Advice
Do not smoke when air recirculation is
circulation mode is switched off.
switched on in vehicles with an air condition-
The system is unable to detect unpleasant er. The smoke taken in could lie on the cool-
smells. ing system vaporiser and on the activated
charcoal cartridge of the dust and pollen fil- Fig. 175 Windscreen humidity and tempera-
The air recirculation will not connect auto- ter, leading to a permanently unpleasant ture sensor.
matically in versions without humidity sensor

Operation
smell.
and in the following external conditions: The heated windscreen is comprised of a set
of heated wires placed between the layers of
● The outside temperature is lower than +3°C Note the windscreen which, when electric current
(+38°F). Climatronic: air recirculation mode is activa- is supplied to them, heat up and cause the
● The cooling system is switched off and the ted to prevent exhaust gas or unpleasant temperature of the glass to rise.
outside temperature is below +10°C (+50°F). odours from entering the vehicle interior

Emergencies
when it is in reverse and while the automatic Its function is to assist the air-conditioning
● The cooling system is switched off, the out- system to prevent the windscreen from mist-
windscreen wiper is working.
side temperature is below +15°C (+59°F) and ing up or to demist it faster if it does mist up.
the windscreen wipers are switched on.
The system can be switched on manually or
Activation/deactivation of automatic air recir- automatically.
culation is done in the air conditioner menu,
under Configuration. Manual activation

Safety
● Press the button  in the Climatronic
WARNING control panel.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro- ● Press the  function button to switch the
duction on page 171. windscreen heating on or off. »

175
Operation

Automatic activation
To facilitate use of the heated windscreen it
can turn on automatically.
The Climatronic control panel can detect the
danger of the windscreen misting thanks to
its temperature and humidity sensors,
switching the system on or off accordingly
››› Fig. 175. Moreover, it will also be activated
automatically when the  button is
pressed on the Climatronic control panel.
Adjust it as follows for it to switch on auto-
matically:
● Press the button  in the Climatronic
control panel.
● Press the SETTINGS function button on the
infotainment system.
● Switch the function on or off by pressing
the Automatic windscreen heating function but-
ton.

176
Air conditioning

Auxiliary heater (additional ● If you suspect that someone may have suitable for use by the air coming from the

Technical data
swallowed a battery, seek immediate medical vents.
heater)* attention.

Introduction Note
WARNING
After switching the engine on with a 12-volt
The auxiliary heater runs on fuel from the ve- The auxiliary heater exhaust fumes contain battery that is heavily discharged or newly
hicle's tank and can be used while you are carbon monoxide, an odourless and colour- changed or after a jump start some system
driving and when the vehicle is stationary. less toxic gas. Carbon monoxide can cause settings (such as the time, the date, the per-

Advice
people to lose consciousness. It can also sonalised comfort settings and the program-
The auxiliary heater can be switched on using cause death. ming) might be altered or deleted. Check and
the fast heating button of the air condition- correct these settings once the battery is suf-
● Never switch on the auxiliary heater or
ing controls, with the remote control or by ficiently charged.
leave it running in enclosed spaces or areas
previously programming a departure time in with no ventilation.
the auxiliary heater menu of the infotainment
● Never programme the auxiliary heater so
system.

Operation
that it switches itself on and is running in an Switching on and off the auxiliary
In winter, with the auxiliary heater switched enclosed space or an area with no ventila- heater
on, you can defog the windscreen and leave tion.
it free of ice and snow (if it is a thin layer) be-
Switching the auxiliary heater on:
fore you start driving. WARNING
Manually with the fast heating button of the air
If the outside temperature is very high, the

Emergencies
The components of the auxiliary heater are
vehicle interior can be ventilated with the en- extremely hot and could cause a fire.
 conditioner controls. The control lamp of the
button will light up ››› page 170.
gine off using the auxiliary heater. ● Always park your vehicle so that no part of
the exhaust system can come in contact with  Manually with the remote control ››› page 178.
WARNING easily flammable materials that might be be-
Automatically by programming and activating a
Swallowing a battery with a 20 mm diameter low the vehicle, such as dried grass.
departure time ››› page 179.
or any other button battery can cause serious
and even fatal injuries within a very short CAUTION

Safety
time. Switching the auxiliary heater off:
Never place food, medicines or other temper-
● Always keep the remote control, keyrings Manually with the fast heating button of the air
ature-sensitive objects close to the air vents.
with batteries, the spare batteries, button  conditioner controls. The control lamp of the
Food, medicines and other objects sensitive
batteries and all other batteries over 20 mm
to heat or cold may be damaged or made un- button goes off ››› page 170.
out of reach of children.
 Manually with the remote control ››› page 178. »
177
Operation

Switching the auxiliary heater off: Fig. 176 Meaning Control lamp 1 Meaning
Automatically once the programmed departure  Switch the auxiliary heater on The auxiliary heater is
time has arrived or after the programmed oper- It flashes green quickly for locked.
ating time has elapsed ››› page 179.  Switch the auxiliary heater off approximately 2 seconds Possible causes: The fuel
(approximately 10 times tank is almost empty, the
Automatically when the control lamp  (fuel 1 Control lamp per second). 12-volt battery charge is
level indicator) ››› page 292 lights up. too low or there is a fault.
If the buttons of the remote control are press-
Automatically when the 12-volt battery charge It flashes orange for ap-
ed unnecessarily, it could switch on the auxil-
is too low ››› page 305. proximately 2 seconds No offa) signal has been
iary heater involuntarily, even when it is out (approximately 4 times per received.
of range or when the control lamp is flashing. second).
Special feature
Control lamp on the remote control The remote control battery
Once switched off, the auxiliary heater will It will light for about 2 sec-
is almost flat. However,
onds in orange, then
continue to operate for a short period of time When the buttons are pressed, the control the on or off signal has
green or red.
in order to burn the fuel remaining in the sys- lamp on the remote control provides the user been received.
tem and also to expel the exhaust fumes. with different information: It will light for about 2 sec- The remote control battery
onds in orange, then it is almost flat. No on or off
Control lamp 1 Meaning flashes green or red. signal has been received.
Remote control The auxiliary heater has The remote control battery
It will light for about 2 sec- It flashes orange for ap-
been switched on using is flat. No on or off signal
onds in green. proximately 5 seconds.
the  button. has been received.

The auxiliary heater has a)The remote control is out of range. In this case it will be nec-
It will light for about 2 sec-
been switched off using essary to get closer to the vehicle and press the corresponding
onds in red. button again.
the  button.

It flashes green slowly for


Replacing the remote control battery
approximately 2 seconds No ona) signal has been
(approximately 4 times per received. If, when pressing the buttons of the remote
second). control, control lamp 1 flashes orange for
approximately 5 seconds or it does not
switch on, the remote control battery will
Fig. 176 Auxiliary heater: remote control.
need replacing.

178
Air conditioning

The battery is located beneath a cover on the For the sake of the environment Function button: function

Technical data
back of the remote control.
● Please dispose of your used batteries cor- Heat , Ventilate : Set to heat or ventilate the vehicle interi-
● To open the cover, lift it slightly at the bot- rectly and with respect for the environment. or when the auxiliary heater is switched on. By pressing
tom and slide it down. ● The remote control battery may contain the function button  , you can select the desired
perchlorate. Observe the legal provisions re- mode.
● Remove the old battery.
garding disposal.
● Insert the new battery. When doing so, take Set : Opens the Auxiliary heater menu.
● Care should be taken so as not to operate
into account the polarity and use batteries of Departure time 1 , Departure time 2 , Departure time 3 :
the remote control unintentionally so as to
the same type ››› .

Advice
prevent the auxiliary heater being switched Three different departure times (hh.mm) may be
● Replace the battery cover by inserting the on accidentally. programmed. If the auxiliary heater should only
be switched on a certain day of the week, this can
tabs at the top and pressing the bottom. also be selected.

Range Programming the auxiliary heater


Duration : The duration determines the operating
time of the auxiliary heater when switched on us-
The receiver is inside the vehicle. The remote

Operation
ing the fast heating button  on the air condi-
control, when fitted with new batteries, has a Before programming it, check that the vehi- tioning controls. The duration is also used to cal-
range of several hundred metres. Obstacles cle's date and time are set correctly ››› . culate the departure time for the manual air con-
between the remote control and the vehicle, ditioner. It can be set between 10 and 60 mi-
The auxiliary heater is programmed in the nutes at 10-minute intervals.
bad weather conditions and discharged bat- Auxiliary heater menu of the infotain-
teries can considerably reduce the range of
the remote control.
ment system.  This returns to the main menu.

Emergencies
Open the Auxiliary heater menu. The programmed departure time determines
CAUTION the approximate time it should take to reach
● Press the button  in the Climatronic
● The radio frequency remote control con- the temperature set in the vehicle. The start
control panel.
tains electronic components. Therefore, avoid of the heating operation is determined auto-
getting it wet and exposing it to knocks or di- ● Press the  function button. matically depending on the outside tempera-
rect sunlight. ture.
● The use of inappropriate batteries may Function button: function

Safety
damage the radio frequency remote control. Checking the programming
Switch off : The auxiliary heater is immediately switched
For this reason, always replace the used bat- off. When a departure time is activated and the
tery with another of the same voltage, size
and specifications.
ignition is switched off the control lamp of
the fast heating button  lights up for ap-
proximately 10 seconds. »
179
Operation

WARNING auxiliary heater switches off automatically auxiliary heater is switched off again after a
and cannot be switched on. This avoids prob- certain time.
Never programme the auxiliary heater so that lems when starting the engine.
it switches itself on and is running in an en-
closed space or an area with no ventilation. ● The heating must be activated every time
The auxiliary heater exhaust fumes contain you want to set off. Similarly, the departure
carbon monoxide, an odourless and colour- time must reactivate each time.
less toxic gas. Carbon monoxide can cause ● The control lamp  (fuel level indicator)
people to lose consciousness. It can also
lights up.
cause death.
Note
● Noises will be heard while the auxiliary
Operating instructions heater is running.
● When the air humidity is high and the in-
The auxiliary heater exhaust system located
below the vehicle must be kept clear of snow, side temperature low, condensation from the
heating and ventilating system may evapo-
mud and other objects. The exhaust fumes
rate when the auxiliary heater is switched on.
must be able to exit freely. The emissions In this case, steam may be released from un-
generated by the auxiliary heater are re- derneath the vehicle. This does not mean
moved via an exhaust pipe fitted underneath that there is a vehicle malfunction.
the vehicle.
● If the vehicle is tilted, e.g. if parked on a
On heating the vehicle interior, depending on slope, the operation of the auxiliary heater
the outside temperature, the warm air is first may be restricted if the fuel tank level is low
directed at the windscreen and then to the (just above the reserve level).
rest of the vehicle interior through the air ● If the auxiliary heater is used a number of
vents. Directing the diffusers – towards the times for a long period of time, the 12-volt
windows for example – can affect air distribu- battery will lose its charge. To recharge the
tion. battery, the vehicle must be driven for a num-
ber of kilometres from time to time. As a
guideline: The journey should last approxi-
When will the auxiliary heater not be activa-
mately as long as the heater was connected.
ted?
● At temperatures below +5°C (+41°F), the
● The auxiliary heater requires about as
auxiliary heater may switch itself on automat-
much power as the dipped beam headlights. ically when the engine is switched on. The
If the 12-volt battery charge is too low, the
180
Driving

Driving operating temperature, or at outside temper- Select N or P

Technical data
atures above +8°C, the warning lamp  will This message appears if you try to start or
light up for about one second. This means stop the engine when the selector lever of
Starting and stopping the en- that the engine starts immediately. the automatic gearbox is not in position P or
gine If the engine does not immediately start up, N. The engine can only start or stop in certain
interrupt the starting process and try again positions.
Switching the ignition on and starting after 30 seconds. To start the engine again,
the engine with the key return the key to position 1 . Engage position P; the vehicle
can move; doors can only close in

Advice
Start-Stop System* position P.
If the vehicle is stopped and the Start-Stop For safety reasons, this driver message ap-
system* switches off the engine, the ignition pears and an audible warning sounds if the
remains switched on. selector lever of the automatic gearbox is not
in position P after you switch off the ignition.

Operation
Automatic gearbox: before leaving the vehi- Put the selector lever in position P, otherwise
cle, make sure that the ignition is switched the vehicle could roll away.
off and the selector lever is in position P.
Gear change: selector lever in
Driver messages on the instrument panel the drive position!
Fig. 177 Ignition key positions.
display
This driver message is displayed when the

Emergencies
Press the clutch selector lever is not in the position P when
Read the additional information carefully
the driver door is opened. Additionally, a
›››  page 30 This message appears on vehicles with a buzzer will sound. Put the selector lever in
manual gearbox if the driver tries to start the position P, otherwise the vehicle could roll
Diesel engines can take a few seconds longer engine without having the clutch pedal
than usual to start on cold days. Therefore away.
pressed. The engine will only start if you
the clutch pedal (manual gearbox) or the press the clutch pedal.
brake pedal (automatic gearbox) must re- Ignition is switched on

Safety
main pressed until the engine starts up. Dur- This driver message is displayed and a buz-
Press the brake
ing preheating, the warning lamp  remains zer is sounded when the driver door is
lit. This message appears on vehicles with an opened with the ignition switched on. »
automatic gearbox if the driver tries to start
The preheating time depends on the coolant the engine without having the brake pedal
and exterior temperatures. With the engine at pressed.
181
Operation

WARNING the selector lever is in position “P” (parking ● Never remove the key from the ignition if
● Never run the engine in confined spaces, as
lock). Next, the selector lever is locked. the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the steer-
ing could suddenly lock, making it impossible
the exhaust gases are poisonous.
to steer the vehicle: risk of accident!
● Always take the key with you when you
CAUTION Switching off the engine with the key
leave the vehicle. This is particularly impor-
Avoid high engine speeds, full throttle and Switching off the engine tant if there are children in the vehicle, as
extreme load conditions until the engine has they might otherwise be able to start the en-
reached its normal operating temperature, – Stop the vehicle. gine or use power-operated equipment (e.g.
otherwise this can damage the engine. – Turn the ignition key to position 1 the electric windows), which could cause in-
juries.
››› Fig. 177.
For the sake of the environment
Engaging the steering wheel lock CAUTION
Do not warm up the engine by idling it. You
should drive off as soon as you start the en- In vehicles with automatic gearbox, the igni- If the engine has been running under high
gine. This will help avoid unnecessary ex- tion key can only be removed when the selec- load for a long time, there is a risk of heat
haust emissions. tor lever is in position P. building up in the engine compartment after
it has been switched off; this could cause en-
– Remove the key from the ignition in posi- gine damage. For this reason, you should idle
Note tion 1 ››› Fig. 177 ››› . the engine for approximately 2 minutes be-
● If it is difficult to turn the ignition key to fore you switch it off.
– Turn the steering wheel until you hear it en-
the position 2 , turn the steering wheel to
gage.
both sides to release the steering lock. Note
● When starting from cold, the engine may be Possible vehicle theft is prevented with the
steering lock engaged. After the engine is switched off the radiator
a little noisy for the first few seconds until oil
fan may run on for up to 10 minutes, even if
pressure has built up in the hydraulic valve
the ignition is switched off. It is also possible
lifters. This is quite normal, and no cause for WARNING
that the fan turns itself on once more if the
concern. ● Never switch the engine off until the vehi- coolant temperature increases due to the
● If the vehicle battery is disconnected and cle is stationary. The brake servo and power heat accumulated in the engine compartment
reconnected, the key must remain in the posi- steering functions will not be completely cov- or due to its prolonged exposure to solar ra-
tion 1 for around 5 seconds before starting ered under warranty. More force may also be diation.
up. needed to turn the steering wheel or to brake.
● Vehicles with automatic gearbox: depend- As you cannot steer and brake in the normal
ing on the country, after switching off the ig- manner, there is a greater risk of accidents
nition, you can only remove the ignition key if and serious injury.
182
Driving

Starter button* In vehicles with the Keyless Access ample, the battery of the vehicle key button

Technical data
››› page 125 system, the engine can also be is very low or flat:
started with the key in the luggage compart-
ment. ● Immediately after pushing the starter but-
ton, keep the vehicle key next to the right
Opening the driver's door when exiting the trim of the steering column ››› Fig. 179, as
vehicle activates the electronic lock on the close as possible to the Kessy logo.
steering column if the ignition is disabled.
● The ignition connects and the engine starts
automatically.

Advice
Switching the ignition on/off manually
Briefly push the starter button without touch- Emergency disconnection
ing the brake or clutch pedal ››› .
If the engine does not switch off after briefly
Fig. 178 In the lower part of the centre con- For vehicles with both manual and automatic pressing the starter button, an emergency
sole: starter button. transmission, the starter button text disconnect will be required:

Operation
START ENGINE STOP flashes like a heartbeat
when the system is preset for switching the ● Press the starter button twice within 3 sec-
ignition on and off. onds or press it once for more than 1 sec-
ond ››› .
Automatic ignition switch-off ● The engine turns off automatically.
If the driver leaves the vehicle, taking the ve-

Emergencies
hicle key with them but leaving the ignition Engine restart feature
on, the ignition is not switched off automati- If no valid key is detected inside the vehicle
cally. The ignition is switched off automati- after the engine stops, you will only have 5
cally by pressing the lock button on the re- seconds to restart it. A warning will display
mote control  or manually by pressing the on the dash panel screen.
Fig. 179 On the right of the steering column: sensor surface on the door lever ››› Fig. 132
emergency start. After this interval, it will not be possible to
start the engine without a valid key inside
»

Safety
The vehicle engine can be started with a Emergency starting function the vehicle.
starter button (Press & Drive). To do so, there If no valid key is detected inside the vehicle,
must be a valid key inside the vehicle in the an emergency start-up will be required. The
area of the front or rear seats. relevant message will appear in the dash
panel display. This may happen when, for ex-

183
Operation

Automatic deactivation of the ignition on ve- way, operate electronic equipment (e.g. the Starting the engine with the starter
hicles with the Start-Stop system Step
windows). button ››› page 183 (Press & Drive).
The ignition is switched off automatically
In vehicles with a manual gearbox: press
when the vehicle is stopped and the auto- Note 1a. and hold the clutch down until the engine
matic engine shutdown is active, if: starts.
● Before leaving the vehicle, always discon-
● The driver's seat belt is not fastened, nect the ignition manually and, if appropri- Put the gearbox lever in neutral or the selec-
ate, take into account the instructions on the 2.
● the driver does not step on any pedal, tor lever in position P or N.
screen of the dash panel.
● the driver door is opened. ● If the vehicle is stationary for a long time Briefly press the starter button ››› Fig. 178
without pressing the accelerator. For the en-
with the ignition on, the vehicle battery
After automatically turning off the ignition, if might be discharged and it might not be pos-
gine to start there must be a valid key in the
the dipped beam  is on, the side light re- 3. vehicle.
sible to start the engine. After starting the engine, the light of the
mains on for approx. 30 minutes (if the bat-
● In diesel vehicles, there may be a delay in START ENGINE STOP button changes to a fixed
tery is sufficiently charged). If the driver locks light indicating that the engine has started.
the engine starting if it requires preheating.
the vehicle or manually turns off the light, the
side light goes out. ● If during the STOP phase you press the If the engine does not start, stop and wait
START ENGINE STOPbutton, the ignition is for approx. 1 minute before trying again. If
4.
switched off and the button flashes. necessary, perform an emergency start
WARNING
● If the indication “Start-Stop system deacti- ››› page 183.
Any accidental movement of the vehicle could
vated: Start the engine manually” is dis- Disconnect the electronic parking brake
result in serious injury.
played on the dash panel display, the 5. when you are about to start driving
● When switching on the ignition, do not START ENGINE STOP button will blink. ››› page 186.
press the brake or clutch pedal, otherwise
the engine could start immediately.
WARNING
Starting the engine Never leave the vehicle with the engine run-
WARNING
3 Valid for vehicles: with Keyless Access ning, especially if a gear or gear range is en-
If vehicle keys are used negligently or with- gaged. The vehicle could then suddenly move
out due care, this may cause accidents and Starting the engine with the starter or something strange could happen that
serious injury. Step would cause damage, fire or serious injury.
button ››› page 183 (Press & Drive).
● Never leave any key inside the vehicle
when exiting. Otherwise, a child or unauthor- Press and hold the brake pedal until step 5
1.
is performed.
WARNING
ised person could lock the vehicle, start the
engine or connect the ignition and, in this Cold start sprays could explode or cause a
sudden increase in the engine speed.
184
Driving

● Never use sprays to cold start the engine. Stopping the engine ● Power steering does not work when the en-

Technical data
3 Valid for vehicles: with Keyless Access gine is not running. You need more strength
to steer when the engine is switched off.
CAUTION
Switch off the engine with the starter ● If the ignition is switched off, the steering
● The starter motor or the engine may be Step
button ››› page 183. column could be locked, making it impossible
damaged if you try to start the engine while to control the vehicle.
driving or if you restart it immediately after 1. Stop the vehicle completely ››› .
switching it off.
● If the engine is cold, avoid high engine
Press and hold the brake pedal until the step CAUTION
2.

Advice
4 is performed.
speeds, pushing the engine too hard and rap- If the engine is made to work hard for a long
id acceleration. If you are driving an automatic vehicle, place time, it may overheat after being switched
3.
● Do not start the engine by pushing the ve- the selector lever in position P. off. To prevent damage to the engine before
hicle or towing it. Unburnt fuel could enter switching it off, leave it idle for approx. 2 mi-
Connect the electronic parking brake nutes in neutral.
the catalytic converter and damage it. 4.
››› page 186.

Operation
Briefly press the start-up button ››› Fig. 178. Note
Note The START ENGINE STOP button blinks again. If
5. After switching off the engine, the cooling fan
● Do not wait until the engine warms up with the engine fails to switch off, perform an
the vehicle stationary; if you have good visi- emergency disconnect ››› page 183. may continue to operate in the engine com-
bility through the windows, start driving im- partment for a few more minutes, even with
If the vehicle is equipped with a manual the ignition off. The radiator fan is automati-
mediately. This helps the engine reach oper- 6.
gearbox, put it into 1st or reverse. cally switched off.

Emergencies
ating temperature faster and reduces emis-
sions.
WARNING
● Electrical components with a high power
consumption are switched off temporarily Never switch off the engine while the vehicle “My Beat” Function
when the engine starts. is moving. This could cause loss of control of
the vehicle, accidents and serious injury. For vehicles with a convenience key there is
● When starting with a cold engine, noise
levels may briefly increase. This is quite nor- ● The airbags and belt tensioners do not the “My Beat” function. This feature provides
mal, and no cause for concern. work when the ignition is switched off. an additional indication of the vehicle igni-

Safety
● When the outside temperature is below ● The brake servo does not work with the en- tion system.
+5°C (+41°F), if the engine is diesel, some gine off. Therefore, you need to press the When accessing the vehicle, e.g. by opening
smoke may appear under the vehicle when break pedal harder to brake the vehicle.
the doors with the remote control, the
the fuel-operated auxiliary heater is on. START ENGINE STOP button flashes, calling at-
tention to the relevant starter system button. »
185
Operation

Upon switching the ignition on/off, the light Braking and parking Releasing the electronic parking brake
of the START ENGINE STOP button flashes. With ● Switch the ignition on.
the engine switched off, after a few seconds,
Electronic parking brake ● Press the button  ››› Fig. 180. At the same
the STOP ENGINE START button stops flashing
and goes out. time step hard on the brake pedal or, if the
engine is running, press the accelerator ped-
With the engine running, the al slightly.
START ENGINE STOP button light stays on, indi-
● The control light of the ››› Fig. 180 button
cating that the engine is running. The time
(arrow) and the red  control light of the dis-
that lapses between the moment the user
play in the dash panel go out.
starts the engine with the START ENGINE STOP
button and the lighting changes from flash-
Automatic release of the electronic parking
ing to fixed will depend on specific engine
brake on starting the engine
size characteristics. Upon switching the igni-
tion off with the START ENGINE STOP button, it The electronic parking brake is automatically
starts flashing again. Fig. 180 In the lower part of the centre con-
switched off when starting if, after the driv-
sole: electronic parking brake button. er's door is closed and the driver's seat belt
In vehicles with the Start-Stop system, the
fastened, any of the following situations take
“My Beat” function also offers additional in-
The electronic parking brake replaces the place:
formation:
handbrake. ● On vehicles with an automatic gearbox: A
● When the engine stops during the Stop
gear range is engaged or the vehicle is
phase, the light of the START ENGINE STOPbut- Activating the electronic parking brake
switched to another one and the accelerator
ton stays on, since, even though the engine The electronic parking brake can be activated pedal is lightly pressed.
is off, the Start-Stop system is active. whenever the vehicle is at a standstill, even ● In vehicles with a manual gearbox: The
● When the engine cannot be stated again when the ignition is switched off. Activate it clutch pedal is pressed fully before starting
with the Start-Stop system, ››› page 208, and whenever you leave or park the vehicle. off and the accelerator is pedal lightly press-
needs to be started manually, the
● Pull and hold the  ››› Fig. 180 button. ed.
START ENGINE STOP button flashes to indicate
this fact. ● The parking brake is activated when the ● To facilitate certain manoeuvres there are
control light of the ››› Fig. 180 button (arrow) exceptions that allow the automatic parking
and the red  control light of the display in brake to be released without the driver's seat
the dash panel are on. belt being fastened.
● Release the button. The parking brake can be prevented from be-
ing automatically released by continuously
186
Driving

pulling up the  ››› Fig. 180 switch when WARNING some time elapses without the electronic

Technical data
starting off. parking brake being used.
The improper use of the electronic parking
The electronic parking brake is not discon- brake can cause accidents and serious injury.
nected until the  button is released. This ● Never use the electronic parking brake to
can facilitate starting off when a heavy load stop the vehicle, unless it is an emergency. Parking
is towed ››› page 273. Braking distances can be considerably lon-
ger, since, under certain circumstances, only The electronic parking brake should always
Automatic activation of the electronic park- the rear wheels brake. Always use the foot be applied when the vehicle is parked.

Advice
ing brake when exiting the vehicle incorrect- brake.
Always note the following points when park-
ly ● Never accelerate from the engine when a
ing the vehicle:
In vehicles with automatic transmission, the gear range or a gear is engaged and the en-
gine is running. The vehicle could move, even – Use the brake pedal to stop the vehicle.
electronic parking brake is activated auto-
if the electronic parking brake is activated.
matically when exiting the vehicle incorrectly – Apply the electronic parking brake.
if:

Operation
– Put it in 1st gear.
CAUTION
● The selector lever is in the D/S or R posi- – Switch the engine off and remove the key
To prevent the vehicle from unintentionally
tion or in the Tiptronic selector gate. from the ignition. Turn the steering wheel
moving when parking it, first apply the elec-
● AND: the vehicle is stationary. tronic parking brake and then remove your slightly to engage the steering lock.
● AND: the driver door is open. foot from the brake pedal. – Never leave a vehicle key in the vehicle.

Emergencies
Emergency braking function Note Additional notes on parking the vehicle on
gradients:
Only use the emergency brake function if you ● In vehicles with a manual gearbox, releas-
are unable to stop the vehicle with the foot ing the clutch and accelerating at the same Turn the steering wheel so that the vehicle
brake ››› . time automatically disconnects the electronic rolls against the kerb if it started to roll.
parking brake.
● Pull and hold the  ››› Fig. 180 button in ● If the vehicle is parked facing downhill,
● If the vehicle battery is flat, it will not be
this position to forcefully stop the vehicle. At turn the front wheels so that they point to-
possible to disconnect the electronic parking

Safety
the same time, an acoustic warning can be wards the kerb.
brake. Use the jump-start ›››  page 69.
heard. ● When the electronic parking brake is ap-
● If the vehicle is parked facing uphill, turn
● To stop the braking process, release the plied or released, noises may be heard. the front wheels so that they point away from
button or press the accelerator. ● The system performs automatic and audi-
the kerb. »
ble tests sporadically in the parked vehicle if

187
Operation

● Secure the vehicle as usual by applying the first. However, you can compensate for the The effectiveness of the brakes can also be
electronic parking brake firmly and putting it slightly reduced braking effect by applying temporarily reduced if the vehicle is driven
in 1st gear. more pressure on the brake pedal. Avoid for some distance without using the brakes
overloading the brakes while running them when there is a lot of salt on the road in win-
WARNING in. ter. The layer of salt that accumulates on the
● Take measures to reduce the risk of injury discs and pads can be removed by gently ap-
when you leave your vehicle unattended. Wear plying the brakes a few times.
● Never park where the hot exhaust system The rate of wear on the brake pads depends
could ignite inflammable materials, such as a great deal on how you drive and the condi- Corrosion
dry grass, low bushes, spilt fuel etc. tions in which the vehicle is operated. This is There may be a tendency for corrosion to
● Never allow vehicle occupants to remain in a particular problem in urban traffic and form on the discs and dirt to build up on the
the vehicle when it is locked. They would be short stretches, or with very sporty driving. brake pads if the vehicle is used infrequently
unable to open the vehicle from the inside, or the brakes are not used very often.
Depending on the speed, the braking force
and could become trapped in the vehicle in
an emergency. In the event of an emergency,
and the environmental conditions (for exam- If the brakes are not used frequently, or if
locked doors will delay assistance to vehicle ple, the temperature, air humidity, etc.) rust has formed on the disks, it is advisable
occupants. noises may be produced on braking. to clean off the pads and disks by braking
● Never leave children alone in the vehicle.
firmly a few times at a moderately high speed
They could set the vehicle in motion, for ex- Wet roads or road salt ››› .
ample, by releasing the electronic parking In certain situations (for example, on driving
brake or the gearshift lever, which would through flooded areas, in severe downpours Fault in the brake system
cause the vehicle to move, but uncontrolla- or after washing the vehicle) the braking ac- If the brake pedal travel should ever increase
bly. tion could be delayed if the discs and pads suddenly, this may mean that one of the two
● Depending on weather conditions, it may are damp, or frozen in winter. In this case the brake circuits has failed. Drive immediately
become extremely hot or cold inside the vehi- brakes should be “dried” by pressing the to the nearest specialised workshop and
cle. This can be fatal. brake pedal several times. have the fault repaired. Drive there slowly
and remember that you will have to apply
At high speed and with the windscreen wip-
more pressure on the brake pedal and allow
ers activated, the brake pads will briefly
Information on the brakes for longer stopping distances.
touch the brake discs. This takes place, al-
though unnoticeable to the driver, at regular
New brake pads
intervals to improve the response time of the
For the first 400 km (250 miles), new brake brakes when they are wet.
pads have not yet reached their maximum
braking capacity, and need to be “run in”
188
Driving

Low brake fluid level and relieves the brakes. If you still have to traction control system (ASR), electronic dif-

Technical data
Malfunctions can occur in the brake system if use the brakes, it is better to brake firmly at ferential lock (EDS), electronic torque control
the brake fluid level is too low. The brake flu- intervals than to apply the brakes continu- (XDS) and tractor-trailer sway mitigation*.
id level is monitored electronically. ously. ESC also helps stabilise the vehicle by chang-
ing the torque.
Brake servo Note
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
The brake servo increases the pressure you ● If the brake servo is out of action, for exam-
apply to the brake pedal. It works only when ple when the car is being towed, you will ABS prevents the wheels from locking up un-
der braking until the vehicle has reached a

Advice
the engine is running. have to press the brake pedal considerably
harder than normal to make up for the lack of virtual standstill. You can continue to steer
WARNING servo assistance. the vehicle even when the brakes are on full.
● If you wish to equip the vehicle with acces- Keep your foot on the brake pedal and do not
● Apply the brakes heavily to clean the brake
sories such as a front spoiler or wheel covers, pump the brakes. You will feel the brake ped-
system only in a suitable traffic situation. Do al pulsate while the ABS is working.
it is important that the flow of air to the front
not put other road users in danger: there is

Operation
wheels is not obstructed, otherwise the
risk of causing an accident.
brakes can overheat. Hydraulic Brake Assist (HBA)
● Ensure the vehicle does not move while in
neutral, when the engine is stopped. Failure The brake assist system can reduce the re-
to follow this instruction could result in an quired braking distance. The braking force is
accident. Hydraulic Brake Assist (HBA) automatically boosted if you press the brake
● If the brake fluid loses its viscosity and is pedal quickly in an emergency. You must

Emergencies
subjected to heavy use, vapour bubbles can
Electronic stability control (ESC) keep pressing the brake pedal until the dan-
form in the brake system. This reduces the ef- The ESC helps to improve safety. It reduces ger has passed.
ficiency of the brakes. the tendency to skid and improves the stabil-
ity and roadholding of the vehicle. The ESC Traction control system (ASR)
CAUTION detects critical handling situations, such as In the event of wheelspin, the traction control
vehicle understeer or oversteer, or wheelspin system reduces the engine torque to match
● Never let the brakes “drag” by leaving your
on the driving wheels. It stabilises the vehi- the amount of grip available. This helps the
foot on the pedal when it is not necessary to

Safety
cle by braking individual wheels or by reduc- car to start moving, accelerate or climb a gra-
brake. This overheats the brakes, resulting in
longer stopping distances and greater wear.
ing the engine torque. The warning lamp will dient.
flash on the instrument panel when the ESC
● Before driving down a long, steep gradient,
is intervening . Electronic differential lock (EDL)
it is advisable to reduce speed and select a
lower gear. This makes use of engine braking The ESC includes the anti-lock brake system When the EDL detects wheelspin, it brakes
(ABS), the hydraulic brake assist (HBA), the the spinning wheel and directs the power to »
189
Operation

the other driven wheel. This function is active The XDS system can detect and correct this tem’s braking pressure the vehicle will brake
up to approximately 100 km/h (62 mph). effect via the sensors and signals of the ESC. automatically.
To prevent the disc brake of the braked wheel Via the ESC, the XDS will brake the inside ● Multi-collision braking will not be available
from overheating, the EDL cuts out automati- wheel and counter the excess driving torque if ESC is malfunctioning.
cally if subjected to excessive loads. The ve- of that wheel. This means that the driver's
hicle can still be driven. The EDL will switch desired trajectory is much more precise. WARNING
on again automatically when the brake has ● The ESC, ABS, ASR, EDS and the electronic
The XDS system works in combination with
cooled down. torque control system cannot exceed the lim-
the ESC and is always active, even when ASR
its imposed by the laws of physics. Always
traction control is disconnected, or the ESC in
Tractor-trailer sway mitigation* bear this in mind, especially on wet or slip-
Sport mode or disconnected. pery roads. If you notice the systems cutting
If the vehicle is pulling a trailer, it will control in, you should reduce your speed immediate-
the following: Tractor-trailers tend to sway. Multi-collision brake ly to suit the road and traffic conditions. Do
When the swaying of the trailer is felt by the not be encouraged to take risks by the pres-
In an accident, the multi-collision brake can
vehicle and detected by the ESC, it will auto- ence of more safety systems. If you do, an ac-
help the driver by braking to avoid the risk of
matically brake the towing vehicle within the cident may occur.
skidding during the accident, which could
limits of the system and mitigate the sway. ● Please remember that the accident risk al-
lead to further collisions.
Tractor-trailer sway mitigation is not available ways increases if you drive fast, especially in
in all countries. The multi-collision brake works for front, side corners or on a slippery road, or if you follow
or rear accidents, when the airbag control too close behind the vehicle in front of you.
Electronic torque management (XDS) unit records its activation level and the acci- The ESC, ABS, brake assist, EDS and the elec-
dent takes place at a speed of over 10 km/h tronic torque control system cannot prevent
When taking a curve, the driveshaft differen-
(6 mph). The ESC automatically brakes the accidents: risk of accidents!
tial mechanism allows the outer wheel to turn
vehicle, as long as the accident has not dam- ● Accelerate with caution on slippery surfa-
at a higher speed than the inner wheel. In
aged the ESC, the brake hydraulics or the on- ces (for example, icy or snow-covered). De-
this way, the wheel that is turning faster (out-
board network spite the control systems, the driven wheels
er wheel) receives less drive torque than the
could spin, affecting the stability of the vehi-
inner wheel. This may mean that in certain The following actions control automatic brak- cle: risk of accident!
situations the torque delivered to the inner ing during the accident:
wheel is too high, causing the wheels to
spin. On the other hand, the outer wheel is ● When the driver presses the accelerator, Note
receiving a lower drive torque than it could the automatic braking does not take place. ● The ABS and ASR will only operate correctly
transmit. This causes an overall loss of lateral ● When the braking pressure through press- if the four wheels have identical tyres. Any
grip on the front axle, resulting in understeer ing the brake pedal is greater than the sys- differences in the rolling radius of the tyres
or “lengthening” of the trajectory.
190
Driving

can cause the system to reduce engine power Disable ASR Electronic Stability Control

Technical data
when this is not desired. The Easy Connect system menu is used to (ESC): sport. Warning! Limited
● The regulating processes of the systems switch off the ASR ››› page 120. The traction stability
can make noises when they intervene. control system will be disabled.
Disable ESC “Sport” mode
● If the warning lamp  lights up, or  alter- The control lamp  lights up. For vehicles
natively, there could be a fault ››› page 119. with a driver information system* the driver Through the Easy Connect system menu
will be informed that ASR is disabled. ››› page 120. The warning lamp  will switch
off. For vehicles with a driver information sys-
tem* the driver will be informed that:

Advice
Switching on/off the ESC and ASR Activate ASR
The Easy Connect system menu ››› page 120 Electronic Stability Control
The ESC is switched on automatically when (ESC): On
is used to switch on the ASR. The traction
the engine is started, and only works when
control system will be enabled.
the engine is running and includes the ABS,
ESC in “Offroad”1) mode
EDS and ASR systems. The control lamp  switches off. For vehicles

Operation
with a driver information system* the driver Turn the Driving Experience button to select
The ASR function should only be switched off the Offroad mode and connect it
will be informed that ASR is enabled.
in situations in which traction is insufficient, ››› page 243. The interventions of the ESC, as
including: well as of the ASR, EDS and the ABS, adapt to
ESC in “Sport” mode
● When driving in deep snow or on surfaces irregular terrain.
Sport mode can be connected via the Easy
that are not very firm. Connect ››› page 120 system menu. In front- In the following exceptional situations it may

Emergencies
● To “free” the vehicle if it gets stuck. wheel drive vehicles, the interventions by the make sense to activate the Offroad mode to
ESC and the ASR are limited. In four-wheel allow the wheels to spin:
Then switch the ASR function back on. drive vehicles, the interventions by the ESC
● When “swinging” the vehicle to get it un-
Depending on the finishes and versions, are limited and the ASR is switched off com-
pletely ››› . stuck.
there is the possibility of disconnecting only
● Driving in deep snow or on loose surfaces.
the ASR or activating the ESC Sport mode. The control lamp  lights up. For vehicles
with a driver information system* the driver ● When driving on rough terrain with much of

Safety
will be informed that: the car's weight is lifted off the wheels (axle
articulation). »

1) Only for 4Drive models.


191
Operation

● Steep descents with braking on unpaved WARNING Changing down gears


terrain. While driving, changing down a gear must al-
You should only activate the Offroad Mode or
For your safety we recommend that you turn disable the ASR if the experience of the driver ways be done gradually, i.e. to the gear di-
off the Offroad mode when it is not absolute- and traffic conditions allow it. Danger of skid- rectly below and when the engine speed is
ly necessary. ding! not too high ››› . Changing down while by-
● With the Offroad mode activated, the stabi- passing one or various gears at high speeds
Disable the ESC Offroad mode lisation function is limited. In particular, if or at high engine speeds can damage the
the road is too smooth and slippery, the driv- clutch and the gearbox, even if the clutch
Turn the Driving Experience button to select a ing wheels could spin and the vehicle could pedal remains depressed ››› .
different driving mode ››› page 243. skid.
WARNING
ESC in “Snow” mode1)
Note When the engine is running, the vehicle will
Turn the Driving Experience button to select start to move as soon as a gear is engaged
If the ASR or the ESC is disconnected or the
the “Snow” mode and connect it. and the clutch released. This is also the case
Sport mode is selected, cruise control* will
››› page 243 Traction control system (ASR) in- be switched off.
with the electronic parking brake switched
terventions adjust to the adhesion of snowy on.
roads. ● Never engage reverse gear when the vehi-
cle is moving.
Disable the ESC “Snow” mode Manual gearbox
Turn the Driving Experience button to select a WARNING
different driving mode ››› page 243. Changing gear If the gear is changed down inappropriately
by selecting a gear that is too low, you may
WARNING Read the additional information carefully lose control of the vehicle, causing an acci-
›››  page 49 dent and serious injuries.
The ESC Sport mode should be activated only
when traffic conditions and the ability of the In some countries the clutch pedal must be
driver allow it. Danger of skidding! fully pressed down for the engine to start. CAUTION
● With ESC in Sport mode, the stabilising
When travelling at high speeds or at high en-
function will be limited to allow for a sportier Selecting reverse gear gine speeds, selecting a gear that is too low
drive. The driving wheels could spin and the ● Engage reverse gear only when the vehicle can cause considerable damage to the clutch
vehicle could skid.
is stopped. and the gearbox. This can also occur if the

1) Only for 4Drive models.


192
Driving

clutch pedal is pressed and held and it does The tiptronic system allows the driver to To move the selector lever to position R, the

Technical data
not engage. change gears manually if desired interlock button must be pressed in and at
››› page 195, Engaging gears with the trip- the same time the brake pedal must be de-
tonic mode*. pressed. The reverse lights come on when
CAUTION
the selector lever is in the R position with the
To prevent damage and avoid premature ignition on.
wear, please observe the following: Selector lever positions
● Do not rest your hand on the gear lever N – Neutral (idling)
while driving. The pressure applied by your Read the additional information carefully With the selector lever in this position, the

Advice
hand is transmitted to the gearbox selector ›››  page 49 gear is in neutral.
forks.
The selector lever position engaged is high-
● Always ensure that the vehicle is complete-
lighted on the display in the instrument clus- D/S – Permanent drive (forward) position
ly stopped before engaging the reverse gear.
ter. With the selector lever in the manual The selector lever in the D/S position enables
● Always press the clutch to the floor when
gearbox positions G, D, E and S, the engaged the gears to be controlled in normal mode (D)
changing gears.

Operation
gear is also indicated on the display. or Sport (S). To select Sport mode (S), move
● Never hold the vehicle “on the clutch” on
the selector lever backwards. Moving the lev-
hills with the engine on. P – Parking lock er again will select normal mode (D). The se-
When the selector lever is in this position, lected driving mode is shown on the instru-
the driven wheels are locked mechanically. ment panel display.
Automatic gearbox/DSG auto- The parking lock must be engaged only when In normal mode (D), the gearbox automatical-

Emergencies
the vehicle is stationary ››› .
matic gearbox* ly selects the best gear ratio. This depends
The interlock button (the button on the selec- on the engine load, the road speed and the
tor lever handle) must be pressed in and si- dynamic gear control programme (DCP).
Introduction
multaneously the brake pedal must be de- Sport mode (S) must be selected for a sporty
Your vehicle is equipped with an electronical- pressed before moving the selector lever ei- driving style. This setting makes use of the
ly controlled manual gearbox. Torque be- ther in or out of position P. engine's maximum power output. When ac-
tween the engine and the gearbox is trans- celerating the gear shifts will be noticeable.

Safety
mitted via two independent clutches. They re- R – Reverse gear
place the torque converter found on conven- Press the brake pedal to move the selector
Reverse gear must be engaged only when the lever from N to D/S when the vehicle is sta-
tional automatic gearboxes and allow for vehicle is stationary and the engine is idling
smooth, uninterrupted acceleration of the ve- tionary or at speeds below 3 km/h (2 mph)
››› . ››› . »
hicle.

193
Operation

Under certain circumstances (e.g. when driv- gaged. If you have to leave your vehicle while Selector lever lock
ing in mountains) it can be advantageous to the engine is running, you must apply the
switch temporarily to tiptronic mode handbrake and engage the parking lock (P).
››› page 195, in order to manually select gear ● To avoid accidents, apply the handbrake
ratios to suit the driving conditions. and put the selector lever in position P before
opening the bonnet and working on the vehi-
WARNING cle with the engine running. Please always
● Take care not to accidentally press the ac- observe the important safety warnings
celerator pedal when the vehicle is stopped. ››› page 298, Working in the engine compart-
The vehicle could otherwise start moving im- ment.
mediately (in some cases even if the parking
brake is engaged) resulting in the risk of an Note
accident.
● If the selector lever is moved accidentally Fig. 181 Selector lever lock.
● Never move the selector lever to R or P
to N when driving, release the accelerator and
when driving. Failure to follow this instruc- let the engine speed drop to idling before se- The selector lever lock prevents gears from
tion could result in an accident. lecting gear range D or S again. being engaged inadvertently, so that the ve-
● With selector lever in any position (except
● Should the power supply to the selector hicle is not set in motion unintentionally.
P) the vehicle must always be held with the lever be interrupted in position P, the selector
foot brake when the engine is running. This is The selector lever lock is released as follows:
lever will be locked. If this should happen the
because an automatic gearbox still transmits manual release can be used ›››  page 49. – Switch the ignition on.
power even at idling speed, and the vehicle
tends to “creep”. The accelerator pedal must – Press the brake pedal and, at the same
on no account be pressed inadvertently when time, hold the lock button in the direction
a gear is engaged with the vehicle stationary. of the arrow ››› Fig. 181.
The vehicle could otherwise start moving im-
mediately (in some cases even if the parking Automatic selector lever lock
brake is engaged) resulting in the risk of an With the ignition switched on, the selector
accident. lever is locked in the positions P and N. The
● While you are selecting a gear and the vehi- brake pedal must be pressed to release the
cle is stopped with the engine running, do lever while pressing the release button if the
not accelerate. Failure to follow this instruc- selector lever is in the position P. As a re-
tion could result in an accident. minder for the driver, with the lever in posi-
● As a driver you should never leave your ve- tions P or N the following message will be
hicle if the engine is running and a gear is en- shown on the display:
194
Driving

When stationary, apply footbrake Note Engaging gears with the triptonic

Technical data
while selecting a gear. mode*
● If the selector lever lock does not engage,
Level lock only engages with the vehicle sta- there is a fault. The transmission is interrup-
tionary and at speeds of up to 5 km/h ted to prevent the vehicle from accidentally
(3 mph). At speeds of over 5 km/h (3 mph) moving. Follow the procedure below in order
the lever lock is automatically deactivated in for the selector lever lock to engage again:
position N. – With a 6-speed gearbox: press the brake
pedal and release it again.
The selector lever lock is not engaged if the

Advice
selector lever is moved quickly through posi- – With a 7-speed gearbox: press the brake
tion N (e.g. when shifting from R to D). This pedal. Move the selector lever to posi-
makes it possible, for instance, to rock the tion P or N and subsequently engage a
gear.
vehicle “backwards and forwards” if it is
stuck. The selector lever lock engages auto- ● Despite a gear being engaged, the vehicle
does not move forwards or back. Proceed to Fig. 182 Centre console: changing gear with
matically if the brake pedal is not depressed

Operation
the next mode: tiptronic
and the lever is in position N for more than
about two seconds. – When the vehicle does not move in the
required direction, the system may not
Interlock button have the gear range correctly engaged.
Press the brake pedal and engage the
The interlock button on the selector lever gear range again.

Emergencies
handle prevents the driver from inadvertently – If the vehicle still does not move in the
engaging certain gears. Press the button in required direction, there is a system mal-
to disengage the selector lever lock. function. Seek specialist assistance and
have the system checked.
Safety interlock for ignition key
Depending on the country, once the ignition
has been turned off, the key may be removed Fig. 183 Steering wheel: automatic gearbox
only if the gear selector is in position P. While levers

Safety
the key is not in the ignition, the selector lev-
er is locked in position P. The tiptronic gives the driver the option to
change gears manually. »

195
Operation

Changing gear manually with the selector When accelerating, the gearbox automatical- Stopping briefly
lever ly shifts up into the next gear shortly before – Apply the foot brake to hold the vehicle
It is possible to change to tiptronic mode, the maximum engine speed is reached. briefly when stationary (for instance at traf-
both when the vehicle is stopped and while If you select a lower gear, the automatic gear- fic lights). Do not press the accelerator.
driving. box will not shift down until there is no risk of
– To switch to tiptronic mode, move the se- over-revving the engine. Stopping/Parking
lector lever from position D/S to the right. When the kick-down feature is used, the If the driver door is opened and the selector
As soon as the change is made the selector gearbox shifts down to a lower gear, depend- lever is not in position P, the vehicle could
level will be shown in the position M on the ing on road speed and engine speed. move. The driver message will be:  Gear
instrument panel display (for example M4 change: selector lever in the
means that the fourth gear is engaged). drive position!. Additionally, a buzzer
Driving tips will sound.
– Move the selector lever forwards + to se-
lect a higher gear ››› Fig. 182. – Press and hold the brake pedal ››› .
The gearbox changes gear ratios automatical-
– Move the selector lever backwards – to ly as the vehicle moves. – Apply the handbrake.
select a lower gear. – Move the selector lever to position P.
The engine can only start with the selector
Changing gear manually with the gearshift lever in position P or N. At low temperatures,
below -10°C (50°F), the engine can only start Holding the car on a hill
paddles*
with the selector lever in position P. – Always apply the brake pedal firmly to pre-
The gearshift paddles can be used when the
vent the vehicle from “moving backwards;
selector lever is in the position D/S or M. Starting the vehicle if necessary, apply the handbrake” ››› .
– Press the gearshift paddle + to select a – Press and hold the brake pedal. Do not try to stop the vehicle “rolling back”
higher gear ››› Fig. 183. by increasing the engine speed when a
– Press and hold the interlock button (the gear is engaged (pressing the accelerator)
– Press the gearshift paddle – to select a button on the selector lever handle), move ››› .
lower gear. the selector lever to the desired position,
– With the selector lever in position D/S, if no for instance D ››› page 193, and release the Starting off uphill
paddle is operated during a short period of interlock button.
– Apply the handbrake.
time, the gearbox control system switches – Wait for the gearbox to engage the gear (a
back to automatic mode. To switch to per- – Once you have engaged a gear press the
slight movement can be felt).
manent manual gear change using the accelerator carefully and disengage the
gearshift paddles, move the selector lever – Release the brake and press the accelerator handbrake.
from position D/S to the right. ››› .
196
Driving

Driving down hills: in some situations (on age the automatic gearbox. Apply the hand- cause the driving wheels to spin, which could

Technical data
mountain roads or when towing a trailer or brake firmly or press the brake pedal in order result in skidding.
caravan) it can be advantageous to switch to prevent the vehicle from rolling back.
temporarily to the manual gearbox pro- ● If you allow the car to roll with the selector
gramme so that the gear ratios can be selec- lever in position N with the engine switched
ted manually to suit the driving conditions
Launch control program
off, the automatic gearbox will be damaged
››› . as it will not be lubricated. 3 Valid for vehicles: with Launch-Control/6-Speed
DSG with diesel engines superior to 125 kW and pet-
On level ground it is sufficient to move the ● In certain driving situations or traffic condi- rol engines superior to 140 kW.
tions, such as frequently starting, prolonged

Advice
selector lever to position P. On slopes, first
engage the parking brake and then put the “creeping” of the vehicle or traffic jams with The Launch control programme enables maxi-
selection lever into the P position. This continuous stoppages, the gearbox could mum acceleration.
overheat causing damage! If the warning
avoids overloading the locking mechanism Important: the engine must have reached op-
lamp  lights up, stop the vehicle as soon as
and it will be easier to move the selector lev- erating temperature and the steering wheel
possible and wait for the gearbox to cool
er from position P. ››› page 200. must not be turned.

Operation
WARNING The engine speed for launch-control is differ-
ent on petrol and diesel engines. To use the
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Selector
Kick-down feature launch-control you must disconnect the anti-
lever positions on page 194.
slip regulation (ASR) through the Easy Con-
● Never allow the brake to rub and do not use The kick-down feature allows maximum ac- nect system menu ››› page 120. The warning
the brake pedal too often or for long periods. celeration to be reached. lamp  will stay switched on or will flash

Emergencies
Constant braking causes overheating in the
When the accelerator pedal is pressed right slowly depending on whether or not the vehi-
brakes. This could significantly reduce brak-
down past the point of resistance at full throt- cle has a driver information system*.
ing power, increase braking distance or even
result in the total failure of the brake system. tle, the gearbox will shift down to a lower On vehicles with the driver information sys-
● To avoid rolling back on gradients always gear, depending on road speed and engine tem, the ESC lamp lights up permanently and
hold the vehicle with the footbrake or hand- speed. The upshift to the next higher gear is the corresponding text message Stability
brake if you have to stop. delayed until the engine reaches maximum control deactivated (temporary) ap-
rpm. pears on the instrument panel to indicate the

Safety
CAUTION deactivation status. »
WARNING
● If you stop the vehicle on a gradient, do not
Please note that if the road surface is slip-
attempt to stop it from rolling by depressing
pery or wet, the kick-down feature could
the accelerator when a gear has been selec-
ted. This could cause overheating and dam-
197
Operation

– When the engine is running, switch off the causing the vehicle to lose grip. Risk of acci- ble for the slope. The downhill speed control
traction control (ASR)1). dent! function attempts to maintain the speed at
● After putting the vehicle into gear, the
which the vehicle was travelling when the
– Turn the selector lever to the position “S”
“sport” mode of the ESC should be deactiva- foot brake was applied (subject to the laws of
or tiptronic, or else select the sport driv-
ted again by briefly pressing the OFF but- physics and technical drive limitations). It
ing mode from the SEAT Drive Profile*
ton. may be necessary to adjust the speed again
››› page 242.
using the foot brake in certain situations. Giv-
– Press the brake pedal firmly with your left en that the downhill speed control can only
foot and hold it down for at least one sec- Note
change down to 3rd gear, on very steep de-
ond. ● After using the Launch control programme, scents the tiptronic mode may be required. In
the temperature in the gearbox may have in- this case, manually reduce the tiptronic to
– With your right foot, press the accelerator
creased considerably. In this case, the pro- 2nd or 1st gear to use the engine brake and
down to the full throttle or kick-down posi- gramme could be disabled for several mi- reduce the charge on the brakes.
tion. The engine speed will stabilise at nutes. The programme can be used again af-
about 3,200 rpm (petrol engine) or about ter the cooling phase. Downhill speed control is deactivated as
2,000 rpm (diesel engine). ● Accelerating with the Launch control pro- soon as the road levels out again or you
– Take your left foot off the brake pedal. gramme places a heavy load on all parts of press the accelerator pedal.
the vehicle. This can result in increased wear On vehicles with cruise control system*
WARNING and tear. ››› page 212, downhill speed control is acti-
● Always adapt your driving style to the traf- vated when you set a cruising speed.
fic conditions.
● Only use the launch control programme
Downhill speed control* WARNING
when road and traffic conditions permit, and The downhill speed control cannot defy the
make sure your manner of driving and accel-
The downhill speed control function helps laws of physics. Therefore, speed cannot be
erating the vehicle does not inconvenience or the driver when driving down steep gradi- maintained constant in all situations. Always
endanger other road users. ents. be prepared to use the brakes!
● Make sure that the ESC remains switched Downhill speed control is activated when the
on. Please note that when the ASR and ESC selector lever is in D/S and the driver applies
are deactivated, the wheels may start to spin, the foot brake. The automatic gearbox auto-
matically engages a lower gear that is suita-

1) Vehicles without driver information system: the

warning lamp flashes slowly/Vehicles with driver in-


formation system: the warning lamp stays on.
198
Driving

Inertia mode the need for fuel) facilitates improved fuel If all the positions of the selector lever are

Technical data
consumption and emission balance. shown over a light background on the instru-
The inertia mode enables the kinetic energy ment panel display, there is a system fault
of the vehicle to be harnessed enabling cer- WARNING and the automatic gearbox will operate in
tain stretches to be driven without using the ● If the inertia mode has been switched on, with the backup programme. When the back-
accelerator. This enables fuel to be saved. take into account, when approaching an ob- up programme is activated, it is possible to
Use the inertia mode to “let the vehicle roll” stacle and releasing the accelerator pedal, drive the vehicle, however, at low speeds and
before, for example, arriving in a town. that the vehicle will not decelerate in the usu- within a selected range of gears. In some ca-
al manner: risk of accident! ses driving in reverse gear may not be possi-

Advice
Switching on inertia mode ● When using inertia mode while travelling ble.
Important: selector lever must be in position down hills, the vehicle can increase speed:
risk of accident! CAUTION
D, gradients below 12 %.
● If other users drive your vehicle, warn them If the gearbox operates with the backup pro-
– Select, in SEAT Drive Profile*, Eco mode
about inertia mode. gramme, take the vehicle to a specialised
››› page 242. workshop and have the fault repaired without

Operation
– Take your foot off the accelerator. delay.
Note
The driver message Inertia will be dis- ● Inertia mode is only available in eco (SEAT
played. At speeds higher than 20 km/h (12 Drive Profile*) driving mode.
mph), the gearbox will automatically disen- Clutch
● The driver message Inertia is only dis-
gage and the vehicle will roll freely, without played with the current consumption. In iner-

Emergencies
 Clutch overheating! Please
the effect of the engine brake. While the vehi- tia mode the gear will no longer be displayed stop!
cle rolls, the engine runs at idling speed. (for example “E” will appear instead of “E7”).
● On downhill sections with gradients above The clutch has overheated and could be dam-
Stopping inertia mode 15 %, the inertia mode will automatically be aged. Stop the vehicle and wait for the gear-
– Press the brake or the accelerator pedal. switched off temporarily. box to cool with the engine at idling speed
and the selector lever in position P. When the
To make use of the braking force and switch warning lamp and the driver message switch
off the engine again, simply press the brake off, have the fault corrected by a specialised

Safety
pedal briefly. Emergency program workshop without delay. If the warning lamp
and the driver message do not switch off, do
Applying both the inertia mode (= prolonged A backup programme is in place if a fault
not continue driving. Seek specialist assis-
section with less energy) and the switching should occur in the control system.
tance.
off using inertia (= shorter section without

199
Operation

Gearbox malfunctions  Gearbox: press the brake and  (in yellow) Steering: System
engage a gear again. fault! You may continue driving.
 Gearbox: Fault! Stop the ve-
If the fault was caused by a gearbox with a If the warning lamp comes on, the steering
hicle and place the lever in the
high temperature, this driver message will be could react with more difficultly or more sen-
position P.
displayed when the gearbox has cooled sitivity than normal. In addition, when driving
There is a fault in the gearbox. Stop the vehi- again. in a straight line the steering wheel may be
cle in a safe place and do not continue driv- off-centre.
ing. Seek specialist assistance.
Drive slowly to a specialised workshop and
 Gearbox: System fault! You Address have the fault repaired.
may continue driving.
 (in yellow) Steering lock:
Have the fault corrected by a specialised Electromechanical steering fault! Go to an Official Service
workshop without delay.
Electro-mechanical power steering assists The electronic steering lock is malfunction-
 Gearbox: System fault! You the driver when steering. ing.
can continue driving with re-
Electro-mechanical power steering adapts Go to a specialised workshop as soon as
strictions. Reverse gear disa‐
electronically to the speed of the car, torque possible and have the fault repaired.
bled
and turning angle.
Take the vehicle to a specialised workshop WARNING
and have the fault repaired without delay. If the power steering should fail at any time
Take it immediately to a specialised work-
or the engine is switched off (for instance
 Gearbox: System fault! You shop and have the fault repaired: risk of acci-
when being towed), the car can still be dent!
can continue driving in D until steered. However, more effort than normal
switching off the engine will be required to turn the steering wheel.
Stop the vehicle in a safe place well away Note
from moving traffic. Seek specialist assis- Driver warning lamps and messages If the lamp  (in red) or else  (in yellow)
tance.  (in red) Faulty steering! To lights up briefly, you may continue driving.

 Gearbox: too hot. Adapt your park the vehicle


driving accordingly If the warning lamp remains on and the driver
Continue driving at moderate speeds. When indication appears, the power steering could
the warning lamp switches off, you can con- be faulty.
tinue driving in a normal manner. Do not continue driving. Seek specialist as-
sistance.
200
Driving

Run-in and economical driving Environmental compatibility Manufacturing methods

Technical data
● Reduction of the quantity of thinner in the
Environmental protection is a top priority in
Running in the engine protective wax for cavities.
the design, choice of materials and manufac-
● Use of plastic film as protection during ve-
A new vehicle should be run in over a dis- ture of your new SEAT.
hicle transport.
tance of 1500 km (1000 miles). For the first
Constructive measures to encourage recy- ● Use of solvent-free adhesives.
1,000 km the engine speed should not ex-
ceed 2/3 of the maximum permissible engine cling ● Use of CFC-free coolants in cooling sys-
speed. In doing so, do not accelerate at full ● Joints and connections designed for easy tems.

Advice
throttle and do not drive with a trailer! From dismantling. ● Recycling and energy recovery from resi-
1000 to 1500 km (600 to 1000 miles) you ● Modular construction to facilitate disman- dues (RDF).
can gradually increase the engine rpm and tling. ● Improvement in the quality of waste water.
road speed.
● Increased use of single-grade materials. ● Use of systems for the recovery of residual
During its first few hours of running, the in- ● Plastic parts and elastomers are marked in heat (thermal recovery, enthalpy wheels,

Operation
ternal friction in the engine is greater than etc.).
accordance with ISO 1043, ISO 11469 and
later on when all the moving parts have bed-
ISO 1629. ● The use of water-soluble paints.
ded down.
How the vehicle is driven for the first 1,500 Choice of materials
km influences the future engine perform- ● Use of recycled materials. Economical and environmentally-
ance. Subsequently, also drive at a moderate

Emergencies
● Use of compatible plastics in the same part friendly driving
rate, especially when the engine is still cold:
this will lead to less engine wear and tear if its components are not easily separated.
Fuel consumption, environmental pollution
and will prolong its useful life. ● Use of recycled materials and/or materials
and wear to the engine, brakes and tyres de-
originating from renewable sources. pends largely on driving style. Fuel consump-
You should also avoid driving with the engine
speed too low. Change down to a lower gear ● Reduction of volatile components, includ- tion can be reduced by 10-15% with an eco-
when the engine no longer runs “smoothly”. ing odour, in plastic materials. nomical driving style and proper anticipation
If the engine revs too much, cut fuel injection ● Use of CFC-free coolants. of traffic conditions. The following section

Safety
to protect the engine. gives you some tips on lessening the impact
Ban on heavy metals, with the exceptions on the environment and reducing your oper-
dictated by law (Annex II of ELV Directive ating costs at the same time. »
2000/53/EC): cadmium, lead, mercury, hexa-
valent chromium.

201
Operation

Active cylinder management (ACT®)* gear enables fuel savings. Select the highest the engine. Avoid running the engine at high
Depending on vehicle equipment, the active possible gear appropriate for the driving sit- speed.
cylinder management (ACT®) may automati- uation (the engine should continue function-
cally deactivate some of the engine cylinders ing with cyclical regularity). Regular maintenance
if the driving situation does not require too Automatic gearbox: accelerate gradually and Regular servicing helps in saving fuel even
much power. When it is switched off, no fuel without reaching the “kick-down” position. before the engine is started. A well-serviced
is injected into these cylinders, hence total engine gives you the benefit of improved fuel
fuel consumption may be reduced. The num- Avoid driving at high speed efficiency as well as maximum reliability and
ber of active cylinders can be seen on the in- an enhanced resale value. A badly serviced
Avoid travelling at top speed, whenever pos-
strument panel display ›››  page 37. engine can consume up to 10% more fuel
sible. Fuel consumption, emission of harmful
than necessary.
gases and noise pollution multiply dispropor-
Foresight when driving
tionately as speed is increased. Driving at
Acceleration causes the vehicle to consume Avoid short journeys
moderate speeds will help to save fuel.
more fuel. If you think ahead when driving, The engine and catalytic converter need to
you will need to brake less and thus acceler- Reduce idling time reach their optimal operating temperature in
ate less. Wherever possible, let the car roll order to minimise fuel consumption and
In vehicles with the Start-Stop system idling
slowly to a stop, with a gear engaged (for in- emissions.
is automatically reduced. In vehicles without
stance when you can see that the next traffic
the Start-Stop system it is worth switching off A cold engine consumes a disproportionate
lights are red). This takes advantage of the
the engine, for example, at level crossings amount of fuel. The engine reaches its work-
engine braking effect, reducing wear on the
and at traffic lights that remain red for long ing temperature after about four kilometres
brakes and tyres. Emissions and fuel con-
periods of time. When an engine has reached (2.5 miles), when fuel consumption will re-
sumption will drop to zero due to the overrun
operating temperature, and depending on turn to a normal level.
fuel cut-off.
the cylinder capacity, keeping it switched off
for a minimum of about 5 seconds already Check tyre pressure
Changing gear to save energy
saves more than the amount of fuel necessa-
Always make sure the tyres are inflated to the
An effective way of saving is to change in ad- ry for restarting.
correct pressures ››› page 308 to save fuel. If
vance to a higher gear. Running the engine at
The engine takes a long time to warm up the pressure is below half bar, fuel consump-
high rpm in the lower gears uses an unneces-
when it is idling. Mechanical wear and pollu- tion may increase by 5%. Due to the greater
sary amount of fuel.
tant emissions are also especially high dur- rolling resistance, under-inflation also increa-
Manual gearbox: shift up from first to second ing this initial warm-up phase. It is therefore ses tyre wear and impairs handling.
gear as soon as possible. In any case, we rec- best to drive off immediately after starting
Do not use winter tyres all year round as they
ommend that you change to a higher gear
increase fuel consumption by up to 10%.
upon reaching 2,000 rpm. Choosing the right
202
Driving

Avoid carrying unnecessary loads If a vehicle with a conventional electrical sys- switched off. The system takes the battery di-

Technical data
Given that every kilo of extra weight will in- tem is left parked for a long time, the battery agnosis data into consideration.
crease the fuel consumption, it is advisable will gradually lose its charge because certain
Depending on the power level of the battery,
to always check the luggage compartment to electrical devices, such as the electronic
switch off the individual electrical devices
make sure that no unnecessary loads are be- gearbox lock continues to draw current even
one after the other to prevent the battery
ing transported. when the ignition is off. In some cases there
from losing too much charge and to ensure
may not be enough power available to start
Since the luggage rack increases the aerody- that the engine can be started reliably.
the engine.
namic drag of the vehicle, you should remove

Advice
it when not needed. At speeds of 100-120 Your vehicle is equipped with an intelligent Dynamic power management
km/h (62-75 mph), this will save 12% of fuel. power management system to control the
While the vehicle is moving, this function dis-
distribution of electrical energy. This signifi-
tributes the available power to the various
Save electrical energy cantly improves reliability when starting the
electrical devices and systems according to
engine, and also prolongs the useful life of
The engine drives the alternator, thereby gen- their requirements. The power management
the battery.
erating electricity. This implies that any in- ensures that on-board systems do not con-

Operation
crease in power consumption also increases The main functions incorporated in the power sume more electrical power than the alterna-
fuel consumption! For this reason, switch off management system are battery diagnosis, tor can supply, and thus maintains the maxi-
any unneeded electrical devices. Devices that residual current management and dynamic mum possible battery power level.
use a lot of electricity includes the blower at power management.
a high setting, the rear window heating or Note
the seat heating*. Battery diagnosis ● Neither is the power management system

Emergencies
The battery diagnosis function constantly able to overcome the given physical limits.
registers the condition of the battery. Sen- Please remember that the power and useful
sors detect the battery voltage, battery cur- life of the battery are limited.
Power management rent and battery temperature. This enables ● When there is a risk that the vehicle will
the system to calculate the current power lev- not start, the alternator power failure or low
This system helps to ensure reliable el and charge condition of the battery. battery charge level warning lamp will be
starting shown  ››› page 119.

Safety
Residual current management
The power management controls the distribu-
tion of electrical energy and thus helps to en- The residual current management reduces
power consumption while the vehicle is Flat battery
sure that there is always enough power avail-
parked. It controls the supply of power to the
able to start the engine.
various electrical devices while the ignition is
Starting ability has first priority. »
203
Operation

Short trips, city traffic and low temperatures appear in vehicles with a driver information ment and charge the battery at the same
all place a heavy load on the battery. In these system*. time.
conditions a large amount of power is con-
This driver indicator tells you that you must
sumed, but only a small amount is supplied.
start the engine so that the battery can re-
The situation is also critical if electrical devi-
ces are in use when the engine is not run-
charge. Engine management and ex-
ning. In this case power is consumed when
When the engine is running
haust gas purification system
none is being generated.
Although the alternator generates electrical Introduction
In these situations you will be aware that the
power, the battery can still become dis-
power management system is intervening to
charged while the vehicle is being driven.
control the distribution of electrical power. WARNING
This can occur when a lot of power is being
consumed but only a small amount supplied, ● Because of the high temperatures which
When the vehicle is parked for long periods especially if the battery is not fully charged can occur in the exhaust purification system
If you do not drive your vehicle for a period of initially. (catalytic converter or diesel particulate fil-
several days or weeks, the power manage- ter), do not park the vehicle where the ex-
To restore the necessary energy balance, the haust can come into contact with flammable
ment will gradually shut off the electrical de-
system will then temporarily shut off the elec- materials under the car (e.g. on grass or at
vices one by one or reduce the amount of cur-
trical devices that are using a lot of power, or the forest edge). Fire hazard!
rent they are using. This limits the amount of
reduce the current they are consuming. Heat- ● Do not apply wax underneath the vehicle
power consumed and helps to ensure relia-
ing systems in particular use a large amount around the area of the exhaust system: Fire
ble starting even after a long period. Some
of electrical power. If you notice, for instance, hazard!
convenience functions, such as remote vehi-
that the seat heating* or the rear window
cle opening, may not be available under cer-
heater is not working, they may have been
tain circumstances. These functions will be Note
temporarily switched off or regulated to a
restored when you switch on the ignition and While the control lamps , ,  or  re-
lower heat output. These systems will be
start the engine. main lit, there may be engine problems, fuel
available again as soon as sufficient electri-
cal power is available. consumption may increase and the engine
With the engine switched off may lose power.
You may also notice that the engine runs at a
For example, if you listen to the sound sys-
slightly faster idling speed when necessary.
tem with the engine switched off the battery
This is quite normal, and no cause for con-
will run down.
cern. The increased idling speed allows the
If the energy consumption means there is a alternator to meet the greater power require-
risk that the engine will not start, a text will
204
Driving

Catalytic converter (automatic gearbox: gear S). Maintain the en- The control lamp  lights up:

Technical data
3 Applies to vehicles with petrol engine
gine speed at approximately 2,000 rpm. The If a fault has developed during driving which
rise in temperature causes the soot on the fil- has reduced the quality of the exhaust gas
The vehicle must only be used with unleaded ter to burn. On completion of the cleaning (e.g. lambda probe fault). Reduce speed and
petrol, otherwise the catalytic converter will the warning lamp will switch off. If the warn- drive carefully to the nearest specialised
be irreparably damaged. ing lamp does not switch off, go immediately workshop to have the engine checked.
to a specialised workshop to rectify the prob-
Never drive until the tank is empty; an irregu-
lem.
lar supply of fuel can cause faulty combus-

Advice
tion. In these cases, unburned fuel reaches Engine pre-heating/fault system* 
the exhaust system, which can overheat and
damage the catalytic converter. Engine management*  The warning lamp lights up to show that the
glow plugs are preheating the diesel engine.
This warning lamp monitors the engine man-
agement system for petrol engines. The control lamp  lights up
Diesel particulate filter

Operation
The warning lamp  (Electronic Power Con- If the control lamp  lights up when the en-
3 Applies to vehicles with diesel engine
trol) lights up when the ignition is switched gine is started it means that the glow plugs
The diesel engine particulate filter eliminates on while system operation is being verified. It are preheating. The engine can be started
most of the soot from the exhaust gas sys- should go out once the engine is started. straight away when the lamp switches off.
tem. Under normal driving conditions, the fil- If there is a fault in the electronic engine
ter cleans itself. The diesel particulate filter is management system while you are driving, Control lamp  flashes

Emergencies
cleaned automatically without need for indi- this warning lamp will light up. Take the vehi- If a fault develops in the engine management
cation by the warning lamp . This may be cle to a specialised workshop as soon as system while you are driving, the glow plug
noticed because the engine idle speed in- possible and have the engine checked. system lamp will flash . Take the vehicle to
creases and an odour may be detected.
a specialised workshop as soon as possible
If automatic filter purification cannot be car- and have the engine checked.
ried out (because only short trips are taken, Emission control system* 
for example), soot will accumulate on the fil-

Safety
ter and the Diesel particulate filter warning Control lamp  flashes:
lamp will  switch on. When there is misfiring that can damage the
Facilitate the automatic filter cleaning proc- catalytic converter. Reduce speed and drive
ess by driving in the following manner: drive carefully to the nearest specialised workshop
for approximately 15 minutes at a minimum to have the engine checked.
speed of 60 km/h (37 mph) in 4th or 5th gear
205
Operation

Driving tips ● Do not stop in the water, drive in reverse, or Winter tyres
stop the engine in any situation. Thanks to four-wheel drive, your vehicle will
Driving on flooded roads ● Note that vehicles travelling in the opposite have plenty of traction in winter conditions,
direction may splash water that could exceed even with the standard tyres. Nevertheless,
To prevent damage to the vehicle when driv- the maximum permitted water height for your we still recommend that winter tyres or all-
ing through water, for example, along a floo- vehicle. season tyres be fitted on all four wheels to
ded road, please observe the following: ● Avoid driving through salt water (corro- give even better braking response.
sion).
● The water should never come above the
Snow chains
lower edge of the bodywork.
On roads where snow chains are mandatory,
● Drive at pedestrian speed.
Four-wheel drive this also applies to cars with four-wheel drive
3 Valid for vehicles: with four-wheel drive ›››  page 67.
WARNING
After driving through water, mud, sludge, On four-wheel drive models, the engine pow- Changing tyres
etc., the braking effect can be delayed slight- er is distributed to all four wheels
ly due to moisture build-up on the discs and On vehicles with four-wheel drive, all four
brake pads. Applying the brakes carefully tyres must have the same rolling circumfer-
General notes
several times will remove the moisture and ence. Also avoid using tyres with varying
restore the full braking effect. On four-wheel drive vehicles, the engine tread depths ››› page 309.
power is distributed to all four wheels. The
distribution of power is controlled automati- Off-roader?
CAUTION
cally according to your driving style and the
Your SEAT is not an off-road vehicle: it does
● Driving through flooded areas may severely road conditions. Also see ››› page 189.
damage vehicle components such as the en- not have enough ground clearance to be
gine, transmission, running gear or electrical The four-wheel drive is specially designed to used as such. It is therefore best to avoid
system. complement the superior engine power. This rough tracks and uneven terrain as much as
● Whenever driving through water, the Start-
combination gives the vehicle exceptional possible.
Stop system* must be switched off
handling and performance capabilities, both
››› page 208. on normal roads and in more difficult condi- WARNING
tions, such as snow and ice. Even so (or per- ● Even with four-wheel drive, you should al-
haps especially for this reason), it is impor- ways adjust your speed to suit the condi-
Note tant to observe certain safety points ››› . tions. Do not let the extra safety features
● Check the depth of the water before enter- tempt you into taking any risks when driving.
ing the flooded zone. Risk of accident!

206
Driving

● The braking capability of your vehicle is

Technical data
limited by the tyres' grip. It is therefore no
different from a car without four-wheel drive.
So do not be tempted to drive too fast on firm
or slippery roads just because the vehicle
still has good acceleration in these condi-
tions. Risk of accident!
● On wet roads bear in mind that the front
wheels may start to “aquaplane” and lose

Advice
contact with the road if the car is driven too
fast. If this should happen, there will be no
sudden increase in engine speed to warn the
driver, as occurs with a front-wheel drive car.
For this reason you should always choose a
driving speed suitable for the road condi-

Operation
tions. Risk of accident!

Emergencies
Safety
207
Operation

Driver assistance systems ● The bonnet must be closed. Stopping/Starting the engine
● The engine must have reached a minimum
service temperature. Vehicles with a manual gearbox
Start-Stop System* – Before stopping the vehicle or when it is
● The reverse gear must not be engaged.
stopped, put it into neutral and release the
Description and operation ● The vehicle must not be on a very steep
clutch pedal. The engine will switch off. The
slope.
warning lamp  will appear on the instru-
The Start-Stop system helps save fuel and re-
ment panel display. The engine may stop
duce CO2 emissions. WARNING
before the vehicle comes to a halt in the
In Start-Stop mode, the engine will automati- ● Never switch the engine off until the vehi- deceleration phase (at 7 km/h).
cally switch off when the vehicle stops or is cle is stationary. The brake servo and power
steering functions will not be completely cov- – When the clutch pedal is pressed the en-
stopping; for example when stopping at traf-
ered under warranty. More force may also be gine will start up again. The warning lamp
fic lights. The ignition remains switched on
needed to turn the steering wheel or to brake. will switch off.
during the stopping phase. The engine auto-
As you cannot steer and brake in the normal
matically switches back on when required. In
manner, there is a greater risk of accidents Vehicles with an automatic gearbox
this situation, the light of the and serious injury.
START ENGINE STOP button stays on1). – Use the foot brake to bring the vehicle to a
● Never remove the key from the ignition if
stop and keep the brake pedal pressed
As soon as the ignition is switched on, the the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the steer- down with your foot. The engine will switch
Start-Stop function is automatically activa- ing could lock making it impossible to steer
off. The warning lamp  will appear in the
ted. the vehicle.
display. The engine may stop before the ve-
● To avoid injury, make sure that the Start- hicle comes to a halt in the deceleration
Further information about the Start-Stop sys-
Stop system is switched off when working in phase (at 7 km/h or 2 km/h, depending on
tem can be found in the Easy Connect sys-
the engine compartment ››› page 210.
tem: by pressing the  button in the Vehi- the vehicle’s gearbox).
cle status menu. – When you take your foot off the brake pedal
CAUTION
the engine will start up again. The warning
Basic requirements for the Start-Stop mode The Start-Stop system must always be lamp will switch off. In vehicles with the Au-
● The driver door must be closed. switched off when driving through flooded to Hold* system, when the system is active,
areas ››› page 210. the engine will not start if you remove your
● The driver must have their seat belt fas-
tened. foot from the brake pedal. The car starts
when you press the accelerator pedal.

1) Only in vehicles with Keyless Access.


208
Driver assistance systems

Additional information related to the auto- soon as strong pressure is applied to the ● The battery is very low.

Technical data
matic gearbox brake pedal, the engine will stop. ● The steering wheel is overly turned or is be-
The engine stops when the selector lever is in ● In vehicles with manual gearbox, during ing turned.
the positions P, D, N and S, in addition to the stopping phases the brake pedal must re- ● If there is a danger of misting.
when in manual mode. With the selector lev- main depressed to prevent the vehicle from
● After engaging reverse gear.
er in position P, the engine will also remain moving.
switched off when you take your foot off the ● If the engine “stalls” in vehicles with man- ● In case of a very steep gradient.
brake pedal. In order to start the engine up ual gearbox, it can be directly started up
again by immediately pressing the clutch
The indication  is shown on the instrument
again the accelerator must be pressed, or an-

Advice
pedal. panel display, and in addition, the driver in-
other gear engaged or the brake released.
formation system* shows, .
If the selector lever is placed in position R
during the stopping phase, the engine will The engine starts by itself
start up again. General notes
During a stopping phase the normal Start-
Change from position D to P to prevent the Stop mode can be interrupted in the follow-

Operation
The system can interrupt the Start-Stop mode
engine from accidentally starting when frequently for different reasons. ing situations: The engine restarts by itself
changing and passing by position R. without involvement from the driver.
The engine does not switch off
● The interior temperature differs from the
Additional information about vehicles with
Before the stopping phase, the system veri- value selected on the air conditioner.
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
fies whether certain conditions are met. The

Emergencies
● Defrost function button activated
In vehicles with ACC function, the engine will engine does not switch off, in the following
start up again in certain operating conditions ›››  page 51.
situations for example:
if the radar sensor detects that the vehicle ● The brake has been pressed several times
ahead drives off again. ● The engine has not yet reached the mini- consecutively.
mum required temperature for the Start-Stop ● The battery is too low.
Note mode.
● High power consumption.
● In vehicles with an automatic gearbox, you ● The interior temperature selected for the air
conditioner has not yet been reached.

Safety
can control whether the engine should switch Note
off or not by reducing or increasing the brake ● The interior temperature is very high/low.
force applied. While the vehicle remains stop- In vehicles with an automatic gearbox, if the
ped, the engine will not stop if the brake ped- ● Defrost function button activated selector lever is placed in position D, N or S
al is slightly pressed, in traffic jams with fre- ›››  page 51. after engaging reverse gear, the vehicle must
quent stopping and starting for example. As ● The parking aid* is switched on.
be driven at a speed faster than 10 km/h (6 »
209
Operation

mph) for the system to return to conditions in Driver messages on the instrument After starting the descent of a slope below
which the engine can be stopped. panel display 30 km/h (18 mph), speed is limited to a min-
imum of 2 km/h (1 mph) and a maximum of
Start-Stop system deactivated. 30 km/h (18 mph). When appropriate, the
Start the engine manually driver may increase or decrease the speed
Manually switching on/off the Start- within the limit by pressing the accelerator or
Stop system This driver message is displayed when cer-
the brake. At this point the function is inter-
tain conditions are not met during the stop-
rupted and, if necessary, it is then reactiva-
ping phase and the Start-Stop system cannot
ted.
restart the engine. The engine must be star-
ted manually. Even so, it is imperative that the surface
guarantees sufficient adhesion. For this rea-
Start-Stop system: Fault! Func- son, the Hill Descent Control will not fulfil its
tion not available function when, for example, descending a
slope with a frozen or slippery surface.
There is a fault in the Start-Stop system. Take
the vehicle to a workshop to have the fault Hill Descent Control is available when the
repaired. dash panel display shows the message .
Hill Descent Control automatically intervenes
Fig. 184 Centre console: Start-Stop system if the following conditions are met:
button.
Hill Descent Control (HDC) ● The vehicle engine is running.
If you do not wish to use the system, you can
● The Offroad driving profile has been selec-
switch it off manually. Description and operation
ted ››› page 242. Driving at a speed below 30
– To manually switch on/off the Start-Stop 3 Valid for vehicles: 4Drive
km/h (18 mph) (the message  is shown on
system, press the  button. The button Hill Descent Control limits the speed on steep the dash panel display).
symbol remains lit up yellow when the sys- descents by automatically braking all four ● The slope of the descent is at least 10%
tem is switched off. wheels, both when moving forward and in re- when driving forward and 9% when driving in
verse. As the anti-lock brake system remains reverse.
Note active, it prevents the wheels from locking. In ● The brake and the accelerator are not
The system is automatically switched on each vehicles with manual transmission, the Hill pressed.
time the engine is deliberately stopped dur- Descent Control adapts the theoretical speed
ing a stopping phase. The engine will start without slowing the engine below its idling Hill Descent Control is deactivated on press-
automatically. speed. ing the brake and the accelerator or if the
slope is below 5%. The function may be
210
Driver assistance systems

disconnected manually in the Easy Connect ● The speed of the vehicle may increase de- When connected, the Auto Hold function au-

Technical data
system by pressing the  button and the spite the intervention of Hill Descent Control. tomatically prevents the vehicle from rolling
HDC function button ›››  Fig. 42. when stationary without pressing the brake
pedal.
Control lamps
After detecting that the vehicle is stationary
››› in Warning and control lamps on Auto Hold Function and the brake pedal has been released, the
page 119. Auto Hold function holds the vehicle. The
Description and operation driver can lift their foot off the brake pedal.
 It lights up white

Advice
When the driver touches the accelerator ped-
Hill Descent Control is active. al or accelerates slightly to continue driving,
the Auto Hold function releases the brake.
The vehicle moves according to the slope of
 It lights up grey
the road.
Hill Descent Control is not active. The system is switched

Operation
on, but is not adjusting. If the vehicle is stationary and one of the con-
ditions required by the Auto Hold function is
Some warning and control lamps will light up impaired, it disconnects itself and the but-
briefly when the ignition is switched on to ton's control light goes out ››› Fig. 185. The
check certain functions. They will switch off electronic parking brake connects automati-
after a few seconds. Fig. 185 In the lower part of the centre con- cally, if necessary, to park the vehicle safe-
ly ››› .

Emergencies
sole: Auto Hold function button.
WARNING
The control light of the  ››› Fig. 185 button Conditions for keeping the vehicle stationary
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning remains on when the Auto Hold function is with the Auto Hold function
and control lamps on page 119.
connected.
● The driver door must be closed.
Once connected, the Auto Hold function as- ● The driver's seat belt must be fastened.
WARNING
sists the driver in keeping the vehicle station-
Always be ready to brake. Otherwise, an acci- ● The engine is running.
ary at repeated intervals or for a certain peri-

Safety
dent could occur and cause injury. od of time with the engine running, for exam-
● Hill Descent Control is only an auxiliary ple, when going up a slope, when stopped at Switching the Auto Hold function on and off
system that in some situations may not suffi- traffic lights or in heavy traffic with intermit- Press the button  ››› . The control lamp on
ciently brake the vehicle when going down a tent stops. the button goes out when the Auto Hold func-
slope. tion is switched off. »
211
Operation

Automatically engaging and disengaging the The Auto Hold function is automatically ● The Auto Hold function cannot always keep
Auto Hold function turned off if the following conditions are the vehicle stationary uphill or downhill or
If the Auto Hold function was switched on met: stop it sufficiently, for example, on slippery
with the  button before disengaging the ig- or frozen surfaces.
Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox
nition, the function will remain on after the
ignition is re-engaged. If any of the conditions mentioned on Note
1.
››› page 211, Conditions for keeping the vehicle
If the Auto Hold function was not switched stationary with the Auto Hold function are no lon- Before entering a car wash, always switch off
on, it will automatically remain off next time ger met. the Auto Hold function, because if the elec-
the ignition is engaged. tronic parking brake is automatically connec-
If the engine is running irregularly or an anomaly ted, it may cause damage.
2.
is detected.
The Auto Hold function is automatically
switched on if the following conditions are 3.
If the engine is turned If the engine is switch-
met: off or stalls. ed off.
Cruise control system (CCS)*
The clutch and the ac-
All conditions must be met at the same time If the accelerator is
4. celerator are pressed at
››› : the same time.
pressed. Operation
Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox If any of the tyres has
only minimal contact
1. The vehicle is kept stationary with the brake ped- 5. with the ground, e.g. in
al on a flat surface or on a slope. the case of axle articu-
lation.
2. The engine rotates “correctly”.

Upon pressing the Upon accelerating, the WARNING


clutch and accelerating brake releases gradu-
at the same time, the ally. The smart technology incorporated into the
brake releases gradu- Auto Hold function cannot defy the laws of
ally. physics; it only works within the limits of the
system. The greater convenience provided by
the Auto Hold function should never tempt
you to take any risk that may compromise
safety.
● Never leave the vehicle running and with Fig. 186 Instrument panel display: CCS status
the Auto Hold function switched on. indications.

212
Driver assistance systems

Read the additional information carefully WARNING Operating the cruise control system*

Technical data
›››  page 44
Use of the cruise control could cause acci- Read the additional information carefully
The cruise control system (CCS) is able to dents and severe injuries if it is not possible
maintain the set speed from 20 km/h (15
›››  page 44
to drive at a constant speed maintaining the
mph). safety distance. The value indicated in the table in brackets
● Do not use the cruise control in heavy traf- (in mph, miles per hour) only refers to instru-
The CSS only reduces vehicle speed by ceas-
fic, if the distance from the vehicle in front is ment panels with indications in miles.
ing to accelerate, not by actively braking the
insufficient, on steep roads, with several
vehicle ››› .

Advice
bends or in slippery circumstances (snow, Changing gear in CCS mode
ice, rain or loose gravel), or on flooded roads.
Control lamp The CCS decelerates as soon as the clutch
● Never use the CCS when driving off-road or
pedal is pressed, intervening again automati-
When the warning lamp  is lit, cruise con- on unpaved roads. cally after a gear is engaged.
trol is active. ● Always adapt your speed and the distance
Several warning and control lamps light up to the vehicles ahead in line with visibility, Travelling down hills with the CCS

Operation
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- weather conditions, the condition of the road
and the traffic situation. When travelling down hills the CCS cannot
ed on, signalling that the function is being
● To avoid unexpected operation of the cruise
maintain a constant speed. Slow the vehicle
verified. They will switch off after a few sec-
control system, turn it off every time you fin- down using the brake pedal and reduce
onds.
ish using it. gears if required.
Displayed on the CCS screen ● It is dangerous to use a set speed which is

Emergencies
too high for the prevailing road, traffic or
Automatic off
Status Fig. 186: weather conditions. The cruise control system (CCS) is switched
A CCS temporarily switched off. The set ● When travelling down hills, the CCS cannot off automatically or temporarily:
speed is displayed in small or darkened maintain a constant speed. The vehicle tends
● If the system detects a fault that could af-
figures. to accelerate under its own weight. Select a
lower gear or use the foot brake to slow the fect the working order of the CCS.
B System error. Contact a specialised work- vehicle. ● If you press and maintain the accelerator
shop.
pedal for a certain time, driving faster than

Safety
C CCS switched on. The speed memory is WARNING the stored speed.
empty. ● If the dynamic driving control systems in-
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
D The CCS is switched on. The set speed is and control lamps on page 119. tervene (e.g. ASR or ESC).
displayed in large figures. ● If the airbag is triggered.

213
Operation

Speed limiter C The speed limiter is switched off. The to- aquaplaning, snow, ice, leaves, etc. You
tal mileage is displayed. should use the speed limiter function only
Display messages and warning and when traffic, road and weather conditions al-
Warning and control lamp low it to be used safely.
control lamp
● When driving downhill, the speed limiter
 Lights up green
cannot limit the vehicle speed. Its speed will
The speed limiter is switched on and active. increase due to its own weight. In this case,
select a lower gear or use the foot brake to
slow the vehicle.
 Flashes green
The speed set by the speed limiter has been exceeded. WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
 Lights up and control lamps on page 119.
The adaptive cruise control (ACC) and the speed limiter
are active. Note
Fig. 187 On the instrument panel display:
● Different versions of the instrument panel
messages on the status of the speed limiter. Some warning and control lamps will light up
are available and therefore the versions and
briefly when the ignition is switched on to
instructions on the display may vary.
The speed limiter helps avoid exceeding a check certain functions. They will switch off
● If when switching the ignition off, the
speed individually programmed upwards of after a few seconds.
approximately 30 km/h (19 mph) driving in cruise control system (CCS), the adaptive
cruise control (ACC) or the speed limiter were
forwards gears ››› WARNING
switched on, then the cruise control system
After use, always switch off the speed limiter or the adaptive cruise control will automati-
Display messages on the speed limiter to prevent the speed being regulated against cally switch themselves on when the ignition
Status ››› Fig. 187: your wishes. is back on. However, no speed will be stored.
● The speed limiter does not relieve the driv- The last set speed of the speed limiter will be
A The speed limiter is active. The last
er of their responsibility to drive at the appro- stored.
speed set is displayed in large figures.
priate speed. Do not drive at high speed if not
B The speed limiter is not active. The last necessary.
speed set is displayed in small or dark- ● Using the speed limiter with adverse
ened figures. weather conditions is dangerous and can
cause serious accidents, e.g. because of

214
Driver assistance systems

Operate the speed limiter

Technical data
Advice
Fig. 188 On the left of the steering column: Fig. 189 On the left of the steering column:
control and buttons to operate the speed lim- third lever for operating the speed limiter.
iter.

Operation
Position of the turn signal lever ››› Fig. 188 or the third lever
Function Effect
››› Fig. 189
Move controller 1 of the turn signal lever to the  position and press but- The system switches on. The last set speed of the speed lim-

Emergencies
Switching on the speed limiter
ton 2 or move the third lever forward and press button 2 . iter is stored. It does not take effect yet.

Switching between the speed limiter and


cruise control (CCS) or the adaptive cruise It switches between the speed limiter and the CCS or the
Press button 2 on the turn signal lever or button 2 on the third lever
control (ACC) (with the speed limiter adaptive cruise control (ACC).
switched on)

The current speed is stored as the maximum speed and the


Activating the speed limiter Press button 3 on the turn signal lever or button  1 on the third lever.
limiter is switched on.

Safety
Temporarily switching off the speed limit- Place control 1 of the turn signal lever in position  or move the third The limiter is switched off temporarily. The speed will be
er limitation lever into position . stored.

Temporarily switch off the speed limiter The limiter is switched off temporarily. The speed will be
Press down on the accelerator beyond the point of resistance (e.g. to over-
limitation pressing down the accelerator stored. The limiter is reactivated automatically after return-
(kick-down)
take). Surpassing the set speed switches the speed limiter off temporarily.
ing to less than the set speed. »
215
Operation

Position of the turn signal lever ››› Fig. 188 or the third lever
Function Effect
››› Fig. 189
Press button 3 on the turn signal lever or move the third lever into posi- The speed is limited to the set speed as soon as the speed
Switching the speed limiter on again
tion . you are driving at is lower than the speed set as maximum.

Briefly press button 3 on the turn signal lever in the  area or move
the third lever into position  to increase the speed in small incre-
ments of 1 km/h (1 mph) and set it.

Press  on the third lever to increase the speed in increments of


Increasing the set speed of the limiter The speed is limited to the set value
10 km/h (5 mph) and set it.

Hold down button 3 on the turn signal lever in the area  or hold
down  to increase continuously in increments of 10 km/h (5 mph)
and set it.

Briefly press button 3 on the turn signal lever in the  area or press
 1 on the third lever to reduce the speed in small increments of 1 km/h
(1 mph) and set it.

Press  on the third lever to reduce the speed in increments of


Reducing the set speed of the limiter The speed is limited to the set value
10 km/h (5 mph) and set it.

Hold down button 3 on the turn signal lever in the  area or hold
down  to reduce the speed continuously in increments of 10 km/h
(5 mph) and set it.

Move control 1 of the turn signal lever into position  or the third lever
Switching off the speed limiter The system switches off
into position .

The values shown in the table in brackets, in ››› page 214 and an acoustic warning may ››› Fig. 188 1 of the turn signal lever into po-
mph, are displayed only in instrument panels sound. In this case, use the foot brake to sition  or the third lever into pressure
with indications in miles. slow the vehicle or, if necessary, select a low- point  or press button 2 on any lever.
er gear.
After overtaking, the speed limiter can be
Going down slopes with the speed limiter
switched on with the previously set speed by
If the set speed of the speed limiter is excee- Switching off temporarily
pressing button 3 on the turn signal lever in
ded while driving downhill, soon afterwards If you wish to temporarily switch off the the area  or by moving the third lever in-
the warning and control lamps flash  speed limiter, e.g. to overtake, move control to pressure point.
216
Driver assistance systems

Switch the speed limiter off temporarily by Emergency brake assist system The function is intended to prevent collisions

Technical data
pressing down the accelerator (kick-down) with parked vehicles or vehicles in the same
(Front Assist)* lane travelling in the same direction, or with
If the accelerator is pressed right down (kick-
down) and the set speed is exceeded be- pedestrians crossing the vehicle’s path. It
cause driver wishes to do so, the limiter is
Topic introduction may fail to activate in other danger situa-
temporarily disabled. tions.

To confirm it being switched off an acoustic The Front Assist function is active within a
signal sound once. While the limiter is off, range of speeds between 4 km/h (2.5 mph)

Advice
the warning and control lamp  flashes. and 250 km/h (156 mph). Depending on
speed, traffic conditions and driver behav-
When the accelerator is no longer pressed iour, some of the sub-functions described be-
down and the speed is reduced below the set low are omitted in order to optimise the sys-
value, the limiter switches on again. The con- tem’s general behaviour.
trol lamp  will light up and remain lit.
The Front Assist is a driving assistance func-

Operation
Automatic off tion that can never replace the driver’s atten-
Fig. 190 On the instrument panel display: tion.
The speed limiter is automatically switched pre-warning messages.
off: Safety distance warning
● If the system detects a fault that could neg- The objective of the emergency brake assist If the system detects a situation of danger
system is to prevent head-on collisions

Emergencies
atively affect the working order of the limiter. because the vehicle is too close to the vehi-
against objects that may be in the vehicle’s cle ahead, it will warn the driver by means of
● If the airbag is triggered. path or minimise the consequences of such an indication on the instrument panel display
impacts. .
CAUTION
Within the limitations imposed by the envi- The timing of the warning varies depending
For automatic switching off due to system
ronmental conditions and by the system it- on driver behaviour and the traffic situation.
failures, for security reasons, the limiter is
self, the function acts in staggered fashion,
only completely switched off when the driver
stops pressing the accelerator at some point depending on how critical the situation is. In- Advance warning

Safety
or consciously switches off the system. itially it warns the driver, and if the driver’s
reaction does not occur or is insufficient, it If the system detects a possible collision with
activates an independent emergency brak- the vehicle in front, it may alert the driver by
ing. means of an audible warning and an indica-
tion on the instrument panel display
››› Fig. 190. »
217
Operation

The warning moment varies depending on WARNING ● The Front Assist does not react to animals
the traffic situation and driver behaviour. At or vehicles crossing your path or approaching
the same time, the vehicle will prepare for a Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
head-on down the same lane.
and control lamps on page 119.
possible emergency braking ››› . ● The Front Assist does not react to pedes-
trians walking in the same direction or ap-
Critical warning WARNING proaching head-on down the same lane.
If the driver fails to react to the pre-warning The Front Assist system cannot change the ● The driver must always be ready to take
(advance warning), the system may actively laws of physics or replace the driver in terms over the control of the vehicle.
intervene in the brakes and generate a brief of keeping control of the vehicle and reacting ● When the Front Assist causes a braking,
jolt to warn the driver of the imminent danger to a possible emergency situation.
the brake pedal is “harder”.
of a collision. ● Automatic interventions by the Front Assist
WARNING on the brakes may be interrupted by pressing
Automatic braking Following a Front Assist emergency warning, the clutch, accelerator or moving the wheel.
If the driver also fails to react to the critical pay immediate attention to the situation and
warning, the system may initiate independ- try to avoid the collision by braking or by Note
ent emergency braking by progressively in- dodging the obstacle, as applicable.
● When the Front Assist is connected, the in-
creasing the braking effect in accordance ● If the Front Assist does not work as descri-
dications on the instrument panel screen may
with how critical the situation is. bed in this chapter (e.g. it repeatedly inter-
be concealed by warnings from other func-
venes unnecessarily), switch it off.
tions, such as an incoming call.
Driver emergency brake assist system ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
● When the Front Assist causes a braking,
vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi-
Faced with an imminent collision, the system the brake pedal is “harder”.
bility, weather, road and traffic conditions.
may detect that the driver is not braking hard ● Automatic interventions by the Front Assist
● The Front Assist alone cannot avoid acci-
enough to avoid the collision. In this case, it on the brakes may be interrupted by pressing
will automatically increase the braking effect. dents and serious injuries.
the clutch, accelerator or moving the wheel.
● In complex driving situations, occasionally
Due to certain driving circumstances and the ● The Front Assist may brake the vehicle until
the Front Assist may issue warnings and in-
limitations of its operation, there are some it stops completely. However, the brake sys-
tervene in braking unnecessarily, for example
cases in which the system cannot prevent a tem does not halt the vehicle permanently.
at traffic islands.
Use the foot brake!
collision, although it can significantly mini- ● If the operation of the Front Assist is im-
mise the consequences by reducing the ● If the Front Assist does not work as descri-
paired, for example, by dirt or because the ra-
speed and the force of the impact. bed in this chapter (e.g. in intervenes several
dar sensor has lost its settings, the system
times unnecessarily), switch it off. Have the
may issue unnecessary warnings and inter-
system checked by a specialised workshop.
vene inopportunely in the braking.
SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership.
218
Driver assistance systems

Radar sensor to the presence of metallic objects (e.g. rails Operating the Emergency braking as-

Technical data
on the road or sheets used in road works). sistance system (Front Assist)
The area in front of and around the radar sen-
sor should not be covered with adhesives,
additional or similar headlights, as this may
negatively affect Front Assist operation.
If the front of the vehicle is not properly re-
paired or structural modifications are made

Advice
to it, for example if the suspension is low-
ered, Front Assist operation may be affected.
SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership
for this purpose.
Fig. 191 On the front behind the SEAT badge:
radar sensor. Fig. 192 On the instrument panel display:
CAUTION

Operation
Front Assist switched off message.
On the front behind the SEAT badge, a radar If you have the sensation that the radar sen-
sensor has been installed to capture the traf- sor is damaged or has lost its settings, dis- The Front Assist is active whenever the igni-
fic situation ››› Fig. 191. connect the Front Assist. This will avoid pos- tion is switched on.
sible dangerous situations caused by a sys-
The radar sensor's visibility may be impaired tem malfunction. If this occurs have it adjus- When the Front Assist is switched off, so too
by dirt, mud or snow, or by environmental in- ted. are the advance warning function (pre warn-

Emergencies
fluences such as rain or mist. In this case, the ● The sensor may become damaged or lose ing) and the distance warning.
Front Assist does not work. The instrument its settings when knocked, for example, dur-
panel displays the following message: SEAT recommends leaving the Front Assist al-
ing a parking manoeuvre. This may compro- ways switched on. Exceptions ››› page 220,
Front Assist: No sensor vision! If mise the system's efficacy or disconnect it.
necessary clean the radar sensor ››› . Switching the Front Assist off temporarily in
● Repairs to the radar sensor require special- the following situations.
When the radar sensor begins to operate ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom-
properly again, the Front Assist will automati- mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur-
Switching the Front Assist on and off

Safety
cally be available again. The message will pose.
disappear from the instrument panel display. ● Clean away the snow with a brush and the With the ignition switched on, the Front As-
ice preferably with a solvent-free de-icer sist can be switched on and off as follows:
Front Assist operation may be affected by a spray. ● Select the corresponding menu option us-
strong radar reverse reflection. This may oc-
ing the button for the driver assistance sys-
cur, for example, in a closed car park or due
tems ›››  page 36. »
219
Operation

● OR: switch the system on and off in Easy Switching distance warning on and off ● If the radar sensor is covered temporarily
Connect using the  button and the If the safe distance with regard to the vehicle with some kind of accessory, such as an ad-
SETTINGS and Driver assistance function but- ditional headlight or the like.
in front is exceeded, the relevant warning will
tons ›››  page 33. appear on the instrument panel display ● When the vehicle is to be loaded on a lorry,
. In this case, increase the safe dis- ferry or train.
When Front Assist is switched off, the instru-
ment panel will inform that it has been tance.
switched off with the following indicator  The distance warning can be switched on and
››› Fig. 192. off in the Easy Connect system using the System limitations
 button and the SETTINGS and
Activating or deactivating the pre-warning Driver assistance function buttons
The Front Assist has certain physical limita-
(advance warning) ›››  page 33. tions inherent to the system. Thus, in certain
circumstances, some of the system's reac-
The pre-warning function (advance warning) The system will store the setting for the next tions may be inopportune from the driver's
can be switched on or off in the Easy Connect time the ignition is switched on. standpoint. So pay attention in order to inter-
system with the  button and the SETTINGS vene if necessary.
and Driver assistance function buttons SEAT recommends keeping the distance
›››  page 33. warning switched on at all times.
The following conditions may cause the Front
The system will store the setting for the next Assist not to react or to do so too late:
time the ignition is switched on. Switching the Front Assist off tempo- ● In the first few instants of driving after
SEAT recommends keeping the pre-warning rarily in the following situations switching on the ignition, due to the system’s
function switched on at all times. initial auto-calibration.
In the following situations the Front Assist ● On taking tight bends or complex paths.
Depending on the infotainment system in-
should be deactivated due to the system's ● Pressing the accelerator all the way down.
stalled in the vehicle, the advance warning
limitations:
function may be adjusted as follows: ● If the Front Assist is switched off or dam-
● When the vehicle is to be towed. aged.
● Advance
● If the vehicle is on a test bed. ● If the ASR has been disconnected or the
● Medium
● When the radar sensor is damaged. ESC activated in Sport mode manually
● Delayed ››› page 191.
● If the radar sensor takes a heavy knock, for
● Deactivated ● If the ESC is controlling.
example in a rear collision.
SEAT recommends driving with the function ● If it intervenes several times unnecessarily. ● If several brake lights of the vehicle or elec-
in “Medium” mode. trically connected trailer are damaged.

220
Driver assistance systems

● If the radar sensor is dirty or covered. Introduction If the vehicle is equipped with automatic

Technical data
● If there are metal objects, e.g. rails on the gearbox, the ACC can brake the vehicle until
road or sheets used in road works. it stops completely if a vehicle in front of it
stops.
● If the vehicle is reversing.
● If the vehicle over-accelerates. The distance programmed should be in-
creased when the road surface is wet.
● In case of snow or heavy rain.
● In case of narrow vehicles, such as motor- Driver intervention prompt

Advice
bikes.
During driving, the ACC is subject to certain
● Misaligned vehicles. limitations inherent in the system. In other
● Vehicles crossing the other's path. words, in certain circumstances the driver will
● Vehicles approaching in the opposite direc-
have to adjust speed him or herself, as well
Fig. 194 Detection area.
as the distance from other vehicles.
tion.
The adaptive cruise control (ACC) is an exten-

Operation
● Special loads and accessories of other ve- In this case, the instrument panel screen will
hicles that jut out over the sides, backwards sion of the normal cruise control system warn you to intervene by applying the brake
or over the top. (CCS) ››› . and a warning tone will be heard
The ACC function allows the driver to program ››› page 223.
a cruise speed of between 30 and 210 km/h
(18 and 150 mph) and to select the distance WARNING
Adaptive Cruise Control ACC*

Emergencies
required with regard to the vehicle in front. The intelligent technology in the ACC cannot
overcome the system's inherent limitations
Related video The ACC will adapt the vehicle's cruise speed or change the laws of physics. If used negli-
at all times, maintaining a safe distance with gently or involuntarily, it may cause serious
the vehicle in front based on its speed. accidents and injuries. The system is not a re-
When driving behind another vehicle, the placement for driver awareness.
ACC function reduces speed until it is the ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
same as that of the vehicle ahead and main- vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi-

Safety
tains the set distance between the vehicles. bility, weather, road and traffic conditions.
Fig. 193 Autonomous
driving If the vehicle ahead accelerates, the adaptive ● Do not use the ACC when visibility is bad,
cruise control also accelerates, going no on steep roads, with several bends or in slip-
higher than the target speed programmed. pery circumstances such as snow, ice, rain or
loose gravel, or on flooded roads. »
221
Operation

● Never use the ACC when driving off-road or ● Repairs to the radar sensor require special- Indications on the display, warning
on unpaved roads. The ACC has been de- ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom- and control lamps
signed for use on paved roads only. mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur-
● The ACC does not react on approaching a pose.
fixed obstacle, such as the tail of a traffic
jam, a damaged vehicle or a vehicle stopped Note
at the traffic lights.
● If the ACC system does not work as descri-
● The ACC only reacts to people if a pedes-
bed in this chapter, do not use it until it has
trian monitoring system is available. In addi- been checked by a specialised workshop.
tion, the system does not react to animals or SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership
vehicles crossing your path or approaching for this purpose.
head-on down the same lane.
● Maximum speed with the ACC activated is
● If the ACC does not reduce speed sufficient-
limited to 210 km/h (150 mph).
ly, brake the vehicle immediately by applying
● When the ACC is switched on, strange
the pedal.
noises may be heard during automatic brak-
● If you are driving using the spare wheel,
ing cause by the braking system.
the ACC system could automatically switch
off during the journey. Switch off the system
when starting off.
● If the vehicle continues to move involuntar-
ily after a driver intervention prompt, brake
the vehicle by applying the pedal.
● If the dash panel displays a driver interven-
tion prompt, adjust the distance yourself. Fig. 195 On the instrument panel display: (A)
● The driver should be ready to accelerate or ACC inactive (Standby). (B) ACC active.
brake by him/herself at all times.
Status display
CAUTION Indications on the display ››› Fig. 195:
If you have the sensation that the radar sen- 1 Vehicle ahead detected. ACC is not active
sor is damaged, disconnect the ACC. This will and is not regulating your speed.
avoid possible damage. If this occurs have it 2 Distance from the vehicle ahead. ACC is
adjusted. not active and is not regulating your dis-
tance.
222
Driver assistance systems

3 Vehicle ahead detected. ACC is active and If the symbol is white: the ACC is ac- Radar sensor

Technical data
is regulating your speed.  tive.
4 Distance level 2 set by the driver.
A vehicle in front has been detected. The ACC adjusts
5 ACC is active and is regulating your dis- speed and distance from the vehicle in front.
tance based on speed.
If the symbol is grey: ACC is inactive
Warning and control lamps  (Standby)
››› in Warning and control lamps on

Advice
The system is switched on, but is not adjusting.
page 119.

The speed reduction by the ACC to  It lights up green


 maintain the distance from the vehi- The ACC is active. Fig. 196 On the front behind the SEAT badge:
cle in front is not sufficient. radar sensor.

Operation
Brake! apply the foot brake! Driver intervention prompt. Some warning and control lamps will light up
briefly when the ignition is switched on to On the front behind the SEAT badge, a radar
check certain functions. They will switch off sensor has been installed to capture the traf-
 The ACC is not currently available. a) after a few seconds. fic situation ››› Fig. 196.
With the vehicle stationary, switch off the engine and The radar sensor's visibility may be impaired
start it up again. Check the SEAT badge area on the front WARNING by dirt, mud or snow, or by environmental in-
››› Fig. 196 (in case it is dirty or icy or it has been hit). If

Emergencies
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning fluences such as rain or mist. In this case the
it is still unavailable, refer to a specialised workshop to
and control lamps on page 119. adaptive cruise control (ACC) does not work.
have the system inspected.
The instrument panel displays the following
a) The symbol on the instrument panels with colour display is in
Note message: ACC: No sensor vision! If
colour. necessary, clean the SEAT badge area ››› .
When the ACC is connected, the indications
 The ACC is active. on the instrument panel screen may be con- When the radar sensor begins to operate
cealed by warnings from other functions, properly again, the ACC will automatically be

Safety
No vehicle is detected in front. The programmed speed such as an incoming call. available again. The message on the instru-
remains constant.
ment panel screen will switch off and the ACC
will be reactivated again.
ACC operation may be affected by a strong ra-
dar reverse reflection. This may occur, for ex-
ample, in a closed car park or due to the »
223
Operation

presence of metallic objects (e.g. rails on the Operating the Adaptive Cruise Control programmed speed and ACC status will be
road or sheets used in road works). ACC displayed ››› Fig. 195.
The area in front of and around the radar sen-
What ACC settings are possible?
sor should not be covered with adhesives,
additional or similar headlights, as this may ● Setting your speed ››› page 224.
negatively affect ACC operation. ● Setting your distance ››› page 225.
If the front of the vehicle is not properly re- ● Connecting and activating the ACC
paired or structural modifications are made ››› page 225.
to it, for example, if the suspension is low- ● Disconnecting and deactivating the ACC
ered, ACC operation may be affected. In this ››› page 225.
scenario, SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT
● Adjusting the default distance level at the
dealership.
start of your journey ››› page 225.
Fig. 197 On the left of the steering column: ● Adjusting the driving profile ››› page 225.
CAUTION
third lever for operating the Adaptive Cruise
If you have the sensation that the radar sen- Control. ● Conditions in which the ACC does not react
sor is damaged or has lost its settings, dis- ››› page 225.
connect the ACC. This will avoid possible
damage. If this occurs have it adjusted. Setting speed
● The sensor may become damaged or lose
To set your speed, move the third lever loca-
its settings when knocked, for example, dur-
ted in position 1 upwards or downwards un-
ing a parking manoeuvre. This may compro-
til the desired speed is shown on the instru-
mise the system's efficacy or disconnect it.
ment panel display. The speed adjustment is
● Repairs to the radar sensor require special-
made at 10 km/h (6 mph) intervals.
ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom-
mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur- Once you are driving, if you wish to set the
pose. current speed as the vehicle’s cruise speed
● Clean away the snow with a brush and the and activate the ACC, press the  button
Fig. 198 On the left of the steering column:
ice preferably with a solvent-free de-icer ››› Fig. 198. If you wish to increase or reduce
third lever for operating the Adaptive Cruise
spray. speed by intervals of 1 km/h (0.6 mph),
Control.
move the lever to position 2 ››› Fig. 197 or
When the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is press the  button, respectively.
connected, the green control lamp  will The set speed can be changed when the ve-
light up on the instrument panel, and the hicle is stopped or during driving, as you like.
224
Driver assistance systems

Any modification to the programmed speed When the ACC function is active, the vehicle In the Easy Connect system you can adjust

Technical data
will be shown on the bottom left part of the travels at a set speed and distance from the the distance level that will be applied when
instrument panel display ››› Fig. 195. vehicle ahead. Both speed and distance can the ACC is connected using the  button
be changed at any time. and the SETTINGS and Driver assistance function
Setting your distance level buttons ›››  page 33.
To increase/reduce the distance level, press Disconnecting and deactivating the ACC
the rocker switch towards the left/right To disconnect the ACC move the lever to the Changing the driving profile
››› Fig. 198 A . 0 position ››› Fig. 197 (engaged). An ACC In vehicles with SEAT Drive Profile, the driving
deactivated message appears and the profile selected can have an influence on the

Advice
The instrument panel display shows the mod-
function is totally deactivated. ACC’s acceleration and braking behaviour
ification of the distance level. There are 5 dis-
tance levels to choose from. SEAT recom- If you do not wish to disconnect the ACC, just
››› page 242.
mends level 3. The set distance can be to switch it temporarily to inactive mode In vehicles without SEAT Drive Profile, the be-
changed when the vehicle is stopped or dur- (Standby), move the third lever to position 3 haviour of the ACC can also be affected by se-
ing driving, as you like ››› . ››› Fig. 197 or press the brake pedal. lecting any of the following drive profiles in

Operation
the Easy Connect system:
It will also switch to inactive mode (Standby)
Connecting and activating the ACC
if the vehicle is stopped and the driver door ● Normal
To connect and activate the ACC, the position is opened.
● Sport
of the gearbox selector lever, the vehicle
speed and the position of the third level of Adjusting the default distance level at the ● Eco

Emergencies
the ACC must all be taken into account. start of your journey. ● Convenience

● With a manual gearbox, the gearbox selec- In wet road conditions, you should always set In this case, you should access the ACC set-
tor lever must be in any gear except first, and a larger distance with regard to the vehicle in tings using the  button and the SETTINGS >
speed must be greater than approximately 30 front than when driving in dry conditions. Driver assistance > ACC function buttons
km/h. With an automatic gearbox, the gear- The following distances can be preselected: ›››  page 33.
box selector lever must be in position D or S.
● To activate the ACC, with the third lever in ● Very short The following conditions may lead the ACC

Safety
position 1 press the  button or move the ● Short not to react:
third lever of the ACC to position 2 ● Media ● If the accelerator is pressed.
››› Fig. 197. At this point, the image of the ● Long ● If there is no gear engaged.
ACC on the instrument panel display will
switch to Active mode ››› Fig. 195. ● Very long ● If the ESC is controlling. »
225
Operation

● If the driver is not wearing his/her seat  ACC: parking brake applied The ACC is operational as of the 2nd gear
belt. (manual gearbox).
The ACC is deactivated if the parking brake is
● If several brake lights of the vehicle or elec- applied. The ACC is available once again after  ACC: engine speed
trically connected trailer are damaged. the parking brake is released.
The message for the driver is displayed if,
● If the vehicle is reversing.
 ACC: currently not available. when the ACC accelerates or brakes, the driv-
● Driving faster than 210 km/h (150 mph). Intervention of stability con- er does not shift up or down a gear in time,
trol which means exceeding or not reaching the
Driver messages permissible engine speed. The ACC switches
The message for the driver is displayed when
 ACC not available itself off. A buzzer warning is heard.
the electronic stability control (ESC) inter-
The system can no longer continue to guar- venes. In this case, the ACC is automatically  ACC: clutch pressed
antee safe vehicle detection and will be de- switched off.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox: pressing the
activated. The sensor has lost its setting or is  ACC: Take action! clutch pedal for longer abandons control
damaged. Take the vehicle to a specialised mode.
The message for the driver is displayed if,
workshop and have the fault repaired.
when the vehicle starts up on a hill with a Door open
 ACC and Front Assist: cur- mild slope, the vehicle rolls back even al-
Vehicles with automatic gearbox: the ACC
rently not available. No sensor though the ACC is activated. Apply the brake
vision
cannot be activated with the vehicle station-
to stop the vehicle from moving/colliding
ary and the door open.
This message will be displayed to the driver if with another vehicle.
the radar sensor's vision is impaired due, for  ACC: speed limit WARNING
example, to leaves, snow, heavy fog or dirt.
The message for the driver is displayed if, in There is a danger of rear collision when the
Clean the SEAT badge ››› Fig. 196. minimum distance to the vehicle in front is
vehicles with manual gearbox, the current
 ACC: currently not available. speed is too low for the ACC mode. exceeded and the speed difference between
Gradient too steep both vehicles is so great that a speed reduc-
The speed to be stored must be at least tion by the ACC will not suffice. In this case
The maximum road slope has been excee- 30 km/h (18 mph). The speed limiter the brake pedal should be applied immedi-
ded, hence safe ACC operation cannot be switches off if the speed falls below 20 km/h ately.
guaranteed. The ACC cannot be switched on. (12 mph). ● The ACC may not be able to detect all situa-
 ACC: only available in D, S  ACC: available as of the 2nd tions properly.
or M gear ● “Stepping” on the accelerator may cause
the ACC not to intervene in braking. Driver
Select the D/S or M position on the selector
lever.
226
Driver assistance systems

braking will have priority over intervention by Function for preventing overtaking in Deactivating the Adaptive Cruise Con-

Technical data
the speed control or adaptive cruise control. an inside lane trol ACC temporarily in certain situa-
● Always be ready to use the brakes! tions
● Observe country-specific provisions gov-
erning obligatory minimum distances be- In the following situations the Adaptive
tween vehicles. Cruise Control (ACC) should be deactivated
due to the system's limitations ››› :
Note ● When changing lanes, on tight bends and

Advice
● The programmed speed is erased once the roundabouts, in acceleration and decelera-
ignition or the ACC are switched off. tion lanes on motorways or in sections with
● When the traction control system (ASR) is road works to prevent involuntary accelera-
deactivated during acceleration or else the tion to reach the programmed speed.
ESC is activated in Sport* Mode Fig. 199 On the instrument panel display: ● When going through a tunnel, as operation
(››› page 120), the ACC switches off automati- could be affected.

Operation
ACC active, vehicle detected in an outer lane.
cally.
● On roads with several lanes, when other ve-
● In vehicles with the Start-Stop system, the The adaptive cruise control (ACC) has a func- hicles are driving more slowly in the overtak-
engine switches off automatically during the tion that helps avoid overtaking while driving ing lane. In this case, slower vehicles will be
ACC stopping phase and restarts automatical- in inside lanes at certain speeds. overtaken on the right.
ly to begin driving.
If another vehicle is detected travelling at a ● In case of heavy rain, snow or spray, as the

Emergencies
slower speed in an outer lane, it is displayed vehicle in front might not be detected proper-
on the multifunction display ››› Fig. 199. ly or, in certain circumstances, might not be
detected at all.
To avoid overtaking while driving in an inside
lane the system will gently brake, and in ac-
WARNING
cordance with the speed will prevent the car
from overtaking. The driver can override this If the ACC does not switch off in the situa-
function at any time by pressing the accelera- tions described, serious accidents and inju-

Safety
tor pedal. At low speeds the function is inac- ries may occur.
tive, for greater comfort in a traffic jam or in ● Always switch off the ACC in critical situa-
city traffic. tions. »

227
Operation

Note When the ACC halts the vehicle (e.g. traffic


jam), the instrument panel display shows the
If you do not switch off the ACC in the afore- ACC ready to start message. If the ve-
mentioned situations, you may commit a le-
hicle ahead drives off again, the ACC will also
gal offence.
do so automatically.
If the vehicle ahead does not drive off again,
Special driving situations the vehicle can be kept indefinitely in the
ACC ready to start status by operating
the third lever repeatedly towards position
2 ››› Fig. 197 or by pressing the brake pedal.
If the Press the brake message is shown
on the instrument panel, press the brake. If
you do not, an acoustic warning will be heard
and the ACC will switch to inactive mode
(Standby). At this point, the vehicle may be-
Fig. 201 (C) Vehicle changing lanes. (D) One gin to move towards the stopped vehicle
vehicle turning and another stationary. ahead ››› .

The adaptive cruise control (ACC) has certain Overtaking


physical limitations inherent in the system.
For example, certain reactions of the ACC, in When the turn signal lights up before the ve-
certain circumstances, may be unexpected or hicle begins an overtaking manoeuvre, the
come late from the driver's point of view. So ACC accelerates the vehicle automatically
pay attention in order to intervene if necessa- and thus reduces the distance from the vehi-
Fig. 200 (A) Vehicle on a bend. (B) Motorcy- ry. cle in front.
clist ahead out of range of the radar sensor. When the vehicle enters the overtaking lane,
For example, the following traffic situations
call for the utmost attention: if the ACC does not detect another vehicle in
front, it accelerates until it reaches the pro-
grammed speed and maintains it.
Starting driving after a stopping phase (only
vehicles with automatic gearbox) System acceleration can be interrupted at
After a stopping phase, the ACC may begin any time by pressing the brake or moving the
driving automatically when the vehicle in third lever backwards ››› page 224.
front drives off ››› .
228
Driver assistance systems

Driving through a bend Other vehicles changing lanes Factors that may affect how the radar sensor

Technical data
On entering or exiting bends, the radar sen- Vehicles changing lanes a short distance operates
sor may no longer determine the vehicle in away from your own can only be detected If laser sensor operation is impaired, due to
front or react to a vehicle in the adjacent lane when they are within range of the sensors. heavy rain, spray, snow or mud, the ACC is
››› Fig. 200 A. In these situations the vehicle Consequently, the ACC will take longer to re- deactivated temporarily. The relevant text
may brake unnecessarily or fail to react to re- act ››› Fig. 201 C. In these cases, you should message will appear in the dash panel dis-
act to the vehicle in front. In this case, the brake as necessary. play. If necessary clean the SEAT
driver has to intervene by accelerating or in- badge ››› Fig. 196.
terrupting the braking process by applying Stationary vehicles

Advice
When the radar sensor begins to operate
the brake or pushing the third lever back-
The ACC does not detect stationary objects properly again, the ACC will automatically be
wards ››› page 224.
while driving, such as traffic tails or damaged available again. The message on the instru-
vehicles. ment panel screen will switch off and the ACC
Driving in tunnels
will be reactivated again.
If a vehicle detected by the ACC turns or
When driving through tunnels the radar sen-
moves over and there is a stationary vehicle ACC operation may be affected by a strong ra-

Operation
sor may be limited. Switch off the ACC in tun-
in front of it, the ACC will not react to it dar reverse reflection, for example in a closed
nels.
››› Fig. 201 D. In these cases, you should car park.
brake as necessary.
Narrow or misaligned vehicles
Trailer mode
The radar sensor can only detect narrow or Vehicles driving in the opposite direction
When driving with trailer the ACC controls
misaligned vehicles when they are within and vehicles crossing your path

Emergencies
less dynamically.
range ››› Fig. 200 B. This applies particularly
The ACC does not react to vehicles approach-
to narrow vehicles such as motorbikes. In
ing from the opposite direction or vehicles Overheated brakes
these cases, you should brake as necessary.
crossing your path.
If the brakes overheat, for example after
Vehicles with special loads and accessories abrupt braking or in long and steep slopes,
Metal objects
the ACC may be deactivated temporarily. The
Special loads and accessories of other vehi-
Metal objects, e.g. rails on the road or sheets relevant text message will appear in the dash
cles that jut out over the sides, backwards or

Safety
used in road works, can confuse the radar panel display. In this case, adaptive cruise
over the top may be out of the ACC's range.
sensor and cause the ACC to react wrongly. control cannot be activated.
Switch off the ACC when driving behind vehi-
Adaptive cruise control can be reactivated
cles with special loads and accessories or
once brake temperature has cooled suffi-
when overtaking them. In these cases, you
ciently. The message will disappear from the
should brake as necessary.
instrument panel display. If the message ACC »
229
Operation

not available remains on for quite a long Using the camera located in the windscreen, Indications on the display and lamps
time it means that there is a fault. Contact a the Lane Assist system detects the possible
specialised workshop. SEAT recommends vis- lines dividing the lanes. When the vehicle in-
iting a SEAT dealership. voluntarily approaches a dividing line it has
detected, the system notifies the driver with
WARNING a corrective steering movement. The purpose
If you do not heed the Press the brake is not only to warn the driver, but also to
message, the vehicle may initiate an involun- keep the vehicle inside the lane. This move-
tary movement and could crash into the vehi- ment can be over-regulated at any time.
cle ahead. In any event, before driving off, No warning is produced with the turn signals
check that the road is clear. The radar sensor
activated, given that the Lane Assist system
may not detect obstacles on the road. This
understands that a lane change is required.
could cause an accident and serious injuries.
If necessary, apply the brake.

Lane Assist system*


Introduction

Fig. 203 On the instrument panel display: In-


dication on the Lane Assist system display
(example 1).

Fig. 202 In the windscreen: field of vision of


the Lane Assist system camera.

230
Driver assistance systems

– The system is operational, the highligh- ● When the steering angle assist value re-

Technical data
ted line A indicates that there was a quired to keep the vehicle in the lane is high-
risk of involuntarily crossing the lane er than the system’s maximum operating val-
line and that the steering is being adjus- ue.
ted to correct the angle ››› Fig. 204 C. ● If the system ceases to display the lane
– The two highlighted lines A light up si- lines while assisting with steering.
multaneously when both lane lines are
recognised and the Lane Assist function Switching the Lane Assist system on or off
is active ››› Fig. 204 D.

Advice
Through the Easy Connect system
Control lamps ● Press the Easy Connect button 
● Press the SETTINGS function button
It lights up yellow: Lane Assist active
 but not available.
● Press the function button Driver assistance to
open the menu.

Operation
The system can not accurately recognise the lane.
Please see page 232, the Lane Assist system is not OR: Using the Driving Assist button on
available (the control lamp is lit up yellow). the turn signal lever* ›››  page 37.

 It lights up green Lane Assist with lane centring guide

Lane Assist system active and available.


The Lane Centring Guide function is in-

Emergencies
Fig. 204 On the instrument panel display: In- tended to keep the vehicle in the centre of
dication on the Lane Assist system display the lane.
(example 2). WARNING
If the driver has a tendency to veer slightly off
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
Status display and control lamps on page 119. centre in the lane, the system adapts to driv-
– The system is active, but not available, er preferences.
either because the minimum speed has The Lane Centring Guide function is ac-
not been reached or because the lane Operating mode tivated/deactivated in the Easy Connect sys-

Safety
lines are not recognised ››› Fig. 203 A. tem using the  button and the SETTINGS
– The system is active and available, both Steering wheel vibration function button ››› page 120. »
lane lines are recognised. The steering The following situations can cause vibration
angle is not being corrected at this mo- in the steering wheel and require the driver
ment ››› Fig. 203 B. to take active control of driving:
231
Operation

Self-deactivation: the Lane Assist system can ● When the distance to the next marking to Switching off the Lane Assist system in the
be automatically deactivated if there is a sys- too great. following situations
tem malfunction. The control lamp ● When the system does not detect any clear Due to the limits of the Lane Assist system,
disappears. and active steering movement during a long switch it off in the following situations:
period of time.
Hands-Off Function ● When more attention is required of the
● Temporarily, in the event of very dynamic
In the absence of steering wheel activity the driver
driving styles.
system alerts the driver with acoustic signals ● When driving in a sporty style
● If a turn signal is activated.
and a text message on the dash panel asking ● In unfavourable weather conditions
to actively take over the steering. ● With the stability control system (ESC) in
Sport mode or switched off. ● On roads in poor condition
If the driver does not react to this, the system ● In areas of road works
also alerts the driver with a little shaking mo- BSD Plus (Lane Assist with Blind Spot Detec-
tion through the brakes and, if the vehicle tor)* WARNING
has it, activates the Emergency Assist func-
tion ››› page 234. The BSD Plus function is achieved by activat- The intelligent technology in the Lane Assist
ing the Lane Assist and BSD functions system cannot change the limits imposed by
In vehicles without Emergency Assist, the ››› page 237. In this case, the Lane Assist the laws of physics and by the very nature of
adaptive lane guidance function will be disa- function expands its functions in the follow- the system. Careless or uncontrolled use of
bled after the corresponding warnings to the ing way: the Lane Assist system may cause accidents
driver. and injury. The system is not a replacement
If the driver tries to change lane and there is for driver awareness.
The lane assist system is active but it is not a vehicle in the blind spot: ● Always adapt your speed and the distance
available (the control lamp is lit up yellow) to the vehicles ahead in line with visibility,
● The  lamp flashes in the corresponding
weather conditions, the condition of the road
● When driving at speeds below 65 km/h (38 rear-view mirror even though the turn signal and the traffic situation.
mph). has not been activated.
● Always keep your hands on the steering
● When the Lane Assist system does not de- ● The steering wheel vibrates to warn the wheel so it can be turned at any time.
tect the dividing lines of the road. For exam- driver of the risk of collision. ● The Lane Assist system does not detect all
ple, in the event warnings indicating road ● torque is applied to correct the steering road markings. The road surfaces, road struc-
works, and snow, dirt, moisture or reflec- and return the vehicle to its lane. tures or objects in poor condition can be in-
tions. correctly detected as road markings under
● When the radius of a curve is too small. certain circumstances by the Lane Assist sys-
tem. In such situations, switch the Lane As-
● When no road markings can be seen.
sist system off immediately.
232
Driver assistance systems

● Please observe the indications on the in- ● Always keep the field of vision of the cam- Operation of Traffic Jam Assist

Technical data
strument panel and act as is necessary. era clean. At speeds of below 60 km/h (40 mph), Traffic
● Always pay attention to the vehicle's sur- ● If there is a fault in the system, have it Jam Assist can maintain a (temporary) dis-
roundings. checked by a specialised workshop. tance preset by the driver with respect to the
● When the area of vision of the camera be- vehicle ahead and help stay within the lane
comes dirty, covered or is damaged, the Lane ››› .
Assist system function can be affected.
Traffic Jam Assist To do this, the system automatically controls
the accelerator, brakes and steering, and

Advice
CAUTION slows the vehicle, stopping it fully if neces-
Related video
In order to avoid influencing the operation of sary, when faced with a vehicle in front that
the system, the following points must be tak- has stopped. It automatically moves off again
en into account: when the vehicle ahead moves.
● Regularly clean the area of vision of the Traffic Jam Assist is designed only for use on
camera and keep it in a clean state, without motorways and wide roads. Therefore, never

Operation
snow or ice. use it in city traffic.
● Do not cover the area of vision of the cam- Fig. 205 Autonomous
era. driving
Technical requirements for using Traffic Jam
● Check that the area of vision of the wind- Assist
screen camera is not damaged. ● Lane departure warning must be activated:
Description and operation

Emergencies
 button > SETTINGS > Driver as-
Note sistance > Lane departure warning
Traffic Jam Assist helps the driver keep the
● The lane departure warning system has (Lane Assist) ›››  page 33.
car within its lane and to move in convoy in
been exclusively developed for driving on case of traffic congestion or slow traffic. ● The Lane Centring Guide must be activated:
paved roads only.  button > SETTINGS > Driver as-
Traffic Jam Assist is an additional function of sistance > Lane departure warning
● If the Lane Assist system does not work as
Lane Assist ››› page 230 and combines Lane (Lane Assist)
described in this chapter, do not use it and
Assist functions with Adaptive Cruise Control

Safety
contact a specialised workshop. ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) must be con-
(ACC) ››› page 221. Therefore, it is essential
● Before starting a journey, verify that the
that you read these two chapters carefully nected and active ››› page 224.
field of vision of the camera is not covered ● The speed must be below 60 km/h
and note the limitations of the systems and
››› Fig. 202. (38 mph). »
the information about them.

233
Operation

Traffic Jam Assist is not active (the Lane As- tem. Accidents and severe injury may occur if time. The driver is always responsible for
sist control light turns yellow) Traffic Jam Assist is used negligently or invol- keeping the vehicle in its own lane.
● If any of the conditions mentioned on untarily. The system is not a replacement for ● Always be prepared to take charge of driv-
page 233, Technical requirements for using driver awareness. ing (accelerating or braking) yourself.
Traffic Jam Assist are no longer met. ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
● If any of the conditions required for opera- vehicle in front of you at all times to suit the
Note
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
tion of the Lane Assist are not met tions. ● If Traffic Jam Assist does not work as de-
››› page 230. scribed in this chapter, stop using it and con-
● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist in city jour-
● If any of the conditions necessary for the neys. tact a specialised workshop.
adaptive cruise control (ACC) to work are no ● If the system is faulty, take it to a special-
● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist if there is poor
longer fulfilled ››› page 221. ised workshop and have it checked.
visibility, for example, in case of snow, ice,
rain or loose gravel, or on steep or slippery
Situations in which Traffic Jam Assist must sections or flooded roads.
be switched off ● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist offroad or on
Due to the limitations of the system, Traffic roads where the surface is not firm. Traffic
Emergency Assist
Jam Assist must always be switched off in the Jam Assist has been designed for use on
following situations: paved roads only. Description and operation
● Traffic Jam Assist does not react to people
● When more attention is required by the Emergency Assist detects whether there is in-
or animals or vehicles crossing your path or
driver. that approach you head-on down the same activity by the driver and can automatically
● When driving in a very sporty style. lane. keep the car within the lane and stop it alto-
gether if necessary. This way the system can
● In adverse weather conditions, e.g. in case ● If Traffic Jam Assist does not reduce speed
actively help avoid an accident.
of snow or heavy rain. sufficiently, brake the vehicle immediately by
applying the pedal. Emergency Assist is an additional function of
● When driving on roads in poor condition.
● If the vehicle continues to move when you Lane Assist ››› page 230 and combines Lane
● In sections with roadworks. wish it to stop after a driver intervention Assist functions with Adaptive Cruise Control
● In city journeys. prompt, brake the vehicle by applying the (ACC) ››› page 221. Therefore, it is essential
pedal. that you read these two chapters carefully
WARNING ● If driver intervention is requested on the and note the limitations of the systems and
dash panel display, immediately resume con- the information about them.
The smart technology incorporated into Traf-
trol of the vehicle.
fic Jam Assist cannot defy the laws of phys-
ics; it only works within the limits of the sys- ● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times
to be ready to intervene in the steering at any
234
Driver assistance systems

Operation of Emergency Assist ● The Lane Assist must be switched on visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-

Technical data
Emergency Assist detects when the driver ››› page 230. tions.
ceases to perform any activity and repeatedly ● The selector lever must be in the D/S posi- ● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times
requests that he/she regain active control of tion or in the Tiptronic selector gate. to be ready to intervene in the steering at any
the vehicle, through the use of optical and ● The system must have detected a lane sep- time.
acoustic warnings and by applying the aration line on both sides of the vehicle ● The Emergency Assist alone cannot always
brakes. ››› Fig. 204. avoid accidents or serious injuries.
If the driver continues to do nothing, the sys- ● If the operation of the Emergency Assist is

Advice
tem automatically takes over the accelerator, The following conditions may cause the impaired, for example if the radar sensor of
brakes and steering in order to brake the ve- Emergency Assist not to react or to switch off the adaptive cruise control (ACC) or the Lane
hicle and keep it in its lane ››› . When the automatically: Assist camera are covered or have lost their
settings, the system may intervene inoppor-
Emergency Assist is actively adjusting, the ● If the driver accelerates, brakes or moves tunely in braking or in steering.
hazard warning lights come on ››› page 149 the steering wheel.
● The Emergency Assist does not react to
and the vehicle makes slight zigzag move- ● If any of the conditions mentioned in

Operation
ments in the lane in order to warn other driv- people or animal or vehicles crossing your
››› page 235, Technical requirements for us- path or which approach you head-on in the
ers.
ing the Emergency Assist are not fulfilled. same lane.
If the remaining braking distance is suffi- ● If any of the conditions required for opera-
cient, if necessary the system slows down the tion of the Lane Assist are not met WARNING
vehicle until it stops completely and auto- ››› page 230.
matically switches on the electronic parking If the Emergency Assist Intervenes inoppor-

Emergencies
● If any of the conditions necessary for the tunely, serious accidents and injuries may oc-
brake ››› page 186.
adaptive cruise control (ACC) to work are no cur.
longer fulfilled ››› page 221. ● If the Emergency Assist does not operate
Switching the Emergency Assist on and off
properly, switch off the Lane Assist
The Emergency Assist is switched on auto- WARNING ››› page 230. Doing so will also switch off the
matically when the Lane Assist is switched on Emergency Assist.
The smart technology incorporated into the
››› page 230. Emergency Assist cannot overcome the limits ● Have the system checked by a specialised

Safety
imposed by the laws of physics; it only works workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT
Technical requirements for using the Emer- within the limits of the system. The driver is dealership for this. »
gency Assist responsible for driving the vehicle.
● The adaptive cruise control (ACC) must be ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
switched on ››› page 221. vehicle in front of you at all times to suit the

235
Operation

Note
● Automatic interventions by the Emergency
Assist on the brakes may be interrupted by
pressing the accelerator or brake or by mov-
ing the wheel.
● Hazard warning lights that come on auto-
matically can be switched off by pressing the
accelerator or the break, moving the steering
wheel or pressing the hazard warning light
switch.
● If this occurs, the Emergency Assist may
decelerate the vehicle until it comes to a com-
plete stop.
● When the Emergency Assist is activated, it
is only available again after the ignition has
been switched off and back on again.

236
Driver assistance systems

Blind spot detector (BSD) with alert are used negligently or involuntarily. CAUTION

Technical data
The system is not a replacement for driver
parking assistance (RCTA)* awareness.
● The radar sensors on the rear bumper may
be damaged or shifted in the event of a colli-
● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the sion, for example, when entering or exiting a
Related video vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi- parking space. This may result in the system
bility, weather, road and traffic conditions. disconnecting itself, or at least possibly hav-
● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times ing its functionality diminished.
to be ready to intervene in the steering at any ● In order to ensure that the radar sensors
time.

Advice
work properly, keep the rear bumper free of
● Pay attention to the control lamps that may snow and ice and do not cover it.
come on in the external rear view mirrors and ● The rear bumper should only be painted
Fig. 206 Smart solutions on the instrument panel, and follow any in- with paint authorised by SEAT. The blind spot
structions they may give. detector's functions may be limited or work
● The blind spot assistant could react to any incorrectly if other paints are used.

Operation
special constructions that might be present
Introduction
on the sides of the vehicle: e.g. high or irreg- Note
ular dividers. This may cause erroneous warn-
The blind spot detector (BSD) helps to detect If the blind spot detector with parking assis-
ings.
the traffic situation behind the vehicle. tant does not work as described in this chap-
● Never use the blind spot detector with rear
The integrated parking assistant (RCTA) helps ter, do not use it and contact a specialised
cross traffic alert on unpaved roads. The blind
the driver when backing out of a parallel workshop.

Emergencies
spot detector with rear cross traffic alert has
parking spot and in manoeuvring. been designed for use on paved roads.
The blind spot detector has been developed ● Always pay attention to the vehicle's sur-
for driving on paved roads. roundings. Control lamps
● Never use the blind spot detector or the
Control lamp in external rear view mirrors:
WARNING parking assistant if the radar sensors are
dirty.
The smart technology incorporated into the  Lights up
● The external rear view mirror control lamps

Safety
blind spot detector (BSD) with parking assis-
may have limited functionality due to solar Lights up once briefly: the blind spot detector is activa-
tance (RCTA) included cannot overcome the
radiation. ted and ready to operate.
limits imposed by the laws of physics; it only
works within the limits of the system. Acci- Lights up: blind spot detector has detected a vehicle in
dents and severe injury may occur if the blind the blind spot. »
spot detection system or the rear cross traffic

237
Operation

 Flashes CAUTION

The blind spot detector has detected a vehicle in the Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
blind spot and the turn signal has been turned on in the sponding text messages when they light up
direction of the detected vehicle ››› . may result in damage to the vehicle.

For vehicles that are also equipped with Lane Assist


››› page 230, a warning to switch lanes will also appear
even though the turn signal has not been engaged Blind spot detector (BSD)
(blind spot detector “Plus”).

Some warning and control lamps will light up


briefly when the ignition is switched on to Fig. 208 Rear view of the vehicle: radar sen-
check certain functions. They will switch off sor zones.
after a few seconds.
The blind spot detector uses radar sensors to
If there are no indications from the control monitor the areas behind the vehicle
lamp in the external rear view mirror, this ››› Fig. 208. The system does this by measur-
means that the blind spot detector has not ing the vehicle's distance from other vehicles
detected any other vehicles in the area ››› . and its speed differential. The blind spot de-
If the dipped beam is on, then the control tector will not work at speeds of less than ap-
lamps in the external rear view mirrors will be prox. 15 km/h (9 mph). The system uses opti-
dimmed (night mode). cal signals in the external rear view mirrors to
notify the driver.
WARNING
Indication in the external rear view mirrors
If the warning lamps and the corresponding
messages are ignored when they light up, the The control lamp (expanded view) provides
vehicle may stall in traffic and cause acci- an indication in the corresponding external
dents and severe injuries. mirror ››› Fig. 207 regarding the traffic situa-
● Never ignore the warning lamps or messag- tion behind the vehicle, if it is deemed to be
es. critical. The control lamp of the left-hand ex-
Fig. 207 In the exterior mirrors: indication of
● Carry out the necessary operations. ternal mirror indicates the traffic situation to
the blind spot detector.
the left of the vehicle, and the control lamp of
the right-hand external mirror indicates the
traffic situation to the right of the vehicle.

238
Driver assistance systems

In the case of retrofitted tinted windows or the outside ››› Fig. 208. The sensors monitor there are any), and can also detect stationary

Technical data
windows with tinted film, the indications of both the blind spot and traffic behind the ve- objects such as dividers, and thus give an in-
the external mirrors may not be seen clearly hicle ››› Fig. 209, ››› Fig. 210. The range to the correct indication.
or correctly. sides of the vehicle is a bit larger than the
width of a lane.
Keep the external mirrors clean and free of
snow and ice, and do not cover them with ad- The lane width is not detected individually,
hesives or other similar materials. but is rather pre-configured in the system.
Thus if you are driving in wide lanes or in be-

Advice
Radar sensors tween two lanes, the indications may be in-
correct. Furthermore, the system can detect
The radar sensors are located on the left and
vehicles driving in the lane next to you (if
right of the bumper and are not visible from

Operation
Emergencies
Safety
239
Operation

Driving situations

Fig. 209 Schematic diagram:  Passing sit-


uation with traffic behind the vehicle.  Indi-
cation from the blind spot detector in the left-
hand external mirror.

Fig. 210 Schematic diagram:  Situation of


passing and then moving into the right-hand
lane.  Indication from the blind spot detec-
tor in the right-hand external mirror.

In the following situations, an indication will ing at a considerably higher speed, no indi- Physical limitations inherent to the system
be displayed in the external mirror ››› Fig. 209 cation will be displayed. In some situations the blind spot detector
 (arrow) or ››› Fig. 210  (arrow): may not interpret the traffic situation correct-
The faster the vehicle approaches, the sooner
● When being overtaken by another vehicle an indication will be displayed in the external ly. E.g. in the following situations:
››› Fig. 209 . mirror, because the blind spot detector takes ● on tight bends;
● When overtaking another vehicle into account the speed differential with other
● in the case of lanes with different widths;
››› Fig. 210  with a speed differential of ap- vehicles. Thus even though the distance from
the other vehicle is identical, the indication ● at the top of slopes;
prox. 10 km/h (6 mph). If the vehicle is pass-
will appear sooner in some cases and later in ● in adverse weather conditions;
others.
240
Driver assistance systems

● in the case of special constructions to the If the system detects that someone else on You can interrupt the automatic braking by

Technical data
side of the vehicle, e.g., high or irregular di- the road is approaching the rear of the vehi- stepping hard on the accelerator pedal or the
viders. cle ››› Fig. 211, an acoustic alarm is heard. brake pedal in order to regain control of the
vehicle.
In addition to the acoustic alarm, the driver is
also informed by means of a visual signal on
Parking assistant (RCTA) WARNING
the radio screen. This signal is displayed in
the form of a red strip at the back of the im- The smart technology incorporated into the
age of the vehicle on the radio screen. This rear cross traffic alert cannot overcome the
limits imposed by the laws of physics; it only

Advice
strip displays the side of the vehicle towards
which traffic is approaching.1) works within the limits of the system. The
parking assistant function should not tempt
you into taking any risks. The system is not a
Automatic braking to reduce damages replacement for driver awareness.
If the rear cross traffic alert detects that ● The system should never be used in limited
someone else on the road is approaching the visibility conditions or complicated traffic,

Operation
rear of the vehicle and the driver does not e.g., in high-traffic areas or when crossing
step on the brake, the system will engage the multiple lanes.
brakes automatically. ● Be sure to always be aware of the vehicle's
The parking system helps the driver by auto- surroundings, since the system often fails to
Fig. 211 Schematic representation of the rear matically engaging the brakes to reduce any detect things such as bicycles or pedestrians.
cross traffic alert: zone monitored around the ● The rear cross traffic alert itself will not

Emergencies
damage. The system will brake automatically
vehicle exiting the parking space. if the vehicle is reversing at a speed of ap- brake the vehicle to a complete stop.
proximately 1-12 km (1-7 mph). Once it has
The parking assistant uses the radar sensors detected that the vehicle has stopped, the
on the rear bumper ››› Fig. 208 to monitor the system will keep the vehicle stopped for ap-
traffic crossing behind the vehicle as it backs prox. 2 seconds.
out of a parallel parking space or as it is be-
ing manoeuvred, for example in very low visi- After automatically braking to reduce dam-
age, the system will not be able to automati-

Safety
bility conditions.
cally brake again for approximately 10 sec-
onds.

1) It is only displayed if the vehicle is equipped with

a parking system.
241
Operation

Using the blind spot detector (BSD) Automatic deactivation of the blind spot de- SEAT Drive Profile*
with parking assistant (RCTA) tector (BSD)
The radar sensors of the blind spot detector Related video
Activating and deactivating the blind spot with rear cross traffic alert will be automati-
detector (BSD) with parking assistant (RCTA) cally deactivated when, among other rea-
The blind spot detector with parking assis- sons, one of the sensors is detected to be
tant can be switched on and off by accessing permanently covered. This may be the case if,
the Assistance systems menu on the for example, there is a layer of snow or ice in
dash panel display using the steering wheel front of one of the sensors.
Fig. 212 Autonomous
controls. If the vehicle is equipped with a The relevant text message will appear in the driving
multifunction camera, it can also be ac- dash panel display.
cessed by means of the driver assistance sys-
tems key located on the main beam head- Trailer mode
light lever. Introduction
The Blind spot detector and the rear cross
Open the Assistants menu. traffic alert will be automatically deactivated The SEAT Drive Profile enables the driver to
●  Blind spot and it will be impossible to activate them if choose between four profiles or modes, Eco,
the tow hitch is electrically connected to a Normal, Sport and Individual, that
●  Exit Assist trailer or other similar object. modify the behaviour of various vehicle func-
If the verification box on the control panel is tions, providing different driving experiences.
As soon as the driver starts to drive with a
checked , the functionality will be automat- trailer connected electrically to the vehicle, a In addition, the 4Drive version features the
ically activated at ignition. message will appear on the instrument panel Offroad and Snow profiles.
display indicating that the blind spot detec-
When the blind spot detector is ready to op- The Individual profile can be configured
tor and the rear cross traffic alert are deacti-
erate, the indications in the external mirrors according to personal preferences. The other
vated. Once the trailer has been unhitched
will turn on briefly as confirmation. profiles have a fixed configuration.
from the vehicle, if you want to use the blind
When the vehicle is restarted, the last adjust- spot detector and the rear cross traffic alert,
ment in the system will remain active. you will have to reactivate them in the corre-
sponding menu. Description
If the blind spot detector was automatically
deactivated, it will only be possible to restart If the towing hitch is not factory equipped, Depending on the equipment fitted in the ve-
the system after turning the vehicle off and then the blind spot detector and the rear hicle, SEAT Drive Profile can operate on the
restarting it. cross traffic alert will have to be deactivated following functions:
manually when driving with a trailer.
242
Driver assistance systems

Engine Adaptive cruise control (ACC) You can select the Eco, Normal, Sport, In-

Technical data
Depending on the profile selected, the en- The acceleration gradient of the adaptive dividual, Offroad1) and Snow1) profiles in
gine responds more spontaneously or more cruise control varies according to the active the following way:
in harmony with the movements of the accel- driving profile ››› page 221. ● Turn the Driving Experience button until the
erator. Additionally, when the Eco profile is required profile lights up on the Easy Con-
selected, the Start-Stop function is automati- Electronic stability control (ESC) nect system display as well as on the Driving
cally activated. Experience button ››› Fig. 213.
In the Offroad and Snow driving profiles,
In vehicles with automatic transmission, the the electronic stability Control (ESC) ● OR: select the required profile on the

Advice
gear change points are modified to position ››› page 189 adjusts to adapt to the terrain. touch-screen of the Easy Connect system, in
them in lower or higher engine speed ranges. the menu that opens up on turning the
In addition, hill descent control (HDC) is acti-
Additionally, the Eco profile activates the in- Driving Experience button.
vated in the Offroad profile ››› page 210.
ertia function, enabling consumption to be
further reduced. The features of each profile can be seen by
pressing the Profile information button of the
In manual gearbox vehicles, the Eco profile

Operation
Adjusting driving profile Easy Connect system display.
causes the gear change recommendation in-
dications that appear on the dash panel to In the Individual profile it is possible to
vary, facilitating more efficient driving. configure the characteristics of the vehicle
using the Profile setup button of the Easy
Address Connect system display.

Emergencies
The power steering varies its driving modes An icon on the Easy Connect system display
and adapts to the profile selected, thus offer- provides information about the active profile
ing the best behaviour for each situation. if it is different than Normal. The selector
identifies the profile chosen by means of a
Air conditioning red LED light. »
In vehicles with Climatronic, this can operate
in Eco mode, especially restricting fuel con- Fig. 213 Centre console: Driving Experience
button.

Safety
sumption.

1) Only for 4Drive models.


243
Operation

Driving ertheless, when the engine is restarted, the


Characteristics engine and the gear will not restart in the set-
profile
ting selected. For engine and gear to revert to
Places the vehicle in a particularly low the desired position, select the correspond-
state of consumption, facilitating a fuel- ing drive profile again or press the Easy Con-
Eco
saving driving style that is respectful to nect system button repeatedly.
the environment.
● When the vehicle is restarted after using
Offers a balanced driving experience, the Offroad or Snow settings, the system is
Normal
suitable for everyday use. always activated in the Normal profile.
Provides a complete dynamic perform- ● Your speed and driving style must always
Sport ance in the vehicle, enabling the user a be adjusted to visibility, weather, and traffic
more sporty driving style. conditions.
● The Eco profile is not recommended when
It allows you to personalise the configura-
Individ- tion. The functions that can be adjusted towing a vehicle.
ual depend on the equipment fitted in the ve-
hicle.

It adjusts the vehicle's parameters in or- Kick-down


Offroada)
der to maintain optimal off-road driving.
The Kick-down feature allows maximum ac-
It adjusts the vehicle's behaviour for driv- celeration to be reached.
Snowa) ing on slippery road surfaces, optimising
grip and manoeuvrability. If the Eco* profile has been selected in the
a)
SEAT Drive Profile ››› page 243 and the
Only for 4Drive models.
accelerator is pressed beyond a hard point,
the engine power is automatically controlled
WARNING
to give your vehicle maximum acceleration.
When operating SEAT Drive Profile, pay atten-
tion to all traffic: doing otherwise could cause WARNING
an accident.
Please note that if the road surface is slip-
pery or wet, the kick-down feature could
Note cause the driving wheels to spin, which could
● When the vehicle is switched off it will al- result in skidding.
ways store the driving profile that was selec-
ted when the ignition key was removed. Nev-
244
Driver assistance systems

Traffic sign detection system*1) ● Adapt your speed and driving style to suit ● Do not cover the field of vision of the cam-

Technical data
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi- era.
Introduction tions. ● Always replace damaged or worn blades
● Poor visibility, darkness, snow, rain and fog when required to avoid lines on the camera's
The traffic sign detection system records the may lead to the system failing to display traf- field of vision.
standard traffic signs in front of the vehicle fic signs or not displaying them correctly. ● Check that the windscreen is not damaged
with a camera located on the base of the in- ● If the camera's field of vision is dirty, cov- in the area of the camera's field of vision.
terior mirror and provides information about ered or damaged, system operation may be
speed limits and overtaking prohibitions. impaired.

Advice
Note
Within its limitations, the system also dis-
plays additional signals, such as time-specif- ● The use of outdated maps on the naviga-
WARNING
ic prohibitions, signs for vehicles towing trail- tion system may cause the system to show
ers ››› page 273 or limitations that only apply The driving recommendations and traffic indi- traffic signs incorrectly.
cations shown on the traffic sign detection ● In the waypoints mode of the navigation
in the event of rain. Even on journeys without
system may differ from the actual current system, the traffic sign detection system is

Operation
signs, the system may display any applicable
traffic situation. only partly available.
speed limits.
● The system may not detect or correctly
In Germany, on motorways and vehicle roads, show all the traffic signs.
besides speed limits and overtaking provi- ● Traffic signs and traffic regulations have
sions the system also displays the end of priority over the recommendations and dis-
prohibition signs. The valid speed limit at the plays provided by the system.

Emergencies
time in other countries is always shown.
Note
WARNING
In order not to compromise the system's op-
The technology in the traffic sign detection
eration, please take the following points into
system cannot change the limits imposed by
account:
the laws of physics and only works within the
system's limits. Do not let the extra conven- ● Regularly clean the area of vision of the
ience afforded by the traffic sign detection camera and keep it in a clean state, without

Safety
system tempt you into taking any risks when snow or ice.
driving. The system is not a replacement for
driver awareness.

1) System available depending on the country.


245
Operation

Indication on display Traffic sign de- Cause and solution WARNING


tection system If messages are ignored, the vehicle may stall
messages in traffic and cause accidents and severe inju-
ries.
There are no The system is booting up.
traffic signs OR ELSE: the camera has not rec- ● Never ignore the messages displayed.
available ognised any obligation or pro- ● Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity
hibition signs.
and in a safe place.
Error: Detec- There is a fault in the system.
tion of traffic Have the system checked by a Note
signs specialised workshop.
Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
Speed warning The speed warning function of sponding text messages when they light up
currently un- the traffic sign detection system may result in damage to the vehicle.
available. is faulty.
Have the system checked by a
specialised workshop.

Detection of The windscreen is dirty in the


Operation
traffic signs: camera area.
Clean the wind- Clean the windscreen. The traffic sign detection system does not
screen! work in all countries. Keep this in mind when
travelling abroad.
Detection of The navigation system is not
traffic signs: transmitting any data.
Limited at the Check that the navigation sys- Activating and deactivating traffic sign dis-
Fig. 214 On the instrument panel display: ex- play on the instrument panel
moment tem's maps are up-to-date.
amples of speed limits or overtaking prohibi-
OR ELSE: the vehicle is currently The permanent display of traffic signs on the
tions with their respective additional signs. in a region that is not included
in the navigation system's map.
instrument panel can be activated or deacti-
The traffic signs detected by the system are vated in the infotainment system using the
displayed on the dash panel display No data availa- The traffic sign detection system  button and the SETTINGS and
››› Fig. 214 and, depending on the navigation ble does not work in the current Driver Assistance function buttons.
country.
system fitted in the vehicle, on the infotain-
ment system as well ›››  page 33. Display of traffic signs
When the traffic sign detection system is con-
nected, a camera located on the base of the
interior rear-view mirror records the traffic
246
Driver assistance systems

signs in front of the vehicle. After checking Driver Assistance function buttons Limited operation

Technical data
and evaluating the information from the cam- ›››  page 33. The speed is adjusted in The traffic sign detection system has certain
era, the navigation system and the current steps of 5 km/h (3 mph) within a range of be- limitations. The following cases may lead the
vehicle data, up to three valid traffic signs tween 0 km/h (mph) and 20 km/h (12 mph) system to operate with limitations or not at
are displayed ››› Fig. 214 B in conjunction above the maximum speed permitted. all:
with their corresponding additional signs.
Trailer mode ● In the case of poor visibility, e.g. in snow,
First: The sign that is currently valid for the rain, fog or intense mist.
driver is shown in the left side of the In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket
device from the factory and a trailer that is ● In cases of dazzling, e.g. caused by head-

Advice
screen For example, a maximum speed
limit of 130 km/h (100 mph) electrically connected to the vehicle, it is pos- on traffic or by the sun.
››› Fig. 214 A. sible to activate or deactivate the display of ● When driving at high speeds.
specific traffic signs for vehicles with trailer,
Second: A sign valid only in certain circum- ● If the camera is covered or dirty.
such as speed limits or overtaking prohibi-
stances, e.g. 100 km/h (60 mph) is ● If the traffic signs are out of the camera's
tions. Activation or deactivation is performed
shown second, together with the addi- field of vision.

Operation
on the infotainment system using the
tional rain sign.  button and the SETTINGS and ● If the traffic signs are partially or totally
Additional sign: If the windscreen wiper is Driver Assistance function buttons covered, e.g. by trees, snow, dirt or other ve-
working while you are driving, the signal ›››  page 33. hicles.
with the additional rain sign will be
For trailer mode, the display of speed limits ● In the case of traffic signs that do not fulfil
shown first, on the left, as it is the one
applicable to the type of trailer or to the legal the regulations.
that is applicable at the time.

Emergencies
provisions can be adjusted. The speed is ad- ● In the case of damaged or bent traffic
Third: A sign valid only with restrictions, e.g. justed in steps of 10 km/h (5 mph) within a signs.
No overtaking at certain times, will be range of between 60 km/h (40 mph) and
displayed third ››› Fig. 214 C. 130 km/h (80 mph). If it is adjusted to a
● In the case of variable messages on over-
head or gantry signs (LED-based variable traf-
speed greater than that which is permitted in
Speed warning fic signs or other lighting units).
the country in question for driving with a
If the system detects that the permitted trailer, the system automatically displays the ● If the maps on the navigation system are
usual speed limits, e.g. in Germany 80 km/h not up-to-date.

Safety
speed is exceeded, it may warn the driver
with a “gong” and visually with a message (50 mph). ● In the case of adhesives affixed to vehicles
on the dash panel display. If the speed warning for the trailer is deacti- that depict traffic signs, e.g. speed limits on
vated, the system displays the speed limits lorries.
The speed warning can be adjusted or deacti-
vated completely in the infotainment system as if there were no trailer hitched.
using the  button and the SETTINGS and
247
Operation

Fatigue detection (break rec- Note shown for approximately 5 seconds, and de-
pending on the case, is repeated. The system
ommendation)* ● Fatigue detection has been developed for
stores the last message displayed.
driving on motorways and well paved roads
only. The message on the instrument panel display
Introduction
● If there is a fault in the system, have it can be switched off by pressing the 
The Fatigue detection informs the driver checked by a specialised workshop. button on the windscreen wiper lever or the
when their driving behaviour shows signs of button  on the multi function steering
fatigue. wheel ›››  page 36.
Function and operation The message can be recalled to the instru-
WARNING ment panel display using the multifunction
Do not let the comfort afforded by the Fatigue display ›››  page 36.
detection system tempt you into taking any
risks when driving. Take regular breaks, suffi- Conditions of operation
cient in length when making long journeys.
Driving behaviour is only calculated on
● The driver always assumes the responsibil- speeds above about 65 km/h (40 mph) up to
ity of driving to their full capacity. around 200 km/h (125 mph).
● Never drive if you are tired.
● The system does not detect the tiredness of Switching on and off
the driver in all circumstances. Consult the in- Fatigue detection can be activated or deacti-
formation in the section ››› page 248, System
vated in the Easy Connect system with the
limitations. Fig. 215 On the instrument panel display: fa-
 button and the SETTINGS function button
● In some situations, the system may incor- tigue detection symbol.
›››  page 33. A mark indicates that the ad-
rectly interpret an intended driving manoeu- justment has been activated.
vre as driver tiredness. Fatigue detection determines the driving be-
● No warning is given in the event of the ef-
haviour of the driver when starting a journey,
making a calculation of tiredness. This is System limitations
fect called microsleep!
constantly compared with the current driving The Fatigue detection has certain limitations
● Please observe the indications on the in-
behaviour. If the system detects that the driv- inherent to the system. The following condi-
strument panel and act as is necessary.
er is tired, an audible warning is given with a tions can limit the Fatigue detection or pre-
sound and an optic warning is shown with a vent it from functioning.
symbol and complementary message on the
instrument panel display ››› Fig. 215. The ● At speeds below 65 km/h (40 mph)
message on the instrument panel display is ● At speeds above 200 km/h (125 mph)
248
Driver assistance systems

● When cornering Introduction ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all

Technical data
● On roads in poor condition times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
The Park Assist system is an additional func- fic conditions.
● In unfavourable weather conditions
tion of ParkPilot ››› page 257 and helps the ● Certain surfaces of objects and garments
● When a sporty driving style is employed driver to: do not reflect the ultrasound sensors' sig-
● In the event of a serious distraction to the nals. The system cannot detect, at least cor-
● find a suitable parking space,
driver rectly, these objects or people wearing such
● select a parking mode, clothes.
Fatigue detection will be restored when the ● park driving in reverse in suitable perpen- ● Ultrasound sensor signals may be affected

Advice
vehicle is stopped for more than 15 minutes, dicular and parallel spaces, by external sound sources. In certain circum-
when the ignition is switched off or when the stances this may prevent them from detect-
● park driving forwards in suitable perpen-
driver has unbuckled their seat belt and ing people or objects.
opened the door. dicular spaces,
● The ultrasound sensors have blind spots in
● exit a parking space driving forwards from
In the event of slow driving during a long pe- which obstacles and people are not regis-
a parallel space. tered.

Operation
riod of time (below 65 km/h, 40 mph) the
system automatically re-establishes the tired- In vehicles with a Park Assist system and fac- ● Monitor the area around the vehicle at all
ness calculation. When driving at a faster tory radio the front, rear and side areas are times, since the ultrasound sensors do not
speed the driving behaviour will be recalcula- represented, and the position of obstacles is detect small children, animals or certain ob-
ted. jects in all situations.
shown relative to the vehicle.
The Park Assist system is subject to certain

Emergencies
WARNING
limitations inherent to the system and its use
Park Assist* requires special attention by the driver ››› . Quick turns of the steering wheel when park-
ing or exiting a parking space with Park As-
WARNING sist can cause serious injury.
Related video
● Do not hold the steering wheel during ma-
The technology used in the park assist sys-
noeuvres to park or exit a parking space until
tem involves a series of limitations inherent
the system requests it. Doing so disables the
in the actual system and in the use of ultra-
system during the manoeuvre, resulting in

Safety
sonic sensors. The use of Park Assist should
never tempt you to take any risk that may
the parking being cancelled. »
compromise safety. The system is not a re-
placement for driver awareness.
Fig. 216 Smart solutions
● Any accidental movement of the vehicle
could result in serious injury.
249
Operation

CAUTION ● If one of the ultrasonic sensors is damaged, Description of the Park Assist system
● In certain circumstances, the ultrasonic
the area corresponding to that group of sen-
sors (front or rear) is deactivated and cannot
sensors do not detect objects such as trailer
be activated until the fault is corrected. How-
tongues, bars, fences, posts or thin trees, or
ever, you can still use the sensors of the oth-
an open (or opening) rear lid, which could
er bumper as per usual. If there is a fault in
damage the vehicle.
the system, consult a specialist workshop.
● Retrofitting of certain accessories to the ve- SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership
hicle, such as a bicycle rack, may interfere for this.
with the operation of the Park Assist system
and cause damage.
Note
● The Park Assist system uses as a reference
parked vehicles, curbs and other objects. ● In order to guarantee good system opera-
Make sure that the tyres and wheels are not tion, keep the ultrasound sensors of the Fig. 217 At the top of the centre console: but-
damaged while parking. If necessary, oppor- bumper clean, free of snow or ice, and do not ton to switch on the Park Assist system.
tunely interrupt the parking manoeuvre to cover them with adhesives or other objects.
avoid damaging the vehicle. ● Certain sources of noise, such as rough as- The components of the Park Assist system
● The ultrasound sensors on the bumper may phalt or paving stones and the noise of other are the ultrasonic sensors located in the front
be damaged or shifted in the event of a colli- vehicles can induce the Park Assist system or and rear bumpers, the  button ››› Fig. 217
sion, for example, when entering or exiting a ParkPilot to give erroneous warnings. to switch the system on and off and the mes-
parking space. ● In order to become familiar with the system sages on the instrument panel display.
● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip- and its functions, SEAT recommends that you
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, do not practice operating the Park Assist system in Prematurely stopping or automatically inter-
apply it directly unless very briefly and al- an area where there is not too much traffic or rupting the manoeuvres for parking or exit-
ways from a distance of more than 10 cm. in a car park. ing a parking space
● A registration plate or plate holder on the Park Assist interrupts the manoeuvres for
front with larger than the space for the regis- parking or exiting a parking space in any of
tration plate, or a registration plate that is
the following cases:
curved or warped can cause:
– false detections, ● Press the  button.
– loss of sensor visibility. ● The speed exceeds approximately 7 km/h
– cancellation of the parking manoeuvre or (4 mph).
defective parking. ● The driver takes hold of the steering wheel.

250
Driver assistance systems

● The parking manoeuvre does not end with- While entering or exiting a parking space, a Trailer mode

Technical data
in approximately 6 minutes following activa- brief signal sounds to prompt the driver to The Park Assist system cannot be switched
tion of the automatic steering. change between forward and reverse gears on if the factory-fitted towing bracket
● There is a fault in the system (the system is (depending on the case). In successive ma- ››› page 273 is electrically connected to a
temporarily unavailable). noeuvres, the assistant tells the driver to trailer.
change gears, at the latest, when the contin-
● ASR is switched off.
uous audible signal is given (object present After changing a wheel
● ASR or ESC intervene with regulation. at a distance of ≤30 cm) by Park Pilot.
● The driver door is opened. If, after changing a wheel, the vehicle stops

Advice
When the Park Assist system turns the steer- entering and exiting parking spaces correctly,
ing wheel with the vehicle stationary, the in- the circumference of the new wheel may be
To restart the manoeuvre it is necessary that
strument panel also displays the symbol . different and the system may need to adapt
none of these things occur and that the 
Keep the brake pedal depressed while the to it. The adaptation is automatic and takes
button is pressed again.
symbol remains on the dash panel display to place during driving. Making turns slowly and
turn the wheels with the vehicle stopped. in both directions (20 km/h [12 mph]) for a
Special Characteristics

Operation
This way, the system will require fewer ma- few minutes may contribute to this adapta-
The Park Assist system is subject to certain noeuvres to complete the parking action. tion process ››› in Introduction on
limitations inherent to the system. For exam-
page 249.
ple, it is therefore not possible to enter or exit
a parking space on sharp bends.

Emergencies
Safety
251
Operation

Selecting a parking mode

Fig. 218 Overview of reduced displays for park-


ing modes:  Parallel parking in reverse.  Per-
pendicular parking in reverse.  Perpendicular
parking forwards.

mode is shown on the instrument panel dis- Action


play ››› Fig. 219. The reduced display of other
possible parking modes is also shown Turn on the corresponding turn signal towards
››› Fig. 218. If the mode selected by the sys- the side of the road where you are parking. The
instrument panel displays the side correspond-
tem does not correspond to the desired 3.
ing to the road. By default, if the turn signal is
mode, you can select another mode by press- not on, it parks on the right in the direction of
ing the  button ››› Fig. 217. traffic.

Action If necessary, press the  button again to change


to the next parking mode.
The necessary conditions to park with Park Assist 4.
1. Once you have switched to all possible parking
Fig. 219 On the instrument panel display: have to be met ››› page 254.
displaying the Park Assist system with re- modes, if the  button is pressed again, the
Press the  button. system switches off.
duced display.
A control lamp on the  button lights up when Press the  button again to switch the system
Selecting a parking mode with Park Assist 5.
2. the system is switched on. Additionally, the se- back on.
with prior step in front of the space lected parking mode is shown on the instrument
panel display and the reduced display shows an- Follow the instructions displayed on the instru-
After activating the Park Assist system and 6. ment panel while paying attention to traffic and
other parking mode it can be changed to.
after detecting a parking space, the display drive the vehicle past the parking space.
on the instrument panel proposes a parking
mode. The Park Assist system selects the
parking mode automatically. The selected
252
Driver assistance systems

Special case of perpendicular parking space Action

Technical data
to park forwards without driving past first
Press the  button once.
Action
A control lamp on the  button lights up when
The necessary conditions to park with Park Assist 3. the system is switched on. Additionally, the se-
1.
have to be met ››› page 254. lected parking mode is shown on the instrument
panel display without reduced display.
Drive forward towards the parking space while
2.
paying attention to traffic and stop the vehicle. Release the steering wheel ››› in Introduction
4.

Advice
on page 249.

Operation
Emergencies
Safety
253
Operation

Park with Park Assist

Fig. 220 On the instrument panel display: paral-


lel parking.  Finding a parking space.  Park-
ing position.  Manoeuvring.

Fig. 221 On the instrument panel display: per-


pendicular parking.  Finding a parking space.
 Parking position.  Manoeuvring.

Key to Fig. 220 and Fig. 221: Progress bars Necessary conditions to park with Park As-
1 Message to move forwards The progress bar sist
2 Your vehicle ››› Fig. 220 7 and ››› Fig. 221 7 on the For parallel parking For perpendicular
screen of the instrument panel displays the spaces parking spaces
3 Parked vehicle
relative distance to be covered. The greater
4 Parking space detected the distance, the fuller the progress bar. The traction control system (ASR) must be turned on
5 Message to park When driving forward, the content of the pro- ››› page 191.
gress bar decreases upwards, and when re-
6 Message to press the brake pedal
versing, it decreases downwards.
7 Progress bar
254
Driver assistance systems

For parallel parking For perpendicular Do the following: Do the following:

Technical data
spaces parking spaces
Please note the following message: Active au- Go forward until the ParkPilot continuous signal
Do not exceed approxi- Do not exceed approxi- tomatic steering. Watch out around is heard.
mately 40 km/h (25 mph) mately 20 km/h (12 mph) you.
OR: go forward until the instrument panel display
when driving past the when driving past the
While you keep watch around you, carefully start 9. shows the message to reverse.
parking space. parking space.
5. accelerating up to no more than 7 km/h (4 mph).
The Park Assist system steers the vehicle forward
Keep a distance between 0.5 and 2.0 metres when driv-
During the parking manoeuvre, the system only and back until it centres it in the space ››› Fig. 220
ing past the parking space.
 or ››› Fig. 221 .

Advice
takes charge of the steering. You, as the driver,
Length of the space: Width of the space: width have to accelerate, engage the clutch if necessa-
ry, change gears and brake. For best results, wait at the end of each manoeu-
length of the vehicle + of the vehicle + 0.8 me-
vre until the Park Assist system has finished turn-
0.8 metres tres
Reverse until the ParkPilot continuous signal is ing the steering wheel.
Do not exceed approximately 7 km/h (4 mph) when heard. 10.
The parking manoeuvre ends when a correspond-
parking.
OR: reverse until the instrument panel displays ing message is displayed on the instrument panel

Operation
the message to go forwards ››› Fig. 220  and, in some cases, an acoustic signal sounds.
Parking 6. or ››› Fig. 221 .

OR: reverse until the instrument panel displays Note


Do the following:
the message Park Assist finished.
If the manoeuvre is terminated prematurely
The necessary conditions have to be met to park during parking, the result may not be the
The progress bar 7 indicates the distance to
1. with Park Assist ››› page 254 and the parking best.

Emergencies
cover ››› page 254.
mode must be selected ››› page 252.
Press down the brake pedal until the Park Assist
Look at the display on the instrument panel to
system has finished turning the steering wheel.
see if the space has been detected as “appropri- 7.
ate” and if the correct position for parking has OR: until the  symbol on the instrument panel
2. been reached ››› Fig. 220  or ››› Fig. 221 . display switches off.
The space is considered “appropriate” if the dis- 8. Select first gear.
play on the instrument panel shows the message

Safety
to park 5 .

Stop the vehicle and, after a brief pause, engage


3.
the reverse gear.

Release the steering wheel ››› in Introduction


4.
on page 249.
255
Operation

Exiting a parking space with Park As- ● Do not exceed approximately 7 km/h
For parallel parking spaces
sist (only for parallel spaces) (4 mph) when exiting the parking space.
Reverse until the ParkPilot continuous signal is
Exiting a parking space heard.

Do the following: OR: reverse until the instrument panel display


7.
shows the message to go forward.
For parallel parking spaces The progress bar ››› Fig. 222 3 indicates the dis-
tance to cover ››› page 254.
The necessary conditions to exit a parking space
1.
with Park Assist have to be met ››› page 256. Press down the brake pedal until the Park Assist
system has finished turning the steering wheel.
2. Switch on the engine ››› page 181. 8.
OR: press down the brake pedal until the  sym-
Press the  button ››› Fig. 217. bol on the instrument panel display switches off.
Fig. 222 On the instrument panel display: ex- 3. A control lamp on the  button lights up when Go forward until the ParkPilot continuous signal
iting a parallel parking space. the system is switched on. is heard.
Turn on the corresponding turn signal towards OR: go forward until the instrument panel display
Key to the Fig. 222: 9.
4. the road you will enter when exiting the parking shows the message to reverse.
1 Parked vehicle space.
The Park Assist system steers the vehicle forward
2 Your vehicle in reverse gear Engage reverse gear or turn the selector lever to and back until it can exit the space.
5.
3 Progress bar to indicate the distance left position R.
The vehicle can exit the space when a corre-
to cover Release the steering wheel ››› in Introduction sponding message is displayed on the instru-
4 Message giving the proposed manoeuvre on page 249. ment panel and, in some cases, an acoustic sig-
to exit the parking space 10. nal sounds.
Please note the following message: Active
automatic steering. Watch out around Take charge of the steering with the turning an-
Necessary conditions to exit a parking space you. gle set by the Park Assist system.
with Park Assist 6. While you keep watch around you, carefully start Paying attention to the traffic, exit the parking
● Only for parallel parking spaces 11.
accelerating up to no more than 7 km/h (4 mph). space.
● The traction control system (ASR) must be
When exiting the parking space, the system only
turned on ››› page 191. takes charge of the steering. You, as the driver,
● Length of the space: length of the vehicle have to accelerate, engage the clutch if necessa-
+ 0.5 metres ry, change gears and brake.

256
Driver assistance systems

Automatic braking intervention by WARNING During parking, Parking System Plus assists

Technical data
Park Assist the driver by visually and audibly warning
The automatic braking intervention by Park them about obstacles detected in front of
Assist should never tempt you to take any
Park Assist helps the driver by automatically and behind the vehicle.
risk that may compromise safety. The system
braking in certain situations. is not a replacement for driver awareness. There are ultrasound sensors integrated in
The driver is always responsible for braking ● The Park Assist system is subject to certain the front and rear bumpers. When they detect
in time ››› . limitations inherent to the system. In certain an obstacle, you are alerted by audible warn-
situations, the automatic braking interven- ings and visually on the Easy Connect sys-

Advice
Automatic braking intervention to avoid ex- tion may only work in a limited way or not tem.
ceeding the speed limit work at all.
In the event of danger of a frontal collision,
● Always be ready to use the brakes yourself!
To avoid exceeding the speed limit of approx- the audible warnings come from the front of
imately 7 km/h (4 mph) when entering or ● The automatic braking intervention will end the vehicle, and in the event of the danger of
leaving a parking space, the brakes may acti- after approximately 1.5 seconds. Following a rear-end collision they come from the rear.
vate automatically. After automatically acti- this, brake the vehicle yourself.

Operation
Make particularly sure that the sensors are
vating the brakes, the manoeuvres to enter or not covered by adhesives, residues and the
exit a parking space may continue. like, as this could affect the system's opera-
The brakes are only automatically activated Parking System Plus (ParkPi- tion. Cleaning instructions ››› page 287.
once for each attempt to enter or exit a park- lot)* The approximate measurement range of the
ing space. If the speed of approximately sensors is:

Emergencies
7 km/h (4 mph) is exceeded again, the corre-
sponding operation is halted. Description A 1.20 m
B 1.60 m
Automatic braking to reduce damages
C 0.90 m
Depending on certain conditions, the Park
Assist system can automatically brake the ve- As you approach the obstacle, the time inter-
hicle when faced with an obstacle, briefly ac- val between the audible warnings will be re-
tioning and holding down the brake ped- duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the

Safety
al ››› . Following this the driver must press warning will be constant: do not continue to
the brake pedal. move forward (or backward)!
Automatic braking intervention to reduce If you maintain separation from the obstacle,
damage leads to the parking manoeuvre fin- the volume of the warning begins to reduce »
ishing. Fig. 223 Represented area.
257
Operation

after four seconds (does not affect the tone ● The ultrasound sensors have blind spots in the sensors as the car moves closer, so the
of the constant warning). which obstacles and people are not regis- system will not give any further warning. In
In order to view the entire periphery of the ve- tered. Pay special attention to children and certain circumstances, objects such as high
animals. kerbs that could damage the bottom of the
hicle, the vehicle must be moved a few me-
● Always keep visual control of the vehicle vehicle are not detected either.
tres forwards and backwards. Thus, the miss-
ing areas are screened and obstacles at the surroundings: use the mirrors for additional ● If the first warning from the ParkPilot is ig-
sides of the vehicle are displayed help. nored, the vehicle could suffer considerable
damage.
››› Fig. 223 C .
CAUTION ● The knocks or damage on the radiator
Special features of ParkPilot with Area View grille, bumper, wheel arch and vehicle under-
Parking Aid functions may be negatively af- body can adjust the orientation of the sen-
In the following situations the screened area fected by different factors that may lead to sors. This can affect the parking aid function.
on the side of the vehicle is automatically damage to the vehicle or its immediate sur- In this case, have the function checked by a
hidden: rounds: specialised workshop.
● Under certain circumstances, the system ● A registration plate or plate holder on the
● When a vehicle door is opened. does not detect or display certain objects: front with larger than the space for the regis-
● When the ASR is switched off. – Objects such as chains, trailer draw bars, tration plate, or a registration plate that is
● When there is ASR or ESC regulation. fences, posts and thin trees. curved or warped can cause:
● If the vehicle remains stationary for more – Objects that are located above the sen- – false detections,
sors, such as protrusions in a wall. – loss of sensor visibility.
than approximately 3 minutes.
– Objects with certain surfaces or struc-
WARNING tures, such as wire mesh fences or pow-
Note
der snow.
● Always pay attention, also when looking ● In certain situations, the system can give a
● Certain surfaces of objects and garments
straight ahead, to traffic and the vehicle sur- warning even though there is no obstacle in
roundings. The assistance systems are not a do not reflect the ultrasound sensors' sig-
nals. The system cannot detect these objects the detected area, e.g:
replacement for driver awareness. When in-
serting or removing the vehicle from a park- or people wearing such clothes correctly. – with rough or cobbled floors or ground
ing space, or when performing similar ma- ● Ultrasound sensor signals may be affected with long grass;
noeuvres the driver always assumes the re- by external sound sources. In certain circum- – with external ultrasound sources, such as
sponsibility. stances this may prevent them from detect- cleaning vehicles or other vehicles equip-
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all ing people or objects. ped with ultrasound systems;
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf- ● Please note that low obstacles detected by – in downpours, intense snow, hail or
fic conditions. the system may no longer be registered by dense exhaust gases,

258
Driver assistance systems

– if the number plate is not perfectly se- Parking Aid operation 10 km/h (6 mph) ››› page 260. The obstacle

Technical data
cured to the bumper surface, is detected as of a distance of approx. 95 cm
– or in locations such as the brow of a hill.
if the automatic connection is activated in
the infotainment system. A reduced display is
● In order to guarantee good system opera-
shown.
tion, keep the ultrasound sensors clean, free
of snow or ice, and do not cover them with ● OR: If the vehicle moves backwards.
adhesives or other objects.
● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip- Automatic disconnection of Parking Aid

Advice
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, apply ● Move the selector lever to position P.
it directly only very briefly and always from a
● OR: accelerate to more than approx.
distance of more than 10 cm.
10 km/h (6 mph) forward.
● Retrofitting of accessories to the vehicle,
such as a bicycle rack, may interfere with the Fig. 224 Centre console: Park Assist button
(depending on the version). Temporary suppression of sound in Parking
operation of the Parking Aid.
Aid

Operation
● Fitting certain accessories to the front of
Manual connection of Parking Aid ● Press the  function button.
the vehicle, such as a plate holder with ad-
vertising, may interfere with the operation of ● Press the  button once.
the Park Assist. Change from reduced view to full view
● In order to familiarise yourself with the sys- Manual disconnection of Parking Aid ● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
tem, it is advised that you practice parking in ● Press the  button again. lever to position R.

Emergencies
an area or car park that is free from traffic.
● OR: press the car icon in reduced view.
There must be good weather and light condi-
tions. Manual disconnection of Parking Aid display
(the audible sounds remain active) If necessary, switch to the rear-assist image
● The volume and tone of the warnings can
be modified, in addition to the indications ● Press a button on the main menu of the fac- (Rear View Camera “RVC”)
››› page 265. tory-assembled infotainment system. ● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
● In vehicles without an infotainment system, ● OR: press the BACK function button. lever to position R.
these parameters can be modified in a SEAT ● OR: Press the RVC function button.

Safety
Official Service or in a specialised workshop. Automatic connection of Parking Aid
● Please observe information on towing a A short confirmation signal will be heard and
● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
trailer ››› page 265. the button symbol will light up yellow when
lever to position R.
● The display on the Easy Connect screen the system is switched on.
● OR: If the vehicle approaches an obstacle
shows a slight time delay.
that is in its forwards path at a speed below
259
Operation

Automatic activation ● OR: accelerate above 10 km/h (6 mph) be- Segments of the visual indication
fore reducing speed below this number
again.
● OR: place the selector lever in position P
and then move it from this position.
● OR: switch on and off the automatic activa-
tion in the Easy Connect system menu.

The automatic activation with parking aid


miniature indication can be switched on and
off from the Easy Connect system menu
›››  page 33:
Fig. 225 Miniature indication of automatic ac- Fig. 226 Parking Aid display on the Easy Con-
● Switch the ignition on.
tivation. nect system screen.
● Select:  button > Settings > Parking
When the Parking System Plus is switched on and manoeuvring. The distance of separation from the obstacle
automatically, a miniature of the vehicle will ● Select the Automatic activation op- can be estimated using the segments around
be displayed and the segments will be tion. When the function button check box is the vehicle.
shown on the left side of the screen activated , the function is on. The optical indication of the segments works
››› Fig. 225.
as follows:
Automatic activation occurs when slowly ap- If the system has been activated automatical-
proaching an obstacle located in front of the ly, an audible sound warning will only be giv- White segments: they are displayed when
vehicle. It only operates every time the speed en when obstacles in front are at a distance the obstacle is not within the vehicle's
is reduced below approximately 10 km/h (6 of less than 50 cm. trajectory or the direction of travel is in
mph) for the first time. the opposite direction to its location,
CAUTION and also when the electronic parking
If the parking aid is switched off using the  brake is activated.
The automatic connection of the Parking Aid
button, the following actions must be carried only works when you are driving slowly. If Yellow segments: obstacles located in the
out in order for it to automatically switch on: driving style is not adapted to the circum- vehicle's trajectory and which are more
● Switch off the ignition and switch it on
stances, an accident and serious injury or than 30 cm away from the vehicle are
damage may be caused. displayed in yellow.
again.

260
Driver assistance systems

Red segments: obstacles that are less than Automatic activation ing aid error is displayed on the instrument

Technical data
30 cm away from the vehicle are dis-  on – activates the Automatic activa- panel, there is a fault in the system.
played in red. tion option ››› page 260. If the fault does not disappear before discon-
Moreover, with the SEAT Media System  off – deactivates the Automatic ac- necting the ignition, the next time that the
Plus/Navi System/Navi System Plus radios, a tivation option ››› page 260. parking aid is engaged in reverse, no audible
yellow trail indicates the vehicle's expected signal of the existence of a fault will be is-
trajectory based on the steering angle. Front volume* sued.

Whenever the obstacle is located in the vehi- Volume in the front and rear area. If there is a fault in the parking aid system a

Advice
cle’s direction of travel, the corresponding message will appear on the instrument panel
audible warning will sound. Front sound settings/sharpness* indicating the error. In addition the  key
LED will blink.
As the vehicle approaches an obstacle, the Frequency (tone) of the sound in the front
segments are displayed closer to the vehicle. area. If there is a fault in a sensor, the symbol  is
When the penultimate segment is displayed, displayed on the Easy Connect display in

Operation
this means that the vehicle has reached the Rear volume* front of/behind the vehicle. If a rear sensor is
collision zone. In the collision zone, the ob- faulty, only the obstacles in area A are dis-
Volume in the rear area. played ››› Fig. 223. If a front sensor is faulty,
stacles are represented in red, including
those out of the path. Do not continue to only the obstacles in area B are displayed.
Rear sound settings/sharpness*
move forward (or backward) ››› in Descrip- Have the fault corrected by a specialised
tion on page 258, ››› in Description on Frequency (tone) of the sound in the rear workshop without delay.

Emergencies
page 258 ! area.
In the event the car is equipped with the Top
Adjust volume
View Camera system, Park Assist visual guid-
ance will appear in accordance with the view With the parking aid switched on, the active
selected in the Top View Camera system. audio/video source volume will be reduced
to the intensity of the selected setting.

Safety
Adjusting the display and audible
warnings Error messages

The settings for the display and audible When the Parking Aid is activated or when it
warnings are controlled via the Easy Con- is switched on, if a message reporting a Park-
nect*.
261
Operation

Driving with a trailer Braking while manoeuvring function* on the Parking System screen of the Easy
3 Only valid with Parking System Plus
Connect system.
● Whenever any of the car doors, rear lid or
As soon as an obstacle is detected while re- bonnet are opened.
versing, the braking while manoeuvring func-
tion activates the emergency braking. De-
pending on the equipment, the braking while
manoeuvring function can also activate Parking aid (Park Pilot)*
emergency braking while moving forwards.
The emergency braking function is used to Description
minimise collisions. Vehicle speed must not
Assorted assistance systems – which vary
be higher than 10 km/h.
Fig. 227 ParkPilot display on the screen with
depending on the equipment fitted in the car
trailer attached. The braked manoeuvre function is active or – will help you when parking or manoeu-
inactive when the parking light is lit or off, re- vring.
In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket spectively. If an emergency braking is activa-
The rear parking aid is an audible assistant
device from the factory, when the trailer is ted, the function will remain inactive until the
that warns of obstacles located behind the
connected electrically, the Parking Aid rear gear is changed.
vehicle.
sensors will not be activated when reverse The Parking System’s limitations apply.
gear is engaged, when the selector lever is There are sensors integrated in the rear
turned to position R or when the button  is The braking while manoeuvring function is bumper. When they detect an obstacle, you
pressed. controlled in the Easy Connect system with are alerted by audible warnings and visually
the  button and the SETTINGS and on the Easy Connect system.
The distance to possible obstacles at the rear Park and manoeuvre function buttons.
of the vehicle and at its sides will not be dis- If the Top View Camera* is installed, the rear
played on the screen and will not be indica- ●  on – permits the use of the braking parking aid will issue an audible warning
ted by means of audible sound signals. while manoeuvring function. about objects near the rear of the vehicle,
and the Top View Camera* image will be
The Easy Connect system screen will only dis- ●  off – does not permit the use of the
available on the Easy Connect screen, giving
play objects detected at the front, and the ve- braking while manoeuvring function.
a real image of the objects around the car.
hicle's trajectory will be hidden.
Temporary suppression of emergency brak- Make particularly sure that the sensors are
ing not covered by adhesives, residues, dirt and
● When the function is deactivated with the
the like, as this could affect the system's op-
eration. Cleaning instructions ››› page 287.
Braking while manoeuvring button that appears
262
Driver assistance systems

The approximate measurement range of the ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all stances this may prevent them from detect-

Technical data
rear sensors is: times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf- ing people or objects.
fic conditions. ● Please note that low obstacles detected by
side area 0.60 m ● The ultrasound sensors have blind spots in the system may no longer be registered by
central area 1.60 m which obstacles and people are not regis- the sensors as the car moves closer, so the
tered. Pay special attention to children and system will not give any further warning. In
As you approach the obstacle, the time inter- animals. certain circumstances, objects such as high
val between the audible warnings will be re- ● Always keep visual control of the vehicle kerbs that could damage the bottom of the
surroundings: use the mirrors for additional vehicle are not detected either.
duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the

Advice
warning will be constant: Do not continue to help. ● If the first warning from the ParkPilot is ig-
move forward (or backward) ››› , ››› ! nored, the vehicle could suffer considerable
damage.
If you maintain separation from the obstacle, CAUTION
● The knocks or damage on the radiator
the volume of the warning begins to reduce Parking Aid functions may be negatively af- grille, bumper, wheel arch and vehicle under-
after four seconds (does not affect the tone fected by different factors that may lead to body can adjust the orientation of the sen-

Operation
of the constant warning). damage to the vehicle or its immediate sur- sors. This can affect the parking aid function.
rounds: In this case, have the function checked by a
Activating/Deactivating ● Under certain circumstances, the system specialised workshop.
does not detect or display certain objects:
When engaging reverse gear, the parking aid
is automatically switched on. This is con- – Objects such as chains, trailer draw bars, Note
firmed with a short warning. fences, posts and thin trees.

Emergencies
● In certain situations, the system can give a
– Objects that are located above the sen-
On disengaging reverse gear, the parking aid warning even though there is no obstacle in
sors, such as protrusions in a wall. the detected area, e.g:
system is switched off.
– Objects with certain surfaces or struc- – with rough or cobbled floors or ground
tures, such as wire mesh fences or pow- with long grass;
WARNING
der snow.
● Always pay attention, also when looking – with external ultrasound sources, such as
● Certain surfaces of objects and garments
straight ahead, to traffic and the vehicle sur- cleaning vehicles or other vehicles equip-
do not reflect the ultrasound sensors' sig- ped with ultrasound systems;

Safety
roundings. The assistance systems are not a nals. The system cannot detect these objects
replacement for driver awareness. When in- or people wearing such clothes correctly. – in downpours, intense snow, hail or
serting or removing the vehicle from a park- dense exhaust gases,
ing space, or when performing similar ma- ● Ultrasound sensor signals may be affected
by external sound sources. In certain circum- – if the number plate is not perfectly se-
noeuvres the driver always assumes the re- cured to the bumper surface, »
sponsibility.

263
Operation

– or in locations such as the brow of a hill. Parking Aid operation Switch from reduced to full-screen view if the
rear assist is fitted (Rear View Camera
● In order to guarantee good system opera-
Manual disconnection of Parking Aid display “RVC”)
tion, keep the ultrasound sensors clean, free
of snow or ice, and do not cover them with (the audible sounds remain active) ● Press the car icon in the reduced view.
adhesives or other objects. ● Press a button on the main menu of the fac-
● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip- tory-assembled infotainment system. If necessary, switch to the rear-assist image
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, apply ● OR: press the BACK function button. (Rear View Camera “RVC”)
it directly only very briefly and always from a ● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
distance of more than 10 cm.
Parking Aid connection lever to position R.
● Retrofitting of accessories to the vehicle,
● Engage reverse (for manual gears) or set ● OR: press the RVC function icon.
such as a bicycle rack, may interfere with the
operation of the Parking Aid. the selector lever to R (for automatic gears).
● In order to familiarise yourself with the sys-
tem, it is advised that you practice parking in
Parking Aid disconnection Segments of the visual indication
an area or car park that is free from traffic. ● Place the selector level in position P, N or D
There must be good weather and light condi- (for automatic gearboxes) or disengage re-
tions. verse (for manual gearboxes). If you set the
● The volume and tone of the warnings can lever to N or D, the system will remain active
be modified, in addition to the indications for approximately 8 seconds before switching
››› page 265. off, except with Top View Camera*, when it
● In vehicles without an infotainment system, will be switched off immediately after engag-
these parameters can be modified in a SEAT ing reverse.
Official Service or in a specialised workshop.
● Please observe information on towing a Temporary suppression of sound in Parking
trailer ››› page 265. Aid
● The display on the Easy Connect screen ● Press the  function button. If you have the Fig. 228 Parking Aid display on the Easy Con-
shows a slight time delay. Top View Camera* system installed, you can- nect system screen.
not use the temporary suppression of sound
in Parking Aid. The distance to the obstacles can be estima-
ted with the help of the segments at the rear
of the vehicle.
The optical indication of the segments works
as follows:
264
Driver assistance systems

White segments: they are displayed if the available on the screen, giving a real image aid is engaged in reverse, no audible signal

Technical data
obstacle is not in the vehicle's direction of the objects around the car. of the existence of a fault will be issued.
of travel, even when the electronic park-
If there is a fault in a sensor, the  symbol is
ing brake is activated.
displayed on the Easy Connect display.
Yellow segments: obstacles located in the Adjusting the display and audible
Have the fault corrected by a specialised
vehicle's trajectory and which are more warnings
than 30 cm away from the vehicle are workshop without delay.
displayed in yellow. The settings for the display and audible
warnings are controlled via the Easy Con-

Advice
Red segments: obstacles that are less than
30 cm away from the vehicle are dis- nect*. Towing bracket
played in red.
Rear volume* In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket
Whenever the obstacle is located in the vehi- device from the factory, when the trailer is
Volume in the rear area. connected electrically, the Parking Aid rear
cle’s direction of travel, the corresponding
audible warning will sound. sensors will not be activated when reverse

Operation
Rear sound settings/sharpness* gear is engaged (manual gears) nor when the
As the vehicle approaches an obstacle, the Frequency (tone) of the sound in the rear selector lever is turned to position R (auto-
segments are displayed closer to the vehicle. area. matic gears).
When the penultimate segment is displayed,
this means that the vehicle has reached the Adjust volume
collision zone. In the collision zone, the ob-

Emergencies
stacles are represented in red, including With the parking aid switched on, the active Top View Camera*
those out of the path. Do not continue to re- audio/video source volume will be reduced
verse ››› in Description on page 263, ››› to the intensity of the selected setting. Related video
in Description on page 263 !

If you are equipped with the Top View Error messages


Camera*
When the Parking Aid is activated or when it

Safety
Segments are not displayed when the vehicle
is switched on, if a message reporting a Park-
is equipped with Top View Camera*.
ing aid error is displayed on the instrument
The PDC system will issue an audible warning panel, there is a fault in the system. Fig. 229 Smart solutions
for objects that are near the rear of the vehi-
If the fault disappears before disconnecting
cle, and the Top View Camera* image will be
the ignition, the next time that the parking
265
Operation

Introduction the limits imposed by the laws of physics and ● The system displays the auxiliary lines and
it only works within the limits of the system. boxes regardless of the vehicle's environ-
Using 4 cameras, the system generates a rep- The greater convenience provided by the Area ment, no objects are detected. The driver is
resentation that is shown on the infotain- View system should never tempt you to take responsible for determining that the vehicle
ment system display. The cameras are loca- any risk that may compromise safety. If used will fit in the parking space.
ted on the radiator grille, the exterior mirrors negligently or involuntarily, it may cause se-
and the rear lid. rious accidents and injuries. The system is
CAUTION
not a replacement for driver awareness.
The functions and representations of the In order to guarantee good system operation,
● Adapt your speed and driving style to suit
Area View system may vary depending on keep the cameras clean, free of snow or ice,
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
whether or not the vehicle has ParkPilot. tions. and do not cover them with adhesives or oth-
er objects.
● Do not be distracted from the traffic by
WARNING ● Never use abrasive cleaning products to
looking at the screen.
The image from the cameras does not make it clean the camera lenses.
● Monitor the area around the vehicle at all
possible to calculate the distance to the ob- ● Do not use hot or warm water to remove ice
times, since the cameras do not capture small
stacles (people, vehicles, etc.) precisely, so or snow from the camera lenses. Doing so
children, animals and certain objects in all
using them could cause serious accidents could damage the lenses.
situations.
and injury.
● The use of a number plate may interfere in
● The camera lenses augment and distort the
the views shown on the screen, since the
visual field and the objects on the screen are
cameras' field of vision may be reduced. Area View system
seen differently and imprecisely.
● The system will probably be unable to rep-
● Certain objects may not be shown or may
resent all areas clearly.
not be shown very clearly, for example, posts
or thin rails, due to the screen resolution or if
light conditions are insufficient. CAUTION
● The cameras have blind spots in which ob- ● The camera images are only two-dimen-
stacles and people are not registered. sional. Due to a lack of spatial depth, objects
● The camera lens must be kept free, without that jut out or holes on the road, for example,
snow or ice, and should not be covered. are more difficult to detect or may not be
seen at all.
● In certain circumstances, the camera does
WARNING
not capture objects such as beams, fences,
The smart technology incorporated into the posts or thin trees, which could damage the Fig. 230 Display of the Area View system: aer-
Top View Camera* system cannot overcome vehicle. ial view.

266
Driver assistance systems

There are four different views to choose from: ● The image must be reliable and clear. For ● Rear camera (rear view): To observe traffic

Technical data
this reason, for example, the camera lens behind the vehicle (vehicles crossing) , for
Key to the Fig. 230: must be clean. reverse perpendicular parking , for reverse
● The area around the vehicle must be clearly parallel parking  and for hitching a trailer
Symbol Meaning to the vehicle .
and totally visible.
A Front camera area ● The area for parking or manoeuvring The selected view is displayed on the right
should be a flat surface. side of the screen. The reduced aerial view
B Right camera area
● The vehicle should not be loaded very shown on the right side displays the view

Advice
C Rear camera area heavily at the rear. framed in yellow. In addition, the right mar-
● The driver must be used to the system.
gin of the screen displays the menu options
D Left camera area possible and the views (the so-called
● There should be no damage to the vehicle “modes”) of the camera in question. The ac-
 Exit the current display. in the camera area. If the position or installa- tive view (mode) at the time is highlighted.
tion angle of the cameras have been
 Three-dimensional views The reduced aerial view can be hidden by

Operation
changed, e.g. after a rear-end collision, the
system should be checked by a specialised pressing the  symbol to thus display the se-
Depending on the equipment: connect-
workshop. lected view full-screen.
 ing and disconnecting the ParkPilot
sound.
Camera image view
Setting the display: brightness, contrast
 and colour. ● Aerial view (bird's eye view): to obtain a

Emergencies
panoramic view of the vehicle , three-di-
The aerial view is generated by combining mensional views, from different camera posi-
the images from all the cameras  tions.
››› Fig. 230. The aerial view can be selected ● Front Camera (front view): to observe traffic
by pressing the vehicle in the area. ahead of the vehicle (vehicles crossing) ,
Select the corresponding view by pressing for front parallel parking , when approach-
the different areas ››› Fig. 230 A to D of the ing an obstacle and in off-road driving .

Safety
aerial view or the reduced aerial view. ● Side cameras (side view): to view the area
close to the sides of the vehicle, both on the
Conditions necessary for the use of the Area left  and on the right , or a combination of
View system both sides .
● The doors and the rear lid must be closed.

267
Operation

Instructions for use Connecting and disconnecting the Area View Examples of optical illusions caused by the
system cameras:
Press the  button ››› Fig. 231 – If the vehicle approaches protruding objects. These
again. objects may be outside the cameras' angle of visibility.
Manual discon-
OR: press a button on the factory-
nection of the Trailer mode
equipped infotainment system, for
display:
example the RADIO button.
The Area View system conceals, in the rear
OR: press the function button  . camera area, all the auxiliary guiding lines
when the factory-fitted towing bracket is con-
Drive forward at more than approx. nected electrically to a trailer ››› page 273.
Automatic dis- 15 km/h (9 mph).
Fig. 231 Centre console: button for activat- connection of OR: switch the ignition off. The Area Note
ing/deactivating the Area View system man- the display: View system menu disappears imme-
In order to become familiar with the system
ually in combination with the parking aid sys- diately.
and its functions, SEAT recommends that you
tem () or else with the rear ParkPilot system
practice handling the Area View system in an
(). Special characteristics area where there is not too much traffic or in
a car park.
Connecting and disconnecting the Area View Examples of optical illusions caused by the
system cameras:

Press the  button ››› Fig. 231 once. The images on the area view system cameras are only
two-dimensional. Due to a lack of spatial depth, it is dif-
Manual con- The infotainment system screen dis- ficult or impossible to make out on-screen any holes
nection of the plays the aerial view ››› Fig. 230. If there may be on the ground, objects jutting out from the
display: you press the  button when driving ground or parts protruding from other vehicles.
above 15 km/h (9 mph), the image
will not be displayed. Situations in which the objects or other vehicles appear
to be further away or closer than they really are:
Engage reverse gear.
OR: The vehicle moves backwards. – On moving from a horizontal plane to a slope.
Automatic con-
nection of the The view of the image of the vehicle's – On moving from a slope to a horizontal plane.
display: rear camera is shown in parallel park-
– If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the rear.
ing mode with the reduced aerial
view.

268
Driver assistance systems

Top View Camera system menus (modes)

Technical data
Advice
Fig. 232 Display on the Area View system
screen:  Front camera: off-road view  Rear
camera: off-road view

Key to the Fig. 232: Aerial views (bird's eye view) Front camera views (front view)

Operation
Symbol Meaning View On-screen display of all cameras On-screen display of the front
View
camera
Depending on the equipment: connect- Main The vehicle and its immediate vicinity
 ing and disconnecting the ParkPilot mode seen from above are shown. Depending Left area of the screen: street to the left.
sound. on the equipment, the ParkPilot's path Cross traffic
 may also be displayed.
at the front
Central area of the screen: area directly
in front of the vehicle.
 Showing the reduced display.

Emergencies
The vehicle and its vicinity seen
 from above are shown.
 Right area of the screen: street to the
 Hiding the reduced display.
right.
Three-di- The vehicle and its vicinity seen
 Exiting the Area View system screen:
mensional  from above are shown oblique- Parallel park-
The area in front of the vehicle is
Setting the display: brightness, contrast views ly. ing shown. Orientation lines are shown to
 and colour. give guidance.
The vehicle and its vicinity seen 
 obliquely are shown.
The area directly in front of the vehicle

Safety
seen from above is shown. For example,
Swipe the infotainment system display with Off-road on a slope, in order to see the area di-
your finger in the direction of the arrows to rectly in front of the vehicle. The red line
change the angle of vision in the three-di-  is shown at a distance of approx. 0.4 m
mensional views of the vehicle and its vicini- from the vehicle. »
ty.
269
Operation

Side camera views (side view)


View
On-screen display of the rear Rear Assist (Rear View Cam-
On-screen display of the side camera era)*
View
cameras The vehicle's rear is presented. The red
The areas located directly to the side of
auxiliary line establishes the safety dis- Operating and safety warnings
tance.
Right and left the vehicle seen from above are repre-
sides sented in order to navigate possible ob- Green and red semicircular auxiliary WARNING
stacles more precisely. The orange aux- lines are displayed in vehicles with a
 ● The Rear Assist does not make it possible
iliary lines are shown at a distance of factory-fitted towing bracket. The auxili-
approx. 0.4 m from the vehicle. Off-road or to precisely calculate the distance from ob-
ary lines indicate the distance from the
hitching a
towing bracket. The distance between stacles (people, vehicles, etc.) and nor can it
Left side The area directly next to the vehicle, on trailer func- the auxiliary lines (green and red) is ap- overcome the system's own limits, hence us-
the driver's or front passenger's side, is tion prox. 0.3 m. The orange auxiliary line in- ing it may cause serious accidents and inju-
 displayed, and the blind spots all along dicates, depending on the turn of the ries if used negligently or without due care.
the vehicle can be seen. The orange  steering wheel, the pre-calculated di- The driver should be aware of his/her sur-
Right side
auxiliary line is shown at a distance of rection of the towing bracket. roundings at all times to ensure safe driving.
 approx. 0.4 m from the vehicle.
In vehicles with a factory-fitted towing
● The camera lens expands and distorts the
bracket, the distance from the red auxil- field of vision and displays the objects on the
Rear camera views (rear view) iary line to the vehicle is approx. 0.4 m. screen in a different, vague manner. The per-
No other auxiliary line is displayed. ception of distances is also distorted by this
On-screen display of the rear effect.
View Left area of the screen: street to the left.
camera ● Due to the screen resolution or insufficient
Cross traffic
Central area of the screen: area directly light conditions, some items may be dis-
Parallel park- at the rear behind the vehicle.
The area behind the vehicle is shown. played in an unsatisfactory manner or not at
ing Auxiliary lines are shown to give guid- all. Take special care with thin posts, fences,
ance.
 Right area of the screen: street to the
 right. railings or trees that might not be displayed
on screen and could damage the vehicle.
The vehicle's initial position on initiat- ● The rear assist has blind spots where it is
Parallel park-
ing this function will be a decisive fac-
ing not possible to represent people or objects
tor in determining the place where the
manoeuvre executed by the assistant
(small children, animals and certain objects
 will end. cannot be detected in its field of vision). Mon-
itor the vehicle's surrounding area at all
times.
● Keep the camera lens clean, free of ice and
snow, and do not cover it.

270
Driver assistance systems

● The system is not a replacement for driver so be outside the camera's angle of vi- number plate area that will be used as refer-

Technical data
awareness. Supervise the parking operation sion when reversing. ence by the driver.
at all times, as well as the vehicle's surround-
ing area. Adapt your speed and driving style Rear assist settings
Note
at all times to suit visibility, weather, road
Rear assist offers the user the possibility to
and traffic conditions. ● It is important to take great care and pay
change the image's brightness, contrast and
● Do not be distracted from the traffic by special attention if you are not yet familiar
with the system. colour settings.
looking at the screen.
● The images on the rear assist screen are ● Rear assist will not be available if the vehi- To change these settings:

Advice
only two-dimensional. Due to a lack of spatial cle's rear lid is open.
● Park the vehicle in a safe place.
depth, protruding parts or holes in the road,
for example, are more difficult to detect or ● Apply the parking brake.
may not be seen at all. Instructions for use ● Switch the ignition on.
● Vehicle load modifies the representation of ● If necessary, switch on the Easy Connect
the orientation lines displayed. The width

Operation
system.
represented by the lines diminishes with ve-
hicle load. Pay special attention to the vehi- ● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
cle's surroundings when the inside of the ve- lever to position R.
hicle of the luggage compartment is carrying ● Press the  function button displayed on
a heavy load. the right of the image.
● In the following situations, the objects or

Emergencies
● Make the desired adjustments on the menu
other vehicles shown in the navigation sys-
by pressing the –/+ function buttons or by
tem display appear to be further away or
closer than they really are: Pay special atten-
moving the corresponding scroll button.
tion:
Fig. 233 In the rear lid handle: location of the Necessary conditions for parking and ma-
– On moving from a horizontal plane to a
rear assist camera. noeuvring with the rear assist
slope.
– On moving from a slope to a horizontal The system should not be used in the follow-
A camera installed in the rear lid handle as- ing cases:

Safety
plane.
sists the driver in reverse parking or manoeu-
– If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the vring ››› Fig. 233. The camera image is viewed ● If the image displayed is not very reliable or
rear. together with orientation lines projected by is distorted, for example low visibility or dirty
– When the vehicle approaches objects the system on the Easy Connect system lens. »
that are not on the ground surface or are screen. The bottom of the screen displays
jutting out from it. These objects may al- part of the bumper corresponding to the
271
Operation

● If the area behind the vehicle is not dis- Parking and manoeuvring with the In combination with the Parking System Plus
played very clearly or is incomplete. rear assist ››› page 262, the camera image will cease to
● If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the rear. be transmitted immediately when reverse
gear is disengaged or when the selector lever
● If the position and installation angle of the
is moved from the R position, and the optical
camera have been changed, e.g. after a rear- information provided by the Parking Aid sys-
end collision. Have the system checked by a tem will be displayed.
specialised workshop.
Also in combination with the system, the rear
Familiarising yourself with the system assist image can also be concealed:
To familiarise yourself with the system, the ● By pressing one of the Infotainment system
orientation lines and their function, SEAT rec- buttons on the display.
ommends practising parking and manoeu- ● OR: By pressing the miniature vehicle that
vring with the rear assist in a place without
Fig. 234 Display on the Easy Connect system appears on the left of the screen (which
too much traffic or in a car park when there screen: orientation lines. switches to the full-screen mode of the Park-
are good weather and visibility conditions.
ing System Plus's optical system).
Switching the system on and off
Cleaning the camera lens If you wish to display the rear assist image
● The rear assist will switch on when the igni-
Keep the camera lens clean and clear of snow again:
tion is on or the engine running, on engaging
and ice: reverse gear (manual gearbox) or on chang- ● Disengage reverse, or change the selector
● Moisten the lens using a normal alcohol-
ing the selector lever to the R position (auto- lever's position, engage reverse again or
matic gearbox). move the selector lever to position R.
based glass cleaning product and clean the
lens with a dry cloth. ● The system switches off 8 seconds after
● Remove snow using a small brush.
disengaging reverse gear (manual gearbox)
or removing the selector lever from the R po-
● Use de-icing spray to remove any ice. sition (automatic gearbox). The system will
also disconnect immediately after the igni-
CAUTION tion is switched off.
● Never use abrasive cleaning products to ● The camera will stop transmitting images
clean the camera lens. above the speed of 15 km/h (9 mph) with re-
● Do not use hot or warm water to remove ice verse engaged.
or snow from the camera lens. Doing so could
damage the camera.
272
Towing bracket device*

● OR: Press the RVC function button1) ● Guide the vehicle into the parking space so
Towing bracket device*

Technical data
that the side orientation lines run parallel to
Meaning of the orientation lines it.
Trailer mode
››› Fig. 234
1 Side lines: extension of the vehicle (the Introduction
approximate width of the vehicle plus the
rear view mirrors) on the road surface. Take into account country-specific regula-
2 End of the side lines: the area marked in tions about driving with a trailer and the use

Advice
green ends approximately 2 m behind of a towing bracket.
the vehicle on the road surface. The vehicle has been developed primarily for
3 Intermediate line: indicates a distance of carrying people, although it can also be used
approximately 1 m behind the vehicle on to tow a trailer if fitted with the correspond-
the road surface. ing technical equipment. This additional load

Operation
4 Red horizontal line: indicates a safe dis- has an effect on the useful life, fuel con-
tance of approximately 40 cm at the rear sumption and vehicle performance and in
of the vehicle on the road surface. some cases can reduce the service intervals.
Driving with a trailer requires more force from
Parking manoeuvre the vehicle, and thus more concentration
● Place the vehicle in front of the parking from the driver.

Emergencies
space and engage reverse gear (manual In winter, winter tyres should be fitted on
gearbox) or move the selector to the R posi- both the vehicle and the trailer.
tion (automatic gearbox).
● Reverse slowly, and turn the steering wheel Maximum vertical load technically permissi-
so that the side orientation lines lead to- ble on the coupling
wards the parking space. The maximum vertical load technically per-
mitted from the trailer draw bar on the towing

Safety
bracket's tow hitch is 80 kg. »

1) WARNING: the RVC function button will only be ac-


tivated and available when the reverse gear is en-
gaged or the selector lever is set to position R.
273
Operation

Vehicles with the Start-Stop system ● Never modify or repair the towing bracket ● Never drive at more than 80 km/h (50 mph)
If the vehicle has a factory-fitted towing in any way. when towing a trailer (or at more than
bracket or one that is retrofitted by SEAT, the ● In order to reduce the danger of injury in 100 km/h (60 mph) in exceptional circum-
Start-Stop system operates as normal. No the event of rear-end collisions and to avoid stances). This also applies in countries where
special characteristics need to be taken into injury to pedestrians and cyclists when park- driving at higher speeds is permitted. Take
ing the vehicle, cover or remove the tow hitch into account the speed limit for vehicles with
account.
when you are not using a trailer. trailers in the corresponding country, as it
If the system does not recognise the trailer or could be less than the speed limit for vehi-
● Never fit a towing bracket “with weight dis-
the trailer bracket has not been retrofitted by cles without a trailer.
tribution” or “load compensation”. The vehi-
SEAT, the Start-Stop system must be discon- cle has not been designed for this type of ● Never attempt to “straighten” the towing
nected by pressing the corresponding button towing bracket. The towing bracket could fail vehicle and trailer while accelerating.
in the lower part of the centre console before and the trailer could be released from the ve-
driving with the trailer, and it should remain hicle. WARNING
off for the rest of the journey ››› .
If the towing bracket has been retrofitted by a
WARNING non-SEAT workshop, the Start-Stop system
Vehicles with driving profile selection
Driving with a trailer and transporting heavy must be disconnected manually whenever
If you are going to be towing a trailer, the use or large objects can affect driving properties driving with a trailer. Otherwise the brake
of the Eco driving profile is not recommen- and even cause an accident. system could be damaged and could conse-
ded. You are advised to select another of the quently cause a serious accident or injury.
● Always secure the load properly using belts
available driving profiles before beginning to ● Always disconnect the Start-Stop system
or straps that are suitable and in good condi-
drive with a trailer. tion. manually when using a towing bracket that
has not been fitted by a SEAT workshop.
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
WARNING
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
Never use the trailer to transport people, fic conditions. Note
since it would put their life in danger and is ● Trailers with a high centre of gravity are ● Before hitching or unhitching a trailer, al-
also prohibited.
more likely to overturn than those with a low ways deactivate the anti-theft alarm
one. ››› page 125. Otherwise, the tilt sensor could
WARNING ● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres. cause the alarm to go off.
Undue use of the towing bracket may cause ● Take great care when overtaking. ● Do not drive with a trailer for the engine's
injury and accidents. first 1000 km ››› page 201.
● Reduce speed immediately if you notice
● Only use the towing bracket if it is in a per- that the trailer is swaying, however slightly. ● SEAT recommends that, if possible, the tow
fect state of repair and is properly secured. hitch be disassembled or covered when it is

274
Towing bracket device*

not going to be used. In the event of a rear- CAUTION Engine cooling system

Technical data
end collision, the damage to the vehicle Driving with a trailer increases the load on
Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
could be greater if the bracket is fitted. the engine and cooling system. The cooling
sponding text messages when they light up
● Some retrofitted towing brackets cover the may result in damage to the vehicle. system should have sufficient coolant and be
rear towing eye. In these cases, the towing prepared for the additional effort involved in
eye should not be used for tow-starting or for driving with a trailer.
towing other vehicles. For this reason, if the
vehicle has been retrofitted with a towing Technical requirements
Trailer brakes
bracket, always keep the tow hitch in the ve-

Advice
hicle when you disassemble it. Vehicles that are factory-equipped with a If the trailer has its own brake system, please
towing bracket fulfil all the technical and le- take the relevant legal requirements into ac-
gal requirements for driving with a trailer. count. Never connect the trailer's brake sys-
tem to the vehicle's brake system.
Control lamp If the vehicle is retrofitted with a towing
bracket, only a bracket that is authorised for
the maximum authorised load of the trailer Tow rope

Operation
 Lamp on button lights up
that is to be towed may be fitted. The towing Always use a cable between the vehicle and
The tow hitch is not securely locked in position. bracket must be suitable for the vehicle and the trailer ››› page 278.
Check that the towing bracket is locked ››› page 276. the trailer and must be properly secured to
the vehicle's chassis. Only use a towing Trailer rear lights
Some warning and control lamps will light up bracket that has been authorised by SEAT for
briefly when the ignition is switched on to The trailer's rear lights should comply with
this vehicle. Always check and take into ac-

Emergencies
check certain functions. They will switch off the statutory safety regulations ››› page 278.
count the towing bracket manufacturer's in-
after a few seconds. structions. Never fit a towing bracket “with Never connect the trailer's rear lights directly
weight distribution” or “load compensation”. to the vehicle's electric system. If you are not
WARNING sure that the trailer's electrical connection is
If the warning lamps and the corresponding Towing bracket fitted on the bumper correct, have it checked by a specialised
messages are ignored when they light up, the workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT
Never fit a towing bracket to the bumper or to
vehicle may stall in traffic and cause acci- dealership for this.
the area where the bumper is mounted. The

Safety
dents and severe injuries.
towing bracket should not impair the bum-
● Never ignore the warning lamps or messag- Exterior mirrors
per's function. Do not make modifications or
es. If you cannot see the area behind the trailer
repairs to the exhaust system or the brake
● Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity system. Make regular checks to ensure that with the exterior mirrors of the towing vehi-
and in a safe place. the towing bracket is secure. cle, additional mirrors will have to be instal-
led in accordance with the regulations of the »
275
Operation

country in question. The exterior mirrors CAUTION There should be no person, animal or object
should be adjusted before you start driving in the path of the tow hitch ››› .
● If the rear lights of the trailer are not cor-
and must provide a sufficient field of vision
rectly connected, the vehicle's electronic sys-
at the rear. Unlock the tow hitch and remove it
tem may be damaged.
● If the trailer absorbs excessive electric cur- ● Stop the vehicle and connect the electronic
Trailer maximum electricity consumption parking brake ››› page 186.
rent, the vehicle's electronic system may be
Consumers Europe, Asia, Australia damaged. ● Switch off the engine.
Africa, South ● Never connect the trailer's electric system ● Open the rear lid.
America and directly to the electrical connections of the
● Pull the ››› Fig. 235 button briefly. The tow
Central America tail lights or any other power sources. Only
use the connections intended for providing hitch unlocks electrically and automatically
Brake lights (total) 84 Watts 108 Watts electric current to the trailer. turns outwards. The control lamp in the but-
ton will flash ››› Fig. 235.
Turn signal (on each 42 Watts 54 Watts
side) ● Remove the tow hitch with your hand until
Electrical unlocking tow hitch you feel and see that it has engaged and the
Side lights (on each 50 Watts 100 Watts control lamp on the button stays on.
side)
● Close the rear lid.
Reverse lights (in 42 Watts 54 Watts
total)
Cover the tow hitch
Rear fog light 42 Watts 54 Watts ● Stop the vehicle and apply the electronic
Never exceed the values indicated! parking brake.
● Switch off the engine.
WARNING ● Unhook the trailer and interrupt the electri-
If the towing bracket is wrongly fitted or is cal connection between it and the vehicle. If
not the right one, the trailer could become you are using an adapter, remove it from the
detached from the vehicle and cause serious Fig. 235 On the right side of the luggage trailer's power socket.
injury. compartment: button for unlocking the tow ● Open the rear lid.
hitch.
● Pull the ››› Fig. 235 button briefly. The tow
hitch unlocks electrically.
The tow hitch is located in the bumper. The
electrical unlocking tow hitch cannot be dis-
assembled.
276
Towing bracket device*

● Turn the tow hitch under the bumper with ● If the tow hitch is not attached properly, do can be mounted are allowed. Heavier bicy-

Technical data
your hand until you feel and see that it en- not use it. Instead, go to a specialised work- cles must be mounted as close to the vehicle
gages and the control lamp on the ››› Fig. 235 shop and have the towing bracket checked. as possible (tow hitch).
button stays on. ● If you detect any fault in the electrical sys-
● Close the rear lid. tem or in the towing bracket, contact a speci- WARNING
alised workshop and ask them to check it. The incorrect use of the tow hitch with a bicy-
Meaning of control lamp ● If the ball has a diameter of less than 49 cle rack mounted on the tow hitch can cause
mm at any one point, do not use the towing accidents and injury.
● If the warning light of the button ››› Fig. 235
bracket under any circumstances.

Advice
● Never exceed the maximum weight or the
is flashing, this means that the tow hitch has
not been attached properly or is damaged limits indicated above.
››› . CAUTION ● The bicycle rack may not be mounted to the
neck of the hitch below the ball because, due
● If the warning lamp stays on with the rear If you clean the vehicle with high-pressure or
to the shape of the neck and depending on
lid open, the tow hitch is correctly in place steam devices, do not point the jet directly
the rack model, the rack could be incorrectly
both when engaged and when covered. towards the retractable tow hitch or the trail-
mounted on the vehicle.

Operation
er power socket, as this may damage the
● The control lamp of the button will go off ● Always read and take the manufacturer as-
joints or remove the grease necessary for lu-
approx. 1 minute after closing the rear lid. brication. sembly instructions into account.

WARNING
Note CAUTION
Undue use of the towing bracket may cause
If the maximum weight and limits indicated

Emergencies
injury and accidents. At extremely low temperatures, the tow hitch
may be impossible to use. In this case, place above are exceeded, the vehicle may suffer
● Only use the tow hitch if it is properly en- considerable damage.
the vehicle in a warmer location (for example,
gaged.
a garage). ● Never exceed the values indicated!
● Always ensure that no person, animal or
object is to be found in the path of the tow
hitch. Note
● Never use a tool or instrument while the
Fitting a bicycle carrier on the retract- SEAT recommends removing, as far as possi-
able tow hitch

Safety
tow hitch is moving. ble, all removable parts of the bicycles before
● Never press the ››› Fig. 235 button when setting off. These parts include, for example,
The maximum allowed weight of the carrier baskets and saddlebags, child seats or bat-
there is a trailer hooked to the vehicle or
system, including the load, is 75 kg. The car- teries. This improves aerodynamics and the
when a carrier system or other accessories
are mounted on the tow hitch.
rier system should not protrude more than centre of gravity of the rack system.
700 mm backwards from the spherical head.
Only carrier systems on which up to 3 bikes
277
Operation

Hooking up and connecting a trailer Key to the Fig. 236: Tow rope
The tow rope must always be securely fixed
Pin Meaning
to the towing vehicle and loose enough so
12 Unassigned that the vehicle can handle turns smoothly.
However, make sure that the cable does not
13 Earth for pin 9 rub on the ground while driving.

Trailer power socket Trailer rear lights


The vehicle is fitted with a 13-pole power Always check the trailer's rear lights to en-
socket for the electrical connection between sure they are working correctly and that they
the trailer and the vehicle. With the engine comply with the relevant safety regulations.
Fig. 236 Schematic diagram: assignment of running, electrical devices on the trailer re- Make sure that the maximum permissible
the pins of the trailer's power socket. ceive power from the electrical connection power that can be absorbed by the trailer is
(pin 9 and pin 10 of the trailer power socket). not exceeded ››› page 276.
Key to the Fig. 236: If the system detects that a trailer has been
connected electrically, the electrical equip- Connection to the anti-theft system
Pin Meaning
ment on the trailer will receive voltage The trailer is included in the anti-theft system
1 Left turn signal through this connection (pins 9 and 10). Pin if the following conditions are met:
2 Rear fog light 9 has a permanent live. This powers, for ex-
ample, the trailer's interior lighting. Electrical ● If the vehicle is factory-equipped with an
3 Earth for pins 1, 2, 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8 devices such as a fridge in a caravan only re- anti-theft alarm and towing bracket.
ceive electrical power if the engine is running ● If the trailer is electrically connected to the
4 Right turn signal
(through pin 10). towing vehicle through the trailer power
5 Rear light, right
To avoid overloading the electrical system, socket.
6 Brake lights you cannot connect the ground wires of pin ● If the electrical systems of the vehicle and
3, pin 11 or pin 13. trailer are in perfect condition and have no
7 Rear light, left faults or damage.
If the trailer has a 7-contact connector, you
8 Reverse lights will need to use an adapter cable. In this case ● If the vehicle is locked with the key and the
the function corresponding to pin 10 will not anti-theft alarm is activated.
9 Permanent live
be available.
10 Live charge cable
When the vehicle is locked, the alarm is trig-
gered if the electrical connection with the
11 Earth for pin 10 trailer is cut off.
278
Towing bracket device*

Before hitching or unhitching a trailer, always ● Ensure that any repairs that need to be car- the anti-theft system, have these checked out

Technical data
turn off the anti-theft alarm. Otherwise, the ried out on the electrical system are carried by a specialised workshop.
tilt sensor could cause the alarm to go off. out by a specialised workshop. ● If the trailer accessories consume energy
● Never connect the trailer's electric system through the power socket to the trailer and
Trailers with LED rear lights directly to the electrical connections of the the engine is turned off, the battery will dis-
For technical reasons, trailers fitted with LED tail lights or any other power sources. charge.
rear lights cannot be connected to the anti- ● If the vehicle battery is running low, the
theft alarm system. WARNING electrical connection with the trailer will be
automatically cut.

Advice
When the vehicle is locked, the alarm does Contact between the pins of the trailer power
not go off when the electrical connection with socket can cause short circuits, overloading
the trailer is cut if it has rear lights with light- of the electrical system or failure of the light-
emitting diodes. ing system, and consequently can cause acci- Loading a trailer
dents and serious injuries.
If the Eco driving profile was selected when Technically permissible maximum trailer
● Never connect the pins of the trailer power

Operation
hitching the trailer, this will automatically weight and vertical load on the coupling de-
socket to each other.
switch to the Normal profile. If the system vice
● Make sure any work on bent pins is carried
cannot detect the attached trailer or if the
out by a specialised workshop. The technically permissible maximum trailer
towing bracket has been retrofitted by an au-
weight is the weight that the vehicle can tow
to repair shop other than SEAT, you must
manually select the Normal profile before you CAUTION
››› . The vertical load on the coupling load
is exerted vertically from above on the tow

Emergencies
start driving with a trailer attached. To recon- Do not leave the trailer connected to the vehi- hitch of the towing bracket ››› page 319.
nect the Eco profile once the trailer has been cle when parked; place it on its support
unhitched, switch the ignition off and back wheel or its supports. If the vehicle rises or The information on the maximum trailer
on once. falls due, for example, to a variation of the weight and vertical load on the coupling de-
load or a burst tyre, increased pressure will vice contained in the type plate of the towing
WARNING be placed on the towing bracket and the trail- bracket are experimental values only. The
er, and both the vehicle and the trailer can be correct figures for your specific model, which
If the cables are improperly or incorrectly
damaged. may be lower than these figures, are given in
connected, it may lead to an excessive

Safety
amount of current supplied to the trailer, the vehicle documentation. The information
which can cause abnormalities in the entire Note in the vehicle documentation takes prece-
vehicle electronic system, as well as acci-
● In case of malfunctioning of the electrical
dence at all times. »
dents and serious injuries.
systems of the vehicle or trailer, as well as of

279
Operation

To promote safety while driving, SEAT recom- ● Secure the trailer load properly. ● Always secure the load properly using belts
mends making the most of the maximum ver- or straps that are suitable and in good condi-
tical load technically permissible on the cou- Tyre pressure tion.
pling device ››› page 273. An insufficient ver-
Set the tyre pressure of the trailer tyres in ac-
tical load has a negative influence on the be-
cordance with the trailer manufacturer's rec-
haviour of both the vehicle and trailer.
ommendations. Driving with a trailer
The vertical load increases the weight on the
When towing a trailer, inflate the tyres of the
rear axle, reducing the vehicle's carrying ca- Adjusting the headlights
towing vehicle with the maximum allowable
pacity.
pressure ››› page 308. When towing a trailer, the front part of the ve-
hicle could lift up, and if the dipped beams
Gross combination weight of the towing ve- WARNING are on, this could dazzle other drivers. Use
hicle and trailer the headlight range control to lower the cone
If the maximum permissible axle weight, the
The gross combination weight is the actual of light. If you do not have headlight range
maximum load technically permissible on the
weight of the loaded vehicle plus the actual coupling point, the maximum authorised ve- control, have the headlights adjusted by a
weight of the loaded trailer. hicle weight or the gross combination weight specialised workshop.
of the towing vehicle and trailer are excee-
In some countries trailers are classified into
ded, accidents and serious injuries may oc- Special characteristics of driving with a trail-
distinct categories. SEAT recommends ob-
cur. er
taining information from a specialised work-
● Never exceed the values indicated! ● If your trailer has an overrun brake, brake
shop regarding which type of trailer is most
suitable for your vehicle. ● The actual weight on the front and rear gently at first and then rapidly. This will pre-
axles must never exceed the maximum per- vent the jerking that can be caused by the
Trailer loading missible axle weight. The weight on the front locking of trailer wheels.
and rear axles must never exceed the maxi- ● Due to the gross combination weight of the
The weight of the towing vehicle and trailer mum permissible weight.
must be balanced. In order to do this, the towing vehicle and trailer, the braking dis-
load must be as close as possible to the max- tance increases.
WARNING ● When going down a slope, go into a lower
imum vertical load technically permissible on
the coupling point, and it must be evenly dis- A shift in weight could jeopardize the stabili- gear (if using a manual gearbox or the tip-
tributed between the back and front of the ty and security of the towing vehicle and tronic automatic gearbox mode) to take ad-
trailer: trailer, which could lead to accidents and se- vantage of the braking power provided by the
rious injuries. engine. Otherwise, the braking system could
● Distribute loads in the trailer so that heavy ● Always load the trailer correctly. overheat and even fail.
objects are as near to the axle as possible or
above it.
280
Towing bracket device*

● The trailer weight, as well as the gross com- ● Do not release the  button until the en- Stabilisation of the towing vehicle

Technical data
bination weight of the towing vehicle and gine has sufficient force to start driving. and trailer
trailer, change the centre of gravity and the
properties of the vehicle. WARNING The stabilisation of the towing vehicle and
● If the towing vehicle is empty and the trail- If a trailer is pulled incorrectly, this may lead trailer together is an additional function of
er is loaded, then the load distribution is in- to loss of control of the vehicle and serious the electronic stability control (ESC).
correct. Under these conditions, drive slowly injury.
If the system detects that the trailer is sway-
and with extra caution. ● Driving with a trailer and transporting ing, it intervenes automatically with the driv-
heavy or large objects will change the vehicle

Advice
er steering recommendation to reduce the
Hill starts with a trailer handling and braking distances. swaying of the trailer.
Depending on the slope of the hill and the ● Always drive cautiously and carefully.
combination weight of the towing vehicle Brake earlier than usual. Requirements for the stabilisation of the
and trailer, the vehicle might start rolling ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all towing vehicle and trailer
backwards slightly when you first start up. times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf- ● The vehicle is factory-equipped with a tow-

Operation
fic conditions. Slow down, especially when
For hill-starting with a trailer, do the follow- ing bracket or has been retro-fitted with a
driving down hills or slopes.
ing: compatible towing bracket.
● Accelerate with particular care and caution.
Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres. ● The ESC and ASR are active. The control
● Press and hold the brake pedal.
lamp  or  is not lit up on the instrument
● Take great care when overtaking. Reduce
● Press the  button to disconnect the elec- panel.
speed immediately if you notice that the trail-
tronic parking brake ››› page 186.

Emergencies
er is swaying, however slightly. ● The trailer is electrically connected to the
● If the vehicle is equipped with a manual towing vehicle through the trailer power
● Never attempt to “straighten” the towing
gearbox, push the clutch pedal all the way vehicle and trailer while accelerating. socket.
down. ● The vehicle is travelling at over 60 km/h
● Take into account the speed limit for vehi-
● Put the vehicle into first gear or turn the se- cles with a trailer, as it could be lower than (approx. 37 mph).
lector lever to position D/S ››› page 192. for vehicles without a trailer. ● The maximum vertical load technically per-
● Pull out the  button and hold it in that missible is being utilised on the coupling de-

Safety
position to stop the towing vehicle and trailer vice.
with the electronic parking brake. ● The trailer has a rigid draw bar.
● Release the brake pedal.
● If the trailer has brakes, it must be equip-
● Start driving slowly. To do this, in the case ped with a mechanical overrun brake. »
of a manual gearbox, slowly release the
clutch pedal.
281
Operation

WARNING matic braking may occur in extreme driving SEAT recommends that towing brackets be
conditions. retrofitted at a specialised workshop. For ex-
The enhanced security provided by the elec- ample, it may very well be necessary to ad-
tric stability control of the towing vehicle and
just the cooling system or mount thermal pro-
trailer should not lead you to take any risks
tection plates. SEAT recommends visiting a
that could compromise your safety. Retrofitting a towing bracket SEAT dealership for this.
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf- If a towing bracket is retrofitted, the distance
fic conditions. specifications should always be kept in
● Accelerate with caution when the road is mind. The distance between the centre of the
slippery. spherical head and the road ››› Fig. 237 D
● When adjusting any settings, stop acceler- must never be less than that indicated. This
ating. also applies when the vehicle is fully loaded,
including the technically permissible maxi-
mum vertical load on the coupling device.
WARNING
The electric stability control for the towing Distance specifications ››› Fig. 237:
vehicle and trailer may not correctly detect all A Attachment points
driving conditions. B 932.5 mm
● When the ESC is switched off, the stabilisa-
C 65 mm min.
tion of the towing vehicle and trailer is also
switched off. D 350-420 mm
● The stability system does not always detect E 220 mm
light and unstable trailers, so it may not sta- F 615.5 mm
bilise these correctly.
G 1,043 mm
● When driving on slippery surfaces with
poor grip, the trailer can even interfere with
WARNING
the stability system.
● Trailers with a high centre of gravity can tip If the cables are improperly or incorrectly
even without having previously swayed. connected, this may lead to malfunctions in
the entire vehicle electronic system, as well
● If a trailer is not attached, but the trailer
as to accidents and serious injuries.
power socket is connected (e.g. installation Fig. 237 Limits and attachment points for ret-
of a bicycle rack with lights), repeated auto- ● Never connect the trailer's electric system
rofitting a towing bracket.
to the electrical connections of the tail lights

282
Towing bracket device*

or any other unsuitable power sources. Only

Technical data
use suitable connectors to connect the trail-
er.
● The towing bracket should be retrofitted
only at a specialised workshop.

WARNING
If the towing bracket is badly fitted or unsuit-

Advice
able, the trailer may separate from the vehi-
cle while driving. This could cause serious ac-
cidents and fatal injuries.

Note

Operation
Only use towing brackets that have been ap-
proved by SEAT for the model in question.

Emergencies
Safety
283
Advice

Advice Any retro-fitted equipment which has a direct


effect on the vehicle and/or the way it is driv-
wear of components, and also invalidate your
vehicle registration documents.
en, such as a cruise control system or elec-
You will appreciate that your SEAT dealership
Care and maintenance tronically-controlled suspension, must be
cannot be held liable for any damage caused
approved for use in your vehicle and bear the
by modifications and/or work performed in-
e mark (the European Union's authorisation
Accessories and modifications symbol).
correctly.
to the vehicle If any additional electrical devices are fitted
We therefore recommend that all work should
be performed by a SEAT Official Service using
which do not serve to control the vehicle it-
Accessories, replacement parts and genuine SEAT parts®.
self (for instance a refrigerator box, laptop or
repair work ventilator fan, etc.), they must bear the 
WARNING
sign (manufacturer conformity declaration in
Always ask your dealer or specialist retailer the European Union). Incorrectly performed modifications or other
for advice before purchasing accessories and work on your vehicle can lead to malfunctions
replacement parts. WARNING and cause accidents.

Your vehicle is designed to offer a high Accessories, for example telephone holders
standard of active and passive safety. For this or cup holders, should never be fitted on the
reason, we recommend that you ask a SEAT covers, or within the working range of the air- Radio transmitters and office equip-
Official Service for advice before fitting ac- bags. Otherwise, there is a danger of injury if ment
cessories or replacement parts. Your SEAT Of- the airbag is triggered in an accident.
ficial Service has the latest information from Radio transmitters (fixed installation)
the manufacturer and can recommend acces- Any retrofit installations of radio transmitters
sories and replacement parts which are suita- Technical modifications in the vehicle require prior approval. SEAT
ble for your requirements. They can also an- generally authorises in-vehicle installations
swer any questions you might have regarding Modifications must always be carried out ac- of approved types of radio transmitters provi-
official regulations. cording to our specifications. ded that:
We recommend you to use only SEAT acces- Unauthorised modifications to the electronic ● The aerial is installed correctly.
sories and Genuine SEAT parts®. SEAT has components, software, wiring or data transfer
tested these parts and accessories for suita- ● The aerial is installed on the exterior of the
in the vehicle may cause malfunctioning. Due
bility, reliability and safety. SEAT Official to the way the electronic components are vehicle (and shielded cables are used togeth-
Services have the necessary experience and linked together in networks, other indirect er with non-reflective aerial trimming).
facilities to ensure that the parts are installed systems may be affected by the faults. This ● The effective transmitting power does not
correctly and professionally. can seriously impair safety, lead to excessive exceed 10 Watts at the aerial base.
284
Care and maintenance

A SEAT Official Service and specialised work- WARNING WARNING

Technical data
shop will be able to inform you about options
for installing and operating radio transmitters Mobile telephones or radio equipment which ● Cleaning products and other materials used
is operated inside the vehicle without a prop- for car care can be damaging to your health if
with a higher transmitting power.
erly installed external aerial can create exces- misused.
sive magnetic fields that could cause a health ● Always keep care products in a safe place,
Mobile radio transmitters hazard. out of the reach of children. Failure to comply
Commercial mobile telephones or radio could result in poisoning.
equipment might interfere with the electron- Note
ics of your vehicle and cause malfunctions.

Advice
● The posterior fitting of electric and elec- For the sake of the environment
This may be due to:
tronic equipment in this vehicle affects its li- ● If possible, use environmentally friendly
● No external aerial. cence and could lead to the withdrawal of the products.
vehicle registration document under certain
● External aerial incorrectly installed. ● The remains of car care products should not
circumstances.
● Transmitting power more than 10 W. be disposed of with ordinary household
● Please use the mobile telephone/radio op-

Operation
waste.
erating instructions.
You must, therefore, do not operate portable
mobile telephones or radio equipment inside
the vehicle without a properly installed exter-
nal aerial ››› . Vehicle exterior care
Care and cleaning
Please note also that the maximum range of Washing the vehicle

Emergencies
the equipment can only be achieved with an General information
external aerial. The longer substances such as insects, bird
Regular and careful care helps to maintain droppings, resinous tree sap, road dirt, in-
Business equipment the value of the vehicle. This may also be one dustrial deposits, tar, soot or road salt and
of the requirements for upholding any war- other aggressive materials remain on the ve-
Retrofit installation of business or private
ranty claims in the event of corrosion or paint hicle, the more damage they do to the paint-
equipment in the vehicle is permitted, provi-
defects. work. High temperatures (for instance due to
ded the equipment cannot interfere with the

Safety
driver's immediate control of the vehicle and SEAT Official Services and specialist retailers strong sunlight) further intensify the corro-
that any such equipment carries the  mark. carry stocks of suitable car care materials. sive effect.
Any retrofit equipment that could influence Please follow the instructions for use on the After the period when salt is put on the roads
the driver's control of the vehicle must have a packaging. it is important to have the underside of the
type approval for your vehicle and must carry vehicle washed thoroughly. »
the e mark.
285
Advice

Automatic car washes ● Do not use scrapers to remove ice or snow ● When washing the car during the winter
Before going through a car wash, be sure to from the sheets. season: water and ice in the brake system
take the usual precautions such as closing ● Do not polish the adhesive sheets. can reduce braking effectiveness: risk of acci-
the windows and roof. If the vehicle has spe- dent!
● Do not use dirty cloths or sponges.
cial accessories such as spoilers or a roof
● It is preferable to wash them with a soft
rack, it is advisable to consult the car wash CAUTION
sponge and gentle neutral soap.
tunnel operator. ● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight –
It is best to use a car wash without revolving Washing the car by hand otherwise the paint can be damaged.
bristles if possible. ● Do not use sponges, abrasive household
When washing the car by hand, use plenty of
sponges or similar to clean insect remains.
water to soften the dirt first, and rinse off as
Washing the vehicle with a high pressure This could damage the surface.
well as possible.
cleaner ● Clean off stubborn dirt (insects, etc.) from
Then clean the vehicle with a soft sponge, the headlights at regular intervals, for in-
When washing the vehicle with a high-pres-
glove or brush using only slight pressure. stance when filling the fuel tank. The head-
sure cleaner, always follow the operating in-
You should start on the roof and work down. lights should only be washed with water, do
structions for the equipment. This applies
Special car soap should only be used for very not wipe them with a dry cloth or sponge. It
particularly to the operating pressure and the is best to use soapy water.
persistent dirt.
spraying distance. Do not hold the nozzle too
● Never wash tyres with a jet that sprays the
close to soft materials such as rubber hoses Rinse the sponge or glove thoroughly and of-
water out in a direct stream. This could dam-
or seals. The same applies for the parking aid ten.
age the tyres even if the spray is kept at a
sensors*, which are located in the rear distance and only used for a very short time.
Wheels, sills and similar should be cleaned
and/or front bumper.
last. Use a second sponge for this. ● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic
Do not use a nozzle that sprays the water out car wash, please make sure to retract the ex-
in a direct stream or one that has a rotating WARNING terior mirrors to prevent them from being
jet for forcing off dirt. ● The vehicle should only be washed with the damaged. Electrically retractable exterior
mirrors must not be folded in or out by hand,
ignition switched off. Failure to follow this in-
Factory-fitted adhesive sheets always use the electrical power control.
struction could result in an accident.
The following indications should be taken in- ● Do not clean the underside of chassis, the
to account to avoid damaging adhesive inside of wheel arches or wheel trims without CAUTION
sheets: protecting your hands and arms. You may cut ● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic
yourself on sharp-edged metal parts. Other- car wash, please proceed as follows to lock
● Do not use high pressure cleaners. wise, there is a risk of sustaining cuts. the wiper arms so that they are not moved to-
wards the top of the windscreen:
286
Care and maintenance

– the bonnet must be closed. – Stay a suitable distance from the sensors If the polish does not contain wax, a wax

Technical data
on the front and rear bumpers. product should be applied after polishing.
– switch the ignition on and off.
– press the windscreen wiper lever forward – Do not clean the camera lenses or sur-
rounding area with the pressure washer. CAUTION
briefly (windscreen washer function).
This will lock the wiper arms. ● Never use warm or hot water to remove ● Do not use polishes and hard wax on pain-
snow and ice from the reverse camera lens, ted parts with a matt finish or on plastic
as it could crack the lens. parts.
For the sake of the environment
● Never use abrasive cleaning agents on the ● Do not apply paint polishes to the side trim
The car should only be washed in special that runs around the panoramic roof and ends

Advice
lens.
wash bays. These areas are prepared to pre- on the windscreen. However, it can be treated
vent oily water from getting into the public with hard wax.
drains. In some places, washing vehicles out-
side the areas intended for this purpose is Waxing and polishing
prohibited.
Care Trims

Operation
Waxing protects the paintwork. It is time to In respect for the environment, the silver-
Camera sensors and lenses apply a coat of good wax when water no lon- plated trims on the body are made of pure
ger forms droplets and rolls off the clean aluminium (they do not contain chrome).
● Use a small brush to remove snow and a paintwork.
de-icer spray to remove ice. Dirt or marks on the trim mouldings should
Even if a wax solution is used regularly in the be removed with a cleaning product with a

Emergencies
● Clean the sensors with a solvent-free prod- vehicle washing tunnel, it is advisable to pro- neutral PH (do not use a chrome cleaner).
uct and a soft, dry cloth. tect the paint with a hard wax coating at least Body polish is also unsuitable for use on trim
● Moisten the camera lens using a standard twice a year. mouldings. The intensive cleaning fluids of-
alcohol-based glass cleaning agent and In the summer, you will find it is much easier ten used before the car goes into a car wash
clean the lens with a dry cloth. In the active to remove dead insects (which accumulate may contain alkaline substances, which can
lane assist*, the area in front of the lens is on the bumper and the front of the bonnet) if cause dull or milky patches when they dry
normally cleaned with the windscreen wash- the car has been treated with care products out.
er.

Safety
recently. SEAT Official Services carry stocks of cleaning
CAUTION products which have been tested for use on
Polishing your vehicle and are not harmful to the envi-
● When you clean the vehicle with a pressure ronment.
Polishing is only necessary if the paint has
washer:
lost its shine, and the gloss cannot be
brought back by putting on wax.
287
Advice

Plastic parts Windows avoid scratches caused by dirt on the glass,


the scraper should only be pushed in one di-
Plastic parts are cleaned with a power wash- Clear vision is an essential safety factor. rection and not moved to and fro.
er. If this is not sufficient, plastic parts ● The heating element for the rear window is
The windscreen must not be cleaned with in-
should only be treated with a special solvent- located on the inner side of the window. To
sect remover or wax, otherwise the wind-
free plastic cleaning agent. Do not use paint- avoid damaging them, do not apply stickers
screen wipers will not function properly (jud-
work cleaners, polishes or wax on plastic to these heating elements.
dering).
parts. ● Never use warm or hot water to remove
Traces of rubber, oil, grease or silicone can snow and ice from windows and mirrors. This
be removed with a window cleaning solution could cause the glass to crack!
Carbon parts or a silicone remover. Wax residue can only
be removed with a special cleaner. Your SEAT
The carbon parts on your vehicle have a pain- Official Service will be able to provide you
with more detailed information. Rims
ted surface. They do not need any special
care and are cleaned just like any other pain- The windows should also be cleaned on the The wheels require regular attention to pre-
ted part ››› page 285. inside at regular intervals. serve their appearance. It is important to re-
Use a separate cloth or chamois to dry the move road salt and brake dust by washing
windows. Cloths used for waxing and polish- the wheels at regular intervals, otherwise the
Paint damage finish will be impaired.
ing contain residues that will cause smears
Minor damage to the paint, such as scratches on the glass. After washing, the wheels should only be
or stone chips, should be touched up without cleaned with an "acid-free" cleaning agent
delay before the metal starts to corrode. Suit- WARNING for alloy wheels. This is available from SEAT
able touch-up brushes or sprays for your car Do not use water-repellent coatings on the Official Services and specialist retailers. Nev-
can be obtained from a SEAT Official Service. windscreen. In bad visibility conditions (e.g. er leave the cleaning agent on the rims for
in the rain, dark or with a low sun), these any longer than specified in the instructions
The number of the original paint finish on the coatings may cause dazzle: risk of accident! before rinsing it off. If the wheel cleaner fluid
vehicle is given on the data sticker Such coatings can also cause the windscreen contains acid it can attack the surfaces of the
››› page 317. wiper blades to make noise. wheel bolts.
If corrosion is already visible it must be thor- Car polish or other abrasive agents should
oughly removed by a specialised workshop. CAUTION not be used for maintaining the rims. If the
● Remove snow and ice from windows and ex- protective coating is damaged, e.g. by flying
terior mirrors with a plastic scraper only. To stones, the damaged area should be re-
paired immediately.
288
Care and maintenance

WARNING The Easy Connect control panel* should first Normal cleaning

Technical data
be cleaned with a brush so that no dirt goes We recommend that you use a soft sponge or
Please note when cleaning the wheels that into the device or between the keys and
water, ice and road salt can impair the effec- a commercially available lint-free, micro-fibre
housing. Next, we recommend cleaning the cloth for normal cleaning. Only use brushes
tiveness of the brakes; this can cause an acci-
Easy Connect control panel* using a cloth on floor coverings and mats, as other textile
dent.
dampened with water and washing-up liquid. surfaces could become damaged.
CAUTION In the case of normal surface dirt you can use
Exhaust pipe a foam cleaner. Use a sponge to spread the
● To avoid scratching the screen, do not wipe

Advice
foam on the textile surface and to work it into
the display with a dry cloth.
It is important to remove road salt and brake the material lightly. However, make sure that
dust by washing the wheels at regular inter- ● To avoid damage, ensure that no liquid
the textile material does not become soaking
vals, otherwise the exhaust tail pipe material goes into the Easy Connect control panel*.
wet. Then dab off the foam with a dry and ab-
could be damaged. To remove impurities, do sorbent cloth (e.g. a micro-fibre cloth) and
not use rim, paint or chrome cleaners or oth- vacuum off any residue once the surface is

Operation
er abrasive products. Clean the exhaust tail Plastic and leatherette parts completely dry.
pipes with cleaning products that are suita-
ble for stainless steel. Plastic parts and leatherette can be cleaned Cleaning stains
with a damp cloth. If this is not sufficient,
SEAT Official Services carry stocks of cleaning Treat drink stains (such as coffee or fruit
plastic parts and leatherette should only be
products that have been tested and ap- juice, etc.) with a cleaning solution for deli-
treated with a special solvent-free plastic
proved for use on your vehicle. cate fabrics. This solution should be applied

Emergencies
cleaner.
with a sponge. If the stains are difficult to re-
move, a washing paste can be applied direct-
ly onto the stain and worked into the fabric.
Caring for the vehicle interior Textile covers and trim parts The surface will then have to be wiped with
clear water to remove any residue left by the
Screen for the radio/Easy Connect* Textile covers and trim parts (e.g. seats, door
paste. To do so, use a damp cloth or sponge
and control panel* trim) should be cleaned regularly with a vac-
and then dab the stain with an absorbent
uum cleaner. This will remove surface dirt

Safety
cloth.
The display can be cleaned with a soft cloth which could otherwise be rubbed into the
and a professionally available “LCD cleaner”. textile material during use. Do not use steam Remove chocolate or make-up stains with a
Moisten the cloth with a small amount of the cleaners, as the steam could carry the dirt cleaning paste (for e.g., soft soap). Then re-
cleaning fluid. deeper into the textile material. move the soap with water (wet sponge). »

289
Advice

A spirit-based cleaner can be used to remove ing remain visible; these are the characteris- To maintain the value of natural leather you
grease, oil, lipstick or ball point pen. Then tic features of genuine natural leather. should note the following points:
dab the dissolved grease or colour particles
Natural napped leather does not have a pro-
off with an absorbent cloth or similar. You CAUTION
tective surface coating of dye. It is therefore
may also have to treat the stain once more ● Avoid exposing leather to direct sunlight
somewhat more prone to damage. This
using washing paste and water. for long periods, otherwise it may tend to
should be borne in mind if children or pets
If the covers or textile trim panels are badly often travel in the car, or if there are other lose some of its colour. If the car is left for a
soiled we recommend that you have them factors that could lead to damage. prolonged period in the bright sun, it is best
to cover the leather.
cleaned by a professional cleaning company
Types of leather with a coloured surface coat- ● Sharp-edged objects on clothing, such as
with a shampoo and spray.
ing are likely to be more resistant to damage. belts, zip fasteners, rivets or similar, can also
This has a great advantage for day-to-day leave permanent scratches and rough marks
Note
use. However, this means that the typical on the surface of the leather.
Open Velcro fasteners on clothes can damage natural characteristics of the surface are less
the seat upholstery. Make sure they are apparent, though this does not affect quality.
closed. Note

Cleaning and care ● Use a suitable impregnating cream with ul-


tra-violet protection at regular intervals and
Due to the natural properties of the specially after cleaning. The cream nourishes and
Natural leather selected hides employed, the finished leath- moisturises the leather, keeps it supple and
er has a certain sensitivity to grease and dirt, able to breathe. A protective film will also
General information
etc. so a degree of care is required in every- form.
Our range of leathers is large. The main type day use and when looking after the leather. ● Clean the leather every 2 to 3 months and
used is particularly nappa in various forms, Dark clothing (especially if damp or incorrect- remove fresh dirt as soon as possible.
that is, leather with a smooth surface in dif- ly dyed) may stain leather upholstery on the ● Remove stains from fresh ball-pen and oth-
ferent colours. seats. Dust and grit in the pores and seams er inks, lipstick, shoe cream and similar
The amount of dye used determines the ap- can scratch and damage the surface. There- stains as soon as possible.
pearance and properties of leather. If the fore leather should be cleaned at regular in-
● Preserve the colour of the leather. A special
leather is left in a more natural state, it re- tervals, depending on the actual amount of
coloured cream will renew the colour of the
tains its typical natural napped appearance use. When they have been in use for a certain leather when required and will eliminate dif-
and confers excellent all-weather properties time, your car seats will acquire a typical and ferences in colour.
to the seats. Fine veins, healed scars, insect unmistakable patina. This is characteristic for
bites, wrinkles and a subtle variation in shad- leather as a natural product and is a sign of
genuine quality.

290
Care and maintenance

Cleaning and care of leather uphols- – Treat fat-based, dried-in stains with grease- CAUTION

Technical data
tery dissolving spray.
On no account use solvents (such as petrol,
– Treat less common stains on leather, such turpentine), wax polish, shoe cream or simi-
Natural leather requires an extra degree of at- as ball-pen and other inks, felt-tip pens, lar materials.
tention and care. nail polish, dispersion paint, shoe cream
etc. with a special leather stain remover.
Normal cleaning
Cleaning Alcantara upholstery
– Moisten a cotton or woollen cloth with wa- Leather maintenance

Advice
ter and wipe over the leather surfaces. – The leather should be treated regularly Removing dust and dirt
(about twice a year) with a special leather- – Moisten a cloth just a little and wipe down
More stubborn dirt care product. the seat covers.
– More stubborn dirt can be removed using a
– Apply these products very sparingly.
mild soap solution (pure liquid soap: two Removing stains
tablespoons dissolved in one litre of wa- – Then wipe off with a soft cloth.

Operation
– Moisten a cloth with lukewarm water or di-
ter).
Should you have questions regarding the luted white spirits.
– Do not let the water soak through the leath- care and cleaning of the leather upholstery in
– Dab at the stain. Start at the outside and
er or penetrate into the seams. your vehicle, we recommend that you contact
work inwards.
– Then wipe off with a soft, dry cloth. your SEAT Official Service. Our representa-
tives will be happy to advise you and tell you – Dry the clean area with a soft cloth.

Emergencies
about the product range for leather conserva-
Removal of stains Do not use leather cleaning products on Al-
tion, for example:
– Remove fresh water-based stains such as cantara seat covers.
coffee, tea, juices, blood etc. with an ab- ● Cleaning and care set.
You may use a suitable soap on dust and dirt.
sorbent cloth or kitchen roll, or use the ● Coloured leather-care cream.
cleaning agent from the care set for dried- Dust and grit in the pores and seams can
● Stain remover for ball-pen inks, shoe cream scratch and damage the surface. If the car is
on stains.
etc. left standing in the sun for long periods, Al-
– Remove fresh grease-based stains that

Safety
● Grease dissolving spray. cantara leather should be protected against
have not penetrated the surface such as direct sunlight to prevent it from fading. How-
● New products and further developments
butter, mayonnaise, chocolate, etc. with an ever, slight colour variations will arise in nor-
absorbent cloth or kitchen roll or with the mal use. »
cleaning agent from the care set.

291
Advice

CAUTION the belt in question must be replaced by a Checking and refilling levels
● Do not use solvents, wax polish, shoe
specialised workshop.
cream, stain removers, leather cleaning prod- Filling the tank
ucts or any similar products on Alcantara.
● To avoid damage, stubborn stains should Refuelling
be removed by a specialised workshop.
● On no account use brushes, hard sponges Read the additional information carefully
or similar utensils. ›››  page 56
If the automatic filler nozzle is operated cor-
rectly, it will switch itself off as soon as the
Seat belts fuel tank is “full”. Do not try to put in more
fuel after the nozzle cuts out, as this will fill
– Keep the seat belts clean. the expansion chamber in the fuel tank.
– For cleaning, use a mild solution of soap The correct fuel grade for your vehicle is giv-
and water. en on a sticker on the inside of the fuel tank
– Check the condition of the seat belts at reg- flap. Further notes on fuel can be found at
ular intervals. ››› page 293.
The capacity of your vehicle's fuel tank is giv-
The retract function may not operate properly
en in ›››  page 56.
in very dirty belts. Make sure that the inertia
reel seat belts are completely dry before al-
WARNING
lowing them to retract.
Fuel is highly flammable and can cause seri-
CAUTION ous burns and other injuries.
● Do not remove the seat belts from the vehi- ● When refuelling, turn off the engine, the
cle to clean them. auxiliary heater ››› page 177 and turn off the
ignition for safety reasons.
● Do not use chemical cleaning agents on the
seat belts, as this can damage the webbing. ● Do not smoke when filling the fuel tank or a
Ensure that the seat belts do not come into canister. Naked flames are forbidden in the
contact with corrosive fluids. vicinity due to the risk of explosion.
● If you find any damage to the belt webbing,
belt fittings, the belt retractor or the buckle,
292
Checking and refilling levels

● Observe legislation governing the use, CAUTION Note

Technical data
storage and carrying of a spare fuel canister ● If any fuel is spilt onto the vehicle, it Diesel vehicles are fitted with a protective de-
in the vehicle.
should be removed immediately. It could oth- vice that prevents the insertion of the wrong
● For safety reasons we do not recommend erwise damage the paintwork. fuel hose1). It is only possible to refuel with
carrying a spare fuel canister in the vehicle. ● Never run the tank completely dry. An irreg- Diesel nozzles.
In an accident the canister could be damaged
ular fuel supply could cause misfiring. As a ● If the pump nozzle is worn, damaged, or if
and could leak.
result, unburnt fuel could enter the exhaust it is very small, it is possible that it will not
● If, in exceptional circumstances, you have system and damage the catalytic converter. be able to open the protective device. Before
to carry a spare fuel canister, please observe

Advice
● When filling the fuel tank after having run it trying to insert the pump nozzle by turning it,
the following points: try a different pump or request specialist
completely dry on a vehicle with a diesel en-
– Never fill fuel into the spare fuel canister gine, the ignition must be switched on for at help.
if it is inside or on top of the vehicle. An least 30 seconds before starting the engine. ● If you fill the tank from a reserve fuel canis-
electrostatic charge could build up during When you then start the engine it may take ter, the protective device will not open. One
filling, causing the fuel vapour to ignite. longer than normal (up to one minute) to way to resolve this is to pour the fuel in very
Danger of explosion. Always place the start firing. This is because air needs to be slowly.

Operation
canister on the ground to fill it. bled from the fuel system while starting.
– Insert the filling nozzle as far as possible
into the spare fuel canister. For the sake of the environment
– If the spare fuel canister is made of met- Fuel
Do not overfill the fuel tank, it may cause the
al, the filling nozzle must be in contact
fuel to overflow if it becomes warm.
Types of petrol

Emergencies
with the canister during filling. This
helps prevent an electrostatic charge
building up. Note The correct grade of petrol is listed inside the
– Never spill fuel in the vehicle or in the fuel tank flap.
There is no emergency mechanism for the
luggage compartment. Fuel vapour is ex- manual release of the fuel tank flap. If neces- The vehicle is equipped with a catalytic con-
plosive. Risk of fatal accident! sary, request assistance from specialised per- verter and must only be run on unleaded pet-
sonnel. rol. The petrol must comply with European
Standard EN 228 or German standard DIN

Safety
51626-1 and must be unleaded. You can re-
fuel with a maximum ethanol proportion of »

1) Depending on country
293
Advice

10 % (E10). The types of petrol are differenti- Petrol additives metal additives. Using them may damage the
ated by their octane rating (RON). The quality of the fuel influences the behav- engine!
The following titles appear on the corre- iour, power and service life of the engine. ● Never refuel with fuels containing a large
sponding adhesive on the fuel tank flap: This is why the petrol you use should carry proportion of ethanol (for example, E50, E85).
suitable additives already included by the This could damage the fuel system.
Super unleaded 95 octane or normal 91 oc- petrol industry, free of metals. These addi- ● Just filling one full tank of leaded fuel or
tane unleaded petrol tives will help to prevent corrosion, keep the fuel containing other metal additives would
fuel system clean and prevent deposits from seriously impair the efficiency of the catalytic
We recommend you use super 95 octane pet- converter.
building up in the engine.
rol. If this is not available: normal 91 octane
● Only use fuel additives that have been ap-
petrol, with a slight decrease in power. If good-quality petrol with metal-free addi-
tives is not available or engine problems proved by SEAT. Octane boosting or anti-
knock additives may contain metal additives
Super unleaded petrol with a minimum of 95 arise, the necessary additives must be added
that could seriously damage the engine or
octanes when refuelling ››› . the catalytic converter. These additives must
You should use super petrol with a minimum Not all petrol additives have been shown to not be used.
of 95 octanes. be effective. The use of unsuitable petrol ad- ● High engine speed and full throttle can
ditives may cause significant damage to the damage the engine when using petrol with an
If super is not available, in an emergency you
engine and the catalytic converter. Metal ad- octane rating lower than the correct grade for
may refuel with normal 91 octane petrol. In the engine.
ditives should never be used. Metal additives
this case only use moderate engine speeds
may also be contained in petrol additives for
and a light throttle. Refuel with super as soon
improving anti-detonation ratings or octane Note
as possible.
ratings ››› .
● You may use petrol with a high octane num-
Super unleaded 98 octane or super 95 oc- SEAT recommends “genuine Volkswagen ber than the one recommended for your en-
tane unleaded petrol Group Fuel Additives for petrol engines”. gine.
These additives can be bought at SEAT deal- ● In those countries where unleaded petrol is
We recommend you use super plus 98 octane
ers, where information on how to use them not available, you may refuel with a fuel with
petrol. If this is not available: super 95 oc-
can also be obtained. a low lead content.
tane petrol, with a slight decrease in power.
If super is not available, in an emergency you CAUTION
may refuel with normal 91 octane petrol. In ● Do not refuel if the filler indicates that the Diesel fuel
this case only use moderate engine speeds fuel contains metal. LRP (lead replacement
and a light throttle. Refuel with super as soon petrol) fuels contain high concentrations of Please note the information on the inside of
as possible. the fuel tank flap.
294
Checking and refilling levels

We recommend the use of diesel fuel which ● Do not mix fuel additives, the so-called will appear on the dash panel display

Technical data
complies to European standard EN 590. If “thinners”, petrol or similar additives with ››› page 295. If this information is ignored,
diesel fuel which meets European standard diesel fuel. later on it will not be possible to re-start the
EN 590 is not available, the Cetane number ● If poor-quality diesel fuel is used, it may be engine. If this warning does not appear, it is
(CZ) must, at minimum, be 51. If the engine necessary to drain the fuel filter more fre- not necessary to refill the AdBlue ® tank.
is equipped with a particulate filter, the sul- quently than is specified in the Maintenance AdBlue® is a registered brand of the German
phur content of the fuel must be below 50 Programme. We recommend having this done Association of the Automotive Industry (VDA)
parts per million. by a specialised workshop. If water is allowed
and is also known as AUS32 or DEF (Diesel
to collect in the filter, this can cause engine

Advice
Exhaust Fluid).
Winter-grade diesel performance problems.
Summer fuel becomes thicker in winter and it CAUTION
is more difficult to start the engine. For this Filling the AdBlue® tank excessively can
reason, petrol stations in some countries al- AdBlue® cause damage to the tank.
so offer winter diesel with improved fluidity

Operation
when cold (winter-grade diesel).
Information on AdBlue®
Water in the fuel filter1) Refilling AdBlue®
The consumption of AdBlue® depends on
If your vehicle has a diesel engine and is your personal driving style, the temperature
equipped with a fuel filter with a water sepa- of the system and on the outdoor tempera-
rator, the instrument panel may display the ture when the vehicle is used.

Emergencies
following warning:  Water in the AdBlue® freezes at temperatures of -11°C
fuel filter. If this is the case, take the (+13°F). The system has heating elements
vehicle to a specialised workshop so that that guarantee its operation even at low tem-
they can drain the fuel filter. peratures.
The AdBlue® tank level capacity is approxi-
CAUTION
mately 11 litres.
● The vehicle is not designed for the use of

Safety
FAME fuel (biodiesel). The fuel system would The AdBlue® tank should never be empty. Fig. 238 AdBlue tank cap. »
be damaged if you used biodiesel. When the distance to empty drops below
2400 km, a warning to refill the AdBlue® tank

1) Valid for the market: Algeria.


295
Advice

Operations prior to refilling ● Insert the neck of the bottle in the tank fill- ● Add AdBlue until the nozzle stops for the
Park the vehicle on a flat surface. If the vehi- er neck vertically and screw the bottle on by first time.
cle is not parked on a flat surface, but, for ex- hand, by turning it in a clockwise direction. ● Close the SCR tube by turning it clockwise
ample, on a slope or on the side of a curb, ● Press the refill bottle in the direction of the until you hear a click.
the level indicator may not detect the load filler neck and hold it in this position.
properly. ● Wait until the contents of the refill bottle WARNING

If a warning message about AdBlue®


levels have been poured into the AdBlue® tank. Do AdBlue® should only be stored in the original
appears on the dash panel display, fill at not compress or break the bottle! container, which should be tightly closed and
least the minimum amount required (approx. ● Turn the bottle in a counter-clockwise direc- kept in a safe place.
5 litres). Only after adding this amount will tion and gently pull it upwards ››› . ● Never keep AdBlue® in empty food contain-
the system detect that AdBlue® has been ers, bottles or other similar containers. Other
● The AdBlue®tank is full when no more liq- people may confuse it for other products.
added and you will be able to start the en- uid comes out of the bottle.
gine again. The maximum amount that can ● Keep AdBlue® out of the reach of children.
● Screw on the tank cap in a clockwise direc-
be refilled is 11 litres.
tion until it is tightly closed.
Switch the ignition off. If the ignition is not CAUTION
● Close the fuel tank flap.
switched off during refilling, the warning to ● When refilling, the nozzle grip should be
refill may continue to appear on the instru- aligned downward. Otherwise the nozzle will
Operations before driving
ment panel display. not connect automatically.
● After refilling the tank, only switch on the
● Do not try to add any more additive after
Fill with a refill bottle ignition. the nozzle has stopped for the first time. The
Only use AdBlue® that complies with ISO ● Leave the ignition on for at least 30 sec- AdBlue tank could overflow and AdBlue could
22241-1. Only use original containers. onds for the system to detect the fluid load. spill out.
● Make sure you wait for at least 30 seconds ● Only use AdBlue® that complies with ISO
● Open the tank cover ››› Fig. 238. 22241-1. Only use original containers.
before starting the engine!
● Unscrew the tank cap by turning it in an an- ● Never mix AdBlue® with water, fuel or addi-
ti-clockwise direction. Refilling the dispenser with AdBlue tives. Any type of damage caused by such a
● Please observe the manufacturer's instruc- mixture will not be covered by the warranty.
Valid for vehicles with selective catalytic re-
tions, indicated on the refill bottle. ● Never pour AdBlue® into the fuel tank. This
duction.
could result in engine damage.
● Check the expiry date.
● Open the tank cap. ● Do not carry the refill bottle inside the vehi-
● Remove the cap of the refill bottle.
● Turn the SCR tank cap anti-clockwise cle. If there is a leak (due to temperature
››› Fig. 238.
296
Checking and refilling levels

changes or damage to the bottle), the

Technical data
AdBlue® may damage the vehicle.

For the sake of the environment


Dispose of the refill bottle in an environment-
friendly manner.

Note

Advice
You can buy refill bottles that are adequate
for AdBlue® use at SEAT dealerships.

Operation
Emergencies
Safety
297
Advice

Engine compartment
Checking levels

Fig. 239 Diagram for the location of the various


elements.

From time to time, the levels of the different The checking and refilling of service fluids Working in the engine compartment
fluids in the vehicle must be checked. Never are carried out on the components men-
fill with incorrect fluids, otherwise serious tioned above. These operations are descri- Read the additional information carefully
damage to the engine may be caused. bed in ››› page 298. ›››  page 17
1 Coolant expansion tank Always be aware of the danger of injury and
Overview scalding as well as the risk of accident or fire
2 Engine oil dipstick You will find further explanations, instruc- when working in the engine compartment
3 Engine oil filler cap tions and restrictions on the technical speci- (e.g. when checking and refilling fluids). Al-
4 Brake fluid reservoir fications as of ››› page 317. ways observe the warnings listed below and
follow all general safety precautions. The en-
5 Vehicle battery (underneath the cover)
gine compartment of the vehicle is a poten-
6 Windscreen washer reservoir tially hazardous area ››› .

298
Checking and refilling levels

WARNING alternator, radiator fan) and the high voltage Opening the bonnet

Technical data
● Switch the engine off, remove the key from
ignition system are an additional hazard.
● Observe the following additional warnings
Read the additional information carefully
the ignition and apply the hand brake. If the
if work on the fuel system or the electrical ›››  page 17
vehicle has a manual gearbox, place the lever
in neutral; if it has an automatic gearbox, system is necessary: The bonnet is released from inside the vehi-
place the selector lever in position P. Wait for – Always disconnect the battery from the cle.
the engine to cool down. on-board network.
Check that the windscreen wiper arms are
● Keep children away from the engine com- – Do not smoke. not unfolded. Otherwise the paint may be

Advice
partment.
– Never work near naked flames. damaged.
● Never spill liquids used for vehicle opera-
– Always keep an approved fire extinguish- The bonnet can only be unlocked when the
tion on the engine compartment, as these
er immediately available. driver door is open.
may catch fire (e.g. the antifreeze in coolant).
● Take care not to cause short circuits in the
electrical system, especially when working CAUTION WARNING

Operation
on the battery. When topping up fluids make sure the correct Never open the bonnet if you see steam or
● If working inside the engine compartment, fluid is put into the correct filler opening, oth- drips of coolant being released from the en-
remember that, even when the ignition is erwise this can cause serious malfunctions or gine compartment. Failure to comply could
switched off, the radiator fan may start up au- engine damage. result in burns. Wait until no steam or coolant
tomatically, and therefore there is a risk of in- can be seen before opening the bonnet.
jury. For the sake of the environment

Emergencies
● Never cover the engine with additional in-
Inspect the ground underneath your vehicle
sulating materials such as a blanket. Risk of
regularly so that any leaks are detected at an Closing the bonnet
fire!
early stage. If you find spots of oil or other
● Do not unscrew the cap on the coolant ex- fluids in the area where it was parked, have – Slightly lift the bonnet.
pansion tank when the engine is hot. The your vehicle inspected at the workshop. – Release the bonnet stay before pressing it
cooling system is under pressure.
back into its support.
● Protect face, hands and arms by covering
Note – Carefully close the bonnet.
the cap with a large, thick rag to protect

Safety
against escaping coolant and steam. In right-hand drive vehicles* some brake flu-
– Press the bonnet down until it locks into
● If it is necessary to work in the engine com- id reservoirs are on the other side of the en-
gine compartment ››› Fig. 239.
place.
partment while the engine is running, the ro-
tating components (for example, poly-V belt, – Make sure that the bonnet catches onto its
clasp. Do not press down too hard ››› . »
299
Advice

WARNING We recommend that the oil change indicated ● Only in exceptional circumstances, if the
in the Maintenance Programme, be per- engine oil level is too low ››› page 301,
● For safety reasons the bonnet must always
formed by a technical service or specialised Checking engine oil level and LongLife oil is
be completely closed when the vehicle is
workshop. not available, it is permitted to top up (once)
moving. Therefore, after closing the bonnet,
always check that the locking element is
with oil for fixed service intervals
The correct oil specifications for your engine
properly engaged. This is the case if the bon- are listed in the ›››  page 58, Engine oil
›››  page 58 (up to a maximum of 0.5 li-
net is flush with the adjacent body panels. tres).
specifications.
● Should you notice that the bonnet is not
safely secured when the vehicle is moving, Fixed service intervals*
Service intervals
stop the vehicle immediately and close the If your vehicle does not have the “LongLife
bonnet. Failure to follow this instruction Service intervals can be flexible (LongLife
service interval” or it has been disabled (by
could result in an accident. service) or fixed (dependent on time/dis-
request), you may use oils for fixed service
tance travelled).
intervals, which also appear in
If the PR code that appears on the back of the ›››  page 58, Engine oil specifications. In
Maintenance Programme booklet is PR QI6, this case, your vehicle must be serviced after
Engine oil this means that your vehicle has the LongLife a fixed interval of 1 year/15,000 km (10,000
service programmed. If it lists the codes QI1, miles)(whatever comes first) ››› Booklet
General notes QI2, QI3, QI4 or QI7, the interval service is Maintenance Programme.
dependent on time/distance travelled.
The engine comes with a special, multi-grade ● In exceptional circumstances, if the engine
oil that can be used all year round. Flexible service intervals (LongLife service oil level is too low ››› page 301, Checking en-
Because the use of high-quality oil is essen- intervals*) gine oil level and you cannot obtain the oil
tial for the correct operation of the engine specified for your vehicle, you can add a
Special oils and processes have been devel- small quantity of oil conforming to the speci-
and its long useful life, when topping up or oped which, depending on the characteris-
changing oil, use only those oils that comply fication ACEA A2 or ACEA A3 (petrol engines)
tics and individual driving profiles, enable or ACEA B3 or ACEA B4 (diesel engines) (up
with VW standards. the extension of the oil change service (Long- to 0.5 l).
The specifications (VW standards) set out in Life service intervals).
the following page should appear on the con- Because this oil is essential for extending the Vehicles with diesel particulate filter*
tainer of the service oil; when the container service intervals, it must only be used ob- The Maintenance Programme states whether
displays the specific standards for petrol and serving the following indications: your vehicle is fitted with a diesel particulate
diesel engines together, it means that the oil
● Avoid mixing it with oil for fixed service in- filter.
can be used for both types of engines.
tervals.
300
Checking and refilling levels

Only VW 507 00 engine oil, with reduced ash The engine oil dipstick indicates the level of CAUTION

Technical data
formation, may be used in diesel engines the oil.
equipped with particulate filter. Using other If the oil level is above area A , do not start
the engine. This could result in damage to the
types of oil will cause a higher soot concen- Checking oil level
engine and catalytic converter. Contact a
tration and reduce the life of the DPF. There- – Park the vehicle in a horizontal position. Technical Service.
fore:
– Briefly run the engine at idle speed until
● Avoid mixing this oil with other engine oils. the operating temperature is reached and
● Only in exceptional circumstances, if the then stop. Topping up engine oil 

Advice
engine oil level is too low ››› page 301, – Wait for about two minutes.
Checking engine oil level and you cannot ob-
tain the oil specified for your vehicle, you can – Pull out the dipstick. Wipe the dipstick with
use a small quantity of oil (once) conforming a clean cloth and insert it again, pushing it
to the VW 506 00, VW 506 01, VW 505 00, in as far as it will go.
VW 505 01 or ACEA B3/ACEA B4 specification – Then pull it out once more and check the oil

Operation
(up to 0.5 l). level ››› Fig. 240. Top up with engine oil if
necessary.

Checking engine oil level Depending on how you drive and the condi-
tions in which the vehicle is used, oil con-
sumption can be up to 0.5 l/1000 km. Oil Fig. 241 In the engine compartment: Engine

Emergencies
consumption is likely to be higher for the first oil filler cap.
5,000 km. For this reason the engine oil level
must be checked at regular intervals, prefera- Read the additional information carefully
bly when filling the tank and before a jour- ›››  page 57
ney. Before opening the bonnet, read and observe
the warnings ››› in Working in the engine
WARNING compartment on page 299.

Safety
Any work carried out in the engine compart-
ment or on the engine must be carried out The position of the oil filler opening is shown
Fig. 240 Engine oil dipstick. cautiously. in the corresponding engine compartment il-
● When working in the engine compartment, lustration ››› page 298.
Read the additional information carefully always observe the safety warnings Engine oil specification ›››  page 58. »
›››  page 57 ››› page 298.
301
Advice

WARNING We recommend that you have the engine oil For the sake of the environment
changed by a Technical Service.
Oil is highly inflammable! Ensure that no oil ● Because of disposal problems and the spe-
comes into contact with hot engine compo- The oil change intervals are shown in the cial tools and specialist knowledge required,
nents when topping up. Maintenance Programme. we recommend that you have the engine oil
and filter changed by a Technical Service.
CAUTION WARNING ● Never pour oil down drains or into the
Only change the engine oil yourself if you ground.
If the oil level is above area ››› Fig. 240 A , do
not start the engine. This could result in dam- have the specialist knowledge required! ● Use a suitable container when draining the
age to the engine and catalytic converter. ● Before opening the bonnet, read and ob- used oil. It must be large enough to hold all
Contact a specialised workshop. serve the warnings ››› page 298. the engine oil.
● Wait for the engine to cool down. Hot oil
For the sake of the environment may cause burn injuries.

The oil level must never be above area


● Wear eye protection to avoid injuries, such Cooling system
as acid burns, caused by splashes of oil.
››› Fig. 240 A . Otherwise oil can be drawn in
through the crankcase breather and escape ● When removing the oil drain plug with your Topping up coolant
into the atmosphere via the exhaust system. fingers, keep your arm horizontal to help pre-
vent oil from running down your arm. Read the additional information carefully
Note
● Wash your skin thoroughly if it comes into ›››  page 58
contact with engine oil.
Before a long trip, we recommend finding an Top up coolant when the level is below the
● Engine oil is poisonous! Used oil must be
engine oil that conforms to the correspond- MIN (minimum) mark.
stored in a safe place out of the reach of chil-
ing VW specifications and recommend keep-
dren.
ing it in the vehicle. This way, the correct en- Checking coolant level
gine oil will always be available for a top-up if
– Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
needed. CAUTION
No additives should be used with engine oil. – Switch the ignition off.
This could result in engine damage. Any dam- – Read off the coolant level on coolant ex-
Changing engine oil age caused by the use of such additives pansion tank. When the engine is cold, the
would not be covered by the factory warranty. coolant level should be between the marks.
Read the additional information carefully When the engine is hot, it may be slightly
›››  page 57. above the upper mark.
The engine oil must be changed at the inter-
vals given in the service schedule.
302
Checking and refilling levels

Topping up coolant ● The antifreeze and coolant fluid can be a CAUTION

Technical data
– Wait for the engine to cool down. health hazard. Therefore, the antifreeze
The original additives should never be mixed
should be stored in the original container in a
– Cover the coolant expansion tank cap with with coolants which are not approved by
safe place out of reach of children. Failure to
a cloth and carefully unscrew it to the left SEAT. Otherwise, you run the risk of causing
comply could result in poisoning.
severe damage to the engine and the engine
››› . ● If working inside the engine compartment, cooling system.
– Top up the coolant only if there is still cool- remember that, even when the ignition is ● If the fluid in the expansion tank is not pur-
ant in the expansion tank, otherwise you switched off, the radiator fan may start up au-
ple but is, for example, brown, this indicates
could damage the engine. If there is no tomatically, and therefore there is a risk of in-

Advice
that the G13 additive has been mixed with an
coolant in the expansion tank, do not con- jury.
inadequate coolant. The coolant must be
tinue driving. You should obtain professio- changed as soon as possible if this is the
nal assistance ››› . WARNING case! This could result in serious faults and
engine damage.
– If there is still some coolant in the expan- If there is not enough anti-freeze in the cool-
sion tank, top up to the upper mark. ant system, the engine may fail leading to se-

Operation
rious damage. For the sake of the environment
– Top up with coolant until the level becomes
● Please make sure that the percentage of Coolants and additives can contaminate the
stable. additive is correct with respect to the lowest environment. If any fluids are spilled, they
– Screw the cap back on correctly. expected ambient temperature in the zone in should be collected and correctly disposed
which the vehicle is to be used. of, with respect to the environment.
Any loss of coolant fluid normally indicates a ● When the outside temperature is very low,

Emergencies
leak in the cooling system. Take the vehicle the coolant could freeze and the vehicle
straight to a specialised workshop to have would be immobilised. In this case, the heat-
the cooling system examined. If there are no ing would not work either and inadequately Brake fluid
leaks in the engine cooling system, a loss of dressed passengers could die of cold.
coolant can only occur if the coolant boils Top up brake fluid
and is forced out of the system as a result of CAUTION
overheating. Read the additional information carefully
Do not top up the expansion tank with cool- ›››  page 59

Safety
WARNING ant fluid if it is empty! Air could enter the
cooling system. In this case, stop driving.
● The cooling system is under pressure. Do Seek specialist assistance. Otherwise, there Checking the brake fluid level
not unscrew the cap on the coolant expan- is a risk of engine damage. The brake fluid level must be between the
sion tank when the engine is hot: risk of MIN and MAX markings. »
burns!

303
Advice

However, if the brake fluid level goes down Windscreen washer reservoir proportion of mixture in the washer fluid
noticeably in a short time, or drops below the tank.
MIN mark, there may be a leak in the brake
Checking and topping up the wind-
system. Seek specialist assistance. A warn- Capacity
ing light on the instrument panel display screen washer reservoir
The reservoir holds approximately 3 litres in
monitors the brake fluid level ››› page 119.
Read the additional information carefully versions without headlight washer and 5 li-
In right-hand drive vehicles the brake fluid ›››  page 59 tres in versions with headlight washer.
reservoir is on the other side of the engine
Check the water level in the windscreen
compartment. WARNING
washer reservoir regularly and top up as re-
quired. If the water from the windscreen washer does
Changing brake fluid not contain enough anti-freeze, it may freeze
The container for the windscreen washer con- on the windscreen and rear window, reducing
The regular intervals at which the brake fluid
tains the cleaning fluid for the windscreen, forward and rear visibility.
should be replaced are listed in the Mainte-
the rear window and the headlight washer ● In winter, ensure the windscreen washer
nance Programme. We recommend you have
system*. contains enough anti-freeze.
it replaced at a SEAT Official Service, during
an Inspection Service. ● Open the bonnet  ››› page 298. ● In cold conditions, you should not use the
windscreen wiper system unless you have
● The windscreen washer reservoir is marked
WARNING warmed the windscreen with the ventilation
with the symbol  on the cap. system. The antifreeze could freeze on the
● Brake fluid should be stored in the closed
● Check there is enough windscreen water in windscreen and reduce visibility.
original container in a safe place out of reach
of children. Risk of poisoning! the reservoir.
● If the brake fluid is left in the system for WARNING
Recommended windscreen wipers
too long and the brakes are subjected to Never mix an unsuitable antifreeze or other
heavy use, vapour bubbles may form in the ● For the hottest seasons we recommend similar additives with the windscreen washer
brake system. This would seriously affect the summer G 052 184 A1 for clear glass. Propor- water. A greasy layer may be formed on the
efficiency of the brakes and the safety of the tions of the mixture in the washer fluid tank: windscreen which will impair visibility.
vehicle. This may cause an accident. 1:100 (1 part concentrate per 100 parts wa- ● Use clean water with a window cleaner rec-
ter). ommended by SEAT.
CAUTION ● All year round, G 052 164 A2 for clear ● If necessary, add a suitable antifreeze to
Brake fluid should not come into contact with glass. Approximate proportion of the winter the water in the reservoir.
the vehicle paintwork, as it is abrasive. mixture, up to -18°C (0°F): 1:2 (1 part con-
centrate per 2 parts water); otherwise, a 1:4

304
Checking and refilling levels

CAUTION connected, some of the vehicle's functions Winter conditions

Technical data
are “lost” (››› table on page 305). These During the winter, the starting power may be
● Do not mix cleaning products recommen-
functions will require resetting after the bat- reduced, and if necessary, the battery should
ded by SEAT with other products. This could
tery is reconnected. be charged ››› in Important safety warn-
lead to flocculation and may block the wind-
screen washer jets. Deactivate the anti-theft alarm* before you ings for handling a vehicle battery on
● When topping up service fluids, make abso- disconnect the battery Otherwise the alarm page 306
lutely certain that you fill the fluids into the will be triggered.
correct reservoirs. Using the wrong fluids

Advice
could cause serious malfunctions and engine Function Reprogramming Important safety warnings for han-
damage! dling a vehicle battery
● Not having windscreen wiper fluid reduces
One-touch function of ››› page 141, One-touch
the electric windows opening and closing.
visibility through the windscreen, and leads All work on batteries requires specialist
to loss of visibility in headlights in models If the vehicle does not re- knowledge. Please refer to a SEAT Official
with headlight washer. spond to the key, they Service or a workshop specialising in batter-
Remote control key
should be synchronised

Operation
ies: risk of burns or exploding battery!
››› page 134.
The battery must not be opened. Never try to
Digital clock ››› page 116.
Battery change the fluid level of the battery. Other-
After driving for a few me- wise explosive gas is released from the bat-
General information ESC warning lamp tres, the warning lamp goes tery that could cause an explosion.
out again.

Emergencies
Read the additional information carefully  Wear eye protection.
›››  page 59. If the vehicle is not used for long periods
 Battery acid is very corrosive and caustic. Wear
The battery is located in the engine compart- The vehicle has a system for monitoring the protective gloves and eye protection. In the event
ment and is almost maintenance-free. It is current consumption when the engine is left of electrolyte splashes, rinse off with plenty of
checked as part of the Inspection Service. unused for long periods of time ››› page 203. water.

Nevertheless, check the terminals are clean Some functions, such as the interior lights, or
the remote door opening, may be temporarily
 Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking are pro-
and have the correct tightening torque, espe- hibited.

Safety
cially in summer and winter. disabled to prevent the battery from running
flat. These functions will come back on as  The battery should only be charged in a well-ven-
tilated zone. Risk of explosion!
Disconnecting the battery soon as the ignition is switched on and the
The battery should only be disconnected in
engine started.  Keep children away from acid and batteries! »
exceptional cases. When the battery is dis-
305
Advice

WARNING – Note the warnings ››› in Important safety WARNING


warnings for handling a vehicle battery on
● When repairing or working on the electrical Never charge a battery that has frozen: re-
page 306 and ››› .
system, proceed as follows: place battery! Failure to do so may lead to an
– 1. Remove the key from the ignition. The – Switch off all electrical devices. Remove the explosion.
negative cable on the battery must be ignition key.
disconnected. – Raise the bonnet ››› page 299. Note
– 2. When the repair is finished, reconnect
– Open the battery cover. Use only the terminals in the engine compart-
the negative pole of the battery. ment to charge the battery.
● Switch off all electrical devices before re- – Connect the charger clamps as described
connecting the battery. Reconnect first the to the positive pole of the battery (+) and
positive cable and then the negative cable. exclusively to an earth on the bodywork
Never reverse the polarity of the connections. (–). Replacing the battery
This could cause an electrical fire.
– Only use a charger which is compatible for The new battery should have the same speci-
● Ensure that the vent hose is always connec-
use with 12 V nominal voltage batteries. fications (amperage, load and voltage) as the
ted to the battery.
The charge must not exceed a voltage of 15 used battery.
● Never use damaged batteries. This could
V.
cause an explosion! Replace a damaged bat- Your vehicle is equipped with an intelligent
tery immediately. – Now connect the battery charger to the power management system to control the
power socket and switch on. distribution of electrical energy ››› page 203.
CAUTION – After charging the battery: switch off the
The power management function ensures
that the battery is charged much more effi-
● Never disconnect the battery if the ignition battery charger and disconnect the power
ciently than on vehicles without a power
is switched on or if the engine is running. socket cable.
management system. To maintain this func-
This could damage the electrical system or – Finally disconnect the charger cables from tion after replacing the battery, we recom-
electronic components. the battery. mend that the replacement battery used is of
– Replace the battery cover correctly. the same make and type as the original fitted
battery. To make proper use of the power
Charging the battery – Close the bonnet ››› page 299. management function after the battery has
been changed, have the battery coded to the
Terminals for charging the battery are fitted Important: Before you charge the battery
power management mode at a specialised
in the engine compartment. make sure you read the manufacturer's in-
workshop.
structions for using the battery charger.

306
Wheels

CAUTION Wheels driving carefully and at moderate speeds for

Technical data
about the first 500 km (300 miles). This will
● Some vehicles, for example those with the
also increase the useful life of the tyres.
Start-Stop system* are fitted with a special Wheels and tyres
battery (AGM-type or EFB-type battery). If any The tread depth of new tyres may vary, ac-
other type of battery is fitted, the Start-Stop cording to the type and make of tyre and the
function may be considerably reduced and General notes
tread pattern.
the vehicle may not stop on repeated occa-
sions. – When driving with new tyres, be especially
careful during the first 500 km (300 miles). Concealed damage

Advice
● Make sure that the vent hose is always at-
Damage to tyres and rims is often not readily
tached to the original opening on the side of – If you have to drive over a kerb or similar
the battery. Gases or battery acid can other- visible. If you notice unusual vibration or the
obstacle, drive very slowly and as near as
wise escape and possibly cause damage. car pulling to one side, this may indicate that
possible at a right angle to the obstacle.
one of the tyres is damaged. Reduce speed
● The battery holder and clamps must always
– Check from time to time if the tyres are immediately if there is any reason to suspect
be correctly secured.
damaged (punctures, cuts, cracks or that damage may have occurred. Inspect the

Operation
● Before starting any work on the battery, al- dents). Remove any foreign objects embed- tyres for damage. If no external damage is
ways observe the warnings listed under ded in the treads. visible, drive slowly and carefully to the near-
››› page 305, Important safety warnings for est specialised workshop and have the car
handling a vehicle battery. – Damaged wheels and tyres must be re-
placed immediately. inspected.
● Do not forget to replace the battery cover-
ings, where applicable. It is a protection for – Keep grease, oil and fuel off the tyres. Tyres with directional tread pattern

Emergencies
high temperatures. This in turn extends the
vehicle service life. – Replace any missing valve caps as soon as An arrow on the tyre sidewall indicates the di-
possible. rection of rotation on single drive tyres. Al-
– Mark the wheels before taking them off so
ways note the direction of rotation indicated
For the sake of the environment
that they rotate in the same direction when when mounting the wheel. This guarantees
 Batteries contain toxic substances includ- optimum grip and helps to avoid aquaplan-
ing sulphuric acid and lead. They must be put back.
ing, excessive noise and wear.
disposed of appropriately and must not be – When removed, the wheels or tyres should
disposed of with ordinary household waste.

Safety
be stored in a cool, dry and preferably dark Retrofitting accessories
Make sure disconnected batteries cannot tip place.
over. Sulphuric acid could be spilt! If you wish to change or fit wheels, rims or
New tyres wheel trims, we recommend that you consult
with a SEAT Official Service centre for advice
New tyres do not give maximum grip straight
regarding current techniques.
away and should therefore be “run in” by
307
Advice

Service life of tyres ● In vehicles with a tyre pressure indicator, flated to the highest pressure required for the
save the modified pressure of tyres road wheels.
››› page 311, ››› page 308. In the case of a minimised temporary spare
● Avoid fast cornering and hard acceleration. wheel (125/70 R18) inflate to a pressure of
● Inspect the tyres for irregular wear from 4.2 bar as indicated on the tyre pressure la-
time to time. bel ››› Fig. 242.

The useful life of your tyres depends on the Driving style


following factors:
Fast cornering, heavy acceleration and hard
braking (squealing tyres) all increase tyre
Tyre pressure
wear.
The tyre inflation pressures are listed on a
sticker on the rear of the front left door frame Wheel balance
››› Fig. 242.
The wheels on new vehicles are balanced.
Insufficient or excessive pressure greatly re- However, certain circumstances may lead to
duces the useful life of the tyres and adverse- imbalance (run-out), which is detected as vi-
ly affects vehicle performance and ride. Cor- brations in the steering wheel.
rect inflation pressures are very important,
Fig. 242 Location of the tyre pressure sticker. especially at high speeds. Unbalanced wheels should be rebalanced, as
they otherwise cause excessive wear on
Correct inflation pressures and sensible driv- Depending on the vehicle, tyre pressure can steering, suspension and tyres. A wheel must
ing habits will increase the useful life of your be adjusted to medium load to improve driv- also be rebalanced when a new tyre is fitted
tyres. ing comfort (tyre pressure ). When driving or if a tyre is repaired.
with comfort tyre pressure fuel consumption
● Check tyre pressure at least once a month, may increase slightly. Incorrect wheel alignment
and also prior to any long trip.
The tyre pressure must be adjusted according Incorrect running gear alignment causes ex-
● The tyre pressure should only be checked to the load the vehicle is carrying. If the vehi- cessive tyre wear, impairing the safety of the
when the tyres are cold. Do not reduce the cle is going to carry the maximum load, the vehicle. If you notice excessive tyre wear, you
pressure of warm tyres. tyre pressure should be increased to the max- should check wheel alignment at a SEAT Offi-
● Adjust tyre pressure to the load being car- imum value indicated on the sticker cial Service.
ried by the vehicle. ››› Fig. 242.
Do not forget the spare wheel when checking
the tyre pressures: Keep this spare wheel in-
308
Wheels

WARNING The original tyres on your vehicle have Interchanging tyres

Technical data
1.6 mm high “tread wear indicators” running
● Always adapt the tyre pressure accordingly
across the tread. Depending on the manufac-
when the vehicle load changes.
turer, there will be 6 to 8 of them spaced at
● A tyre with low air pressure has to flex a lot equal distances around the tyre. Markings on
more when the vehicle is heavily loaded or at the tyre sidewall (for instance the letters
high speeds, therefore causing overheating “TWI” or a triangle) indicate the positions of
to occur. Under these conditions, the tyre
the tread wear indicators.
bead may be released or the tyre may burst.

Advice
Risk of accident! The minimum tread depth required by law is
1.6 mm (measured in the tread grooves next
For the sake of the environment to the tread wear indicators). (Different fig-
ures may apply in other countries.)
Under-inflated tyres will increase fuel con- Fig. 244 Interchanging tyres.
sumption. WARNING
To ensure that the wear is equal on all tyres

Operation
The tyres must be replaced at the latest when
the wheels should be changed round from
the tread is worn down to the tread wear indi-
Wear indicators cators. Failure to follow this instruction could
time to time according to the system
result in an accident. ››› Fig. 244. The useful life of all the tyres will
then be about the same time.
● Especially in difficult driving conditions
such as wet or icy roads. It is important that

Emergencies
the tyre tread be as deep as possible and be
approximately the same on the tyres of both New tyres or new wheels
the front and the rear axles.
● The scant driving safety due to insufficient – All four wheels must be fitted with tyres of
tread depth is particularly evident in vehicle the same type, size (rolling circumference)
handling, when there is a risk of “aquaplan- and preferably the same tread pattern.
ing” in deep puddles of water and when driv- – Tyres should be replaced at least in pairs
ing through corners, and braking is also ad- and not individually (i.e. both front tyres or

Safety
Fig. 243 Tyre tread: tread wear indicators versely affected.
both rear tyres together).
● The speed has to be adapted accordingly,
Tread wear indicators indicate if a tyre is otherwise there is a risk of losing control over – Do not use tyres whose effective size ex-
worn. the vehicle. ceeds the dimensions of the factory-ap-
proved makes of tyre. »
309
Advice

– If you wish to fit the vehicle with rims or 95 Load rating code decide to fit a different type of tyre, you must
tyres different to those installed in manu- obtain the appropriate manufacturer's certif-
facture, it is advisable to consult a SEAT Of- V Speed index icate from the tyre retailer to confirm that
ficial Service before purchasing them. the tyres are suitable for your vehicle. Keep
The manufacturing date is also indicated on this certificate in a safe place.
The tyres and wheel rims are an essential the tyre sidewall (possibly only on the outer
part of the vehicle's design. The tyres and part): Your SEAT Official Service will be able to ad-
rims approved by SEAT are specially matched vise you on which tyres may be fitted to your
DOT... 2216... vehicle.
to the characteristics of the vehicle and make
a major contribution to good roadholding it means, for example, that the tyre was man- It is best to have all servicing of wheels and
and safe handling ››› . ufactured in the 22nd week of 2016. tyres performed by a specialised workshop.
The sizes of the rims and tyres approved for But note that with some types of tyre, the ac- They are familiar with the procedure and
your vehicle are listed in the vehicle docu- tual tyre size can differ from the nominal size have the necessary special tools and spare
mentation (e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity or marked on the tyre (for instance 215/60 R16 parts as well as the proper facilities for dis-
COC document1)). The vehicle documentation 95 V), and there may be significant differen- posing of the old tyres respecting the envi-
varies depending on the country of resi- ces in the contours of the tyres, even though ronment.
dence. the tyres are marked with the same nominal
size. When replacing the tyres, it is therefore WARNING
A knowledge of tyre designations makes it
important to make sure that the actual size ● It is very important to ensure that the tyres
easier to choose the correct tyres. The follow-
of the new tyres does not exceed the dimen- you have chosen have adequate clearance.
ing wording can be read on the sides of the
sions of the factory-approved makes of tyre. When selecting replacement tyres, do not re-
tyre:
ly entirely on the nominal tyre size marked on
Failure to observe this requirement can af- the tyre, since the effective tyre size can dif-
215/60 R16 95V
fect the clearance needed for the tyres. If the fer significantly depending on the manufac-
This contains the following information: tyres rub against the bodywork, in certain turer. Inadequate tyre clearance can result in
circumstances the tyres, running gear or damage to the tyres or the vehicle, causing a
215 Tyre width in mm bodywork and pipes may be damaged, and serious safety risk. Risk of accident! It may
vehicle safety could be severely impaired also invalidate the vehicle's registration for
60 Height/width ratio in %
››› . use on public roads.
R Tyre construction: Radial
If you use tyres that are approved by SEAT
16 Rim diameter in inches you can be sure that the actual tyre dimen-
sions will be correct for your vehicle. If you

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


310
Wheels

● Avoid running the vehicle on tyres that are the right length and correctly shaped bolt ● Regularly check your tyres for damage and

Technical data
more than 6 years old. If you have no alterna- heads. This ensures that wheels are fitted se- wear.
tive, you should drive slowly and with extra curely and that the brake system functions ● Never exceed the maximum permitted
care at all times. correctly. speed or loads specified for the type of tyre
● If wheel trims are fitted after the car is pur- The wheel bolts must be clean and turn easi- fitted on your vehicle.
chased, ensure that there is an adequate flow ly.
of air for cooling the brake system.
A special adapter is required to turn the anti- For the sake of the environment
theft wheel bolts* ›››  page 65. Under-inflated tyres lead to increased fuel

Advice
For the sake of the environment
consumption and tyre wear.
Old tyres must be disposed of according to
the laws in the country concerned.
Tyre monitoring systems Note
● Driving for the first time with new tyres at a
Note
Introduction high speed can cause them to slightly ex-

Operation
● A SEAT Service Centre should be consulted pand, which could then produce an air pres-
to find out whether wheels or tyres of differ- sure warning.
WARNING
ent sizes to those originally fitted by SEAT ● Only replace used tyres with those author-
can be fitted, and to find out about the com- Unsuitable handling of the wheels and tyres ised by SEAT for the corresponding type vehi-
binations allowed between the front axle may lead to sudden tyre pressure losses, to cle.
(axle 1) and the rear axle (axle 2). tread separation or even to a blow-out.
● Do not only rely on the tyre monitoring sys-

Emergencies
● Never mount used tyres if you are not sure ● Check tyre pressures regularly and ensure tem. Regularly check your tyres to ensure
of their “previous history”. they are maintained at the pressures indica- that the tyre pressure is correct and that the
● For technical reasons, it is not generally ted. Tyre pressure that is too low could cause tyres are not damaged due to puncture, cuts,
possible to use the wheels from other vehi- overheating, resulting in tread detachment or tears and impacts/dents. Remove objects
cles. In some cases, this may also be true for even burst tyres. from the tyres only when they have not
the same model of wheel. ● Tyre pressure should be that indicated on pierced the tyres.
the label when the tyres are cold at all times
››› page 319.

Safety
Wheel bolts ● Regularly check the cold inflation pressure
of the tyres. If necessary, change the tyre
The wheel bolts are matched to the rims. pressure of the vehicle tyres while they are
When installing different wheels (for instance cold.
alloy wheels or wheels with winter tyres) it is
important to use the correct wheel bolts with
311
Advice

Tyre monitoring control lamp control of the vehicle and a serious or fatal ● Tyre pressures which are too high or too
accident. low reduce the useful life of the tyre, affect-
If a light appears ● If the warning lamp  lights up, stop im- ing vehicle performance.
The pressure in one or more tyres has mediately and check the tyres. ● If a tyre has not been punctured and it does
clearly reduced in comparison to the ● If the tyres are inflated at different pres- not have to be changed immediately, drive to
 tyre pressure set by the driver or the sures or if a tyre pressure is too low, this will the nearest specialised workshop at a moder-
increase tyre wear, negatively affecting vehi- ate speed and have the tyre checked and in-
tyre has structural damage. flated to the correct pressure.
cle stability and increasing braking distan-
Additionally, an audible warning can be heard and a text ces.
message can be seen on the instrument panel display. ● If tyres are inflated at different pressures or WARNING
Stop! Reduce speed immediately! Stop the vehicle
a tyre pressure is too low, a tyre may be dam- Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
safely as soon as possible. Avoid sudden manoeuvres
and braking! Check all tyres and pressures. Replace any aged and burst resulting in a loss of control and control lamps on page 119.
damaged tyres. of the vehicle.
● The driver is responsible for ensuring that
all of the vehicle tyres are correctly inflated Note
If flashing
to the right pressure. The recommended tyre ● If excessively low tyre pressure is detected
 System malfunction pressure is indicated on the label with the ignition on, an audible warning will
››› page 319. sound. In the event that there is a fault in the
The control lamp flashes for approximately one minute ● The tyre monitoring system can only oper- system, an audible warning will sound.
and then lights up permanently.
ate correctly if all of the tyres are inflated to ● Driving on dirt tracks for a long period of
If tyre pressure is correct, switch the ignition off and on
again. If the control lamp remains lit up, the tyre moni- the correct pressure when cold. time or driving in a sporty style can tempora-
toring indicator can be calibrated. Have the system ● Driving with tyres at the wrong pressure rily deactivate the TPMS. The control lamp
checked by a specialised workshop. can damage them and result in an accident. shows a fault, but disappears when road con-
Ensure that the tyre pressures of all the tyres ditions or the driving style change.
Several warning and control lamps light up correspond to the vehicle load.
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- ● Before starting a journey, always inflate
ed on while the function is verified. They will tyres to the correct pressure.
switch off after a few seconds. ● Tyres with insufficient pressure are subjec-
ted to more flexing. Due to this, the tyre
WARNING could become excessively hot, causing tread
When the tyres are inflated at different pres- separation and also tyre blow-out.
sures or at a pressure that is too low then a ● With an overloaded vehicle at high speed,
tyre may be damaged resulting in a loss of the tyres can overheat and burst resulting in
a loss of vehicle control.
312
Wheels

Tyre monitoring indicator Wheel tread change cator must be recalibrated. Do the same, for

Technical data
The wheel tread changes when: example, when the front and rear wheels are
swapped.
● Tyre pressure is manually changed
● Switch the ignition on.
● Tyre pressure is insufficient
● Store the new tyre pressure in the Easy
● Tyre structure is damaged
Connect1) system with the  button and the
● The vehicle is unbalanced because of a SETTINGS function button ›››  page 33.
load ● In vehicles without radio: press and hold

Advice
● The wheels on an axle are subject to a down the   button with the ignition on,
heavier load (e.g. with a heavy load). until an acoustic signal is heard.
● The vehicle is fitted with snow chains When driving, the system self-calibrates the
Fig. 245 Instrument panel: warning of loss of
● The temporary spare wheel is fitted tyre pressure provided by the driver and the
tyre pressure.
● The wheel on one axle is changed wheels fitted. After a long journey with varied

Operation
speeds the programmed values are collected
The tyre monitor indicator compares wheel
There may be a delay in the reaction of the and monitored.
revolutions and, with this information, the
tread of each wheel using the ABS sensors. If tyre  monitoring indicator or it may not in- With the wheels under very heavy loads, the
the rolling circumference of one or more dicate anything under certain circumstances tyre pressure must be increased to the total
wheels has changed, the tyre monitoring in- (e.g. sporty driving, snow-covered or un- recommended tyre pressure before the cali-
dicator will indicate this on the instrument paved roads, or when driving with snow bration ››› page 319.

Emergencies
panel through a warning lamp and a warning chains).
to the driver ››› Fig. 245. When only one spe- Note
cific tyre is affected, its position within the ● The tyre monitoring indicator does not
vehicle will be indicated. Calibrating the tyre monitoring indica- function when there is a fault in the ESC or
 Loss of pressure: Check left
tor ABS ››› page 189. »
tyre pressure!
After changing the tyre pressure or replacing

Safety
one or more wheels, the tyre monitoring indi-

1) In vehicles that are not equipped with the Easy

Connect system, the switch for adjusting tyre pres-


sure is located in the centre console next to the haz-
ard warning lights.
313
Advice

● An erroneous indication may be given when reason, do not use a temporary spare wheel ● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
snow chains are in use because they increase from a different type of vehicle. fast cornering: risk of accident!
the tread of the wheel. ● Never use more than one temporary spare
Removing the temporary spare wheel wheel at the same time, risk of accident.
– Lift and hold up the floor panel to remove ● No other type of tyre (normal summer or
the temporary spare wheel. winter tyre) may be fitted on the compact
Temporary spare wheel temporary spare wheel rim.
– Turn the thumb wheel anti-clockwise
››› Fig. 246. ● If you are driving using the spare wheel,
General information the ACC system could automatically switch
– Take out the temporary spare wheel. off during the journey. Switch off the system
when starting off.
Chains
For technical reasons, snow chains must not
be used on the temporary spare wheel. Extraction of the spare wheel in vehi-
If you have a puncture on one of the front cles with SEAT SOUND 10 speakers
wheels when using snow chains, fit the tem- (with subwoofer)*
porary spare wheel in place of one of the rear
wheels. Fit the snow chains on the rear wheel
that you have removed and replace the punc-
tured front wheel with this wheel.

Fig. 246 Compact temporary spare wheel: WARNING


raised floor panel. ● After fitting the temporary spare wheel,
check the tyre pressures as soon as possible.
The temporary spare wheel has been de- Failure to do so may cause an accident. The
signed to be used for short periods of time. tyre pressure is listed on the back of the left
Have the tyres checked and replaced as soon front door frame ››› Fig. 242.
as possible at a SEAT Official Service or at a ● Do not drive at over 80 km/h (50 mph)
specialised workshop. when the temporary spare wheel is fitted on
Please note the following restrictions when the vehicle: risk of accident! Fig. 247 In the luggage compartment: re-
● Never travel more than 200 km using a tem- move the subwoofer.
using the compact temporary spare wheel.
The compact temporary spare wheel is de- porary spare wheel.
signed specifically for this model. For this
314
Wheels

To remove the spare wheel, you must first re- – Only use winter tyres that are approved for Winter tyres lose a great deal of their proper-

Technical data
move the subwoofer. your vehicle. ties when the tread is worn down to a depth
of 4 mm.
● Lift and secure the luggage compartment – Please note that the maximum permissible
floor as described in ››› page 168. speed for winter tyres may be lower than The performance of winter tyres is also se-
for summer tyres. verely impaired by ageing, even if the tread is
● Disconnect the subwoofer ››› Fig. 247 1
still much deeper than 4 mm.
speaker cable. – Also note that winter tyres are no longer ef-
● Turn the securing wheel in an anti-clock- fective when the tread is worn down. Winter tyres are subject to the following max-
wise direction ››› Fig. 247 2 . imum speed limits according to speed rating
– After fitting the wheels you must always

Advice
code letter: ›››
● Remove the subwoofer speaker and the check the tyre pressures. When doing so,
spare wheel. take into account the correct tyre pressures
Speed rating
● When re-mounting the spare tyre, place the
listed on the rear of the front left door
code letter Maximum speed limit
frame ››› page 308.
subwoofer on the base of the wheel rim with ››› page 309
care. When doing so, the tip of the “FRONT” In winter road conditions winter tyres will

Operation
arrow on the subwoofer should point for- Q 160 km/h (100 mph)
considerably improve vehicle handling. The
ward. design of summer tyres (width, rubber com- S 180 km/h (112 mph)
● Reconnect the speaker cable and firmly ro- pound, tread pattern) gives less grip on ice
T 190 km/h (118 mph)
tate the securing wheel clockwise so that the and snow. This applies particularly to vehi-
subwoofer system and wheel are firmly in cles equipped with wide section tyres or with H 210 km/h (130 mph)
place. high speed tyres (code letters H, V or Y on

Emergencies
the sidewall). 240 km/h (149 mph) (please note
V
relevant restrictions)
Only use winter tyres of the correct type ap-
W 270 km/h (168 mph)
Winter service proved for your vehicle. The sizes of these
tyres are specified in the vehicle's docu- Y 300 km/h (186 mph)
ments (e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity or
Winter tyres
COC1)). The vehicle documentation varies de- Vehicles capable of exceeding these speeds
– Winter tyres must be fitted on all four pending on the country of residence. See al- must have an appropriate sticker attached so

Safety
wheels. so ››› page 309. that it is visible to the driver. Suitable stickers
are available from the SEAT Official Service »

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


315
Advice

and specialised workshop. Please note the


regulations to this effect in your country.
“All-weather” tyres can also be used instead
of winter tyres.
Using winter tyres with V-rating
Please note that the generally applicable
240 km/h (149 mph) speed for winter tyres
with the letter V is subject to technical re-
strictions; the maximum permissible speed
for your vehicle may be significantly lower.
The maximum speed limit for these tyres de-
pends directly on the maximum axle weights
for your car and on the listed weight rating of
the tyres being used.
It is best to contact a SEAT Official Service to
check the maximum speed which is permissi-
ble for the V-rated tyres fitted on your car on
the basis of this information.

WARNING
Exceeding the maximum speed permitted for
the winter tyres fitted on your car can cause
tyre failure, resulting in a loss of control of
the vehicle – risk of accident.

For the sake of the environment


Summer tyres should be fitted again as soon
as possible after the winter period; they give
better handling on roads which are free of
snow and ice. Summer tyres perform with
less rolling noise, tyre wear and – most im-
portant – reduce fuel consumption.
316
Technical specifications

Technical data Abbreviations used in the Technical Specifi-

Technical data
cations section
kW Kilowatt, engine power measurement.
Technical specifications
Pferdestärke (horsepower), formerly used
PS
to denote engine power.
Important
rpm Revolutions per minute - engine speed.
The information in the vehicle documentation
always takes precedence over the informa- Nm Newton metres, unit of engine torque.

Advice
tion in this Instruction Manual. Cetane number, indication of the diesel
CZ Fig. 249 Chassis number.
All technical specifications provided in this combustion power.
documentation are valid for the standard Research octane number, indication of
RON VIN in the Easy Connect
model in Spain. The vehicle data card inclu- the knock resistance of petrol.
ded in the Maintenance Programme or the ● Select:  button > SETTINGS function

Operation
vehicle registration documents shows which button > Service > Chassis number.
engine is installed in the vehicle.
Vehicle identification data Chassis number
The figures may be different depending
whether additional equipment is fitted, for The VIN is located in the Easy Connect, on the
different models, for special vehicles and for vehicle data sticker and under the wind-
other countries. screen, on the driver side ››› Fig. 249. Also

Emergencies
the VIN is located in the engine compart-
ment, on the left-hand side in the direction of
travel. The number is engraved on the top
side rail, and is partially covered.

Type plate
The type plate is located on the right side

Safety
door pillar. Vehicles for certain export coun-
tries do not have a type plate. »

Fig. 248 Vehicle data sticker (luggage com-


partment).
317
Technical data

Vehicle data sticker Information on fuel consump- Weights


The vehicle data sticker is under the carpet tion
trim in the luggage compartment, in the Kerb weight refers to the basic model with a
spare wheel well. A sticker with the vehicle fuel tank filled to 90% capacity and without
data is attached to the inside cover of the
Fuel consumption optional extras. The figure quoted includes
Maintenance Programme. 75 kg to allow for the weight of the driver.
Approved consumption values are derived
The following information is provided on the from measurements performed or supervised Special versions, optional equipment fittings
vehicle data sticker: ››› Fig. 248 by certified EU laboratories, according to the or retro-fitting accessories will increase the
legislation in force at the time (for more infor- weight of the vehicle ››› .
1 Vehicle identification number (chassis mation, see the Publications Office of the Eu-
number) ropean Union on the EUR-Lex website: © Eu- WARNING
2 Vehicle type, model, capacity, engine ropean Union, http://eur-lex.europa.eu/) and ● Please note that the centre of gravity may
type, finish, engine power and gearbox apply to the specified vehicle characteristics. shift when transporting heavy objects; this
type may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
The values relating to fuel consumption and cident. Always adjust your speed and driving
3 Engine code, gearbox code, external CO2 emissions can be found in the documen- style to suit road conditions and require-
paint code and internal equipment code tation provided to the purchaser of the vehi- ments.
4 Optional extras and PR numbers cle at the time of purchase. ● Never exceed the gross axle weight rating
Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions depend or the gross vehicle weight rating. If the per-
Identifying letters on the equipment/features of each individual missible axle load or the permissible total
vehicle, as well as on the driving style, road weight is exceeded, the driving characteris-
The identifying letters of the engine can be
conditions, traffic conditions, environmental tics of the vehicle may change, which could
viewed on the instrument panel when the en-
lead to accidents, injuries and damage to the
gine is switched off and the ignition is on. conditions, load or number of passengers.
vehicle.
● Hold down the button 0.0/SET on the dash Note
panel for more than 15 seconds.
In practice, and considering all the factors
mentioned here, consumption values can dif-
fer from those calculated in the current Euro-
pean regulations.

318
Technical specifications

Trailer mode WARNING 215/60 R16 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm

Technical data
● For safety reasons, you should not drive at 215/55 R17 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
Trailer weights speeds above 80 km/h (50 mph) when towing
a trailer. This also applies in countries where 215/50 R18 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
Trailer weight higher speeds are permitted.
Other dimensions do not allow chains
The trailer weights and drawbar loads ap- ● Never exceed the maximum trailer weights
proved are selected in intensive trials accord- or the drawbar load. If the permissible axle
load or the permissible total weight is excee- Wheel bolts
ing to precisely defined criteria. The ap-

Advice
proved trailer weights are valid for vehicles in ded, the driving characteristics of the vehicle After the wheels have been changed, the
the EU for maximum speeds of 80 km/h (50 may change, leading to accidents, injuries tightening torque of the wheel bolts should
and damage to the vehicle. be checked as soon as possible with a torque
mph) (in certain circumstances up to 100
km/h (62 mph)). The figures may be different wrench ››› . The tightening torque for steel
in other countries. All data in the official vehi- and alloy wheels is 140 Nm.
cle documentation takes precedence over Wheels

Operation
these data at all times ››› . WARNING
● Check the tyre pressure at least once per
Tyre pressure, snow chains and wheel
Drawbar loads month. Checking the tyre pressure is very im-
bolts portant. If the tyre pressure is too high or too
The maximum permitted drawbar load on the
low, there is an increased danger of accidents
ball joint of the towing bracket must not ex- Tyre pressure - particularly at high speeds.
ceed 88 kg.

Emergencies
The sticker with the tyre pressure values can ● If the tightening torque of the wheel bolts
In the interest of road safety, we recommend be found on the back of the left front door is too low, they could loosen while the vehi-
that you always tow approaching the maxi- frame. The tyre pressure values given there cle is in motion. Risk of accident! If the tight-
mum drawbar load. The response of the trail- are for cold tyres. The slightly raised pres- ening torque is too high, the wheel bolts and
er on the road will be poor, if the drawbar sures of warm tyres must not be reduced. threads can be damaged.
load is too small. ›››
If the maximum permissible drawbar load The pressure for winter tyres is 0.2 bar Note

Safety
cannot be met (e.g. with small, empty and (2.9 psi / 20 kPa) higher than that of summer We recommend that you ask your Technical
light-weight single axle trailers or tandem tyres. Service for information about appropriate
axle trailers with a wheelbase of less than 1 wheel, tyre and snow chain size.
metre), a minimum of 4% of the actual trailer Snow chains
weight is legally required for the drawbar
Snow chains may be fitted only to the front
load.
wheels, and only for the following tyres:
319
Technical data

Engine data
Petrol engine 1.0 85 kW (115 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
85 (115)/5,000-5,500 200/2,000-3,500 3/999 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights


Top speed (km/h) 183 (5)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.2

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 11.0

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,830

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,280

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 940

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 940

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 640

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,500

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,300

320
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 1.4 110 kW (150 CV) Start-Stop ACT ®

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
110 (150)/5,000-6,000 250/1,500-3,500 4/1,395 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights 2WD Manual 2WD Automatic 4WD Manual 4WD Automatic

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 201 (5) 198 (6) 192 (5) 189 (5)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.9 6.0 6.0 5.9

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8.5 8.6 9.0 8.9

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,900 1,920 2,000 2,010

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,359 1,375 1,460 1,476

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 970 990 1,000 1,010

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 980 980 1,050 1,050

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 670 680 730 730

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,850 1,800 1,950 1,950

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,800 1,600 1,900 1,900

Safety
321
Technical data

Petrol engine 2.0 140 kW (190 PS) Start-Stop

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
140 (190)/4,200-6,000 320/1,450-4,200 4/1,984 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights 4WD


Top speed (km/h) 212(5)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.2

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.9

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 2,080

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,536

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,070

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 1,060

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 750

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 2,000

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,900

322
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 1.6 85 kW (115 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
85 (115)/3,250-4,000 250/1,500-3,250 4/1,598
51 CZ

Outputs and weights

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 184 (6)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 8.2

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 11.5

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,910

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,375

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,030

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 930

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 680

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500

Safety
323
Technical data

Diesel engine 2.0 105 kW (143 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
105 (143)/3,500-4,000 320/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CZ

Outputs and weights Automatic


Top speed (km/h) 192 (5)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.4

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.2

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,970

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,435

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,080

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 940

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 710

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,900

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,800

324
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 2.0 110 kW (150 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
110 (150)/3,500-4,000 340/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CZ

Outputs and weights 2WD Manual 2WD Automatic 4WD

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 201 (6) 200 (6) 196 (6)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.2 5.9 6.0

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8.8 8.7 9.0

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,990 2,010 2,100

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,453 1,483 1,548

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,060 1,090 1,080

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 940 930 1,070

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 700 720 750

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,900 1,900 2,000

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,900 1,900 2,000

Safety
325
Technical data

Diesel engine 2.0 140 kW (190 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
140 (190)/3,500-4,000 400/1,750-3,250 4/1,968
51 CZ

Outputs and weights 4WD Automatic


Top speed (km/h) 212 (6)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 4.7

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.5

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 2,130

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,589

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,120

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 1,060

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 750

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 8% (kg) 2,100

Weight of trailer with brakes on gradients up to 12% (kg) 2,100

326
Technical specifications

Dimensions

Technical data
Advice
Operation
Fig. 250 Dimensions.

Emergencies
Safety
Fig. 251 Angles and ground clearance »

327
Technical data

››› Fig. 250, ››› Fig. 251 2WD 4WD


A Front projection (mm) 868 868

B Rear projection (mm) 857 865

C Wheelbase (mm) 2,638 2,630

D Length (mm) 4,363

E Fronta) track (mm) 1,576 1,572

F Backa) track (mm) 1,541 1,544

G Width (mm) 1,841

1,601b) 1,611b)
H Height at kerb weight (mm)
1,615c) 1,625c)

I Ground clearance between the axles (mm) 176 189

J Front projection angle limited by the bumper maximum 19.4° maximum 20.6°

K Rear projection angle limited by the bumper maximum 27.9° maximum 25.5°

Turning radius (m) 10.8


a) This data will change depending on the type of wheel rim.
b) Distance to the roof.
c) Dimension to the roof bars.

328
Index

Index Adjustment
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125, 134
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow pro-
A rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 tection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
ABS Airbag covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Anti-theft security system . . . . . . . . . . 15, 125, 133
see Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Anti-theft system
ACC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 84 Anti-tow protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162, 284 activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Anti-trap function
Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 sun blind (sunroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
function for preventing overtaking in an inside deactivation of front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
lane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Area view system (Top View Camera)
indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 86 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 functioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Aspects to note before setting off . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Assistance systems
special driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 knee airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 ACC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
warning and control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Adaptive Cruise Control Air conditioning Auto Hold function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
deactivating temporarily . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 auxiliary heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 blind spot detector (BSD) with parking assis-
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 170 tance (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
AdBlue heated windscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 cruise control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
maximum filling capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 emergency brake assist (Front Assist) . . . . . . . 217
refilling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 user instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 fatigue detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Air outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Hill Descent Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
tank capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 Air recirculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Additional consumers (efficiency program) . . . . . 42 Alcantara: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 parking assistance (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Adjusting Ambient lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 parking system Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Anti-freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Anti-puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 95 Top View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 95 traffic jam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 check after 10 minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 traffic sign detection system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Adjusting the head restraints Anti-puncture set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 tyre monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Anti-slip regulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 tyre monitoring indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
tyre monitoring systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69

329
Index

Audible warning signal


lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
B C
seat belt not fastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Camera
warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 replacement in the remote control (auxiliary cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
heater) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 cleanliness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Auto Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Before setting off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Auto Hold function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Belt tensioners Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Auto Lock (central locking) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 AdBlue tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Automatic car washes
Belt tightening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
switching the Auto Hold function off . . . . . . . . 212
Bench seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 windscreen washer water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Automatic dipped beam control . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Bicycle rack Car-care products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
fitting on the retractable tow hitch . . . . . . . . . 277 Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
downhill speed control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
maximum load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Biodiesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 CCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
emergency program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Blind spot detector (BSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 CD-ROM player (navigation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
kick-down feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Central locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
launch control program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
manual release of the selector lever . . . . . . . . . 49
indication in the external rear view mirror . . . 238 anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
safety interlock for ignition key . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 emergency locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
steering wheel with gear shift paddles . . . . . . 195
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17, 298 Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
tiptronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193, 195
opening the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 Panoramic sliding/tilting sunroof . . . . . . . . . . 140
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 remote control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
AUX-IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Auxiliary heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Central wheel trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
activating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
brake servo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Centre console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
electric consumers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
electronic parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Cetane number (diesel fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
operating instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 dipped beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Braking fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
remote control range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
front assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 main beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
special features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
BSD number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
see Blind spot detector (BSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 rear bulb in the side panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
BSD Plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 rear light in the rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
things to note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
turn signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
subsequent work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
330
Index

Changing gear Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208


engaging gears (manual gearbox) . . . . . . . . . 192 bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 tow hitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Changing settings rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 sun blind (sunroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 tyre monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Changing the blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Controls and displays
Changing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 general instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Clutch (warning lamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Controls for the windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 139
Checking levels Coming Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Controls on the steering wheel
engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298 Coming Home function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 operating the audio, telephone and naviga-
Childproof locks Connectivity Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 tion system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46, 119 Coolant
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 91 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 checking level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
categorisation into groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Cooling
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 90 applying the brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Cooling system
securing with seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 ASR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 checking coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 29 audible warning signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 topping up coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 blind spot detector (BSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Cornering
alcantara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 cruise control system (CCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
carbon parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 depress the brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Correct position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Easy Connect control panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 front passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
fabrics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 emission control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Correct sitting position
leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 rear seat passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
natural leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 engine pre-heating/fault system . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 212
plastic parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288, 289 ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
radio screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Cruise control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
rims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 Hill Descent Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 warning and indication lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46, 48
trims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 instrument panel display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 D
washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Dangers in not using the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Dash panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 parking assistant (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Data sticker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Close refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Deactivating the front passenger front airbag . . . 22
sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 remote control (auxiliary heater) . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Deactivation of front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Defective bulbs
speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
331
Index

Diesel Driver information system Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 139


diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 engine oil temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 convenience opening and closing . . . . . . . . . 140
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 operation through the windscreen wiper lever . 36 Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Driving lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Diesel particulate filter driving through water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 Electronic immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 economical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Electronic self-locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Digital clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Electronic stability control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Electronic torque management (XDS) . . . . . . . . . 190
Direction of rotation Driving abroad Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114, 115 Driving data automatic gearbox emergency program . . . . . 199
Display messages data summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Display of traffic signs on the instrument panel Driving in winter emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Driving mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Disposal Driving on flooded roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Driving profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 manual unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Distance control DSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
see Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Duplicate keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 replacing a blown fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Dust and pollen filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
Door handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Dynamic lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Door release lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 E see Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Doors E10 switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
childproof locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 see Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33, 120 Emergency braking assistance system
Downhill speed control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 Easy Open . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Downhill speed control function . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 things to note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 EDL operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Drink holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 see Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Driver Efficiency program switching off temporarily . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 74, 75, 76 additional consumers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 system limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Driver-side general instrument panel saving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
left-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Electrical accessories Emergency braking warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
right-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 see Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
332
Index

Emergency operation Engine fault Exterior mirrors


front passenger door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Emission control system control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Exterior rear-view mirrors
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57, 300 adjusting the exterior rear-view mirrors . . . . . 155
Emissions data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300, 302 exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Engine checking oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 8
noises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 External aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
running in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 F
Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 Fatigue detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
starting up (driver messages with the mechan- temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
ical contact) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
switching off (key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Environment Fluid Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Engine and ignition ecological driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Fog light bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
automatic ignition switch-off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 environmental compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Four-wheel drive
My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Environmental tips snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
preheating the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 winter tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
starting the engine with Press & Drive . . . . . . 184 Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162, 284 Four wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 ESC Front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 86
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17, 298 electronic stability control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . 189 Front armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 305 Multi-collision brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Front Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 303 Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
closing the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Front passenger front airbag
coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 302 Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57, 301 Exhaust gas purification system deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
opening the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Front seat
safety notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298 diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 manual adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . 59, 304 Exhaust pipe: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56, 293
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Exhaust purification system for vehicles with consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
G 12 plus-plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 diesel engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295 diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
G 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Exiting a parking space with Park Assist . . . . . . 256 ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Exterior lighting fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

333
Index

refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
H Indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
ACT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Fuel consumption Hand brake adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
engine cut-off due to inertia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 see Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 assist systems submenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
why does fuel consumption increase? . . . . . . 204 Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 149 compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Fuel tank cap HDC distance travelled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 see Hill Descent Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 doors, bonnet and rear lid open . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Fuel tank flap Head-on collisions and their laws of physics . . . . 81 driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Head-protection airbags driving data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Full-LED Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Function Leaving Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Emergency brake assist system (Front Assist) 217
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 102 Headlights engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 104 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 MKB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
identifying blown fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
identifying by colours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 headlight washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 recommended gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
preparation before replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 second speed display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116, 193
G rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Gear-change indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Gearbox DSG
front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
see Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Heated rear window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 54 traffic signs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Heated windscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 tyre monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Hill Descent Control warning and information messages . . . . . . . . . 40
kick-down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Infotainment system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
manual gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Gear engaged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
Gear recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Gear shift paddles (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . 195
General instrument panel
I display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114, 115
control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Identifying letters on engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 181 menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298 Ignition lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 181 odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 see Starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 service interval indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Incorrect position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

334
Index

Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Kick-down parking lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150


Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 reading lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
ISOFIX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 28 Knee airbags switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 safety information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
welcome light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
J L Lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64, 95 Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Load compartment in the luggage compartment
mounting points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 cleaning the camera area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 see Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . 162
Journey data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Lane Assist system Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 see Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Loading the vehicle
Launch control (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . 197 fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
K Leather: care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Leaving Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Key-operated switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Lifting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . 164
Keyless-Entry
Light Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Lighting of the instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Locking and unlocking
Keyless-Exit
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 144 in the door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
audible signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Locking the front passenger door manually . . . . . 16
Keyless Access
AUTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Easy Open . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Keyless-Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
coming home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 automatic locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Keyless-Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
cornering lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 electric opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Press & Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
daytime running lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
dipped beam headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 luggage compartment variable floor . . . . . . . . 167
starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 manual release mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
unlocking and locking the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 129
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 net bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Keyless Access locking and ignition system
interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
leaving home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 special characteristics of the electric rear lid . 138
Keys
light control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 storing the rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
assign key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
lighting of instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 see also Loading the luggage compartment . 162
car key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
lighting of the controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Luggage compartment floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
driver messages (mechanical contact) . . . . . . 181
lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Luggage compartment variable floor . . . . . . . . . 167
remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Luggage net
replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
main beam lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
spare key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
main beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
synchronising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 127 motorway light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
335
Index

M Navigation system
CD-ROM player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
in the door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Net bag rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 rear lid with electric opening and closing . . . . 137
Main panel Noises sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
turn signal and main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . 145 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 with the central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300 auxiliary heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Operating malfunction
Malfunction brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 307
diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
emergency braking assistance system (Front
Number of seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 P
Paint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Assist) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
O care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 partial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Paintwork
Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 reset button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Panoramic sliding sunroof
Manual release mechanism Oil change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 convenience opening and closing . . . . . . . . . 140
rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 see also Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Manual unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 On-board computer Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Maximum trailer weight see Driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 automatic braking intervention . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 One-touch opening and closing automatic interruption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
MFD electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 conditions for exiting a parking space . . . . . . 256
see Driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Open and close exiting a parking space (only for parallel
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 spaces) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 operating malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Mobile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 parallel parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Mobile telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 parking conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Model plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 perpendicular parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Multi-collision brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
sun blind (sunroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 see Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Multi-function display (MFD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 stopping prematurely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187, 196
My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 125 with Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
N bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Parking aid
adjusting the display and audible warn-
Natural leather ings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261, 265
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
336
Index

automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 Petrol Rear


driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261, 265 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Rear-view mirror
rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Plastic parts: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288, 289 anti-dazzle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
sensors and camera: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 Polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 interior anti-dazzle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Positioning seat belts Rear Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
visual indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260, 264 during pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 instructions for use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Parking aid system seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257, 262 Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Parking assistance Power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
parking system plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Rear Assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
see Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Rear bulbs in the side panel
surroundings warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Power steering disassemble the rear light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Parking assistance (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 see Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 17
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Pre-heating system see also Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Parking assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Rear lights in the rear lid
Parking assistant (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 disassemble the bulb holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Preheating the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Press & Drive Rear seat backrest
automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 folding down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
automatic release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 folding down and lifting the backrest . . . . . . . 159
emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Puncture lifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Rear seat passengers
Parking distance warning system see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 74, 75, 76
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257, 262 R Rear shelf
Parking (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 Racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
ParkPilot Radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219, 223 Rear View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257, 262 Radio-operated remote control Refuelling
Particulate filter (diesel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 see Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Radio screen: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 opening fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Passenger Radio transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Remote control key
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 74, 75, 76 Rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Passenger-side instrument panel control of the function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Remote control (auxiliary heater) . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
left-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Raising the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
right-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 RCTA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Removing and attaching head restraints . . . . . . 157
Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 see Parking assistance (RCTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Repair work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284

337
Index

Replacement deactivating the front passenger airbag . . . . . . 22 Selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Replacement parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 Safety equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Selector lever (automatic gearbox)
Replacing the battery Safety information malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
of the vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 knee airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 manual release mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Reset the trip recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Safety instructions positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Retaining hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Retrofitting head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Service notification: read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Side airbags
Reverse gear (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . 193 use of seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Revolution counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114, 115 using child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 90 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Rims Safety interlock for ignition key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Saving fuel Sliding panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67, 319
Roll-back function Saving tips (efficiency program) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Seat Spanner symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
RON (petrol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 electric seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Special characteristics
Roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 area view system (Top View Camera) . . . . . . . 268
Roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Seat belt position high-pressure cleaning devices . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Roof load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 for pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98, 99
technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Roof luggage rack Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
attach the cross bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 82 Speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212, 214
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Running in control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 display message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 protective function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 operate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
new engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 84 warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Speed warning device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
unfastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
S Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20, 83 Stabilisation of the towing vehicle and trailer . . 281
Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Safelock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Seat heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Start-Stop system
see also Anti-theft security system . . . . . . . . . 125 Seats driver messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Safety adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 rear seat backrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Selective catalytic reduction starting and stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . 208
see Exhaust purification system (diesel) . . . . 295 switching off and on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210

338
Index

the engine does not switch off . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 System Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Towing
the engine starts by itself . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 blind spot detector (BSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 T special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . . . 164 Towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Tail lights also see Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Steering changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Taking care of your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 electrical unlocking tow hitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
engaging the steering lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 fitting a bicycle rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Steering wheel interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Technical data retrofitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 Towing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68, 98, 99
gear shift paddles (automatic gearbox) . . . . . 195 roof load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Storage area vertical load on the coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Technical modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160, 161 Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 front towing eye . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Textiles: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
glove compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Things to note rear towing eye . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Storing objects towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Tightening torque of wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 things to note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Sun blinds Tiptronic (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . 193, 195 tow bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
anti-trap function (sunroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Top speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 towing not allowed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Top Tether . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 29 with towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Sun protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 29 Towline anchorages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68, 95
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Top View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Tow rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 278
anti-trap function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 see Top View Camera system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Traffic Jam Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Top View Camera system malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Instructions for use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 situations in which Traffic Jam Assist must be
operating malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 switched off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
sun blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Traffic sign detection system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 limited operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Switch Tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Tow-starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Switching off the engine special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
with the key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Tow hitch windscreen damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
Switching off the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Traffic Sign Detection System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Switching on the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 electrical unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 indication on display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Switching the ignition on and off . . . . . . . . 30, 181 Traffic signs
indication on display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
339
Index

Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . 164 Unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
adjusting the headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Trims with Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
anti-theft system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 with the central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
connecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Turn signal convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Upholstery: cleaning
exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 alcantara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
hooking up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Tyre Mobility Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 upholstery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 inflating a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 USB/AUX-IN Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
maximum trailer weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 sealing a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280, 319 Tyre Mobility System V
parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 265 see Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Tyre monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 Vehicle
rear LED lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 278 tyre monitoring indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 chassis number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
rear lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 278 Tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308, 319 data label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
retrofitting a towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 Tyre profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
stabilisation of the towing vehicle and trailer 281 Tyre repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 identification number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
technical requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Tyre repair kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
tow rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275, 278 see also Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 unlocking and locking the vehicle with Keyless
trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
unlocking the electrical unlocking tow hitch . 276 accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Vehicle battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 305
vertical load on the coupling . . . . . . . . . 273, 279 changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Trailer mode dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 charge level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
also see towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 interchanging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
see Driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 connecting and disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Trailer weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 repair kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 disconnect and connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Transporting children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 service life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Transporting items tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 wear indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 winter conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 with compulsory direction of rotation . . . . . . . . 67 Vehicle care
roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 with directional tread pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 natural leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Transporting objects Tyre tread depth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 windscreen wipers service position . . . . . . . . . 71
loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Tyre wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow system 136
net bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
retaining hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 U Vehicle seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Unfastening your seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64, 95
Unfasten the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Ventilation slits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
340
Index

Vertical load on the coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273


Vertical load on the trailer coupling
windscreen and rear window wiper blades
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
X
loading the trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 XDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Windscreen and rear window wiper blades . . . . . 97
W Windscreen washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 153
Warning symbols Windscreen washer water
see Control and warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285 topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Windscreen wiper and rear window wiper sys-
things to note . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 tems
Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Welcome light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Windscreen wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 153
What negatively affects driving safety? . . . . . . . . 73 functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Wheel balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 headlight washer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 heated windscreen washer jets . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
anti-theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 lifting the wiper blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
loosening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 replacing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307, 319 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
central wheel trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 window wiper lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319 Winter conditions
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64, 66 battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
new wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 defrosting the windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
temporary spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Wheel spanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 taking care of your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Wheel trim tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Winter driving
Windows sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
electric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 139 Winter operation
removing ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 headlight washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Window wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 heated windscreen washer jets . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Window wiper blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 salt on the roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Windscreen Winter tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Wireless Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
341
About this manual The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
For the sake of the environment

versions, and is only supplied as op- Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
This manual contains a description of the vant information concerning environmental
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the tional extras for some versions, or are
protection.
time this manual was published. Some of the only offered in certain countries.
units described herein will not be available ® All registered marks are indicated with
Note
until a later date or are only available in cer- ®. Although the copyright symbol does
tain markets. not appear, it is a copyrighted mark. Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
Because this is a general manual for the >> The section is continued on the follow-
ATECA, some of the equipment and functions ing page.
that are described in this manual are not in- This manual is divided into six large parts,
cluded in all types or variants of the model; Important warnings on a given page which are:
they may vary or be modified depending on Detailed contents on a given page 1. The essentials
the technical requirements and on the mar- 2. Safety
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising. General information on a given page
3. Emergencies
The illustrations are intended as a general Emergency information on a given page 4. Operation
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details. 5. Tips
WARNING
The steering indications (left, right, forward, 6. Technical data
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the mation on safety. They warn you about possi- At the end of this manual, there is a detailed SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex- ble dangers of accident or injury. alphabetical index that will help you quickly stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
cept when otherwise indicated. find the information you require. no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
The audiovisual material only is intended to CAUTION All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
help users to understand certain car function- or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
alities better. It does not replace the instruc- Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications. All rights on changes are reserved.

❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.


© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.17
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Ateca
575012720BE
Inglés 575012720BE (11.17)

Ateca Inglés
­­ (11.17)
SEAT recommends SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL Castrol EDGE Professional

S-ar putea să vă placă și